Army Training and Evaluation Program No. 55-819-30-MTP: Mission Training Plan for the Transportation Light & Medium Truck Companies, Motor Transport Battalion

Error message

  • Deprecated function: Return type of DBObject::current() should either be compatible with Iterator::current(): mixed, or the #[\ReturnTypeWillChange] attribute should be used to temporarily suppress the notice in require_once() (line 7 of /usr/home/documentafterliv/public_html/sites/all/modules/contrib/eck/eck.classes.inc).
  • Deprecated function: Return type of DBObject::next() should either be compatible with Iterator::next(): void, or the #[\ReturnTypeWillChange] attribute should be used to temporarily suppress the notice in require_once() (line 7 of /usr/home/documentafterliv/public_html/sites/all/modules/contrib/eck/eck.classes.inc).
  • Deprecated function: Return type of DBObject::key() should either be compatible with Iterator::key(): mixed, or the #[\ReturnTypeWillChange] attribute should be used to temporarily suppress the notice in require_once() (line 7 of /usr/home/documentafterliv/public_html/sites/all/modules/contrib/eck/eck.classes.inc).
  • Deprecated function: Return type of DBObject::valid() should either be compatible with Iterator::valid(): bool, or the #[\ReturnTypeWillChange] attribute should be used to temporarily suppress the notice in require_once() (line 7 of /usr/home/documentafterliv/public_html/sites/all/modules/contrib/eck/eck.classes.inc).
  • Deprecated function: Return type of DBObject::rewind() should either be compatible with Iterator::rewind(): void, or the #[\ReturnTypeWillChange] attribute should be used to temporarily suppress the notice in require_once() (line 7 of /usr/home/documentafterliv/public_html/sites/all/modules/contrib/eck/eck.classes.inc).

Army Manual for Mission Training Plan for Light & Medium Truck Companies, Motor Transport Battalion

Doc_type: 
Other
Doc_date: 
Saturday, February 2, 2002
Doc_rel_date: 
Thursday, December 30, 2004
Doc_text: 

ARTEP 55-718-30-MTP

MISSION TRAINING PLAN
FOR THE
TRANSPORTATION LIGHT, LIGHT-
MEDIUM, AND MEDIUM TRUCK
COMPANIES, TRANSPORTATION
MOTOR TRANSPORT BATTALION

DISTRIBUTION RESTRICTION: Approved for public release; distribution is unlimited.
HEADQUARTERS, DEPARTMENT OF THE ARMY
DODDOA-003678

HEADQUARTERS
ARMY TRAINING ANDM DEPARTMENT OF THE ARMY
EVALUATION PROGRAMM Washington, DC, 2 February 2002
No. 55-718-30-MTPM
MISSION TRAINING PLAN
FOR THE
TRANSPORTATION
LIGHT, LIGHT-MEDIUM, AND MEDIUM TRUCK COMPANIES,
TRANSPORTATION MOTOR TRANSPORT BATTALION

Page
ii
PREFACE 1-1
CHAPTER 1. UNIT TRAINING
2-1
CHAPTER 2. TRAINING MATRIX
CHAPTER 3. MISSION OUTLINE
3-1
CHAPTER 4. TRAINING EXERCISES 4-1 CHAPTER 5. TRAINING AND EVALUATION OUTLINES 5-1 CHAPTER 6. EXTERNAL EVALUATION 6-1 APPENDIX A. COMBINED ARMS TRAINING STRATEGY A-1 APPENDIX B. BATTLEFIELD OPERATING SYSTEMS B-1 GLOSSARY Glossary-1 REFERENCES References-1 QUESTIONNAIRE Questionnaire-1
*This publication supersedes ARTEP 55-717-30-MTP, 1 September 1994.
PREFACE
Unit training is the most important peacetime training. It prepares a unit to accomplish its critical wartime missions. The most difficult job for a unit leader is preparing and conducting unit training. This job must be attacked aggressively and consistently by unit leaders in order to instill a " can do " attitude within their unit and provide challenging training. The ARTEP MTP is the unit leader's basic training document. It will guide him in preparing for the conducting and evaluating of his training. The ARTEP MTP may be used by higher HQ for external evaluation of a unit's training proficiency.
Since modern warfare depends on complex weapon systems which must be supported through extensive logistical channels, effective and timely support is imperative. The unit must be able to anticipate, analyze, and tailor available resources and mission priorities to the changing combat situation. The unit must also be flexible enough to give support from any base cluster and it must be able to survive in order to support the fighting on the battlefield.
The purpose of this MTP is to provide a descriptive, mission-oriented program to be used to train the unit to perform its critical wartime mission. The missions described in the unit MTP will be the principal ones to be executed with a high degree of proficiency. Unless stated in writing by the next higher commander, the unit is expected to train to the missions and standards outlined in this MTP. Task standards can only be changed if they are made more difficult. This MTP is in full alignment with and is part of the USA training doctrine and USA tactical doctrine.
This MTP is designed for the following ARTEPs:

Transportation Light Truck Company (TOE 55718L).


Transportation Light-Medium Truck Company (TOE 55719L).


Transportation Medium Truck Company (TOE 55727L).


Transportation Medium Truck Company (TOE 55728L).

The proponent of this publication is HQ, TRADOC. Submit changes for improving this publication on DA Form 2028 (Recommended Changes to Publications and Blank Forms) and forward it to: Commander, USACASCOM, Training Directorate, ATTN: ATCL-AT, Fort Lee, VA 23801-5000.
Unless otherwise stated, whenever the masculine gender is used, both men and women are included.
DODDOA-003680
ENVIRONMENTAL TRAINING AND INTEGRATION
The US Army environmental strategy into the 21st century defines the Army's leadership commitment and philosophy for meeting present and future environmental challenges. It provides a framework to ensure that environmental stewardship ethic governs all Army activities. As an integral part of all Army missions, the Army's environmental vision is to be a national leader in environmental and natural resource stewardship for present and future generations. The Army's environmental vision statement communicates the Army's commitment to the environment.
Soldiers and leaders are expected to serve as the Army's basic environmental stewards and have a professional and personal responsibility to understand the Army's environmental program.
Soldiers and leaders must understand their specific duties and responsibilities concerning protection of the environment, and comply with environmental laws and regulations. These are delineated in TC 5-400. Commanders must stay current of federal, state, local, and HN laws and must apply whichever are the most stringent.
Stewardship of our environment is part of our mission to maintain a trained and ready Army. Leadership is the key to success. Each leader in the chain of command, including the NCO support channels, is responsible for ensuring that the Army environmental strategy is implemented and that environmental stewardship is an integral part of everything we do. Each soldier, civilian, and family member is a steward of the environment. America's Army shares with all Americans their values of democracy, equal opportunity, and wise use of environmental assets. The American people expect the Army to manage the resources intrusted to it.
iii
ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION AND HAZARD AWARENESS NOTICE
DEATH or serious injury may result if personnel fail to observe safety precautions.
WARNINGS
FUEL FLAMMABLE/NO SMOKING
Fuel is flammable and toxic to eyes, skin, and respiratory tract. Skin/eye protection is required. Avoid repeated/prolonged contact. Use only in well ventilated areas. Keep away from open flames or other sources of ignition. Post FUEL FLAMMABLE/NO SMOKING signs around the area. Suitable fire extinguisher must be present.
Fuel on clothing can be fatal if ignited by a static discharge. If fuel gets on your clothes, leave the refueling area as soon as possible and wet clothes with water before taking them off. In extreme cold conditions, clothes should not be wet; instead, ground yourself to a piece of groundedequipment by taking hold of it before taking off your clothes. Wash skin with warm soapy water.
Spilled fuel creates a flammable, vapor-air mixture and fire can take place. Stop refueling immediately if fuel spill occurs.
FROSTBITE
Touching cold metal with exposed skin will cause skin to bond with metal. Gloves are required when touching cold metal objects. Do not touch cold metal parts with bare hands.
SOLVENT HAZARD
Dry cleaning solvent, P-D 680, Type III, used to clean parts is potentially dangerous to personnel and property. Eye protection is required. Avoid repeated and prolonged skin contact by wearingrubber or nonporous gloves when handling solvents or material wet with dry cleaning solvent. Wash hands wiith soap and water immediately after exposure and use a lanolin based skin cream to prevent skin drying. Do not use near open flame or excessive heat. Flash point of solvent is 138 degrees F. Do not work with solvent in a closed area. Be sure there is good ventilation or the solvent vapors will build up in the air and become a poisonous mixture which can cause physical injury or even death.
ELECTRICAL HIGH VOLTAGE CAN KILL YOU
Electrical high voltage cannot be seen, but it can kill you. Electricity is unlike most otherdangerous things you can come in contact with because it gives no warning and no symptoms; and its effects are immediate. It can kill you, render you unconscious, or severely burn you. To ensure your safety and that of other maintenance personnel, always observe the followingprecautions:
DO NOT perform any maintenance on electrical equipment unless all power isremoved. -
-
BE CERTAIN that there is someone assisting you who can remove powerimmediately.
-
ALWAYS place POWER OFF warning tags on power supply switches so that no onewill apply power while you are performing maintenance.
-
FOR ARTIFICIAL RESPIRATION, refer to FM 21-11.
COMPRESSED AIR HAZARD

Compressed air can blow dust into the eyes. Wear eye protection. Do not exceed 30 psi at the nozzle. FIRST AID instructions are given in FM 21-11.
CARBON MONOXIDE (EXHAUST GAS) CAN KILL YOU
Carbon monoxide is without color or smell, but can kill you. Breathing carbon monoxide produces symptoms of headache, dizziness, loss of muscular control, a sleepy feeling, and coma. Brain damage or death can result from heavy exposure. Carbon monoxide occurs in the exhaust fumes of burning heaters and internal combustion engines. Carbon monoxide can becomedangerously concentrated under conditions of no ventilation. Precautions must be followed to ensure operator's safety when combustion engines are in operation.
OPERATE with the exhaust pipes unobstructed.
-
DO NOT operate the powered module with a known exhaust (combustion air) leak.
-
BE ALERT at all times during operating procedures for carbon monoxide poisoning. If exposure is present, IMMEDIATELY evacuate personnel to fresh air.
-
BE AWARE the field protection mask used for NBC attack WILL NOT protect you from carbon monoxide poisoning.
-
THE BEST DEFENSE AGAINST CARBON MONOXIDE POISONING IS GOOD VENTILATION.
JEWELRY
Jewelry can catch on equipment and cause injury, or may short across an electrical circuit and cause severe burns or electrical shock. Remove rings, bracelets, wristwatches, and neck chains before working around or on the unit.
HOT COMPONENTS
Contact with hot components can cause burns. Allow unit to cool down before attempting service, inspection, or maintenance activity.
STEEL BANDING
Steel banding, cut under tension, can snap free and cause injury. Leather gloves and faceshield are required.
FUEL SPILL
Fuel is toxic and can cause injury to personnel and damage equipment. Improper positioning of external fuel source can cause the internal fuel tank to overflow. Properly position external fuel source.
NOTE

Report all hazards. If at any time you detect a hazard, it is your responsibility to report the hazardto ensure that it is corrected. If you detect a "new" or "suspected new" hazard, particularly due to equipment installation, modification, or repair, it is your responsibility to report through yourchain-of-command to ensure that a SAFETYGRAM is submitted to the US Army Aviation andTroop Command, Safety Office. This will ensure that this hazard will be investigated, publicized, or corrected, as required.
ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION
Environmental damage has many wide-ranging consequences. The complete success of the tactical mission depends on your environmental awareness. Leaders and soldiers must be aware of the ramifications of their actions on the environment, which, in turn, reflects upon the overall mission. Prevention of spills and improper disposal of hazardous materials and hazardous waste is everyone's responsibility. Know the proper procedures for preventing and reporting oil or fuel
spills IAW your local unit SOP.
CHAPTER 1
UNIT TRAINING
1-1. GENERAL. This MTP provides the commander guidance with a tactical and technical training and evaluation document for the unit. It also provides guidance concerning how to train personnel for the key missions of the unit. The specific details of the unit training program will depend on the following factors:
a.
Chain of command training directives and guidance.

b.
Unit training priorities.

c.
Training resources and areas available.

1-2. SUPPORTING MATERIAL. This MTP describes a critical wartime mission-oriented unit training program, which is part of the transportation battalion training program. The unit's training program consists of a unit MTP and includes the following:
a.
STPs for common task training for the appropriate MOS and SLs.

b.
STP 21-II-MQS and manuals for company grade officers.

Figure 1-1 illustrates the relationship of these supporting materials.
TRANSPORTATION
MOTOR TRANSPORT
BATTALION

MISSION TRAINING PLAN
FOR THE
TRANSPORTATION LIGHT, LIGHT-
MEDIUM, AND MEDIUM TRUCK
COMPANIES, TRANSPORTATION
MOTOR TRANSPORT BATTALION
ARTEP 55-718-30-MTP

SOLDIER
QUALIFICATION

MILITARY
TRAINING
STANDARDS

PUBLICATIONS (MQSs)
(STPs)
Figure 1-1. MTP echelon relationship diagram
1-1
DODDOA-003685
1-3. CONTENTS. To provide a complete unit training and evaluation document, this MTP contains six chapters.
a. Chapter 1, Unit Training. This chapter is the foundation for using the MTP. It explains how to use the remaining five chapters for training and evaluating each unit. It also identifies each unit missions and illustrates their relationship to the transportation battalion's
missions.
b.
Chapter 2, Training Matrix. This chapter shows the relationship between missions and collective tasks. Each unit commander uses this training matrix for planning tools for training. •

c.
Chapter 3, Mission Outline. This chapter describes the use of a mission outline and provides a mission for the unit's overall critical wartime mission. The outline shows the relationship of the FTX and its supporting STX.

d.
Chapter 4, Training Exercises. This chapter consists of an FTX and its supporting STXs. These exercises are used to train personnel in the unit's missions and in the supporting tasks. These exercises provide training information and a scenario to give you a pre-constructed, flexible training tool, which supports the training of the unit missions. These exercises may also serve as part of an internal or external evaluation designed to have the unit execute the missions in a tactical setting. These exercises may be modified to suit each unit training needs.

e.
Chapter 5, Training and Evaluation Outlines. This chapter provides the training and evaluation criteria for all the tasks each unit must master to be able to perform its missions. The T&EOs are provided for each task and includes their related standards. Each T&EO is part of a mission and in various combinations they compose the training exercise in Chapter 4.

f.
Chapter 6, External Evaluation. This chapter provides instructions for developing an external evaluation of each unit.

1 4. MISSIONS AND TASKS. This MTP considers two types of missions:
-

Stated missions which are found in the TOE.


Implied missions which must be performed to accomplish the stated missions.

-
-
The relationship of tasks to missions and their training requirements are discussed in paragraphs a
through e.

a. This unit has one critical wartime mission -- provide motor transport services to the US armed forces. There are six supporting missions that support this critical wartime mission. These missions include the following:
1 -2

Deploy unit to a new theater of operations.


Relocate unit to a new operating site.


Establish unit area of operations.


Provide truck transportation.


Defend assigned area.


Redeploy unit to home station.

b.
The critical wartime mission echelon relationship diagram shows the relationship of the missions of the lower echelon unit to those of a higher echelon. The missions of a lower echelon unit must support the missions of a higher echelon unit. Figure 1-2, page 1-5, shows the relationship of the unit missions to the main support battalion missions.

c.
Each unit mission task requires training by the unit. Training for unit tasks may be done individually or with others. In either training situation, the training must be based on the training criteria provided in the T&EOs. Several T&EOs can be grouped and trained as an STX (Chapter 4) and several STXs can be developed into an FTX to train personnel in the unit's critical wartime missions.

d.
Individual STP and MQSs II and HI training, TEWT, battle simulations, and execution of unit missions provide training in leader tasks, which support the unit missions.

e.
Individual tasks that support the unit tasks are mastered through training to standards outlined in the STP. These tasks must be mastered and sustained by all members of the unit.

1-5. TRAINING PRINCIPLES. This MTP is based on the training principles outlined in FM 25-100.
a. Train as Combined Arms and Services Team. Although this MTP addresses only
the company, the company will often train as part of a combined arms team in higher echelon exercises.
b.
Train as You Fight. Units fight as they train. Soldiers remember the last way they performed a task whether it was right or wrong. Soldiers and companies must perform tasks according to established standards, which are rigidly enforced by leaders.

c.
Train Using the Published Army Doctrine. This MTP conforms to published doctrine. Leaders are responsible for knowing current doctrine and training according to doctrine.

d.
Use Performance Oriented Training. Unit's become proficient in the performance of critical tasks and missions by practicing them. Since soldiers learn by doing, the vast majority of a unit's training must involve performing tasks with coaching and critiquing by the leaders and good AARs.

1-3

DODDOA-003687
e.
Train to Challenge. Challenging training builds competence and confidence by developing and sharpening skills. It inspires excellence by fostering initiative, enthusiasm, and eagerness to learn.

f.
Train to Sustain Proficiency. The cornerstone of the ARTEP is the concept of

sustaining proficiency. The unit must be prepared to go to war on short notice. To sustain proficiency, the unit must train—evaluate--train. Sustainment requires practice and repetition. Evaluation of these practices identifies training weaknesses simultaneously. The training plans and smaller training components allow facilitate this process and reduce planning time. Matrixes allow the leader to see training weaknesses in the context of the mission, which will lead to resolution of problems.
g.
Train Using Multiechelon Techniques. Multiechelon training is the most efficient way of training and sustaining a diverse number of mission essential tasks within limited periods of training time. To use available time and resources, commanders must simultaneously train individuals, leaders, and unit at each echelon in the organization during training events.

h.
Train to Maintain. Maintenance training designed to keep equipment in the fight is of equal importance to soldiers as being expert in its use.

i.
Make Commanders the Primary Trainers. Leaders at all levels are responsible for the training of their soldiers. The unit's success on the battlefield will depend on the personal training involvement of the leaders.

1 6. COMBINED ARMS TRAINING STRATEGY. CATS is designed to provide Army
-
leaders a strategy that states the rationale and justification for requesting all Army training resources in both institutions and units. It provides training management guidance for institutional commandants and unit commanders to plan and execute required training to established Army standards. Institutional strategies are prescriptive and define the mandatory training requirements for qualifying soldiers and leaders to specified levels of competency in respective functional specialties. The training program developed and executed by this unit to train to standards in its wartime mission is also a component of CATS. CATS provides the tools that enable the Army to focus and manage training in an integrated manner. The major focus of CATS is a series of proponent-generated unit and institutional strategies that describe the training and resources required to train to standard.
a.
The unit training strategies in CATS provide the commander with a descriptive "menu" for training. While the "menu" may reflect an optional guide for training to standard, it is unlikely that all units will have the exact mix of resources required to execute such a strategy.

b.
This unit's training strategy (see Appendix A) is a descriptive training strategy that provides a means of training this unit to standard by listing required training events, critical training gates, training event frequencies, and training resources. The commander selects from this MTP the tasks required to train his METL. The training strategies provide the means to train these tasks through a focused and integrated training plan.

1 -4
TRANSPORTATION TRANSPORTATION LIGHT, LIGHT-MEDIUM, AND
CRITICAL WARTIME -41- - -MISSION
SUPPORTING MISSIONS
MOTOR TRANSPORT BATTALION
PROVIDE TRANSPORTATION .411 SUPPORT
SUPERVISE DEPLOYMENT
OF SUBORDINATE
ELEMENTS
TO NEW THEATER OF
OPERATIONS

SUPERVISE RELOCATION
OF SUBORDINATE
ELEMENTS AND
SUSTAINMENT RESOURCES

SUPERVISE ESTABLISHMENT
OF SUBORDINATE
ELEMENTS AND
FACILITIES

DIRECT
TRANSPORTATION
SUPPORT

SUPERVISE
FORCE
PROTECTION
ACTIVITIES

SUPERVISE REDEPLOYMENT
OF SUBORDINATE ELEMENTS
TO
HOME STATION

MEDIUM COMPANIES
PROVIDE MOTOR
TRANSPORT SERVICES

DEPLOY UNIT TO A NEW THEATER OF OPERATIONS
RELOCATE UNIT
TO A NEW
OPERATING SITE

ESTABLISH UNIT
AREA OF
OPERATIONS

PROVIDE
TRUCK
TRANSPORTATION

DEFEND ASSIGNED AREA
REDEPOY UNIT
TO HOME STATION

Figure 1-2. Critical wartime mission echelon relationship diagram for the transportation light, light-medium, and medium truck companies to the transportation motor transport battalion
1-5

DODDOA-003689

c. This unit's training strategy has two separate training strategies. When integrated with the training tasks found in the MTP, they form a comprehensive and focused strategy, which permits this unit to train to standard. The elements of this unit's training strategy are as follows:
(1)
CSS unit training strategy. This strategy is intended to provide a set of recommended training frequencies for key training events in a unit and depict those resources, which are required to support training events. CSS unit training strategies must address both technical (mission) and tactical (maneuver/survival) training needs of CSS soldiers and units.

(2)
Soldier strategy. The soldier strategy provides an annual plan for training and maintaining skills at the individual level and lists the resources required to train a soldier.

d.
A critical element in the unit training strategy is the identification of critical training gates. These gates are defined as training events that must be conducted to standard before proceeding to a more difficult or resource-intensive training event or task. Training events follow the crawl, walk, run training methodology. For example, if unit training strategy calls for conducting an FTX, and an STX has been identified as a critical training gate for the FTX, the training tasks contained in the STX must be trained to standard prior to conducting the FTX. Standards must be specific so that a commander can assess the preparedness of his soldiers or unit(s) to proceed to more complex training events. By using training gates, the unit's METL and the commander's assessment of his unit's training status will determine the selection and timing of the collective training exercises in a specific unit's training strategy.

e.
When developing the unit's training plan, the commander identifies tasks from the MTP required to train his METL. He will use the training strategy found in Appendix A to develop a battle-focused training plan that integrates and links METL-derived MTP training tasks with CATS training events.

1-7. CONDUCTING TRAINING. This MTP is designed to facilitate the planning, preparation, and conduct of unit training as explained in FM 25-101.
a.
Based on the battalion's training guidance, the commander will assign the missions or tasks for training. He must plan and execute unit training in support of the battalion commander's guidance.

b.
The unit mission outlined in Chapter 3 must be reviewed to determine whether the FTX provided will support or can be modified to support the battalion commander's guidance. If the matrix in Chapter 2 does not support the guidance or need to be modified, they should be reviewed. This matrix provides a listing of all critical collective tasks, which must be mastered to perform a specific mission. It also shows the collective tasks that must be performed to accomplish an STX.

c.
The tasks required must be prioritized. Training must be oriented toward the greatest challenges and most difficult sustainment skills. The commander and subordinate leaders should analyze and prioritize tasks for training.

1 -6
d. After the training tasks are selected, the commander must incorporate them into the training schedule. The following procedures should be followed:
(1)
List the tasks in the priority and frequency needed to be presented for training.

(2)
Determine the required training time.

(3)
Determine the best procedure for using multiechelon training.

(4)
Determine training location(s).

(5)
Determine training responsibilities.

(6)
Determine time needed for training.

(7)
Determine best training method.

(8)
Determine the resources necessary to train the selected tasks.

1 8. FORCE PROTECTION (SAFETY).

-
a. Safety is a component of force protection. Commanders, leaders, and soldiers use risk assessment/management to tie force protection into the military around the mission. Risk management assigns responsibilities, institutionalizes commander's review of operational safety, and leads to decision-making at a level of command appropriate to the risk. The objective of safety is to help units protect combat power through accident prevention, which enables units to win fast and decisively, with minimum losses. Safety is an integral part of all operations. Safety begins with readiness, which determines a unit's ability to perform its METL to standard. Readiness standards addressed during METL assessment are as follows:
(1)
Soldiers with the self-discipline to consistently perform tasks to standard.

(2)
Leaders who are ready, willing, and able to enforce standards.

(3)
Training that provides skills needed for performance to standard.

(4)
Standards and procedures for task preference that are clear and practical.

(5)
Support for task preference, including required equipment, personnel,
maintenance, facilities, and services.

b.
Risk management is a tool that addresses the root causes (readiness shortcomings) of accidents. It assists commanders and leaders in not only identifying what the next accident is going to be, but it also helps identify who will have the next accident. Risk management is a way to put more realism into training without paying the price in deaths, injuries, or damaged equipment.

1-7

DODD0A-003691
c. Safety demands total chain of command involvement in planning, preparing, executing, and evaluating training. The chain of command responsibilities include the following:
(1) Commanders.
(a)
Seek optimum, not adequate performance.

(b)
Specify the risk they will accept to accomplish the mission.

(c)
Select risk reductions provided by staff.

(d)
Accept or reject residual risk, based on the benefit to be derived.

(e) Train and motivate leaders at all levels to effectively use risk management concepts.
(2) Staff
(a)
Assists the commander in assessing risks and in developing risk reduction options when planning training.

(b)
Integrates risk controls in plans, orders, METL standards, and performance measures.

(c)
Eliminates unnecessary safety restrictions that diminish training effectiveness.

(d)
Assesses safety performance during training.

(e)
Evaluates safety performance during AARs.

(3) Subordinate leaders.
(a) Apply consistently effective risk management concepts and methods to operations they lead.
(b) Report risk issues beyond their control or authority to their superiors.
(4) Individual soldier.
(a)
Reports unsafe conditions and acts and corrects the situation when
possible.

(b)
Establishes a buddy system to keep a safety watch on one another.

(c)
Takes responsibility for personal safety.

(d)
Works as a team member.

(e)
Modifies own risk behavior.

d.
Risk management is a five-step cyclic process that is easily integrated into the decision making process outlined in FM 101-5. The five steps are as follows:

(1)
Identify hazards. Identify the most probable hazards for the missions.

(2)
Assess hazards. Analyze each hazard to determine the probability of its causing an accident and the probable effect of the accident. Identify control options to eliminate or reduce the hazard The Army Standard Risk Assessment Matrix (see Figure 1-3) is a tool for assessing hazards.

HAZARD OBABILITY=N
FREQUENT LIKELY OCCASIONAL SELDOM UNLIKELY
A B C D E

CATASTROPHIC
HIGH CRITICAL H

MARGINAL HI
LOW
NEGLIGIBLE IV
Figure 1-3. Risk assessment matrix
(3)
Make risk decisions. Weigh the risk against the benefits of performing the operations. Accept no unnecessary risks and make any residual risk decisions at the proper level of command.

(4)
Implement controls. Integrate specific controls into plans, OPLANs, OPORDs, SOPs, and rehearsals. Communicate controls to the individual soldier.

(5)
Supervise. Determine the effectiveness of controls in reducing the probability and effect of identified hazards to include follow-up and after action. Develop the lessons learned.

1-9

DODDOA-003693
e.
Fratricide is a component of force protection and is closely related to safety. Fratricide is the employment of weapons, with the intent to kill the enemy or destroy his equipment, that result in unforeseen and unintentional death, injury, or damage to friendly personnel or equipment. Fratricide is by definition an accident. Risk assessment/management is the mechanism with which incidences of fratricide can be controlled.

f.
The primary causes of fratricide are as follows:

(1)
Direct-fire control plan failures. These occur when units fail to develop defensive and, particularly, offensive fire control plans.

(2)
Land navigation failures. These result when units stray out of sector, report wrong locations, and become disoriented.

(3)
Combat identification failure. These failures include gunners or pilots being

unable to distinguish thermal/optical signatures near the maximum range of their sighting systems and units in proximity mistaking each other for the enemy under limited visibility conditions.
(4)
Inadequate control measures. Units fail to disseminate the minimum maneuver and fire support control measures necessary to tie control measures to recognizable terrain or events.

(5)
Reporting communication failures. Units at all levels face problems in generating timely, accurate, and complete reports as locations and tactical situations change.

(6)
Weapons error. Lapses in individual discipline lead to charge errors,
accidental discharges, mistakes with explosives and hand grenades, and similar incidents.

(7)
Battlefield hazards. Unexploded ordnance, unmarked or unrecorded
minefields, FASCAM, and booby traps litter the battlefield. Failure to mark, remove, record or
anticipate these hazards increases the risk of friendly casualties.

g.
Fratricide results in unacceptable losses and increases the risk of mission failure.
Fratricide undermines the unit's ability to survive and function. Units experiencing fratricide
observe the following consequences:

(1)
Loss of confidence in the unit's leadership.

(2)
Increasing self-doubt among leaders.

(3)
Hesitation to use supporting combat systems.

(4)
Over-supervision of units.

(5)
Hesitation to conduct night operations.

(6)
Loss of aggressiveness during fire and maneuver.

DODDOA-003694
(7)
Loss of initiative.

(8)
Disrupted operations.

(9)
General degradation of cohesiveness, morale, and combat power.

1-9. ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION. Protection of natural resources has continued to become an ever increasing concern to the Army. It is the responsibility of all unit leaders to decrease, and if possible, eliminate damage to the environment when conducting training. Environmental risk management parallels safety risk management, and is based on the same philosophy as safety risk management. Environmental risk management consists of the following steps:
a.
Identify Hazards. Identify potential sources for environmental degradation during analysis of METT-T factors. This requires identification of environmental hazards. An environmental hazard is a condition with the potential for polluting air, soil, or water and/or destroying cultural/historical artifacts.

b.
Assess the Hazards. Analyzes potential severity of environmental degradation using environmental risk assessment matrix (Figure 1-4, page 1-12). Severity of environmental degradation is considered when determining the potential effect an operation will have on the environment. The risk impact value is defined as an indicator of the severity of environmental degradation. Quantify the risk to the environment resulting from the operation as extremely high, medium, or low, using the environmental assessment matrixes.

c.
Make Environmental Risk Decisions. Make decisions and develop measures to reduce high environmental risks.

d.
Brief Chain of Command. Brief chain of command (to include installation environment office, if applicable) on proposed plans and pertinent high risk environmental matrixes. Risk decisions are made at a level of command that corresponds to the degree of risk.

e.
Implement Controls. Implement environmental protection measures by integrating them into plans, orders, SOPs, training performance standards, and rehearsals.

f.
Supervise. Supervise/enforce environmental protection standards.

1-10. BATTLE FOCUS. Battle focus derives peacetime training requirements from wartime missions. It guides the planning, execution, and assessment of the unit training program to ensure it trains as it is going to fight. Battle focus is critical throughout the entire training process and is used by commanders to allocate resources for training based on wartime mission requirements. It helps the commander recognize that the unit cannot attain proficiency to standard on every task due to time or resources constraints. However, a successful training program is achievable by narrowing the focus to a reduced number of vital tasks that are essential to mission accomplishment.
1-11
DODDOA-003695
Environmental AreaM _j Rating:
Unit Operations Risk Impact
Movement of heavy vehicles systems 5 4 3 1 0
Movement of personnel and light vehicles/systems 5 4 3 1 0
Assembly area activities 5 4 3 1 0
Field maintenance of equipment 5 4 3 2 1 0
Garrison maintenance of equipment 5 4 3 1 0
Environmental Risk Assessment Worksheet 5 4 3 1 0

Movement ofheavy vehicles/ systems
Movement of personnel andlight ve hic les/systems
Assembly area activities
Field maintenance of equipment
Garrison maintenance of eq uipment
Risk rating
Air pollution
¦
Archeological and historical sites
Hazardous material/waste
Noise pollution
Threaten/endangered species
Water pollution
,,
Wetland protection

Overall rating
Overall Environmental Risk Assessment Form
EnvironmentalM Decision MakerCategoryM RangeM Little or noneM Appropriate LevelLowM 0-58M Appropriate LevelMediumM 59-117M MinorM
118-149M SignificantM Division Cdr
Extremely HighM 150-175M SevereM MACOM Cdr

HighM
Risk Categories
Figure 1 4. Environmental risk assessment matrix
-
1-11. SAFETY. A well-trained unit is normally accident-free. Although accidents can occur through no fault of the soldier, most accidents result from unsafe acts of inadequately trained, unsupervised, or complacent personnel. While conducting the training in this publication, leaders must incorporate safety into every task. Training is effective when soldiers are confident in their abilities to perform the tasks and assured that they will not be injured or cause damage to their equipment. Leaders and trainers must ensure SOPs for safety are complied with during all facets of training. They must also ensure that on-the-spot corrections are made when any unsafe practice is observed.
DODDOA-003696
1-12. EVALUATION. The T&EOs in Chapter 5 list the standards, which the unit must meet for each task.
a.
Evaluation can be either internal or external. Internal evaluations are conducted at all levels and must be inherent in all training. External evaluations are usually more formal and are conducted by the next higher HQ.

b.
A critical weakness in training is the failure to evaluate each task every time it is executed. The ARTEP concept is based on simultaneous training and evaluating. Every training exercise provides the potential for evaluation and every evaluation is a training session. To optimize training, the commander must restate to the trainers and leaders the necessity for continually evaluating training.

c.
Emphasize direct, on-the-spot evaluations. Correcting poor performance during individual or small group training is easy to do. In higher level exercises this is usually not feasible because outside evaluation is used. Continuous evaluation by the leader at every level makes the difference. AARs should be given at frequent, logical intervals during exercises. This allows the commander to correct performance shortcomings while they are still fresh in everyone's mind. This will also prevent reinforcement of bad habits.

d.
FM 25-101 provides detailed instructions for conducting an AAR and detailed guidance on coaching and critiquing during training.

1-13. FEEDBACK. Your recommendations for improvement of this MTP are requested. Use the questionnaire at the end of this MTP for your comments.
1-13
-
CHAPTER 2
TRAINING MATRIX
21. GENERAL. The Training Matrix assists the commander in planning the training of his
-
unit's personnel. The mission identification table (Figure 2-1) provides mission identification for the unit.
Mission Identification Table
Mission Title

Deploy Unit to a New Theater of Operations


Relocate Unit to a New Operating Site


Establish Unit Area of Operations


Provide Truck Transportation


Defend Assigned Area


Redeploy Unit to Home Station

Figure 21. Mission Identification Table
-
-
-
22. MISSION TO COLLECTIVE TASKS MATRIX. This matrix (Table 21, pages 2 2
-
through 2-14), identifies the mission and their supporting collective tasks. The tasks are listed under the appropriate BOS which are indicated by an asterisk. The BOS used in this matrix are defined in TRADOC Pam 11-9. A specific mission is trained by identifying collective tasks in the vertical column for the mission. Based on the proficiency of the unit, training is focused on
operational weaknesses.
Table 2-1. Training Matrix: Mission to Collective Tasks MISSIONS

Collective Tasks and Deploy Unit to a Relocate Unit to a Establish Unit Area Provide Truck Transportation Defend Assigned Redeploy Unit to
T&EO New New of Area Home
Numbers Theater of Operating Operations Station
Operations Site
*DEPLOY/
CONDUCT
MANEU-
VER
Prepare Unit X
To Move
(63-2-4002)
Conduct
Tactical
Road March X X
(63-2-4003)
Perform
Advance/
Quartering
Party X
Activities
(63-2-4008)
Occupy New
Operating
Site X
(63-2-4009)
Perform
Deployment
Alert X
Activities
(63-2-4801)
Perform
Personnel
and
Administra- X
tive Pre­
deployment
Activities
(63-2-4802)

-
MISSIONS
Collective Tasks and Deploy Unit to a Relocate Unit to a Establish Unit Area Provide Truck Transportation Defend Assigned Redeploy Unit to
T&EO New New of Area Home
Numbers Theater of Operating Operations Station
Operations Site

Table 21. Training Matrix: Mission to Collective Tasks (continued)

Perform
Predeploy­
ment X
Training
Activities
(63-2-4803)
Perform
Predeploy­
ment Supply X
Activities
(63-2-48041_ ___ _ _
Perform
Predeploy­
ment Mainte- X
nance
Activities
(63-2-4805)
Prepare
Vehicles and
Equipment X
for
Deployment
(63-2-4806)
Prepare Unit
for
Nontactical X X
Move
(63-2-4807)
Conduct
Nontactical
Road March X X
(63-2-4808)
Perform Sea
Port of
Embarkation X
Activities for
Deployment
(63-2-4809)

Table 2-1. Training Matrix: Mission to Collective Tasks (continued)

MISSIONS
Collective Deploy Relocate Establish Provide Truck Defend Redeploy
Tasks and Unit to a Unit to a Unit Area Transportation Assigned Unit to
T&EO New New of Area Home
Numbers Theater of Operating Operations Station
Operations Site

Perform Aerial Port of Embarkation Activities for Deployment (63-2-4810)
Perform Aerial Port of Debarkation Activities for Deployment (63-2-4811) Perform Sea Port of Debarkation Activities for Deployment (63-2-4812) Prepare Equipment Reception Team for Tactical. Road March (63-2-4813) Perform Redeploy­
ment
Personnel
and Adminis­trative
Actions
(63-2-4814)
Perform
Redeploy­
ment
Training
Activities
(63-2-4815)
X
.
X
.
X
X
X
ARTEP 55-718-30-MTP

Table 2-1. Training Matrix: Mission to Collective Tasks (continued)
MISSIONS

Collective Tasks and Deploy Unit to a Relocate Unit to a Establish Unit Area of Provide Truck Transportation Defend Assigned Redeploy Unit to
T&EO New New Operations Area Home
Numbers Theater of Operating Station
Operations Site

Perform Redeploy-X
ment Supply. Activities (63-2-4816) Perform Redeploy-
X
ment Mainte--nance Activities (63-2-4817) Prepare Vehicles and
X
Equipment for Redeploy­ment (63-2-4818) Perform Sea Port of Embarkation X Activities for Redeploy­ment (63-2-4819)
Perform Aerial Port of Embarkation X Activities for Redeploy­ment (63-2-4820) Perform Aerial Port of Debarkation
X Activities for Redeploy­ment

(63-2-4821)
2-5
Table 2-1. Training Matrix: Mission to Collective Tasks (continued)
MISSIONS

Collective Tasks and Deploy Unit to a Relocate Unit to a Establish Unit Area Provide Truck Transportation Defend Assigned Redeploy Unit to
T&EO New New of Area Home
Numbers Theater of Operating Operations Station
Operations Site
Perform
Home Station X
Activities
(63-2-4822)
Perform Sea
Port of
Debarkation
Activities for X
Redeploy­
ment
(63-2-4823)
Perform
Demobiliza­
tion Station X X
Activities
(63-2-4824)
Conduct
Integration
Activities X
(63-2-4825)
Conduct
Staging
Activities X
(63-2-4826)
*EMPLOY
FIRE-
POWER
Use Passive X X X X
Air Defense
Measures
(63-2-4307)
Take Active
Air Defense
Measures
Against
Hostile X X X X
Aircraft
(63-2-4308)

MISSIONS
Collective Deploy Relocate Establish Provide Truck Defend Redeploy
Tasks and Unit to a Unit to a Unit Area Transportation Assigned Unit to
T&EO New New of Area Home
Numbers Theater of Operating Operations Station
Operations Site
*PROTECT .
THE
FORCE
Set Up Truck
Platoon
(55-2-0007)
Cross a
Radiologi­
cally X X
Contami-
nated Area
(63-2-4005)
Defend
Convoy
Elements X X
(63-2-4006)
Set Up Unit
Defense X
(63-2-4011)
Prepare Unit
for Nuclear,
Biological, X -
and Chemical
Conditions
(63-2-4013)
Employ
Operations
Security X X X X X X
Measures
(63-2-4016)
Perform
Operational
Decontami- X X
nation
(63-2-4018)

2-7
Collective
Tasks and
T&EO
Numbers

Perform
Thorough
Decontami-
nation
(63-2-4019)
Respond to
the Initial
Effects of a
Nuclear
Attack 163-2-4020)
Defend
Against a
Level I
Attack
(63-2-4021)
Prepare Unit
for Level
II/l11 Threat
(63-2-4022)
Conduct
Hasty
Displacement
(63-2-4023)
Defend Unit
Area
(63-2-4024)
Perform
Withdrawal
Under Fire
(63-2-4025)
Reorganize
Unit Defense
(63-2-4026)
Execute
Battle
Handover
(63-2-4027)
Table 2-1. Training Matrix: Mission to Collective Tasks (continued)

MISSIONS
Deploy Unit to a New Relocate Unit to a Establish Unit Area Provide Truck Transportation Defend Assigned Redeploy Unit to
Theater of New of Area Home
Operations Operating Operations Station
Site .
X
X X X X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X

Table 2-1. Training Matrix: Mission to Collective Tasks (continued) MISSIONS

Collective Deploy Relocate Establish Provide Truck Defend Redeploy
Tasks and Unit to a Unit to a Unit Area Transportation Assigned Unit to
T&EO New New of Area Home
Numbers Theater of Operating Operations Station
Operations Site
Perform Area
Damage
Control X
Functions
(63-2-4028)
Cross a
Chemically
Contami- X X
nated Area
(63-2-4226)
Employ
Physical
Security X X X X X X
Measures
(63-2-4306)
Respond to a
Chemical
Attack X X X
(63-2-4334)
Destroy
Supplies and
Equipment X
(63-2-4522)

2-9
-
Table 21. Training Matrix: Mission to Collective Tasks (continued)

MISSIONS
Collective Deploy Relocate Establish Provide Truck Defend Redeploy
Tasks and Unit to a Unit to a Unit Area Transportation Assigned Unit to
T&EO New New of Area Home
Numbers Theater of Operating Operations Station
Operations Site
*PER-
FORM CSS
AND
SUSTAIN-
MENT
Treat Casual- X X X X
ties
(08-2-
0003.63-
0001)
Perform Unit
Mortuary
Affairs X
Operations
(10-2-4513)
Perform
Maintenance
Control X
Functions
(43-2-0050)
Provide
Repair Parts
Supply X
Support
(43-2-0096)
Perform
Recovery
Operations X
(43-2-4071)
Maintain
Records and
Publications X
(43-2-4392)
Perform
Controlled
Exchange of X
Repair Parts
(43-2-4394)

Table 2-1. Training Matrix: Mission to Collective Tasks (continued)
MISSIONS

Collective Deploy Relocate Establish Provide Truck Defend Redeploy
Tasks and Unit to a Unit to a Unit Area Transportation Assigned Unit to
T&EO New New of Area Home
Numbers Theater of Operating Operations Station
Operations Site
Perform
Combat
Repair X
Teams
Functions
(43-2-4508)
Supervise
Maintenance
Platoon X X
Operations
(43-2-4535)
Set Up
Maintenance
Platoon
Headquarters
and Sections
(43-2-4570)
Transport
Personnel
and Cargo X X
(55-2-0011)
Transport
Dry and
Refrigerated X
Container-
ized Cargo
(55-2-0038)
Transport
Bulk Water X
(55-2-0040)
Transport
Bulk X
Petroleum
(55-2-0041)
Provide
Human
Resources X
Support
(63-2-4015)

2-11
MISSIONS
Collective Tasks and T&EO Deploy Unit to a New Relocate Unit to a New Establish Unit Area of Provide Truck Transportation Defend Assigned Area Redeploy Unit to Home
Numbers Theater of Operating Operations Station
Operations Site

Table 2-1. Training Matrix: Mission to Collective Tasks (continued)

Combat
Battlefield
Stress X X X X X X
(63-2-4303)
Process
Enemy Prisoners of X X X X
War
(63-2-4304)
Process
Captured
Documents
and X X X X
Equipment
(63-2-4305)
Perform
Field
Sanitation X
Functions
(63-2-4315)
Transport
Casualties X X X X
(63-2-4316)
Perform Risk
Management Procedures X X X X X X
(63-2-4326)
Provide Unit
Supply
Support X
(63-2-4515) •
Set Up Unit
Headquarters
and Bivouac X
Areas
(63-2-4518)
Perform
Unit-Level
Maintenance X X X
(63-2-4552)

Table 21. Training Matrix: Mission to Collective Tasks (continued)
-
Collective Deploy Unit Relocate
Tasks and to a New Unit to a
T&EO Theater of New
Numbers Operations Operating
Site
*EXER-
CISE COM-
MAND AND
CONTROL
Provide
Command
and Control
of Trans­
portation
Operations
(55-2-0009)
Supervise
Truck
Platoon
Operations
(55-2-0010)
Maintain
ITV, Redirect
Operators,
and Provide
Commit-
ments Using
MTS
(55-2-0016)
Plan Unit
Move X
(63-2-4001)
Plan Occupa­
tion of New
Area of
Operations
(63-2-4007)
Plan Unit
Defense
(63-2-4010)

MISSIONS Establish Unit Area of Operations Provide Truck Transportation X Defend Assigned Area Redeploy Unit to Home Station .
X X
X
X
X
X X

2-13
Collective
Tasks and
T&EO
Numbers

Plan Area Damage Control Operations (63-2-4014) Maintain Communi­cations (63-2-4017) Establish Communica­tions (63-2-4040) Plan Unit Mobilization in a Peace­time Environment (63-2-4827) Plan Unit Deployment Activities Upon Receipt of a Warning Order (63-2-4828) Plan Unit Redeploy­ment (63-2-4829)
MISSIONS
Deploy Unit to a Relocate Unit to a Establish Unit Area Provide Truck Transportation Defend Assigned Redeploy Unit to
New New of Area Home
Theater of Operating Operations Station
Operations Site
X X
X
X
X
X

CHAPTER 3
MISSION OUTLINE
3-1..GENERAL. The mission outline illustrates the relationship between the missions and their supporting tasks.
3-2. PURPOSE OF MISSION OUTLINE. Since unit training is mission-oriented, the mission outline shows how task training contributes to the ability of this unit to perform its missions. The mission outline provides the commander with a visual outline of his unit's mission in a format that ficilitates the planning and management of training.
___..
FTX C-A PROVIDE MOTOR TRANSPORT SERVICES STX C-1 STX C-2 STX C-3 DEPLOY UNIT TO A RELOCATE UNIT TO A NEW ESTABLISH UNIT AREA OF NEW THEATER OF OPERATING SITE OPERATIONS OPERATIONS
63-2-4801 63-2-4812 63-2-4002 63-2-4226 63-2-4008 63-2-4015
63-2-4802 63-2-4813 63-2-4003 63-2-4306 63-2-4009 63-2-4303
63-2-4803 63-2-4824 63-2-4008 63-2-4334 63-2-4307 63-2-4304
63-2-4804 63-2-4825 63-2-4307 08-2-0003.63-0001 63-2-4308 63-2-4305
63-2-4805 63-2-4826 63-2-4308 55-2-0011 55-2-0007 63-2-4315
63-2-4806 63-2-4016 63-2-4005 63-2-4303 63-2-4011 63-2-4316
63-2-4807 63-2-4306 63-2-4006 63-2-4304 63-2-4013 63-2-4326
63-2-4808 63-2-4303 63-2-4016 63-2-4305 63-2-4016 63-2-4552
63-2-4809 63-2-4326 63-2-4018 63-2-4316 63-2-4020 55-2-0010
63-2-4810 63-2-4827 63-2-4019 63-2-4326 63-2-4022 63-2-4007
63-2-4811 63-2-4828 63-2-4020 63-2-4552 63-2-4306 63-2-4010
63-2-4001 63-2-4518 63-2-4014
08-2-0003.63-0001 63-2-4017
63-2-4535 63-2-4040
63-2-4570

3-1
(
-
STX C-4 STX C-5 STX C-6
PROVIDE TRUCK DEFEND ASSIGNED AREA REDEPLOY UNIT TO
TRANSPORTATION HOME STATION
63-2-4003 43-2-4508 63-2-4307 63-2-4306 63-2-4003 63-2-4821
63-2-4307 63-2-4535 63-2-4308 63-2-4334 63-2-4807 63-1 -48 1 2
63-2-4308 55-2-0011 63-2-4016 63-2-4522 63-2-4808 63-2-4823
63-2-4005 55-2-0038 63-2-4020 08-2-0003.63-0001 63-2-4814 63-2-4824
63-2-4006 55-2-0040 63-2-4021 10-2-4513 63-2-4815 63-2-4016
63-2-4016 55-2-0041 63-2-4023 63-2-4303 63-2-4816 63-2-4306
63-2-4018 63-2-4303 63-2-4024 63-2-4304 63-2-4817 63-2-4303
63-2-4020 63-2-4304 63-2-4025 63-2-4305 63-2-4818 63-2-4326
63-2-4226 63-2-4305 63-2-4026 63-2-4316 63-2-4819 63-2-4001
63-2-4306 63-2-4316 63-2-4027 63-2-4326 63-2-4820 63-2-4829
63-2-4334 63-2-4326 63-2-4028 63-2-4010
08-2-0003.63-0001 63-2-4515
43-2-0050 63-2-4552 •
43-2-0096 55-2-0009
43-2-4071 55-2-0010
43-2-4392 55-2-0016
43-2-4394 63-2-4017

3-2
CHAPTER 4
TRAINING EXERCISES
4-1..INTRODUCTION. Training exercises are used to train and practice personnel in the performance of collective tasks. This MIT has two types of exercises: FTX and STX. These exercises assist you in developing, sustaining, and evaluating the unit's mission proficiency. This MTP has one FTX and six STXs (see Table 4-1).
4-2. FIELD TRAINING EXERCISE. The FTX is designed to provide a training method for the unit to train its personnel to perform its overall critical wartime mission. This FTX provides a logical sequence for the performance of tasks previously trained in the STXs.
4-3. SITUATIONAL TRAINING EXERCISE. The STX is a short, scenario-driven, mission-oriented tactical exercise used to train a group of closely related collective tasks. The STX may be modified by the unit commander based on local METT-T and available personnel and equipment. The STX provides the information for training personnel to perform the missions that make up the overall critical wartime mission. The STX performs the following functions:
a.
Provides repetitive training on the missions.

b.
Allows training to focus on identified weaknesses.

c.
Allows the unit to practice the mission before the critical wartime mission.

d.
Saves time by providing a majority of the information needed to develop a method for training.

4-4..SAFETY. During any training exercise, soldiers and leaders must be safety conscious. Evaluators and trainers have the responsibility to ensure that all training is conducted within established safety constraints. Prior to each exercise, all personnel will be briefed on specific safety measures that are to be taken during execution.
Table 4-1. Training exercises
EXERCISE , TITLE PAGE
FTX C-A Provide Motor Transport Services 4-3
STX C-1 Deploy Unit to a New Theater of Operations 4-17
STX C-2 Relocate Unit to a New Operating Site 4-23
STX C-3 Establish Unit Area of Operations 4-29

Table 4-1. Training exercises (continued) EXERCISE TITLE PAGE
4-35
STX C-4 Provide Truck Transportation
4-41
STX C-5 Defend Assigned Area 4-47STX C-6 Redeploy Unit to Home Station
LIGHT, LIGHT-MEDIUM, AND MEDIUM COMPANIES
FTX C-A
PROVIDE MOTOR TRANSPORT SERVICES

1. Objective. This FTX provides training for the light, light-medium, and medium truck companies in its critical wartime mission, Provide Motor Transport Services. This FTX is used for internal and external evaluations. The tasks that are executed during this exercise are listed in Table 4-2, pages 4-5 through 4-9.
2. Interface.
a.
This FTX supports the Transportation Motor Transport Battalion FTX, Provide Transportation Support.

b.
The following STXs support this FTX:

(1)
Deploy Unit to a New Theater of Operations (STX C-1).

(2)
Relocate Unit to a New Operating Site (STX C-2).

(3)
Establish Unit Area of Operations (STX C-3).

(4)
Provide Truck Transportation (STX C-4).

(5)
Defend Assigned Area (STX C-5).

(6)
Redeploy Unit to Home Station (STX C-6).

3. Training Enhancers.
a. Chapter 2, Training Matrix, shows the collective tasks that must be mastered to perform the unit's missions. Training that will improve the unit's ability to perform its missions are:
(1)
Planning, controlling, and providing transportation serices. This training may be conducted in garrison and in local training area by one of the following methods:

(a)
MAPEX combined with a sand or terrain table model exercise. A map of the actual area where the FTX is to be conducted and a sand table model to match the terrain should be used, if possible.

(b)
Tactical exercise without troops.

(c)
COMEX (to practice communications techniques).

4-3

DODDOA-003716
(2)
Establishing an aggressive spirit in leaders and units by the following activities:

(a)
Aggressive unit sport and physical fitness program.

(b)
Leader and individual confidence courses.

(c)
Appropriate training films that have aggressive and positive effect on the soldiers.

(d) Awareness of unit's heritage.

b.
This exercise begins with the receipt of a warning order and ends after redeployment of the unit. AARs are conducted as shown in Table 4-3, pages 4-10 through 4-13. Table 4-3 is a suggested scenario. Figure 4-1, page 4-14, illustrates the general sequence of task performances in this exercise.

c.
This exercise may be conducted under several options.

(1)
Conditional options.

(a)
Support offensive operations.

(b)
Support defensive operations.

(c)
Support retrograde operations.

(d)
Day or night operations.

(e)
Adverse weather conditions.

(2)
Operational options.

(a)
Conduct self-defense operations (move, set up, and defend unit assigned area).

(b)
Conduct logistical operations (move, set up, and transport personnel,
equipment, and cargo).

(c)
Conduct self-recovery operations (receive, move, and to recover mired or disabled vehicle).

4-4
TASK TITLE. TASK NUMBER PAGE
Prepare Unit to Move 63-2-4002 5-8 Conduct Tactical Road March 63-2-4003 5-14 Perform Advance/Quartering Party Activities 63-2-4008 5-20 Occupy New Operating Site 63-2-4009 5-25 Perform Deployment Alert Activities 63-2-4801 5-28 Perform Human Resources Predeployment Activities 63-2-4802 5-32 Perform Predeployment Training Activities 63-2-4803 5-36 Perform Predeployment Supply Activities 63-2-4804 5-38 Perform Predeployment Maintenance Activities 63-2-4805 5-42 Prepare Vehicles and Equipment for Deployment 63-2-4806 5-47 Prepare Unit for Nontactical Move 63-2-4807 5-54 Conduct Nontactical Road March 63-2-4808 5-58 Perform Sea Port of Embarkation Activities for Deployment 63-2-4809 5-62 Perform Aerial Port of Embarkation Activities for Deployment 63-2-4810 5-68 Perform Aerial Port of Debarkation Activities for Deployment 63-2-4811 5-73 Perform Sea Port of Debarkation Activities for Deployment 63-2-4812 5-77 Prepare Equipment Reception Team for Tactical Road March 63-2-4813 5-82 Perform Redeployment Human Resources Actions 63-2-4814 5-86 Perform Redeployment Training Activities 63-2-4815 5-90 Perform Redeployment Supply Activities 63-2-4816 5-93 Perform Redeployment Maintenance Activities 63-2-4817 5-96 Prepare Vehicles and Equipment for Redeployment 63-2-4818 5-101
4-5
-
Table 4-2. T&EOs from chapter 5 to use for evaluating FTX C A (continued)
TASK TITLE
Perform Sea Port of Embarkation Activities for Redeployment Perform Aerial Port of Embarkation Activities for Redeployment Perform Aerial Port of Debarkation Activities for Redeployment Perform Home Station Activities Perform Sea Port of Debarkation Activities for Redeployment Perform Demobilization Station Activities Conduct Integration Activities Conduct Staging Activities Use Passive Air Defense Measures Take Active Air Defense Measures Against Hostile Aircraft Set Up Truck Platoon Cross a Radiologically Contaminated Area Defend Convoy Elements Set Up Unit Defense Prepare Unit for Nuclear, Biological, and Chemical Conditions Employ Operations Security Measures Perform Operational Decontamination Perform Thorough Decontamination Respond to the Initial Effects of a Nuclear Attack Defend Against a Level I Attack Prepare Unit for Level II/III Threat
TASK NUMBER PAGE
63-2-4819 5-110 63-2-4820 5-117 63-2-4821 5-12 1 63-2-4822 5-125 63-2-4823 5-129 63-2-4824 5-133 63-2-4825 5-137 63-2-4826 5-139 63-2-4307 5-143 63-2-4308 5-147 55-2-0007 5-151 63-2-4005 5-153 63-2-4006 5-162 63-2-4011 5-170 63-2-4013 5-176 63-2-4016 5-181 63-2-4018 5-186 63-2-4019 5-189 63-2-4020 5-192 63-2-4021 5-195 63-2-4022 5-199
-
Table 42. T&EOs from chapter 5 to use for evaluating FTX CA (continued)
-
TASK NUMBER PAGE
TASK TITLE
5-202
Conduct Hasty Displacement 63-2-4023 63-2-4024 5-205
Defend Unit Area Perform Withdrawal Under Fire
63-2-4025 5-210 5-213
Reorganize Unit Defense 63-2-4026 63-2-4027 5-216
Execute Battle Handover Perform Area Damage Control Functions 63-2-4028 5-219 Cross a Chemically Contaminated Area 63-2-4226 5-222 Employ Physical Security Measures 63-2-4306 5-229 Respond to a Chemical Attack 63-2-4334 5-233 Destroy Supplies and Equipment 63-2-4522 5-238 Treat Casualties 08-2-0003.63-0001 5-243 Perform Unit Mortuary Affairs Operations 10-2-4513 5-248 Perform Maintenance Control Functions 43-2-0050 5-254 Provide Repair Parts Supply Support 43-2-0096 5-258 Perform Recovery Operations 43-2-4071 5-263 Maintain Records and Publications 43-2-4392 5-266 Perform Controlled Exchange of Repair Parts 43-2-4394 5-268
.
Perform Combat Repair Teams Functions 43-2-4508 5-270 Supervise Maintenance Platoon Operations 43-2-4535 5-272 Set Up Maintenance Platoon Headquarters and Sections 43-2-4570 5-274 Transport Personnel and Cargo 55-2-0011 5-278
4-7
(
ARTEP 55-718-30-MTP Table 42. T&EOs from chapter 5 to use for evaluating FTX CA (continued)
-
-
TASK NUMBER PAGE

TASK TITLE
Transport Dry and Refrigerated Containerized Cargo
Transport Bulk Water Transport Bulk Petroleum Provide Human Resources Support Combat Battlefield Stress Process Enemy Prisoners of War Process Captured Documents and Equipment Perform Field Sanitation Functions Transport Casualties Perform Risk Management Procedures Provide Unit Supply Support Set Up Unit Headquarters and Bivouac Areas Perform Unit-Level Maintenance Provide Command and Control of Transportation Operations
Supervise Truck Platoon Operations
Maintain ITV, Redirect Operators, and Provide Commitments Using MTS Plan Unit Move Plan Occupation of New Area of Operations Plan Unit Defense Plan Area Damage Control Operations Maintain Communications Establish Communications
55-2-0038 55-2-0040 55-2-0041 63-2-4015 63-2-4303 63-2-4304 63-2-4305 63-2-4315 63-2-4316 63-2-4326 63-2-4515 63-2-4518 63-2-4552 55-2-0009 55-2-0010
55-2-0016 63-2-4001 63-2-4007 63-2-4010 63-2-4014 63-2-4017 63-2-4040
5-285
5-292
5-299
5-305
5-309
5-313
5-316
5-319
5-323
5-328
5-331
5-334
5-338
5-345
5-349

5-352
5-356
5-360
5-363
5-368
5-371
5-377

DODDOA-003721
Table 4-2. T&EOs from chapter 5 to use for evaluating FTX C-A (continued) TASK TITLE. TASK NUMBER PAGE Plan Unit Mobilization in a Peacetime Environment .63-2-4827 5-380 Plan Unit Deployment Activities Upon Receipt of a Warning Order 63-2-4828
5-385 Plan Unit Redeployment. 63-2-4829 5-389
4-9

DODDOA-003722
4. General Situation.
a. The transportation light, light-medium, and medium truck companies are attached to a
Transportation Motor Transport Battalion. The battalion will begin new operations in the near The unit commanders are charged with the unit movement plans, movement, and routine or
future.
specialized mission. The companies, as part of the Transportation Motor Transport Battalion,
must deploy to a new theater of operations, relocate to a new operating site, establish area of
operations, provide truck transportation, defend assigned area, and then redeploy to home station.
The unit will be prepared for threat activity during movement, establishment of new unit operating
site, and during operations. The battalion will provide guidance to the commanders when Level
HMI threat is anticipated. The companies will cease operations and participate in battle handover.
If the situation requires the companies to perform hasty displacement, this exercise will terminate
after that activity.

b.
This exercise is also conducted under all day and night environmental conditions. The unit will operate under threat of NBC, by ground or air attack, indirect fire, and electronic warfare.

c.
This exercise is also conducted under threat of Level I, II, or III attack, or during NBC

operations.
Table 4-3. Sample unit FTX C-A scenario
Sequence Event Estimated Time
Deploy Unit to a New Theater of Operations
1 Receive and verify warning order 20 min
2 Initiate recall plan 30 min
3 4 Perform administrative and soldier readiness processing activities Inspect unit's vehicles and equipment 3 hr 2 hr
5 Load vehicles and es uisment 3 hr
6 AAR 1 hr
7 Receive movement order 30 min
8 Conduct nontactical road march 1 hr
9 Arrive at APOE/SPOE 10 min
10 Perform embarkation activities 2 hr
11 12 Arrive at APOD/SPOD Perform debarkation activities 30 min 2 hr
13 14 Perform staging and marshaling activities Conduct theater reception operations 2 hr 2 hr
15 Coordinate theater integration activities 2 hr
16 AAR 1 hr

Table 4-3. Sample unit FTX C-A scenario (continued)
Estimated
Sequence Event
Time

.Relocate Unit to a New Operating Site
17 Receive and verify warning order 10 min
1 hr

18 Conduct route reconnaissance
20 min

19 Provide input to S2/3
30 min

20 Plan unit move
20 min

21 Plan occupation of site
1 hr

22 Prepare vehicles and equipment
23 Organize march elements lhr
24 Organize advance/quartering party .15 min
25 Receive movement order

30 min
26 Brief advance/quartering party 5 min
27 Dispatch advance/quartering party 10 min
5 mm

28 Cross SP
29 Conduct tactical convoy operations to relocate to new operating site 1 hr
5 min

3.0 Cross RP
30 min

31 AAR
10 min

32 Brief march elements
33 Dispatch march elements 30 min
10 min

34 Cross SP
35 Conduct tactical convoy operations to relocate to new operating site 1 hr
36 Cross contaminated area

45 min
37 Threat interdiction

40 min
38 Continues convoy 45 min
39 Cross RP 30 min
40 AAR 1 hr

Establish Unit Area of Operations
41 Perform advance/quartering party activities 4 hrs
42 Establish unit area of operations 6 hrs
43 Organize unit defense 2 hrs
44 AAR 1 hr

Provide Truck Transportation
45 Conducts transportation services 8 hr
46 Performs unit level operations to support unit's mission 8 hr
47 AAR I hr

4-11
Sequence
..48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
Table 4-3. Sample unit FTX C-A scenario (continued)
Event
Defend Assigned Area
Defend unit area Receive alert message Occupy fighting positions Increase perimeter manning Assemble reaction force React to Level I threat Respond to NBC attack Perform decontamination and monitoring operations Receive notification of Level 11/III ground attack Increase defense preparation Defend against OPFOR attack Detect threat Engage threat
Disengage threat Conduct hasty displacement Handover battle to tactical combat force/MP Reorganize unit Conduct ADC Treat casualties Evacuate casualties Perform mortuary affairs operations Reconstitute unit AAR
Estimated
Time

15 min
4 hr
1 hr
10 min
10 min
45 min
45 min
40 min
45 min
10 min
30 min
4 hr
2 hr

30 min
Request indirect fire or close air support 12 hr 30 min 10 min 15 min 20 min 30 min 30 min
1 hr
1 hr
-) hr

Table 4-3. Sample unit FTX CA scenario (continued)
-
Estimated
Sequence Event
Time

.Redeploy Unit to Home Station
72 Receive and verify warning order for redeployment 10 min
30 min

73 Perform administrative and SRP activities
74 Dismantle current operating site 1 hr
15 min

75 Inspect vehicles and equipment
76 Load vehicles and equipment 30 min
30 min

77 AAR
1 hr

78.• Receive movement order
30 min

79 Conduct nontactical road march
1 hr

80 Arrive APOE/SPOE 81 Perform staging activities 2 hr . . 1 hr
82 Perform embarkation activities.
1 hr

83 AAR
2 hr

84 Arrive APOD/SPOD
85 Perform debarkation activities 3 hr
86 Perform staging activities 1 hr
87 Receive movement order 30 min
88 Conduct nontactical road march 1 hr

2 hr
89 Arrive home station
2 hr

90 Conduct home station activities
91 Final AAR

3 hr
TOTAL TIME: 123 hr, 43 min NOTE 1: Events will be performed to standard, not time limitation. The time required to train an event will vary based on METT-T factors and the training proficiency of the unit. NOTE 2: Additional time is required if large portions of the exercise are conducted at night, under limited visibility, or under MOPP conditions.
4-13

• Perform Predeployment Activities • Perform Debarkation Activities • Perform Debarkation
• Conduct Nontactical Road March Activities
SP
HOME STATION APOD/SPOD


Plan The Move —


Plan Occupation of New Operating Site

actical.—•••••

React To

Road March

Ambushes

¦¦¦•••¦¦
•Employ Active and Passive Air Defense Measures
• Cross
Contaminated Area Tactical • Conduct Halts Road arch
• Sweep Area
• Secure Area
COMPANY .••••¦¦• • React
To Air Attacks
4et Up Area
• Employ NBC Defense • Set Up Defense • Provide Motor Transport Services • Respond To Threat

NEW SITE OPFOR •• PROVIDE TRUCK TRANSPORTATION
• PERFORM PRE-DEPLOYMENT • Perform ADC Activities
ACTIVITIES
TAA\RAA • Conduct Nontactical Road March
• Perform Embarkation Activities CPOE\SPOD • Perform Debarkation Activities

Figure 4-1. General scenario illustration

DODDOA-003727
5. Special Situation. The commander has received the following warning order:
The unit will deploy to a new theater of operations NLT.to vicinity coordinates
.. At the new theater of operations the commander will receive a WARNO to relocate to a new operating site and establish a unit area of operations to support the transportation motor transport battalion. Begin your planning process for deploying, relocating, establishing, providing truck transportation services, and defending the assigned area. This exercise will begin with receipt of this warning order and ends on notification from me to redeploy to home station.
6. Support Requirements.
a.
Minimum Trainers/Evaluators. The commander will conduct this exercise. He will be the trainer and also the primary evaluator. If possible, there should be an evaluator with each platoon. At least one other evaluator is required with the OPFOR.

b.
Vehieles/Communications. Communications equipment is needed for each controller/evaluator and the primary trainer. Radios are required for OPFOR vehicles during operations. Each controller/evaluator reports directly to the primary trainer.

c.
Opposing Force. An OPFOR platoon (+) and one aircraft are required for the exercise for Level II threat activities. The OPFOR should be well trained in patrolling, assault, and guerrilla tactics. The OPFOR should have specific missions in the unit area.

d.
Maneuver Area. Depending upon the LTA, it is desirable to have a training area with minimum dimension of 1.5 by 1.5 kilometers. A road network is required that allows a road march of at least 10 kilometers.

e.
Master Incident List. During the FTX, MIL items should be continually fed into proper channels. Input from battalion staff and OPFOR causes response from the unit. A major purpose of this FTX is to drive unit and subordinate elements to a simulated combat level of support requirements.

f.
Using Units. In order to perform this exercise, support units must be in the field requesting transport of supplies, equipment, and personnel.

g.
Consolidated Support Requirements. Table 4-4, page 4-16, shows the support needed to successfully complete this FTX.

4-15

DODDOA-003728
Table 4-4. Sample consolidated support requirements, FTX C-A
AMMUNITION
5.56-mm SAW (blank)
5.56-mm (blank)
7.62-mm (blank)
40-mm (blank)
.45 cal/M9 (blank)
.50 cal (blank
Blank adapter
MILES
Smoke grenades

OPFOR
Simulators, hand grenades Simulators, hand grenades ATWESS Claymores (tng) Simulators, arty Simulators, booby trap Simulators, arty
FUEL QUANTITY
600 rounds/wpn 120 rounds/wpn 400 rounds/wpn 768 rounds/wpn 30 rounds/wpn 400 rounds/wpn 1 set/wpn 1 set/wpn 4 unit
2 per man 10 OPFOR 2 per LAW 4-6 unit 10 trainer/evaluator 10 unit 10 OPFOR
Multiply the pieces of equipment times the amount of fuel per mile or hour times the tentative
operating mileage or hour.
NBC EQUIPMENT
AN/ODR-TI (Radiac set) M72A2 Chemical Stimulant CS Grenades IM 174 PD Radiac meter IM 93/UD Dosimeter
OTHER
Meals War wound moulage set Aircraft for simulated air attack Fire Marker Control System 1 each 2 each 4 each 5 each 13 each
3 per man, per day 1 each 1 each (when available)
NOTE: The consolidated support requirements outlined in this FTX are intended as suggestions only. Local policies or constraints may not allow for provisioning of these items in the suggested amount.
LIGHT, LIGHT-MEDIUM, AND MEDIUM COMPANIES
STX C-1
DEPLOY UNIT TO A NEW THEATER OF OPERATIONS

1. Objective. This STX trains the unit in deployment to a new theater of operations. This STX also provides the commander and key leaders with practice in planning unit movement during deployment activities. The unit must become proficient in planning and preparing the unit for deployment operations.
2. Interface.
a.
This STX supports the unit FTX--Provide Motor Transport Services.

b.
This STX supports the higher echelon STX--Supervise Deployment of Subordinate Elements to New Theater of Operations.

3. Training.
a. Leader Training.
(1)
This STX can be used to plan and implement deployment (land, sea, or air) of the unit as a part of an FTX.

(2)
During classroom activities, the use of the TSOP and the responsibilities and procedures outlined in FMs 55-9, 55-10, 55-12, 55-65, and 100-17; and ARs 220-10, 700-84, and 750-1 should be discussed and the T&EOs listed in this STX should be reviewed.

(3)
The leader should use a map of the area where the STX is to be conducted and a sand table model to match the actual terrain, if possible.

(4)
CPX, CFX, and TEWTs provide ground training for leaders when the exact area of the STXs is used.

(5)
Simulations and games teach leaders as part of a continuing officer and NCO development program.

(6)
Tips for leader training.

(a)
Leaders should familiarize themselves with the procedures for planning and executing deployment operations.

(b) Leaders should review the unit and higher echelon deployment SOPs.

(c)
Leaders should conduct a reconnaissance of the training area where
deployment activities will take place, if possible.

4-17 DODDOA-003730
b. Tips for Training.
(1)
After the unit demonstrates proficiency for the tasks in this STX, this STX can be trained under several options:

(a)
Inclement weather.

(b)
Various unit category levels.

(c)
Different mode of transportation.

(d)
With or without OPFOR interdiction.

(e)
Day or night.

(f)
Movement over single or multiple routes.

(2)
The unit must become proficient in the basics of planning and executing deployment before attempting complex actions.

(3)
After proficiency in this STX is reached, the unit sustains proficiency by executing this STX as part of an FTX.

4. Training Enhancers.
a.
The commander, in coordination with higher echelon command, secures deployment
SOPs and reviews deployment outload team rosters.

b.
UMO/NCO updates unit deployment plans in coordination with unit leaders.

c.
The higher echelon S2/S3 provides unit with the deployment sequence.

d.
Unless otherwise approved by the chief OC, all reports and recommendations should be provided in hard copy to the senior trainer for evaluation.

e.
This exercise begins with receipt of a deployment warning order and ends when unit arrives at the theater of operations. AARs are conducted as shown in Table 4-5, page 4-20. Table 4-5 is a suggested scenario.

5. General Situation.
a.
The unit is deployed from its home station or mobilization site to a new area of
operations. The unit is under the command and control of a higher echelon command.

b.
The commander, UMO, and NCOs provides unit movement data.

c.
The installation provides required deployment support.

d.
The OCONUS location is identified.

e.
This exercise is conducted in all environmental conditions.

6.
FRAGO. The commander issues the following WARNO: "Unit is prepared to deploy to a new theater of operations. Unit will deploy from home station to APOE/SPOE to APOD/SPOD."

7.
Support Requirements.

a.
Minimum Trainer and OCs. This exercise should be conducted with the unit commander as the trainer and primary OC. A minimum of two OCs is required.

b.
Opposing Force.

(1)
The OPFOR may or may not be required when exercise is conducted as part of a CPX. The OPFOR should be used if exercise is part of an FTX.

(2)
The OPFOR should have specific missions and be controlled whenever used.

(3)
The MILES can be used or the OCs can assess damage to equipment and personnel casualties.

c.
Vehicles and Communications. Vehicles and communications equipment organic to the unit are used. When OPFOR is employed, a vehicle and radio for the OCs are needed.

d.
Maneuver Area. Depending upon the LTA, it is desirable to have an adequate training area that is 1.5 by 1.5 kilometers for deployment. A road network is required that allows a road march of at least 25 kilometers.

e.
Master Incident List. During this STX, the MIL is essential to provide input to drive unit actions.

f.
Consolidated Support Requirements. Table 4-6, page 4-21, shows the suggested support requirements for this STX.

4-19
Table 4-5. Sample light, light-medium, and medium companies STX C-1 scenario
Sequence Event
1 Receive and verify deployment warning order
2 Initiate recall plan
3 Perform administrative and soldier readiness processing activities
4 Inspect unit's vehicles and equipment
5 Load vehicles and equipment
6 AAR
7 Receive movement order
8 Conduct nontactical road march
9 Arrive at APOE/SPOE
10 Perform embarkation activities
11 Arrive at APOD/SPOD
12 Perform debarkation activities
13 Perform staging and marshaling activities
14 Conduct theater reception operations
15 Coordinate theater integration activities
16 AAR

Estimated Time
20 min 30 min 3 hr 2 hr 3 hr I hr 30 min 1 hr 10 min 2 hr 30 min 2 hr 2 hr 2 hr 2 hr 1 hr
TOTAL TIME: 23 hr NOTE 1: Events will be performed to standard, not time limitation. The time required to train an event will vary based on METT-T factors and the training proficiency of the unit. NOTE 2: Additional time is required if large portions of the exercise are conducted at night, under limited visibility, or under MOPP conditions.
-
Table 46. Sample consolidated support requirements for STX C 1
-
AMMUNITION QUANTITY
5.56mm SAW (blank) 600 rounds/wpn 5.56mm (blank) 120 rounds/wpn 7.62mm (blank) 400 rounds/wpn 40mm (blank) 768 rounds/wpn M9mm (blank) 30 rounds/wpn Blank adapter 1 set/wpn MILES 1 set/wpn Smoke grenades 4 per company
2 per OPFOR Simulators, hand grenades _per man Simulators, hand grenades 10 per OPFOR ATWESS 2 per LAW
EQUIPMENT
All organic equipment to include TOE and CTA authorized. Rail and aircraft load simulations.
FUEL
Multiply the pieces of equipment times the amount of fuel per mile or hour times the tentative operating mileage or hour.
NBC EQUIPMENT
NOTE: The consolidated support requirements outlined for this STX are intended as suggestions. Local policies or constraints may not allow for providing the items.
8. T&EO Sequence. Table 4-7 lists the T&EOs for this STX.
--
Table 47. T&EOs from chapter 5 to use in evaluating STX C1

TASK TITLE TASK NUMBER PAGE
Perform Deployment Alert Activities 63-2-4801 5-28
Perform Human Resources Predeployment Activities 63-2-4802 5-32
Perform Predeployment Training Activities 63-2-4803 5-36
Perform Predeployment Supply Activities 63-2-4804 5-38
Perform Predeployment Maintenance Activities 63-2-4805 5-42
Prepare Vehicles and Equipment for Deployment 63-2-4806 5-47

4-21

DODDOA-003734
TASK TITLE
Prepare Unit for Nontactical Move Conduct Nontactical Road March Perform Sea Port of Embarkation Activities for Deployment Perform Aerial Port of Embarkation Activities for Deployment Perform Aerial Port of Debarkation Activities for Deployment Perform Sea Port of Debarkation Activities for Deployment Prepare Equipment Reception Team for Tactical Road March Perform Demobilization Station Activities Conduct Integration Activities Conduct Staging Activities Employ Operations Security Measures Employ Physical Security Measures Combat Battlefield Stress Perform Risk Management Procedures Plan Unit Mobilization in a Peacetime Environment Plan Unit Deployment Activities Upon Receipt of a Warning Order
TASK NUMBER PAGE
63-2-4807 5-54 63-2-4808 5-58 63-2-4809 5-62 63-2-4810 5-68 63-2-4811 5-73 63-2-4812 5-77 63-2-4813 5-82 63-2-4824 5-133 63-2-4825 5-137 63-2-4826 5-139 63-2-4016 5-181 63-2-4306 5-229 63-2-4303 5-309 63-2-4326 5-328 63-2-4827 5-380 63-2-4828 5-385
--
LIGHT, LIGHT-MEDIUM, AND MEDIUM COMPANIES
STX C-2
RELOCATE UNIT TO A NEW OPERATING SITE

1. Objective. This STX trains the unit in planning, coordinating, and relocating to a new operating site. This STX provides the commander and key leaders practice in selecting routes, planning occupation of the new area, coordinating required support for the move, and controlling the movement. The unit must become proficient in planning and preparing the move.
2. Interface.
a.
This STX supports the unit FTX--Provide Motor Transport Services.

b.
This STX supports the higher echelon STX--Supervise Relocation of Subordinate Elements and Sustainment Resources.

3. Training.
a. Leader Training.
(1)
This STX can be used to plan and implement movement of the unit as part of a CPX or FTX.

(2)
During classroom activities, the use of the TSOP and responsibilities and

procedures outlined in FM 55-30 and FM 7-20 should be discussed, and the T&EOs listed in this STX should be reviewed.
(3)
CPX, CFX, and TEWT provide ground training for leaders when the exact
STX area is used.

(4)
Tips for leader training.

(a)
Leaders should familiarize themselves with the procedures for planning and executing movement.

(b) The unit TSOP should be reviewed.

(c)
A map/route reconnaissance should be conducted, if possible, of the
training area where the unit will relocate.

4-23
DODDOA-003736
b. Tips for Training
(1)
After the unit demonstrates proficiency for the tasks in this STX, this STX can be trained under several options:

(a)
Elements moving over single or multiple routes.

(b)
With or without OPFOR interdictions.

(c)
With or without NBC environment.

(d)
Day or night.

(e)
Single or multiple lift move.

(2)
The unit must become proficient in the basics of planning and conducting the movement and relocation of the unit before attempting complex actions.

(3)
After proficiency in this STX is reached, the unit sustains proficiency by executing this STX as part of an FTX.

4. Training Enhancers.
a.
The unit commander provides transportation support based on the commander's guidance and personnel and vehicle availability. The enemy situation will affect the movement requirements.

b.
The unit plans the move in conjunction with higher HQ.

c.
Unless otherwise approved by the chief OC, all reports and recommendations should be provided in hard copy to the senior trainer for evaluation.

d.
The unit should be able to relocate at least once every 5 days as a standard capability.

e.
This exercise begins with receipt of a warning order to relocate to a designated area and ends after unit has crossed the RP. AARs are conducted as shown in Table 4-8. Table 4-8 is a suggested scenario.

-
-
-
Table 48. Sample light, light medium, and medium companies STX C2 scenario

Sequence Event Estimated Time
1 Receive and verify warning order 10 min
2 Analyze mission 30 min
3 Prepare movement plan 2 hr
4 Prepare site occupation plan 30 min
5 Provide input to S2/S3 20 min
6 Organize march elements 20 min
7 Conduct route reconnaissance 1 hr
8 Prepare vehicles and equipment 1 hr
9 Receive movement order 30 min
10 Conduct nontactical convoy operations to operating site 1 hr
11 Cross SP 10 min
12 Conduct nontactical road march 1 hr
13 Cross RP 10 min
14 AAR 30 min
15 Receive and verify warning order for relocation to new operating 10 min
site
16 Plan the move 30 min
17 Organize advance/quartering party 10 min
18 Brief advance/quartering party 15 min
19 Dispatch advance/quartering party 15 min
20 Conduct advance/quartering party operation 4 hr
21 AAR 1 hr
22 Conduct tactical convoy operations to relocate to new operating 10 min
site
23 Cross SP 10 min
24 Conduct tactical road march 30 min
25 Cross contaminated area 30 min
26 Threat interdiction 40 min
27 Continue convoy 30 min
28 Cross RP 10 min
29 AAR 30 min
TOTAL TIME: 19 hr, 7 min

NOTE I:. Events will be performed to standard, not time limitation. The time required to train an event will vary based on METT-T factors and the training proficiency of the unit. NOTE 2: Additional time is required if large portions of the exercise are conducted at night, under limited visibility, or under MOPP conditions.
4-25

DODDOA-003738
5. General Situation.
a.
The unit has arrived at the new theater of operations and has assembled the unit's equipment in the initial assembly area. Upon receipt of a movement order, the unit will relocate to a new operating site.

b.
Pertinent maps and engineer overlays are available.

c.
The unit or higher HQ will perform route reconnaissance.

d.
The OPFOR is capable of launching air or ground attacks, employing NBC agents, and engaging in EW.

e.
Major deviation(s) from the movement plan may occur.

f.
This exercise is conducted in all environmental conditions.

6. FRAGO. The commander issues the following FRAGO: "The MSR has been hit with chemical contamination, intelligence reports also states that enemy activity has been observed in or around the vicinity. Reroute the convoy if time permits; if not, stay on MSR and proceed with
caution."
7. Support Requirements.
a.
Minimum Trainers/OCs. This exercise should be conducted with the unit commander as the trainer and primary OC. A minimum of two OCs is required.

b.
Opposing Force.

(1)
OPFOR may or may not be required when the exercise is conducted as part of
a CPX. OPFOR should be used if the exercise is part of an FTX.

(2)
OPFOR should have specific missions and be controlled when used.

(3)
MILES can be used, or the OC can assess damage to the unit.

c.
Vehicles and Communications. Vehicles and communications equipment organic to
the unit are used. When an OPFOR is employed, a vehicle and radio are needed for the OC.

d.
Maneuver Area. A training area of sufficient size, approximately 250 by 250 meters,
is needed to support the number of vehicles and equipment in the unit. A road network is required
that allows a road march of at least 20 kilometers. Vegetation and terrain should allow cover and
concealment for facilities, vehicles, and equipment.

e.
Master Incident List. During the STX, MIL is essential to provide input to drive unit
actions.

Consolidated Support Requirements. Table 4-9 shows the suggested support
requirements for this STX.

DODDOA-003739
-
Table 4-9. Sample consolidated support requirements for STX C-2
AMMUNITION QUANTITY
5.56mm (Blank) 120 rds/per wpn 7.62mm (Blank) 100 rds/per wpn Smoke Grenades 4/per unit/OPFOR
Arty Simulator 4/per OPFOR MILES 1 set per soldier/equipment
.
EQUIPMENT
All equipment organic to each unit to include TOE and CTA authorized.

FUEL QUANTITY
Multiply the pieces of equipment times the amount of fuel per mile or hour times the tentative operating mileage or hour.
NBC EQUIPMENT
AN/PDR-T1 (Radiation Survey Set) 1 per unit M72A2 Kit: Chemical Stimulant 1 each CS Grenades 4/per OPFOR
OTHER
Field rations as required War Wound Moulage Set 1 each Aircraft for simulated air attack 1 each
NOTE: The consolidated support requirements outlined for this STX are intended as suggestions only. Local policies or constraints may not allow for provisioning of all of the items in this table.
8. T&EO Sequence. Table 410 lists the T&EOs for this STX.
-
Table 4-10. T&EOs from chapter 5 to use in evaluating STX C -2
TASK TITLE TASK NUMBER PAGE
Prepare Unit to Move 63-2-4002 5-8
Conduct Tactical Road March 63-2-4003 5-14
5-20Perform Advance/Quartering Party Activities 63-2-4008
Use Passive Air Defense Measures 63-2-4307 5-143
Take Active Air Defense Measures Against Hostile Aircraft 63-2-4308 5-147
Cross a Radiologically Contaminated Area 63-2-4005 5-153
4-27
DODDOA-003740
ARTEP 55-718-30-MTP Table 4-10. T&EOs from chapter 5 to use in evaluating STX C 2 (continued)-
TASK TITLE
Defend Convoy Elements
Employ Operations Security Measures
Perform Operational Decontamination
Perform Thorough Decontamination
Respond to the Initial Effects of a Nuclear Attack
Cross a Chemically Contaminated Area
Employ Physical Security Measures
Respond to a Chemical Attack
Treat Casualties
Transport Personnel and Cargo
Combat Battlefield Stress
Process Enemy Prisoners of War
Process Captured Documents and Equipment
Transport Casualties
Perform Risk Management Procedures
Perform Unit-Level Maintenance
Plan Unit Move
TASK NUMBER PAGE
63-2-4006 5-162 63-2-4016 5-181 63-2-4018 5-186 63-2-4019 5-189 63-2-4020 5-192 63-2-4226 5-222 63-2-4306 5-229 63-2-4334 5-233 08-2-0003.63-0001 5-243 55-2-0011 5-278 63-2-4303 5-309 63-2-4304 5-313 63-2-4305 5-316 63-2-4316 5-323 63-2-4326 5-328 63-2-4552 5-338 63-2-4001 5-356
LIGHT, LIGHT-MEDIUM, AND MEDIUM COMPANIES
STX C-3
ESTABLISH UNIT AREA OF OPERATIONS

1.TObjective. This STX trains the unit in setting up its area of operations. This STX provides the commander and leaders practice in planning, coordinating, and controlling the establishment of the operational area. The unit must become proficient in establishing the AO and defensive positions.
2.
TInterface.

a.
This STX supports the unit FTX-Provide Motor Transport Services.

b.
This STX supports the higher echelon STX-Supervise Establishment of Subordinate Elements and Facilities.

3.
TTraining.

a.
Leader Training.

(1)
This STX can be used to establish the unit area as a part of a CPX or an FTX.

(2)
During classroom activities, the use of the TSOP, the responsibilities and procedures outlined in the unit's doctrinal publications, and the T&EOs listed in this STX should be reviewed.

(3)
Leaders should use a map of the actual area where the STX is to be conducted, and a sand table model to match the actual terrain, if possible.

(4)
Tips for leader training.

(a)
Leaders should familiarize themselves with the procedures for setting up your type unit AO.

(b) Leaders should review the unit and higher echelon TSOPs.

(c)
If possible, leaders should conduct a reconnaissance of the training area where setup will take place.

b.
Tips for Training.

(1)
After the unit demonstrates proficiency for the tasks in this STX, this STX can be trained under several options:

4-29
(a)
With or without OPFOR interdictions.

(b)
With or without NBC conditions.

(c)
In a field or MOUT environment.

(2)
The unit must become proficient in the basics of setting up before attempting complex actions.

(3)
After proficiency in this STX is reached, the unit sustains proficiency by executing this STX as part of an FTX.

4.TTraining Enhancers.
a.
The advance/quartering party has secured the site and has prepared for the arrival of the main body. The unit must be prepared to establish their area of operations and to set up defensive positions to defend against day or night air, ground, or terrorist attacks and to protect against NBC operations.

b.
The unit establishes the new operating site IAW the layout plans. When the site is operational, the higher echelon S2/S3 is notified that the unit is prepared to perform its operational mission.

c.
Unless otherwise approved by the chief OC, all reports and recommendations should be provided in hard copy to the senior trainer for evaluation.

d.
This exercise begins when the unit advance/quartering party arrives at the new site and ends when the unit area is established. AARs are conducted as shown in Table 4-11. Table 4-11 is a suggested scenario.

5.TGeneral Situation.
a.
The advanceiquartering party has performed preliminary security and organization of the new site. The unit has established the unit area and defensive positions.

b.
A site reconnaissance has been performed.

c.
A tentative layout plan and defense plan are available.

d.
Sufficient supplies and equipment are available.

e.
NBC detection equipment is available.

f.
The exercise is conducted in a field site or MOUT environment.

g.
The OPFOR has the potential to conduct ground, air, and NBC warfare.

h.
This exercise is conducted in all environmental conditions.

DODDOA-003743
Table 4-11. Sample light, light-medium, and medium companies STX C-3 scenario Estimated Time
Sequence Event
1 Perform advance/quartering party activities 4 hr
1 2 Establish unit area of operations Organize unit defense 6 hr 2 hr
6 AAR 1 hr
TOTAL TIME: 13 hr

NOTE 1: Events will be performed to standard, not time limitation. The time required to train an event will vary based on METT-T factors and the training proficiency of the unit. NOTE 2: Additional time is required if large portions of the exercise are conducted at night, under limited visibility, or under MOPP conditions.
6.
FRAGO. The commander issues the following FRAGO: "S2/S3 has directed all units to go to MOPP 2 conditions based on reports of enemy threat capabilities. All elements report reaching the condition."

7.
Support Requirements.

a.
Minimum Trainers and OCs. This exercise should be conducted with the unit commander as the trainer and primary OC. A minimum of two OCs is required.

b.
OPFOR.

(1)
The OPFOR should not be more than squad size with one crew-served weapon.

(2)
The MILES can be used or the OCs can assess damage to equipment and personnel casualties.

(3)
The OPFOR should be well-trained in threat tactics, have specific missions, and be controlled when used.

c.
Vehicles and Communications. Vehicles and communications equipment organic to the unit are used. When OPFOR is employed, vehicles and radios for the OCs are needed.

d.
Maneuver Area. Depending upon the LTA, it is desirable to have an adequate training area that is 1.5 by 1.5 kilometers.

e.
Master Incident List. During the STX, the MIL is essential to provide input to drive actions.

f.
Consolidated Support Requirements. Table 4-12, page 432, shows the suggested

-
support requirements for this STX.
4-31
DODDOA-003744
-
Table 4-12. Sample consolidated support requirements for STX C 3

AMMUNITION QUANTITY
5.56mm (Blank) 30 rds/wpn
5.56mm (Blank) 50 rds/wpn OPFOR
7.62mm (Blank) 100 rds/wpn
7.62mm (Blank) 250 rds/wpn OPFOR
Smoke Grenades 8 each OPFOR
Arty Simulator 4 each OPFOR
CS Grenade 4 each OPFOR
Blank Adapter 1 per wpn
Blank Adapter 1 per wpn OPFOR
MILES 1 set per soldier
MILES 1 set per soldier OPFOR
EQUIPMENT

All authorized organic equipment to include TOE and CTA.
FUEL
Multiply the pieces of equipment times the amount of fuel per mile or hour times the tentative operating mileage or hour.
NBC EQUIPMENT
AN/ODR-T1 (Radiation Survey Set) M72A2 Chemical Stimulant 2 each CS Grenades (Practice) 4 each
OTHER
Meals Based on ration cycle War Wound Moulage Set 1 each Aircraft for Simulated Air Attack 1 each
NOTE: The consolidated support requirements outlined for this STX are intended as suggestions. Local policies or constraints may not allow for providing the items.
8.TT&EO Sequence. Table 413 lists the T&EOs for this STX.
-
Table 413. T&EOs from chapter 5 to use in evaluating STX C3
--
T
TASK TITLE TASK NUMBER PAGE
Perform Advance/Quartering Party Activities . 63-2-4008.5-20
.
Occupy New Operating Site 63-2-4009.5-25
DODDOA-003745
Table 4-13. T&EOs from chapter 5 to use in evaluating STX C-3 (continued)
TASK NUMBER PAGE

TASK TITLE
Use Passive Air Defense Measures Take Active Air Defense Measures Against Hostile Aircraft Set Up Truck Platoon Set Up Unit Defense Prepare Unit for Nuclear, Biological, and Chemical Conditions Employ Operations Security Measures Respond to the Initial Effects of a Nuclear Attack Prepare Unit for Level WM Threat Employ Physical Security Measures Treat Casualties Supervise Maintenance Platoon Operations Set Up Maintenance Platoon Headquarters and Sections Combat Battlefield Stress Process Enemy Prisoners of War Process Captured Documents and Equipment Transport Casualties Perform Risk Management Procedures Set Up Unit Headquarters and Bivouac Areas Perform Unit-Level Maintenance Supervise Truck Platoon Operations Plan Occupation of New Area of Operations Plan Unit Defense
63-2-4307 63-2-4308 55-2-0007 63-2-4011 63-2-4013 63-2-4016 63-2-4020 63-2-4022 63-2-4306 08-2-0003.63-0001 43-2-4535 43-2-4570 63-2-4303 63-2-4304 63-2-4305 63-2-4316 63-2-4326
63-2-4518
63-2-4552
55-2-0010
63-2-4007
63-2-4410
5-143 5-147 5-151 5-170 5-176 5-181 5-192 5-199 5-229 5-243 5-272 5-274 5-309 5-313 5-316 5-323 5-328 5-334 5-338 5-349 5-360 5-363
4-33
Table 4-13. T&EOs from chapter 5 to use in evaluating STX C-3 (continued)

TASK TITLE. TASK NUMBER PAGE
Plan Area Damage Control Operations . 63-2-4014.5-368
Maintain Communications. 63-2-4017.5-371

LIGHT, LIGHT-MEDIUM, AND MEDIUM COMPANIES
STX C-4
PROVIDE TRUCK TRANSPORTATION

1.
Objective. This STX trains the unit in providing truck transportation. This STX provides the commander and key leaders practice in planning, coordinating, and controlling transportation assets. The unit must become proficient in performing truck operations.

2.
Interface.

a.
This STX supports the unit FTX--Provide Motor Transport Services.

b.
This STX supports the higher echelon STX--Direct Transportation Support.

3. Training.
a. Leader Training.
(1)
This STX can be used to provide truck transportation as a part of a CPX or an FTX.

(2)
During classroom activities, the use of the TSOP and responsibilities and procedures in FM 3-3, FM 7-8, FM 19-4, FM 44-8, and FM 55-30 should be discussed; and the T&EOs listed in this STX should be reviewed.

(3)
CPX, CFX, and TEWT provide ground training for leaders when the STX exact area is used.

(4)
Games and simulations are developed to teach leaders as part of a continuing officer and NCO development program. They also are used to exercise command and control at various command and staff levels.

(5)
Tips for leader training.

(a)
Leaders should familiarize themselves with the procedures for planning and executing transportation support.

(b)
Leaders should review the unit and higher echelon TSOP.

(c)
A map/route reconnaissance should be conducted, if possible.

b.
Tips for Training.

(1)
After the unit demonstrates proficiency for the tasks in this STX, this STX can
be trained under several options:

4-35
DODDOA-003748
(a)
In a field or MOUT environment.

(b)
With or without NBC conditions.

(c)
Day or night.

(d)
With or without OPFOR interdictions.

(2)
The unit must become proficient in maintaining the programming of unit assets for providing transportation services before attempting complex actions.

(3)
After proficiency in this STX is reached, the unit sustains proficiency by executing this STX as part of an FTX.

4. Training Enhancers.
a.
The unit may conduct a tactical road march while performing transportation support. The unit must be prepared at any time to defend the convoy against air, ground, or threat attacks during the day or night and be prepared to respond appropriately to enemy or friendly chemical or nuclear operations.

b.
The unit receives commitments from higher HQ to provide transportation services.

c.
Unless otherwise approved by the chief OC, all reports and recommendations are provided in hard copy to the senior trainer for evaluation.

d.
This exercise begins when the unit receives commitments from higher HQ and ends when commitments are completed. AARs are conducted as shown in Table 4-14. Table 4-14 is a suggested scenario.

-
NOTE 1: Events will be performed to standard, not time limitation. The time required
Table 4-14. Sample light, light-medium, and medium companies STX C-4 scenario

Sequence Event Estimated Time
1 Commander issues guidance 10 min
2 Provide truck transportation 8 hr
3 Employ operations security measures 50 min
4 Defend convoy against threat situations 1 hr
7 Continue providing truck transportation 1 hr
11 Final AAR 1 hr
TOTAL TIME: 12 hr
to train an

event will vary based on METT-T factors and the training proficiency of the unit. NOTE 2: Additional time is required if large portions of the exercise are conducted at night, under limited visibility, or under MOPP conditions.
5. General Situation.
a.
The unit has established its new operating site. Its mission is to provide transportation support.

b.
Pertinent maps and overlays are available.

c.
The new AO may be in a field or MOUT environment.

d.
The commander has formulated a tentative layout and defensive plan prior to reconnaissance of the new site.

e.
The OPFOR is capable of launching air and ground attacks and engaging in NBC warfare and EW.

f.
This exercise is conducted in all environmental conditions.

6.
FRAGO. The commander is conducting a meeting where he provides the following FRAGO: "We will be operating around the clock performing transportation support. Key leaders and first line supervisors must ensure that vehicles are maintained to support transportation operations."

7.
Support Requirements.

a. Minimum Trainers/OCs. This exercise should be conducted with the unit commander as the trainer and primary OC. A minimum of two OCs is required.
b. Opposing Force.
(1)
The OPFOR may or may not be required when the exercise is conducted as part of a CPX. The OPFOR should be used if the exercise is part of an FTX.

(2)
The OPFOR should have specific missions and be controlled whenever used.

(3)
MILES can be used, or the OC can assess damage to the unit.

c.
Vehicles and Communications. Vehicles and communications equipment organic to the unit are used. When OPFOR is employed, a vehicle and radio are needed for the OC.

d.
Maneuver Area. A training area of sufficient size, approximately 250 by 250 meters, is required to support the vehicles and equipment.

Master Incident List. During the STX, MIL is essential to provide input to drive unit
e.
actions.
f. Consolidated Support Requirements. Table 4-15 shows the suggested support requirements for this STX.
Table 4-15. Sample consolidated support requirements for STX C-4
AMMUNITION _QUANTITY
5.56 mm (Blank) 120 rds/per wpn
7.62 mm (Blank) 100 rds/per wpn
Smoke Grenades 4/per unit/OPFOR Arty Simulator 4/per OPFOR MILES 1 set per soldier/equipment
Blank Adapters 1 per wpn
EQUIPMENT
All organic equipment including TOE and CTA items authorized.
FUEL
Multiply the pieces of equipment times the amount of fuel per mile or hour times the tentative
operating mileage or hour.
NBC EQUIPMENT QUANTITY
AN/PDR-T1 (Radiation Survey Set) 1 per unit
M72A2 Kit: Chemical Stimulant 1 each
CS Grenades 4/per OPFOR

DODDOA-003751
_ ,
Table 4-15. Sample consolidated support requirements for STX C-4 (continued) OTHER
Field rations as required War Wound Moulage Set 1 each
NOTE: The consolidated support requirements outlined for this STX are intended as suggestions
only. Local policies or constraints may not allow for provisioning of all the items in this table.
8. T&EO Sequence. Table 4-16 lists the T&EOs for this STX.
Table 4-16. 1'&E0s from chapter 5 to use in evaluating STX C-4 TASK TITLE TASK NUMBER PAGE
Conduct Tactical Road March 63-2-4003 5-14 Use Passive Air Defense Measures 63-2-4307 5-143 Take Active Air Defense Measures Against Hostile Aircraft 63-2-4308 5-147 Cross a Radiologically Contaminated Area 63-2-4005 5-153 Defend Convoy Elements 63-2-4006 5-162 Employ Operations Security Measures 63-2-4016 5-181.• Perform Operational Decontamination • 63-2-4018 5-186 Respond to the Initial Effects of a Nuclear Attack 63-2-4020 5-192 Cross a Chemically Contaminated Area 63-2-4226 5-222 Employ Physical Security Measures 63-2-4306 5..229 Respond to a Chemical Attack 63-2-4334 5-233 Treat Casualties 08-2-0003.63-0001 5-243 Perform Maintenance Control Functions 43-2-0050 5-254 Provide Repair Parts Supply Support 43-2-0096 5-258 Perform Recovery Operations 43-2-4071 5-263 Maintain Records and Publications 43-2-4392
5-266
4-39

DODDOA-003752
ARTEP 55-718-30-MTP
Table 4-16. T&EOs from chapter 5 to use in evaluating STX C-4 (continued)

TASK TITLE
Perform Controlled Exchange of Repair Parts Perform Combat Repair Teams Functions Supervise Maintenance Platoon Operations Transport Personnel and Cargo Transport Dry and Refrigerated Containerized Cargo Transport Bulk Water Transport Bulk Petroleum Provide Human Resources Support Combat Battlefield Stress Process Enemy Prisoners of War Process Captured Documents and Equipment Perform Field Sanitation Functions Transport Casualties Perform Risk Management Procedures Provide Unit Supply Support
Perform Unit-Level Maintenance Provide Command and Control of Transportation Operations Supervise Truck Platoon Operations Maintain ITV, Redirect Operators, and Provide Commitments
Using MTS Maintain Communications
TASK NUMBER PAGE
43-2-4394 5-268 43-2-4508 5-270 43-2-4535 5-1 72 55-2-0011 5-278 55-2-0038 5-285 55-2-0040 55-2-0041 5-299 63-2-4015 5-305 63-2-4303 5-309 63-2-4304 5-313 63-2-4305 5-316 63-2-4315 5-319 63-2-4316 5-323 63-2-4326 5-328 63-2-4515 5-33I 63-2-4552 5-338 55-2-0009 5-345 55-2-0010 5-349
55-2-0016 5-352 63-2-4017 5-371
-
LIGHT, LIGHT-MEDIUM, AND MEDIUM COMPANIES
STX C-5
DEFEND ASSIGNED AREA

1..Objective. This STX trains the unit in planning and coordinating defense of its unit areas. This STX provides the commander and key leaders practice in passive and active defense measures, selection of defensive positions, coordinating defensive fires, area damage control procedures, first aid, and providing truck transportation services in a hostile environment. The unit must become proficient in defending its area of operation.
2..Interface.
a.
This STX supports the unit FTX-Provide Motor Transport Services.

b.
This STX supports the higher echelon STX-Supervise Force Protection Activities.

3.
.Training.

a.
Leader Training.

(1)
This STX can be used to support defensive operations as a part of a CPX or an FTX.

(2)
During classroom activities, the use of the TSOP, the responsibilities and procedures outlined in the unit's doctrinal publications, and the T&EOs listed in this STX should be reviewed.

(3)
Leaders should use a tnap of the actual area where the STX is to be conducted, and a sand table model to match the actual terrain, if possible.

(4)
Tips for leader training.

(a)
LeaderS should familiarize themselves with the procedures for defensive measures.

(b) Leaders should review the unit and higher echelon TSOPs.

(c)
If possible, leaders should conduct a map/ground reconnaissance of
the training area where setup will take place.

b. Tips for Training.
(1) After the unit demonstrates proficiency in the tasks for this STX, this STX can be trained under several options:
4-41
(a)
With or without OPFOR interdictions.

(b)
With or without NBC conditions.

(c)
In a field or MOUT environment.

(2)
The unit must become proficient in the basics of defensive operations before attempting complex actions.

(3)
After proficiency in this STX is reached, the unit sustains proficiency by executing this STX as part of an FTX.

4.
.Training Enhancers.

a.
The unit should have established the defensive positions. The unit must be prepared at any time to defend against air, ground, or terrorist attacks during the day or night, and to respond appropriately to enemy, friendly, or NBC operations.

b.
The unit establishes the new operating site defensive positions IAW the layout plans. When the site is operational, the higher echelon S2/S3 is notified that the unit is prepared to perform its operational mission.

c.
Unless otherwise approved by the chief OC, all reports and recommendations should be provided in hard copy to the senior trainer for evaluation.

d.
This exercise begins when the unit receives notification of an attack and ends after the

unit completes ADC operations. AARs are conducted as shown in Table 4-17. Table 4-17 is a suggested scenario.
Table 4-17. Sample light, light-medium, and medium companies STX C-5 scenario

Sequence Event Estimated Time
1 Receives notification of attack 10 min
2 Occupy fighting positions 15 min
3 Increase perimeter manning 20 min
4 Assemble reaction force 30 min
5 React to Level I threat 30 min
6 Respond to NBC attack 1 hr
7 Perform decontamination and monitoring operations 1 hr
8 Receive notification of Level II/III ground attack 10 min
9 Increase defense preparation 30 min
10 Defend against OPFOR attack 1 hr
11 Detect threat 15 min
12 Engage threat 30 min
13 Request indirect fire or close air support 15 min
14 Disengage threat 30 min
15 Conduct hasty displacement 1 hr
16 Handover battle to tactical combat force/MP 30 min

Table 4-17. Sample light, light-medium, and medium companies STX C-5 scenario

(continued)
Sequence Event Estimated Time
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 Reorganize unit Conduct ADC Treat casualties Evacuate casualties Perform mortuary affairs operations Reconstitute unit AAR 1 hr 2 hr 1 hr 1 hr 2 hr 3 hr 1 hr
TOTAL TIME: 19 hr, 42 min

NOTE 1: Events will be performed to standard, not time limitation. The time required to train an event will vary based on METT-T factors and the training proficiency of the unit. NOTE 2: Additional time is required if large portions of the exercise are conducted at night, under limited visibility, or under MOPP conditions.
5.
.General Situation.

a.
The unit has established defensive positions. The unit is ready to defend at any time while performing transportation support operations.

b.
A map/ground reconnaissance has been performed.

c.
Sufficient supplies and equipment are available.

d.
NBC detection equipment is available.

e.
The exercise is conducted in a field site or MOUT environment.

f.
The OPFOR has the potential to conduct ground, air, and NBC warfare.

g.
This exercise is conducted in all environmental conditions.

6..FRAGO. The unit commander issues the following FRAGO: "S2/S3 has directed all units go to MOPP 2 conditions based on reports of enemy threat capabilities. All elements report reaching the condition."
7.
.Support Requirements.

a.
Minimum Trainers and OCs. This exercise should be conducted with the unit commander as the trainer and primary OC. A minimum of two OCs is required.

b.
OPFOR.

(1) The OPFOR should not be more than squad size with one crew -served weapon.
4-43
DODDOA-003756
--
(2)
The MILES can be used or the OCs can assess damage to equipment and personnel casualties.

(3)
The OPFOR should be well-trained in threat tactics, have specific missions, and be controlled when used.

c.
Vehicles and Communications. Vehicles and communications equipment organic to the unit are used. When OPFOR is employed, vehicles and radios for the OCs are needed.

Depending upon the LTA, it is desirable to have an adequate training
d. Maneuver Area.
area, which is 1.5 by 1.5 kilometers.
e.
Master Incident List. During the STX, the MIL is essential to provide input to drive actions.

f.
Consolidated Support Requirements. Table 4-18 shows the suggested support requirements for this STX.

Table 4-18. Sample consolidated support requirements for STX C-5

AMMUNITION QUANTITY
5.56mm (Blank) 30 rds/wpn
5.56mm (Blank) 50 rds/wpn OPFOR
7.62mm (Blank) 100 rds/wpn
7.62mm (Blank) 250 rds/wpn OPFOR
Smoke Grenades 8 each OPFOR
Arty Simulator 4 each OPFOR
CS Grenade 4 each OPFOR
Blank Adapter 1 per wpn
Blank Adapter 1 per wpn OPFOR
MILES 1 set per soldier
MILES 1 set per soldier OPFOR
EQUIPMENT

All authorized organic equipment to include TOE and CTA.

FUEL QUANTITY
Multiply the pieces of equipment times the amount of fuel per mile or hour times the tentative
operating mileage or hour.

NBC EQUIPMENT
AN/ODR-T1 (Radiation Survey Set)
M72A2 Chemical Stimulant 2 each
CS Grenades (Practice) 4 each .

Table 4-18. Sample consolidated support requirements for STX C-5 (continued) OTHER
Based on ration cycle
Meals War Wound Moulage Set 1 each Aircraft for Simulated Air Attack 1 each
NOTE: The consolidated support requirements outlined for this STX are intended As suggestions. Local policies or constraints may not allow for providing the items.
8..T&EO Sequence. Table 4-19 lists the T&EOs for this STX.
Table 4-19. T&EOs from chapter 5 to use in evaluating STX C-5 TASK NUMBER PAGE
TASK TITLE.
Use Passive Air Defense Measures 63-2-4307 5-143 Take Active Air Defense Measures Against Hostile Aircraft 63-2-4308 5-147 Employ Operations Security Measures 63-2-4016 5-181 Respond to the Initial Effects of a Nuclear Attack 63-2-4020 5-192 Defend Against a Level I Attack 63-2-4021 5-195 Conduct Hasty Displacement 63-2-4023 5-202 Defend Unit Area 63-2-4024 5-205 Perform Withdrawal Under Fire 63-2-4025 5-210 Reorganize Unit Defense 63-2-4026 5-213 Execute Battle Handover 63-2-4027 5-216 Perform Area Damage Control Functions 63-2-4028 5-219 5-219
Employ Physical Security Measures 63-2-4306 Respond to a Chemical Attack 63-2-4334 5-233 Destroy Supplies and Equipment 63-2-4522 5-238 Treat Casualties 08-2-0003.63-0001 5-243
4-45
Table 4-19. T&EOs from chapter 5 to use in evaluating STX C-5 (continued) TASK TITLE TASK NUMBER PAGE Perform Unit Mortuary Affairs Operations 10-2-4513 5-248 Combat Battlefield Stress 63-2-4303 5-309 Process Enemy Prisoners of War 63-2-4304 5-313 Process Captured Documents and Equipment 63-2-4305 5-316 Transport Casualties 63-2-4316 5-323 Perform Risk Management Procedures 63-2-4326 5-328 Plan Unit Defense 63-2-4010 5-363
LIGHT, LIGHT-MEDIUM, AND MEDIUM COMPANIES
STX C-6
REDEPLOY UNIT TO HOME STATION

1..Objective. This STX trains the.unit in redeploying the unit from a theater of operations to home station or new area of operations. The unit must become proficient in planning and preparing the unit for redeployment operations.
2..Interface.
a.
This STX supports the unit FTX—Provide Motor Transport Services.

b.
This STX supports the higher echelon STX-Supervise Redeployment of Subordinate Elements to Home Station.

3.
.Training.

a.
Leader Training.

(1)
This STX can be used to plan and implement redeployment (land, sea, or air) of the unit as a part of an FTX.

(2)
During classroom activities, the use of the TSOP and the responsibilities and procedures outlined in FMs 55-9, 55-10, 55-12, 55-65, 90-26, and 100-17; ARs 220-10, 700-84, and 750-1 should be discussed and the T&EOs listed in this STX should be reviewed.

(3)
The leader should use a map of the area where the STX is to be conducted and a sand table model to match the actual terrain, if possible.

(4)
CPX, CFX, and TEWTs provide ground training for leaders when the exact area of the STXs is used.

(5)
Simulations and games teach leaders as part of a continuing officer and NCO development program.

(6)
Tips for leader training.

(a)
Leaders should familiarize themselves with the procedures for planning and executing redeployment operations.

(b) Leaders should review the higher echelon and unit SOPs.

(c)
Leaders should conduct a map/ground reconnaissance of the training area where redeployment activities will take place, if possible.

4-47
b. Tips for Training.
(1)
After the unit has demonstrated proficiency in the tasks for this STX, this STX can be trained under several options:

(a)
Inclement weather.

(b)
Multiple increments.

(c)
Different mode of transportation.

(d)
Day or night.

(2)
The unit must become proficient in the basics of planning and executing basic redeployment before attempting complex actions.

(3)
After proficiency in this STX is reached, the unit sustains proficiency by executing this STX as part of an FTX.

4. Training Enhancers.
a.
The unit commander in coordination with the higher echelon S2/S3 secure required redeployment SOPs.

b.
UMO/NCO updates unit redeployment plans in coordination with higher echelon staff.

c.
The higher echelon S2/S3 provides unit with the redeployment sequence.

d.
Unless otherwise approved by the chief OC, all reports and recommendations should be provided in hard copy to the senior trainer for evaluation.

e.
This exercise begins with receipt of a warning order and ends upon completion of redeployment activities. AARs are conducted as shown in Table 4-20. Table 4-20 is a suggested scenario.

5. General Situation.
a.
The unit is employed in a theater of operations and is to be redeployed to CONUS. The unit is under the command and control of a higher echelon element.

b.
Section leaders provide personnel and equipment status reports.

c.
The base support elements provide required redeployment support.

d.
This exercise is conducted in all environmental conditions.

Sequence Event
Receive and verify warning order for redeployment 30 min 1 hr
Table 4-20. Sample light, light-medium, and medium companies STX C-6 scenario Estimated Time

2 3 Perform administrative and SRP activities Dismantle current operating site 2 hr
4 Inspect vehicles and equipment 2 hr
5 Load vehicles and equipment 3 hr
6 7 AAR Receive movement order 1 hr 30 min
8 Conduct nontactical road march 1 hr
9 Arrive APOE/SPOE 10 min
..10 Perform stas activities. , 1 hr
11 Perform embarkation activities 1 hr
12 AAR 1 hr
13 Arrive APOD/SPOD 30 min
14 Perform debarkation activities 1 hr
15 Perform staging activities 30 min
30 min

16 Receive movement order to new area of operations
1 hr
17 Conduct nontactical road march 18 Arrive home station or new operating site 30 min 19 Conduct home station or new operating site activities 2 hr
2 hr
20 Final AAR TOTAL TIME: 20 hr, 17 min NOTE 1: Events will be performed to standard, not time limitation. The time required to train an event will vary based on METT-T factors and the training proficiency of the unit. NOTE 2: Additional time is required if large portions of the exercise are conducted at night, under limited visibility, or under MOPP conditions.
6.
FRAGO. The unit commander issues the following FRAGO: "Alternative route A will be used for moving to TAA/RAA located at . (grid coordinates). Prepare to move within.hours."

7.
Support Requirements.

a. Minimum Trainer and OCs. This exercise should be conducted with the unit commander as the trainer and primary OC. A minimum of two OCs is required.
b. Opposing Force. None.
c.
Vehicles and Communications. Vehicles and communications equipment organic to the unit are used.

d.
Maneuver Area. A road network is required that allows a road march of at least 25 kilometers.

4-49
During this STX, the MIL is essential to provide input to drive
e. Master Incident List.
unit actions.
f. Consolidated Support Requirements. Table 4-21 shows the suggested support requirements for this STX.
Table 4-21. Sample consolidated support requirements for STX C -6
AMMUNITION QUANTITY
NONE
EQUIPMENT
All organic equipment to include TOE and CTA authorized. Rail and aircraft load simulations.
FUEL
Multiply the pieces of equipment times the amount of fuel per mile or hour times the tentative operating mileage or hour.
NBC EQUIPMENT NONE
RATIONS
NOTE: The consolidated support requirements outlined for this STX are intended as suggestions. Local policies or constraints may not allow for providing the items.
8. T&EO Sequence. Table 422 lists the T&EOs for this STX.
-
-
Table 422. T&EOs from chapter 5 to use in evaluating STX C 6
-
TASK TITLE TASK NUMBER PAGE
Prepare Unit for Nontactical Move 63-2-4807 5-54
Conduct Nontactical Road March 63-2-4808 5-58
Perform Redeployment Human Resources Actions 63-2-4814 5-86
Perform Redeployment Training Activities 63-2-4815 5-90
Perform Redeployment Supply Activities 63-2-4816 5-93
Perform Redeployment Maintenance Activities 63-2-4817 5-96
Prepare Vehicles and Equipment for Redeployment 63-2-4818 5-101

Table 4-22. T&EOs from chapter 5 to use in evaluating STX C-6 (continued)
TASK TITLE
Perform Sea Port of Embarkation Activities for Redeployment Perform Aerial Port of Embarkation Activities for Redeployment Perform Aerial Port of Debarkation Activities for Redeployment Perform Home Station Activities Perform Sea Port of Debarkation Activities for Redeployment Perform Demobilization Station Activities Employ Operations Security Measures Employ Physical Security Measures Combat Battlefield Stress Perform Risk Management Procedures Plan Unit Move Plan Unit Redeployment TASK NUMBER PAGE 63-2-4819 5-1 10 63-2-4820 5-117 63-2-4821 5-122 63-2-4822 5-125 63-2-4823 5-129 63-2-4824 5-133 63-2-4016 5-181 63-2-4306 5-229 63-2-4303 5-309 63-2-4326 5-328 63-2-4001 5-356 63-2-4829 5-389
4-51

DODDOA-003764
CHAPTER 5
TRAINING AND EVALUATION OUTLINES
GENERAL. This chapter contains the T&EOs for all the collective tasks that the unit
5-1..
must perform in order to accomplish its critical wartime mission. The unit commander uses T&EOs for training and internally evaluating the unit. Higher HQ also uses the T&EOs to evaluate unit performance.
STRUCTURE. Table 5-1, pages 5-3 through 5-7, is a list of all the T&EOs in this MTP.
5-2..
The mission to collective task matrix in Chapter 2 lists the T&EOs required to train the critical wartime missions according to their specific BOS.
FORMAT. The T&EOs are the training objective prepared for every collective task that
5-3..supports the critical wartime mission accomplishment. Each T&EOs contains the following
components:
a.
Element. The element identifies the unit or unit element that is required to perform the task.

b.
Task. A task is an event that has a start and stop, is measurable, and supports a specific mission.

c.
Task Number. The task number is in parentheses following the task title. This number is used to identify the task throughout the MTP.

d.
References. The references for each task are in parentheses following the task number. The underlined reference is the primary reference. This reference contains the most information concerning the task.

e.
Iteration. Iterations (1 through 5) are used to identify the number of times a task is performed and evaluated during training or an exercise. If the task has been performed more than once, the iteration will indicate the quality of the latest performance. The letter "M" stands for MOPP and will be circled by the evaluator if tasks are performed under MOPP conditions.

f.
Training Status. The training status is used to record the evaluation of the unit's ability
to perform the task. The rating is circled each time the task is evaluated. The two ratings are:

(1)
GO. The unit successfully performed all the task/task steps (subtasks) and
standards with no significant shortcomings.

(2)
NO GO. The unit failed to successfully accomplish the task/task steps
(subtasks) and standards.

g.
Conditions. The conditions statement of the T&EO describes the wartime environment
under which the task is performed. The statement begins with an initiating cue which is an action
taken by a unit or individual outside or within the unit. The cue acts as a catalyst to create the
necessity to perform the task.

h.
Task Standard. The task standard states the ultimate outcome criteria for the task.

5-1
DODDOA-003765
i. Subtasks. Subtasks are actions or events that must take place for a task to be performed. The task steps are sequentially arranged where the performance sequence is important for the correct performance of the task.
NOTE: Leader task steps are identified by an asterisk "*" placed to the left of the critical task step (subtask) symbol "+" which is placed at the immediate left of the task step (subtask) number. The individual and leader tasks that support the collective task are identified in parentheses at the end of the subtask.
j.
Standards. Detailed standards are listed for each task step. The standards for the task . step is the accomplishment of all event standards for the task step. For example, "a" through "h" (task steps) must be completed before the standard is met.

k.
GO/NO GO Column. The GO/NO GO column is used to record the performance of the standards. Each standard for a task step must be evaluated and an "x" placed in the appropriate column. A major portion of the standards for a task step must be marked a "GO" for the task step to be successfully performed.

5-4. OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS. These tasks and standards provide overall OPFOR performance standards for selected collective tasks. These tasks and standards also ensure that OPFOR soldiers accomplish meaningful training. The OPFOR must always attain its task standards, using doctrine and tactics consistent with the type of enemy they are portraying.
5-5..USAGE OF T&EO. The T&EO is used individually to train personnel in a single task. It is used in sequence with other T&EOs to train personnel in and/or evaluate a larger group of tasks, such as an FTX or STX. The T&EOs should be used through more than five iterations of evaluations, either by making copies or using pencil entries to record results.
5-2
(
DODDOA-003766

Table 5-1. List of Unit T&EOs
TASK NUMBER PAGE
TASK TITLE
DEPLOY/CONDUCT MANUEVER
63-2-4002 5-8
Prepare Unit to Move
63-2-4003 5-14
Conduct Tactical Road March Perform Advance/Quartering Party Activities 63-2-4008 5-20 Occupy New Operating Site 63-2-4009 5-25 Perform Deployment Alert Activities 63-2-4801 5-28 Perform Human Resources Predeployment Activities 63-2-4802 5-32 Perform Predeployment Training Activities 63-2-4803 5-36 Perform Predeployment Supply Activities 63-2-4804 5-38 Perform Predeployment Maintenance Activities 63-2-4805 5-42 Prepare Vehicles and Equipment for Deployment 63-2-4806 5-47 Prepare Unit for Nontactical Move 63-2-4807 5-54 Conduct Nontactical Road March 63-2-4808 5-58 Perform Sea Port of Embarkation Activities for Deployment 63-2-4809 5-62 , Perform Aerial Port of Embarkation Activities for Deployment 63-2-4810 5-68 Perform Aerial Port of Debarkation Activities for Deployment 63-2-4811 5-73 Perform Sea Port of Debarkation Activities for Deployment 63-2-4812 5-77 Prepare Equipment Reception Team for Tactical Road March 63-2-4813 5-82 Perform Redeployment Human Resources Actions 63-2-4814 5-86 Perform Redeployment Training Activities 63-2-4815
5-90 Perform Redeployment Supply Activities 63-2-4816
5-93 Perform Redeployment Maintenance Activities 63-2-4817
5-96
5-3
Table 5-1. List of Unit T&EOs (continued)
TASK NUMBER PAGE

TASK TITLE
Prepare Vehicles and Equipment for Redeployment
Perform Sea Port of Embarkation Activities for Redeployment
Perform Aerial Port of Embarkation Activities for Redeployment Perform Aerial Port of Debarkation Activities for Redeployment
Perform Home Station Activities
Perform Sea Port of Debarkation Activities for Redeployment
Perform Demobilization Station Activities
Conduct Integration Activities
Conduct Staging Activities
EMPLOY FIREPOWER
Use Passive Air Defense Measures
Take Active Air Defense Measures Against Hostile Aircraft
PROTECT THE FORCE
Set Up Truck Platoon Cross a Radiologically Contaminated Area Defend Convoy Elements Set Up Unit Defense Prepare Unit for Nuclear, Biological, and Chemical Conditions Employ Operations Security Measures Perform Operational Decontamination Perform Thorough Decontamination Respond to the Initial Effects of a Nuclear Attack Defend Against a Level I Attack 63-2-4818 63-2-4819 63-2-4820 63-2-4821 63-2-4822 63-2-4823 63-2-4824 63-2-4825 63-2-4826
63-2-4307 63-2-4308
55-2-0007 63-2-4005 63-2-4006 63-2-4011 63-2-4013 63-2-4016 63-2-4018 63-2-4019 63-2-4020 63-2-4021
5-101
5-110
5-117
5-122
5-125
5-129
5-133
5-137
5-139

5-143
5-147

5-151
5-153
5-162
5-170
5-176
5-181
5-186
5-189
5-192
5-195

DODDOA-003768
Table 5-1. List of Unit T&EOs (continued)
TASK TITLE. Prepare Unit for Level II/III Threat Conduct Hasty Displacement Defend Unit Area Perform Withdrawal Under Fire
Reorganize Unit Defense Execute Battle Handover Perform Area Damage Control Functions Cross a Chemically Contaminated Area Employ Physical Security Measures Respond to a Chemical Attack Destroy Supplies and Equipment
PERFORM CSS AND SUSTAINMENT
Treat Casualties Perform Unit Mortuary Affairs Operations Perform Maintenance Control Functions Provide Repair Parts Supply Support Perform Recovery Operations Maintain Records and Publications Perform Controlled Exchange of Repair Parts Perform Combat Repair Teams Functions Supervise Maintenance Platoon Operations Set Up Maintenance Platoon Headquarters and Sections
TASK NUMBER PAGE
63-2-4022 5-199 63-2-4023 5-202 63-2-4024 5-205 63-2-4025 5-210 63-2-4026 5-213 63-2-4027 5-216 63-2-4028 5-219 63-2-4226 63-2-4306 63-2-4334 5-233 63-2-4522 5-238
08-2-0003.63-0001 5-243 10-2-4513 5-248 43-2-0050 5-254 43-2-0096 5-258 43-2-4071 5-263 43-2-4392 5-266 43-2-4394 5-268 43-2-4508 5-270 43-2-4535 5-272 43-2-4570 5-274
5-5
Table 5-1. List of Unit T&EOs (continued)
TASK NUMBER PAGE

TASK TITLE
Transport Personnel and Cargo
Transport Dry and Refrigerated Containerized Cargo Transport Bulk Water Transport Bulk Petroleum Provide Human Resources Support Combat Battlefield Stress Process Enemy Prisoners of War Process Captured Documents and Equipment Perform Field Sanitation Functions Transport Casualties Perform Risk Management Procedures Provide Unit Supply Support Set Up Unit Headquarters and Bivouac Areas Perform Unit-Level Maintenance
EXERCISE COMMAND AND CONTROL
Provide Command and Control of Transportation Operations Supervise Truck Platoon Operations Maintain ITV, Redirect Operators, and Provide Commitments
Using MTS Plan Unit Move Plan Occupation of New Area of Operations Plan Unit Defense Plan Area Damage Control Operations Maintain Communications
55-2-0011 55-2-0038 55-2-0040 55-2-0041 63-2-4015 63-2-4303 63-2-4304 63-2-4305 63-2-4315 63-2-4316 63-2-4326 63-2-4515 63-2-4518 63-2-4552
55-2-0009 55-2-0010
55-2-0016 63-2-4001 63-2-4007 63-2-4010 63-2-4014 63-2-4017 5-278
5-285
..5-292 5-299 5-305 5-309 5-313 5-316 5-319 5-323 5-328 5-331 5-334 5-338
5-345
5-349
5-352
5-356
5-360
5-363
5-368
5-371

DODDOA-003770
Table 5-1. List of Unit T&EOs (continued)
TASK NUMBER PAGE Establish Communications. 63-2-4040 5-377 Plan Unit Mobilization in a Peacetime Environment .63-2-4827 5-380 Plan Unit Deployment Activities Upon Receipt of a Warning Order 63-2-4828
TASK TITLE.
5-385 Plan Unit Redeployment. 63-2-4829 5-389
5-7
/
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Prepare Unit To Move (63-2-4002) (FM 55-30, FM 100-14, FM 21-26, FM 24-35, FM 3-100, FM 3-3, STP 21-1-SMCT, STP 21-24-SMCT, STP 55-88II-MQS)
M.(circle)ITERATION. 1.2.3.4.5.
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT . T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit has been directed to move to a designated location. The displacement plan is complete and unit leaders brief soldiers on the plan. Movement can occur in a field or MOUT environment. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD, the unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. The higher HQ staff element has selected tentative route(s) of march and tasked the unit for a reconnaissance party to reconnoiter the route(s). Area reconnaissance has been coordinated by higher HQ staff element. The higher HQ staff element and unit commander briefs the reconnaissance party. The convoy, serial, and march commanders have been designated, as appropriate. Strip maps are provided by the higher HQ staff element. Load plans are available. An advance/quartering party is dispatched prior to completion of this task. SOI/SSI is available. This task is conducted day or night under all environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and ground Level I threat forces attack. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Unit is ready to cross SP NLT time prescribed in movement order. At
MOPP4, performance degradation factors increase movement preparation time.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
1. Reconnaissance party conducts route reconnaissance.
a.
Wears or carries designated uniform and equipment IAW
TSOP and higher HQ guidance.

b.
Activates the automatic chemical alarm(s) system, if
available, on lead vehicle.

c.
Positions chemical detector paper where it can be observed at
all times.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO.'
d.
Positions dosimeters where they can be constantly monitored.

e.
Verifies analog/digital map information along route(s) for accuracy.

f.
Lists capacities of all bridges and underpasses.

g.
Identifies locations of all culverts, ferries, fording areas, steep grades, and possible ambush sites.

h.
Prepares overlay depicting route, obstructions, and key natural and man-made features using analog and/or digital communications.

i.
Computes travel time and distance from a proposed SP to RP.

j.
Debriefs higher HQ staff element and unit commander upon return.

2. Unit prepares vehicles and equipment.
a.
Performs before-operations PMCS on all vehicles and equipment.

b.
Corrects all vehicle and equipment discrepancies within the operator's capabilities IAW applicable TM.

c.
Reports all deficiencies beyond operator's capability to immediate supervisor. _

d.
Removes all unit identification markings on vehicles.

e.
Covers all reflective surfaces of all vehicles or cargo with available materials.

f.
Hardens all vehicles using sandbags and/or other authorized materials.

g.
Places antennas at lowest height.

h.
Turns radio volume and squelch to lowest operational setting consistent with operational requirements.

5-9

DODDOA-003773
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
i.
Sets radio to eliminate operating sounds and lights when moving at night.

j.
Verifies analog and/or digital devices are functioning properly. .

3. Unit dismantles current operating site.
a.
Strikes tentage and camouflage nets IAW applicable TMs and within time specified in the displacement plan.

b.
Loads all designated equipment JAW unit load plans and within time specified in the displacement plan.

c.
Disguises all critical equipment and supplies with tarpaulins or any other authorized covering.

d.
Dismantles wire, analog, and/or digital communications devices, antennas, generators, and power cables within time specified in the displacement plan.

e.
Removes all signs of area occupation.


f. Positions all stay-behind party vehicles and equipment in areas that provide cover and do not impede departure of main body vehicles.

g.
Dispatches advance/quartering party NLT time specified in movement order.

*4. March commander and leaders organize convoy.
a.
Assign vehicle positions with the heavier, slower vehicles placed first.

b.
Assign digital device equipped control vehicles without setting a pattern.

c.
Assign recovery vehicle(s) positions where they can move to disabled vehicles without disrupting convoy movement.

d.
Assign hardened vehicle(s) with crew-served weapons interspersed throughout the convoy.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO, NO GO
e.
Assign passenger locations where all unit personnel have a
position and semi-automatic and automatic weapons are alternated
throughout the convoy to cover front, rear, and flanks.

f.
Assign soldiers to air guard duties with specific search . sectors covering 360 degrees.

g.
Assign sufficient number of recovery vehicles and
mechanics to trail party element.

h.
Provide vehicle position listing with location of all vehicles
to the trail party leader.

i.
Open analog and/or digital net(s) as specified in the SOI and
movement order.

*5. March commander and leaders conduct premovement inspections.
a.
Inspect personnel, equipment, weapons, and ammunition for
compliance with commander's guidance, unit TSOP, and higher HQ
movement order.

b.
Inspect organizational equipment for accountability and
serviceability.

c.
Inspect vehicles, trailers, and loads for serviceability, proper
stowing, and security.

d.
Verify operability of analog and/or digital communications
devices...

e.
Forward personnel and equipment status to unit HQ and
higher HQ staff element using analog or digital communications
devices.

*6. March commander conducts briefings for convoy personnel.
a.
Provides strip maps to each vehicle driver.

b.
Briefs convoy chain of command.

c.
Briefs convoy route.

d.
Prescribes the rate of march and catch-up speeds.

5-11

DODDOA-003775
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
e.
Briefs vehicle intervals.

f.
Identifies scheduled halts.

g.
Briefs safety, accident, and breakdown procedures.

h.
Briefs immediate action security measures.

i.
Briefs blackout condition procedures.

j.
Identifies location of medical support.

k.
Identifies location of maintenance support.

1. Provides location and identification of destination.
m.
Briefs arm/hand signals. .•

n.
Briefs communications frequencies and call signs for control
personnel, security force commander, fire support elements, reserve
security elements, and medical transportation support.

7. Unit prepares to cross SP.
a.
Maintains situational awareness using analog and/or digital
communications devices.

b.
Positions all vehicles under overhead cover.

c.
Clears all individual and crew-served weapons.

d.
Posts air guards in positions designated by convoy
commander.

e.
Posts security guards to maintain 360-degree surveillance.

f.
Forwards movement readiness report to higher HQ staff
element using analog and/or digital communications.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
DODDOA-003776
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS
Task Number Task Title References
01-7300.75-0500 031-503-1020 071-331-0820 Plan Convoy Operations Detect Chemical Agents Using M9 Detector Paper Analyze Terrain STP 55-8811-MQS STP 21-1-SMCT STP 21-24-SMCT

OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE

5-13

DODDOA-003777
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Conduct Tactical Road March (63-2-4003) (FM 55-30, FM 3-3, FM 3-4, STP 21-1-SMCT, STP 21-24-SMCT, STP 55-8811-MQS)
.
4.5.M.(circle)
ITERATION. 1 2.3.
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT . T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The time specified in the movement order to cross the SP has arrived. All equipment is uploaded and vehicles are positioned for departure. The route of march is identified. Convoy operations may be performed during the day or night, including blackout conditions. The convoy may go through an urban area. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD with annexes, including overlays with checkpoints, RP, and critical points are available. Digital and/or analog device, radio, and visual signals are used for convoy column control. Column may conduct halts during movement. This task is performed day or night under all environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and ground Level I threat forces attack. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: SP, checkpoints, and RP are crossed at times specified in the movement order or at times adjusted on the road movement table by higher HQ staff element. At MOPP4, performance degradation factors increase travel time.
— TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. March commander initiates convoy.

a.
Maintains situational awareness at all times using analog
and/or digital communications.

b.
Directs lead vehicle to cross SP at specified time.

c.
Verifies vehicles have crossed the SP.

d.
Forwards SP crossing report to higher HQ staff element
when unit elements have crossed the SP using analog and/or digital
communications.

514
-
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO *2. March commander reports convoy information to higher HQ staff element.
NOTE: All reports are made to higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications.
a.
Forwards checkpoint clearance report as checkpoints are crossed.

b.
Reports all ground sightings that conflict with maps and map overlays.

c.
Forwards enroute NBC information.

d.
Reports all threat sightings using SALUTE format.

e.
Employs correct SOUSSI codes in all transmissions. *3. March commander enforces march discipline.

a.
Maintains situational awareness at all times using analog and/or digital communications.

b.
Assumes position(s) along march route that provides command presence at points of decision for reaction to changing tactical situation.

c.
Enforces all movement policies defined in the TSOP and movement order, with emphasis on formation, distances, speeds, passing procedures, and halts.

d.
Adjusts formation distances and speed consistent with NBC, terrain, and light conditions.

e.
Enforces security measures, with emphasis on air guard's surveillance, manning of automatic weapons, and concealment of critical cargo.

f.
Communicates violations of march discipline, security procedures, or changes to current orders to unit leaders and operators by analog, digital, or visual signal communications.

g.
Enforces COMSEC measures, including radio silence periods IAW the movement order and SOUSSI.

5-15
DODDOA-003779
GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
4. Unit employs march discipline.
a.
Maintains designated march speed specified in movement order or as prescribed by the convoy commander.

b.
Maintains proper vehicle interval as specified in movement order or as adjusted by the convoy commander.

c.
Adjusts formation distances and speed consistent with NBC, terrain, and light conditions.

d.
Dons eye protection goggles if driver or passenger is in a vehicle without cover or when windshield is lowered.

e.
Crosses all checkpoints as scheduled.

f.
Reacts correctly to convoy commander's arm/hand signals or instructions by analog and/or digital communications.

g.
Maintains ground and air surveillance that covers 360 degrees until movement is completed.

h.
Maintains communications security.

5. Unit conducts scheduled halt(s).
a.
Stops column at prescribed time and location.

b.
Moves vehicles off-road to positions that provide overhead cover while maintaining the prescribed interval between vehicles.

c.
Occupies hasty defensive positions with 360-degree protective coverage (passengers).

d.
Reports scheduled halt to the battalion CP.

e.
Performs during-operation PMCS on vehicles (operators).

f.
Inspects vehicle loads for safety and security.

g.
Begins departure at specified time in the movement order.

h.
Reports resumption of march to higher HQ staff element
using analog and/or digital communications.

GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
6. Unit conducts unscheduled halt(s).
a.
Alerts march column with prescribed arm/hand signal.

b.
Reports halt and circumstances immediately to higher HQ staff element by analog and/or digital communications.

c.
Moves vehicles off the road while maintaining the prescribed interval between vehicles.

d.
Occupies hasty fighting position with 360-degree protective coverage.

e.
Resumes march as soon as reason for halt is rectified.

f.
Reports resumption of march to higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications.

7. Trail party recovers disabled vehicle.
a.
Posts guard to maintain surveillance until recovery operation is completed.

b.
Inspects disabled vehicle for repairability.

c.
Repairs disabled vehicle, when possible.

d.
Tows disabled vehicle to applicable maintenance activity.

e.
Reports vehicle status to convoy commander using analog and/or digital communications.

8. Unit conducts a night convoy.
a.
Briefs drivers on night conditions.

b.
Provides visual adjustment period if march began during daylight.

c.
Prepares vehicles for blackout conditions IAW the TSOP.

d.
Maintains prescribed interval between vehicles.

e.
Wears night vision goggles (selected personnel).

5-17
DODDOA-003781
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES f. Wears regular eye protection goggles (all other personnel). GO NO GO
g. Employs ground guides during poor visibility periods.
9. Unit conducts convoy through an urban area.
a. Verifies all weight, height, and width restrictions along route of march.
b. Employs close column formation.
c. Obeys traffic control directions unless escorted by military or HN police.
d. Employs directional guides at all critical intersections.
10. Convoy commander monitors unit crossing RP. •
a. Verifies that lead vehicle has crossed RP at specified time.
b. Verifies that vehicles that have crossed RP.
c. Forwards SITREP to higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications.
TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO" TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO" TOTAL
"*" indicates a leader task step.

SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS
Task Number Task Title References
01-7300.75-0500 Plan Convoy Operations STP 55-8811-MQS
031-503-3008 Implement Mission-Oriented Protective STP 21-24-SMCT
Posture
071-326-3013 Conduct a Tactical Road March STP 21-24-SMCT
071-329-1006 Navigate From One Point on the Ground to STP 21-24-SMCT
Another Point While Dismounted
071-331-0820 Analyze Terrain STP 21-24-SMCT
01-7200.75-0100 Conduct Convoy Operations STP 55-8811-MQS

OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE

5-19

DODDOA-003783
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters 3 Truck Platoon Headquarters 6 Truck Squads Maintenance Section 2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters 4 Light Truck Squads Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters Light Truck Squad Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Perform Advance/Quartering Party. Activities (63-2-4008) (FM 10-27-2, FM 10-27-3, FM 3-100.4, FM 55-30, STP 21-1-SMCT, STP 21-24-SMCT)
4.5.M.(circle)
ITERATION. 1.2.3.
.

T.P.U.(circle)
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT
CONDITIONS: Departure time for the advance/quartering party has arrived, and the party is prepared to depart the assembly area. MOPP2 has been designated. All essential information, such as route, order of march, and estimated arrival time of main body, has been provided by higher HQ staff element. The party leader has been issued tentative unit layout, hasty defense, and traffic plans. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD, the unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. The advance/quartering party possesses all required equipment. Sufficient guides, markers, and other equipment are available. Upon arrival at the new AO, the higher HQ advance/quartering party leader assigns specific unit setup areas. The main body arrives before completion of this task. This task is conducted day or night under all environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and ground Level I threat forces attack. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: All preparation, tasks are accomplished at the new operation site as
directed by the higher HQ staff element and unit commander and the main body moves into
position. At MOPP4, performance degradation factors increase execution times.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
1. Advance/quartering party moves to new operating site.
a.
Wears uniform as prescribed by the higher HQ movement
order and TSOP.

b.
Crosses SP, checkpoints, and RP as prescribed by movement
order maintaining situational awareness using analog and/or digital
communications.

GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
c.
Follows prescribed route from old to new area maintaining situational awareness using analog and/or digital communications.

d.
Reports route changes and/or information to main body by messenger, route guides, route markers, other nonelectronic means, analog and/or digital communications.

2. Advance/quartering party assists in securing the entire higher HQ area.
a.
Assumes designated MOPP level before entering new area.

b.
Provides required number of personnel for initial security teams.

c.
Provides required personnel and equipment to conduct NBC surveys of assigned area.

3. Advance/quartering party secures the unit's new AO.
a.
Places OPs on probable avenues of approach consistent with the available personnel.

b.
Parks vehicles and trailers in covered positions with mirrors turned toward the ground.

c.
Conducts NBC survey of the entire assigned unit area.

NOTE: If survey team(s) monitor high levels of contamination, area should be -..tvacuated immediately.
d. Conducts sweep of unit area to locate all mines, booby traps, and other signs of threat presence.
*4. Advance/quartering party leader supervises area preparation tasks.
a.
Conducts unit area site reconnaissance with subelement leaders, pointing out assigned areas and traffic circulation IAW layout and traffic plans.

b.
Verifies movement of subelements into their respective areas
to ensure compliance with layout plan.

c.
Establishes internal communications system using runner
until wire communications have been established.

5-21
GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
d.
Enforces OPSEC measures during area preparation.

e.
Establishes unit area entrance and exit points with unit personnel as guards.

f.
Assigns to subelements the task of blocking all other possible entrance and exit points into the unit area.

g.
Enforces safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications.

h.
Enforces environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

5. Advance/quartering party leader supervises area preparation tasks.
a.
Marks location of CP IAW the unit layout plan.

b.
Marks location of bivouac and administrative areas IAW the layout plan.

c.
Lays communication wire from CP to all subelements.

d.
Marks unit area traffic direction IAW the traffic plan.

e.
Erects required tentage at locations IAW the layout plan.

f.
Sets up radio antenna(s) in locations as required by the layout plan.

g.
Marks vehicle positions vllowing maximum dispersion consistent with size of area and tactical situation.

h.
Marks subelements defensive boundaries IAW the security plan.

i.
Erects barriers to block all unauthorized entrances and exits into and out of the CP area.

j.
Employs camouflage and concealment measures consistent with tactical situation.

k.
Employs noise and light discipline measures.

1. Employs communication security measures.
-
GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
in. Employs safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications.
n. Employs environmental stewardship protection program procedures.
6. Advance/quartering party prepares an urbanized area.
a.
Selects buildings within assigned area that provide maximum cover, concealment, and protection.

b.
Selects building for CP that provides a line of sight for antenna(s).

c.
Clears all assigned buildings of booby traps and any unnecessary items.

d.
Erects barriers to close off or channel personnel and vehicles into designated areas.

e.
Establishes OPs and defensive positions in upper stories of buildings.

f.
Employs safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications.

g.
Employs environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

*7. Advance/quartering party leader supervises reception of main body.
a.
Identifies guide pickup points using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

b.
Briefs ground guides on moving main body into their respective areas with emphasis on OPSEC.

c.
Monitors subelement guides activities to ensure compliance with guidance by party leader and the higher HQ and unit TSOP.

d.
Enforces counter-surveillance measures.

5-23
a
GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
8. Advance/quartering party performs guide functions.
a.
Guides elements into assigned positions without having
vehicles stop in exposed areas.

b.
Employs prearranged signals IAW the higher HQ and unit
TSOP.

c.
Parks one vehicle at a time during darkness or reduced
visibility.

d.
Employs filtered flashlights during darkness or reduced
visibility.

e.
Employs counter-surveillance measures during reception
activities.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
M
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS
Task Number Task Title References
031-503-3008 Implement Mission-Oriented Protective STP 21-24-SMCT Posture 071-326-5705 Establish an Observation Post STP 21-24-SMCT
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Occupy New Operating Site (63-2-4009) (FM 21-75, FM 10-27-2, FM 10-27-3, FM 20-3, FM 21-10, FM 3-100.4, FM 5-103, FM 55-30, FM 63-2, FM 63-20, FM 63-21, FM 63-2-1, STP 21-1-SMCT, Si? 21-24-SMCT)
.
ITERATION 1.2.3.4.5.M.(circle)
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT . T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit's main body is moving into assigned positions in a new operating site. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD with all annexes and overlays, the unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. Advance/quartering party leader briefs the commander on the status of site preparation. The commander assembles element leaders for briefing. Movement into the new area can occur during the day or night. While the unit is moving into position, the threat has the capability to launch a surprise attack with a small group. This task is performed day or night under all environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and ground Level I threat forces attack. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Unit completes initial camouflage and security functions within 20
minutes of arrival in new area. Commander finalizes layout plan within 30 minutes of arrival at
new area.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
1. Unit moves vehicles into positions.
a.
Reacts correctly to guide's prescribed visual signals.

b.
Takes action to minimize noise.

c.
Takes action to minimize dust and exhaust smoke.

d.
Drives vehicles into predesignated positions without
stopping in exposed areas.

e.
Positions vehicle facing toward roadway to allow for quick
dispersion.

5-25
GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
2. Unit moves vehicles to positions at night.
a.
Picks up guides at dismount point.

b.
Turns off blackout drive lights at dismount point.

c.
Reacts correctly to filtered flashlight signals of guide.

d.
Maintains noise and light discipline. •

e.
Takes action to minimize dust and exhaust smoke.

3. Vehicle operators perform initial camouflage measures.
a.
Reduce reflections by turning mirrors toward the ground.

b.
Employ natural terrain patterns, available overhead cover, and shadows.

c.
Cover windshields with available natural or artificial materials.

d.
Remove vehicle tracks by using available sweeping materials.

e.
Perform after-operations PMCS.

4. Unit occupies initial defensive positions (designated personnel only).
a.
Occupies positions as directed by advance/quartering party leader.

b.
Prepares hasty fighting positions that provide frontal protection from direct fire and are at least half a meter (18 inches) deep.

c.
Positions automatic weapons on likely avenues of approach.

d.
Positions individual weapons to protect flanks of automatic weapons and to provide interlocking fires.

e.
Employs hasty camouflage measures to initial security positions.

f.
Employs light and noise discipline along defensive line.

GO NO GO

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
g.
Employs correct challenge and password techniques.

h.
Employs safety measures IAW TSOP and publications.

i.
Employs environmental stewardship protection program
procedures.

*5. Commander finalizes unit layout plan.
a.
Adjusts layout plan as terrain and tactical considerations
require change.

b.
Records adjustment(s) on analog and/or digital map
overlay(s).

c.
Identifies camouflage requirements based on terrain features.

d.
Identifies essential tasks to be completed.

e.
Briefs sub-element leaders on fmal layout plan and tasks to
be performed.

f.
Enforces safety measures IAW TSOP and publications.

g.
Enforces environmental stewardship protection program
procedures.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
5-27
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Perform Deployment Alert Activities (63-2-4801) (FM 100-17, AR 220-1, AR 220-10, FM 55-65)
.
(circle)
ITERATION 1.2.4.5.M..
T.P.U.(circle)
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT
CONDITIONS: The unit has been at a normal state of deployment readiness and has received a warning order to prepare for overseas deployment. The CQ or 1 SG has notified the commander. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The unit movement plan, recall plan, security plan, unit and higher HQ access rosters, and current maps are available. The unit has a trained officer or NCO appointed as UMO and alternate UMO. Main body personnel, advance party personnel, SPOE team, equipment reception team, packing and crating team. weighing and marking team, rail loading team, and supercargoes have been designated by the commander and trained in their duties. The unit is deploying as part of a higher HQ deployment. Alert notification activities are performed day or night under all environmental conditions. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Unit personnel are recalled IAW the recall plan. All personnel are present or accounted for and briefings are conducted for unit personnel and deployment teams lAW movement plan. Security is established I.AW security plan.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Commander supervises deployment alert notification activities.

a.
Directs the CQ or 1 SG to implement the recall plan.

b.
Coordinates with higher HQ commander for guidance
concerning deployment requirements.

c.
Briefs unit leaders on deployment and mission requirements.

d.
Directs UMO to update movement plan, deployment SOP,
and marshaling plans, as required.

e.
Assigns additional and/or replacement personnel to
deployment teams, as required.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
f.
Monitors security of unit area for compliance with security plan.

g.
Monitors recall of unit personnel to ensure recall time standards are met and personnel accountability is accomplished JAW recall plan..•

h.
Submits reports to higher HQ IAW recall plan, security plan, deployment OPORD, and movement plan using analog and/or digital communications.

i.
Briefs higher HQ commander and staff on status of deployment alert activities.

2. Unit HQ performs recalls personnel accountability functions.
a.
Initiates recall procedures IAW recall plan.

b.
Sets up central check-in IAW recall plan.

c.
Checks personnel as they arrive, to ensure only personnel listed on current access rosters enter the unit area.

d.
Annotates recall roster to indicate personnel are present for duty as they arrive.

e.
Computes percent present for duty IAW recall plan.

f.
Briefs commander on present-for-duty status as recall progresses.

g.
Disestablishes control check-in point when 100 percent of unit are present or accounted for.

*3. UMO assembles deployment teams.
a.
Identifies unit deployment team requirements by reviewing movement plan.

b.
Confirms personnel are available for designated deployment teams.

c.
Requests commander assign additional and/or replacement deployment team members, as required.

5-29
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
d.
Briefs deployment teams on their duties and responsibilities IAW the movement plan.

e.
Briefs commander on status of deployment teams. *4. Unit leaders supervise unit element alert activities.

a.
Monitor arrival of unit element personnel to ensure all personnel are accounted for.

b.
Supervise establishment of security of assigned area IAW security plan.

c.
Brief personnel on deployment. *5. Section chiefs and/or team leaders supervise alert activities.

a.
Inspect personnel as they arrive to ensure all have required clothing and personal gear.

b.
Inspect alert bags to ensure all personal gear is present and serviceable.

c.
Assign personnel to security posts IAW security plan.

d.
Brief unit element leaders on alert status.

6. Unit performs recall activities.
a.
Relays alert notification, as required.

b.
Reports for duty unit HQ IAW recall plan.

c.
Repairs or replaces personal gear, as required.

d.
Performs security functions, as required.

e.
Provides dependents with information on deployment, as permitted.

• TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
ITERATION 1
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS: NONE
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
5-31

DODDOA-003795
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters 3 Truck Platoon Headquarters 6 Truck Squads Maintenance Section 2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters 4 Light Truck Squads Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters Light Truck Squad Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Perform Human Resources Predeployment Activities (63-2-4802) (AR 220-10, AR 220-1, FM 100-17, FM 55-10, FM 55-65)
ITERATION.1.2.3.4.5.M.(circle)
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT . T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit has activated the recall plan. Unit personnel are accounted for and are prepared for predeployment processing. 51 has provided a SRP processing schedule to the commander. The unit has coordinated with the 51 for assistance, as needed. Transportation to move the unit to the.processing center is available. The deployment SOP, movement plan, family assistance plan, and higher HQ deployment OPORD are available. The unit has analog and digital communications with higher HQ. The unit is deploying as part of a higher HQ deployment. SRP activities are performed day or night under all environmental conditions. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Predeployment personnel and administrative activities are accomplished
IAW the movement plan, deployment OPORD, Si SRP processing schedule, and commander's
guidance.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Commander directs personnel and administrative predeployment
activities.

a.
Directs HQ to update the unit USR using current data JAW
AR 220-1.

b.
Directs the XO/1 SG to publish a unit SRP processing
schedule based on the S1 SRP processing schedule.

c.
Forwards list of nondeployable personnel to the higher HQ
staff element using analog and/or digital communications.

d.
Directs personnel to complete SRP processing activities.

DODDOA-003796
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
e.
Directs personnel to secure POVs and personal property IAW movement plan.

f.
Directs XO to prepare briefing for dependents.

g.
Directs XO to update family assistance plan, as required.

h.
Requests that the SI appoint pay agents during deployment, if necessary, using analog and/or digital communications.

i.
Coordinates with S1 Section to close out fund account using analog and/or digital communications.

j.
Coordinates through higher HQ and port commander to identify number of supercargoes (unit personnel traveling with unit equipment) authorized and POC for supercargoes using analog and/or digital communications.

NOTE: Performance step "j" is not used by the IBCT.
k. Briefs battalion commander on status of SRP activities.
2. Unit HQ processes SRP records.
a.
Delivers unit SRP records to SRP processing site.

b.
Verifies that 100 percent of deploying personnel have processed.

c.
Returns SRP records to company HQ.

d.
Delivers SRP records to battalion rear detachment prior to departure.

3. Unit HQ performs personnel replacement functions.
a.
Identifies nondeployable personnel by reviewing monthly USR, 1 SG daily report, and SRP processing results.

b.
Coordinates with higher HQ staff element for replacement personnel using analog and/or digital communications.

c.
Recommends assignment of replacement personnel to commander.

5-33

DODDOA-003797
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES , GO NO GO
d.
Assigns replacement personnel IAW commander's instructions.

e.
Updates the family assistance plan, as required.

4. Unit HQ monitors unit SRP activities.
a.
Publishes unit SRP processing schedule based on movement plan, SI section SRP processing schedule, and commander's guidance.

b.
Distributes unit SRP processing schedule to platoons and sections.

c.
Monitors SRP processing to ensure activities are completed JAW SRP processing schedule.

d.
Coordinates with the higher HQ staff element for additional SRP processing using analog and/or digital communications, as required.

e.
Briefs commander on SRP processing status. *5. Unit leaders supervise personnel and administrative SRP activities.

a.
Direct personnel to complete SRP processing IAW SRP processing schedule.

b.
Designate personnel to assist contact teams in SRP processing activities, as required.

c.
Monitor SRP processing to ensure activities are completed IAW SRP processing schedule.

d.
Coordinate with the UMO/NCO for additional SRP processing, as required.

e.
Identify nondeployable personnel.

f.
Coordinate personnel replacement with company HQ.

g.
Monitor securing of POVs and personal property for compliance with movement plan and commander's instructions.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
h.
Brief personnel on family assistance plan.

i.
Brief commander on results of SRP processing.

6. Company personnel perform SRP activities.
a.
Perform SRP contact team functions, as directed.

b.
Complete processing activities, as directed.

c.
Secure POVs and personal property IAW movement plan
and commander's instructions.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"s" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS: NONE
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
5-35
DODDOA-003799
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Perform Predeployment Training Activities (63-2-4803) (AR 350-41, AR 220-10, AR 350-1, FM 100-17, FM 55-65, TC 25-20)
.
3.4.5.M.(circle)
ITERATION 1.2.
.

COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit is preparing for deployment to an overseas site. Sufficient time exists for the unit to conduct predeployment training. The commander has designated a training officer and NCO. The unit deployment SOP, movement plan, higher HQ deployment OPORD, and training records are available. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The unit is deploying as part of a higher HQ deployment. Predeployment training is performed day or night under all environmental conditions. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Predeployment training is accomplished lAW the training schedule and
commander's guidance.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Commander directs predeployment training activities.

a.
Identifies training requirements through coordination with
unit leaders and review of the movement plan and training records.

b.
Identifies special training requirements by reviewing
deployment OPORD and coordinating with the higher HQ staff
personnel.

c.
Directs training officer to develop a unit training schedule to
correct training deficiencies.

d.
Designates personnel to receive training JAW higher HQ
staff personnel's instructions.

e.
Briefs higher HQ commander on status of predeployment
training.

536
-
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*2. Training officer/NCO supervise predeployment training activities.
a.
Develop training schedule based on movement plan,
deployment OPORD, specialized training requirements identified by
higher HQ and commander's guidance.

b.
Coordinate training support with the higher HQ staff
personnel using analog and/or digital communications, as required.

c.
Provide training schedule to S2/S3 section and unit leader, as
appropriate.

d.
Monitor training to ensure appropriate training is provided to
personnel.

e.
Brief commander on status of predeployment training.
*3. Unit leaders perform predeployment training activities.

a.
Coordinate with UMO for required training support using analog and/or digital communications. •

b.
Conduct training JAW training schedule, if required.

c.
Annotate training results on individual and team training
records.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
5-37

DODDOA-003801
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters 3 Truck Platoon Headquarters 6 Truck Squads Maintenance Section 2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters 4 Light Truck Squads Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters Light Truck Squad Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Perform Predeployment Supply Activities (63-2-4804) (AR 710-2, AR 220-10, AR 700-84, AR 725-50, AR 735-5, FM 100-17, FM 3-100.4)
.
5.M.(circle)
ITERATION 1.2.3.4.
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT .T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit is preparing for deployment to an overseas site. Basic loads of ammunition, rations, equipment identified TAT, and repair parts are available. The unit movement plan, TSOP, and higher HQ deployment OPORD are available. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The unit is deploying as part of a higher HQ deployment. Predeployment supply activities are performed day or night under all environmental conditions. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Predeployment supply activities are accomplished JAW the movement
plan, TSOP, and commander's guidance.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO *1. Commander directs predeployment supply activities.
a.
Identifies float and/or replacement equipment and additional
supply requirements to the movement plan deployment supply list based
on the deployment OPORD, METT-TC, and coordination with the
higher HQ staff personnel.

b.
Coordinates with the higher HQ staff element for issue of
additional supplies using analog and/or digital communications, as
required.

c.
Coordinates with the higher HQ staff element issue of float
and/or replacement equipment using analog and/or digital
communications, as necessary.

d.
Directs unit leaders to provide supply and equipment
requests to supply sergeant.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
e.
Directs supply sergeant to request required supplies and equipment.

f.
Briefs higher HQ commander and higher HQ staff personnel on supply status, as required.

g.
Enforces environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

2. Unit elements perform predeployment supply activities.
a.
Identify shortages of supplies and equipment by conducting inventories and inspections.

b.
Inventory soldier's personal belongings that are designated to remain in the unit area.

c.
Secure personal belongings remaining in the unit area.

d.
Submit requests for supplies and equipment to supply sergeant JAW TSOP, as required.

e.
Issue individual basic loads, as required.

f.
Employ safety procedures IAW TSOP and applicable publications.

g.
Employ environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

3. Unit HQ provides supply support.
a.
Submits requests to servicing SSA to upgrade FAD on all requisitions already in the system.

b.
Coordinates with the S4 for additional DODAACs to be requested, as needed, for the rear detachment and deploying detachments using analog and/or digital communications.

c.
Submits changes of the "ship-to" address for the unit DODAAC to the servicing SSA, to ensure correct routing of requested supplies to the unit's deployment address using analog and/or digital communications.

5-39

DODDOA-003803
GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
d.
Submits requests for issue of personal clothing and equipment to S4 section JAW AR 700-84 using analog and/or digital communications.

e.
Submits request for basic loads and required supplies and equipment to S4 Section IAW Movement Plan and TSOP using analog and/or digital communications.

f.
Submits request for eyeglasses, inserts, and hearing aids to the S4 section using analog and/or digital communications, as required.

g.
Requests supplies to support movement operations (BBPCT, dunnage, and pallet covers).

h.
Draws basic loads JAW S4 section's instructions.

i.
Coordinates with S4 section to resolve outstanding requisitions using analog and/or digital communications.

j.
Coordinates with commander or S4 section for transportation and MHE support using analog and/or digital communications to pick-up, issue, and/or pack deployment supplies, if necessary.

k.
Inspects float and/or replacement equipment for serviceability.

1. Signs for float and/or replacement equipment.
m.
Issues supplies and equipment IAW TSOP, as required.

n.
Secures unissued supplies and equipment IAW TSOP.

o.
Turns in equipment, supplies, and hazardous material to appropriate facility, as required.

p.
Prepares hand receipt annex and/or transfer documentation for unit property being transferred.

q.
Prepares backup of all automated supply systems prior to deployment.

r.
Briefs commander on deployment supply status.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES s. Employs safety procedures IAW TSOP and applicable publications. t. Employs environmental stewardship protection program procedures. GO NO GO
TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO" TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO" TOTAL
"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS: NONE
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE

5-41
DODDOA-003805
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters 3 Truck Platoon Headquarters 6 Truck Squads Maintenance Section 2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters 4 Light Truck Squads Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters Light Truck Squad Medium Truck Squad
TASK: Perform Predeployment Maintenance Activities (63-2-4805) (FM 4-30.3 AR 220-1, AR 700-138, AR 750-1, DA PAM 738-750, DA PAM 750-1, DA PAM 750-35, FM 100-17, FM 3-100.4)

ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M (circle)
TuPuUu(circle)COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT
CONDITIONS: The unit is preparing for deployment to an overseas site. Sufficient time exists for the unit to conduct predeployment maintenance activities. The commander has designated a motor officer. Required tools, equipment, and personnel are available. MSTs are available in the unit maintenance area. The movement plan, maintenance SOP, and higher HQ deployment OPORD are available. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The unit is deploying as part of a higher HQ deployment. Predeployment maintenance is performed day or night under all environmental conditions. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Predeployment maintenance is accomplished TAW the maintenance SOP
and commander's guidance.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Commander directs predeployment maintenance activities.

a.
Monitors maintenance activities for compliance with the
maintenance SOP and commander's guidance.

b.
Approves the use of controlled exchange when required
repair parts are not available.

c.
Checks MCSR for accuracy and completeness.

d.
Forwards MCSR to the S4 section using analog and/or
digital communications.

e.
Coordinates with S4 for maintenance support using analog
and/or digital communications, as required.

GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
f.
Prioritizes internal repair of vehicles and equipment.

g.
Enforces safety procedures IAW TSOP and applicable publications.

h.
Enforces environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

*2. Motor officer/motor sergeant supervises predeployment maintenance activities.
a.
Identifies unit operational readiness levels by reviewing vehicle and equipment status reports, PMCS, and predeployment maintenance checks.

b.
Prepares MCSR IAW AR 220-1 and AR 700-138.

c.
Submits current MCSR to commander.

d.
Submits request for direct support maintenance to •

commander, as required.
e.
Submits request for controlled exchanges to commander for approval.

f.
Designates unit maintenance personnel to assist direct

support maintenance element JAW maintenance SOP and S4 section and commander's instructions.
g.
Directs calibration of tools, if required.

h.
Verifies PLL inventory by conducting spot checks.

i.
Submits request for PLL replenishment to S4 section using analog and/or digital communications, as required.

j.
Verifies completion of repairs by reviewing maintenance
records.

k.
Coordinates with S4 section to identify status of vehicles and
equipment in support maintenance using analog and/or digital
communications.

I.
Coordinates with S4 section to evacuate nondeployable
vehicles and equipment to support maintenance using analog and/or
digital communications.

5-43
GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
m.
Verifies unit member's civilian and military driver's licenses and equipment licenses for validation and reissue, as needed.

n.
Prepares backup of all automated maintenance systems prior to deployment.

o.
Briefs the commander on maintenance status of vehicles and equipment, as required.

p.
Enforces safety procedures LAW TSOP and applicable publications.

q.
Enforces environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

3. Maintenance unit performs field maintenance activities.
a.
Calibrates tools, as required.

b.
Inspects equipment JAW appropriate operator and organizational maintenance TMs.

c.
Records all deficiencies on equipment inspection worksheets.

d.
Corrects unit-level maintenance deficiencies.

e.
Corrects DS-level maintenance deficiencies.

f.
Requests required repair parts from PLL clerk.

g.
Repairs equipment IAW applicable TM(s).

h.
Requests approval for controlled exchange through motor officer or sergeant when required repair parts are not available.

i.
Performs controlled exchange IAW motor officer or sergeant's instructions.

j.
Performs final inspection to ensure quality control of repairs.

k.
Conducts inventory of PLL to confirm shortages IAW PLL listing.

1. Submits request for PLL replenishment to supporting SSA, as
required.

GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
m.
Performs technical inspections of float and/or replacement equipment IAW appropriate TMs and manufacturer's instructions.

n.
Releases equipment to appropriate unit elements.

o.
Employs safety procedures IAW TSOP and applicable publications.

p.
Employs environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

4. Unit HQ conducts transactions with maintenance support elements.
a.
Identifies vehicles and equipment that require maintenance support element support.

b.
Prepares required documentation for submission to maintenance support element.

c.
Delivers vehicles and equipment to maintenance support element.

d.
Picks up equipment from maintenance support element upon notification repairs are completed.

e.
Notifies owning element to pick up vehicles and equipment.

*5. Unit leaders supervise predeployment operator maintenance activities.
a.
Monitor performance of PMCS and predeployment maintenance for compliance with Maintenance SOP, appropriate TM, and commander's guidance.

b.
Inspect vehicles, weapons, and equipment to ensure compliance with Maintenance SOP, appropriate TM, and commander's guidance.

c.
Provide input for MCSR to motor officer, as required.

d.
Enforce safety procedures IAW TSOP and applicable publications.

e.
Enforce environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

5-45
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES 6. Unit performs predeployment operator maintenance. GO NO GO
a. Performs PMCS IAW appropriate TM(s).
b. Notifies supervisor of maintenance problems beyond operator's capabilities.
c. Checks vehicle load plan to ensure required tools and equipment are on hand.
d. Employs safety procedures IAW TSOP and applicable publications. e. Employs environmental stewardship program protection procedures.
TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO" TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO" TOTAL
"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE

ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK: Prepare Vehicles and Equipment for Deployment (63-2-4806) (FM 100-17, AR 220-10, DOD DM 4500.9, FM 21-305, FM 3-100.4, FM 4-30.3, FM 55-9, TB 55-46-1, TM 55-2200-001-12)
ITERATION 2 3 4 5 M (circle)
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT TuPuUu(circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit receives a movement directive to deploy to an overseas site. A railhead is available on the installation. All personnel are present and have been trained on requirements for preparing vehicles and equipment for deployment. Packing and Crating, Weighing and Loading, and Rail Loading Teams have been designated and trained. The Movement Directive, Movement Plan, Deployment SOP, and Deployment OPORD are available. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The unit has a trained officer or NCO appointed as UMO and alternate UMO. The unit is deploying as part of a higher HQ deployment. Equipment preparation is performed day or night under all environmental conditions. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Vehicles and equipment to be deployed are prepared for deployment and
loaded for movement to the APOE or SPOE IAW the Deployment SOP, Movement Plan, and
commander's guidance.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO *1. Commander directs vehicle and equipment preparation activities.
a.
Identifies vehicles, equipment, and supplies to be deployed
based on movement directive, Movement Plan, Deployment OPORD,
higher HQ commander's guidance, and METT-TC.

b.
Identifies personnel, equipment, and vehicles scheduled to
move to the A/SPOE by road or rail by reviewing Movement Plan and
higher HQ commander's guidance.

c.
Designates a unit MA.

d.
Designates storage areas for equipment not to be deployed.

5-47

DODDOA-003811
GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
e.
Coordinates with S4 for disposition of equipment not to be deployed or stored by the unit using analog and/or digital communications.

f.
Provides unit leaders with disposition instructions for equipment not being deployed.

g.
Coordinates with S4 for transportation support to the APOE or SPOE using analog and/or digital communications, if necessary.

h.
Inspects area to ensure all excess vehicles, equipment, and supplies have been turned in or placed in a designated holding area.

i.
Notifies higher HQ S2/S3 when vehicles and containers are loaded and ready to move using analog and/or digital communications.

*2. UMO supervises vehicle and equipment preparation activities.
a.
Updates AUEL to reflect vehicles, equipment, and supplies to be deployed based on physical inventory and commander's guidance.

b.
Updates AUEL to reflect actual weights based on results of weighing and any dimensions beyond those listed in current technical publications for equipment TOE LIN/INDEX NO.

c.
Inputs updated AUEL into the ITO or field movement control element TC-ACCIS station.

NOTE: When verified by the UMO, the updated AUEL becomes the DEL produced by TC-ACCIS.
d.
Provides UMC and/or S4 Section with information on oversize and overweight vehicles, equipment, and cargo requiring special handling, as required.

e.
Coordinates with UMC for DEL, BBPCT material requirements lists, vehicle/rail loading plans and schedules, special hauling permit requests, military shipping labels, and convoy clearance requests produced by TC-ACCIS using analog and/or digital communications.

f.
Coordinates with S4 Section for RF tags for ITV of sensitive/classified cargo, IAW directives from higher HQ using analog and/or digital communications.

GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
g.
Coordinates with S4 Section for packing materials, weighing scales, MHE, containers, inserts, pallets, and other equipment preparation and loading materials using analog and/or digital communications, as required.

h.
Coordinates with S4 for customs inspection per unit SOP using analog and/or digital communications.

i.
Provides unit leaders with deployment forms, shipping labels, and documents, as required.

j.
Coordinates container pick-up with higher HQ staff element.

k.
Provide special instructions to Packing and Crating Teams, if necessary.

1. Provides container packing schedule to unit leaders.
m. Identifies transportation support requirements by reviewing Movement Plan and current vehicle status reports.
.un. Coordinates with S4 Section for movement of vehicles and equipment to rail loading site.
o.
Provides rail loading plan to Rail Loading Team Chief.

p.
Provides Rail Loading Team proper tools to conduct rail
loadout.

q.
Coordinates with UMC for port call message and verification of Movement Plan A/SPOE requirements and procedures.

r.
Conducts risk assessment considering factors such as time,
duration, and cargo to ensure the mission is safely completed.

s.
Briefs commander on status of preparation of vehicles and
equipment for deployment.

*3. Unit leaders supervise preparation of unit elements for deployment.
a.
Verify adequate space has been allowed for personnel items
and secondary loads by reviewing loading plans.

b.
Revise loading plans, as required.

5-49

DODDOA-003813
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
c.
Monitor packing and loading for compliance with Deployment SOP, Movement Plan, and UMO's instructions.

d.
Inspect area to ensure all equipment to be deployed has been packed and/or loaded.

e.
Inspect area to ensure all excess vehicles, equipment, and supplies have been turned in or placed in a designated holding area.

f.
Inspect internal loads to ensure loads are secure and in compliance with loading plans.

g.
Notify UMO of any load plan revisions using analog and/or digital communications.

*4. UMO maintains an up-to-date AUEL.
a.
Conducts physical inventory of vehicles and equipment to be deployed to verify accuracy of AUEL.

b.
Revises AUEL, as required.

c.
Submits AUEL changes to UMC, if necessary.

5. Packing and Crating Teams prepare equipment for deployment.
a.
Pack containers IAW loading plans, DEL, and UMO's instructions.

b.
Pack hazardous materials IAW Deployment SOP, UMO's instructions, and applicable publications.

c.
Prepare container packing lists and shipping documents IAW UMO's instructions and applicable publications.

d.
Distribute container packing lists and shipping documents IAW UMO's instructions and applicable publications.

e.
Place military shipping labels and designated markings on containers IAW Movement Plan, Deployment SOP, and UMO's instructions.

f.
Assist container pick-up crew in loading operations, as required.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
g.
Employ safety procedures JAW TSOP and applicable publications.

h.
Employ environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

6. Unit prepares vehicles, equipment, and personal gear for deployment.
a.
Places equipment not being deployed in designated storage • area IAW Movement Plan and commander's instructions.

b.
Turns in excess vehicles, equipment, and supplies to supply sergeant IAW Deployment SOP and/or commander's instructions.

c.
Packs personal gear IAW Movement Plan.

d.
Marks and/or tags vehicles, equipment, and personal gear IAW Deployment SOP, Movement Plan, and UMO's instructions.

e.
Attaches RF/AIT tags and applies military shipping labels on vehicles and equipment IAW Movement Plan and UMO's instructions.

f.
Moves equipment to be packed in containers, to the container packing area IAW UMO's instructions.

g.
Loads vehicles JAW Deployment SOP, Movement Plan, loading plans, and UMO's instructions.

h.
Moves vehicles to designated area for marshaling or rail loading site, as directed.

i.
Employs safety procedures IAW TSOP and applicable publications.

7. Weighing and Marking Team weighs and marks vehicles for deployment.
a.
Sets up weighing and marking area in designated area IAW Deployment SOP.

b.
Guides vehicles onto scales as they arrive.

c.
Identifies vehicle gross weight.

5-51

DODDOA-003815
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES d. Identifies vehicle axle weights (air movement only). GO NO GO
e. Computes vehicle center of balance based on axle weights (air movement only).
f. Marks center of balance on vehicles IAW Deployment SOP, DOD Dir 4500.9, and UMO's instructions (air movement only).
g. Reports gross weights for each deploying vehicle to UMO.
h. Disestablishes weighing and marking area.
i. Returns vehicle weighing scales IAW UMO or owning facility officials' instructions.
*8. Rail Loading Team OIC/NCOIC supervises rail loading activities.
a. Conducts safety briefing for all unit personnel at the rail loading site IAW local procedures.
b. Coordinates with UMO for rail loading plans.
c. Coordinates with installation UMC to identify special rail loading requirements.
d. Verifies the presence of all rail guards by conducting roll call, if required.
e. Verifies the presence of manifested vehicles and equipment by conducting physical inventory. .
f. Inspects vehicles and equipment for military shipping labels, proper markings, and adequacy of BBPCT procedures.
g. Provides a cargo manifest to conductor, if required.
h. Notifies commander when rail loading is complete.
i. Enforces safety procedures IAW TSOP and applicable publications.
j. Enforces environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
9. Rail Loading Team performs rail loading.
a.
Stages vehicles IAW rail loading plan.

b.
Loads vehicles and equipment on rail cars IAW rail loading
plan and UMO's instructions.

c.
Secures vehicles and equipment IAW rail loading plan and
UMO's instructions.

d.
Notifies Rail Loading Team Chief when rail loading is
complete.

e.
Employs safety procedures IAW TSOP and applicable
publications.

f.
Employs environmental stewardship protection program
procedures.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
ITERATION 1
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a Izader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS: NONE
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
5-53

DODDOA-003817
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters 3 Truck Platoon Headquarters 6 Truck Squads Maintenance Section 2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters 4 Light Truck Squads Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters Light Truck Squad Medium Truck Squad
TASK:uPrepare Unit for Nontactical Move (63-2-4807) (FM 55-30, DOD DIR 4500.9, FM 4-30.3, FM 55-65, FM 55-9, STP 55-881I-MQS)
4u5uMu(circle)
ITERATIONu 1u2u3u
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT u TuPuUu(circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit receives a movement directive to move to the A/SPOE for deployment to an overseas site. Routes, scheduled halts, and logistics and administrative support are available IAW the Movement Plan. Higher HQ has an advanced party at the A/SPOE and the advance party has conducted a route reconnaissance. The convoy,, serial, and march commanders have been designated as appropriate. Security for the move has been coordinated. The Movement Directive, Movement Plan, port call message, load plans, and strip maps are available. Vehicles are loaded and staged for movement in a designated area. The unit has a trained officer and/or NCO appointed as UMO and alternate UMO. The unit is deploying as part of a higher HQ deployment. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. Preparation for movement is performed day or night under all environmental conditions. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Unit is ready to cross SP NLT time prescribed in movement directive.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. UMO supervises preparation for movement to A/SPOE.

a.
Coordinates with higher HQ staff personnel to verify
Movement Plan information for accuracy using analog and/or digital
communications.

b.
Computes travel time and distance from proposed SP to RP.

c.
Compares travel time and start time to verify company will
arrive at A/SPOE IAW port call message.

d.
Inspects vehicles and equipment for proper markings, and
military shipping labels IAW FM 55-9, DOD Dir 4500.9, Movement
Plan, and current instructions.

GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
e.
Notifies higher HQ staff element that unit is ready to move using analog and/or digital communications.

f.
Briefs commander on preparations for movement.

2. Unit prepares vehicles and equipment for movement to A/SPOE.
a.
Performs before-operations PMCS on all vehicles and equipment.

b.
Corrects maintenance discrepancies within the operator's capabilities IAW applicable TM.

c.
Reports all maintenance deficiencies beyond operator's capability to immediate supervisor.

d.
Corrects loading deficiencies IAW loadihg plan, if necessary.

e.
Recomputes vehicle center of balance, if necessary (APOE only).

f.
Re-marks center of balance on vehicle, if necessary (APOE only).

g.
Marks vehicles for movement to A/SPOE IAW DOD Dir 4500.9, FM 55-30, Movement Order, and UMO's instructions.

h.
Places military shipping labels on vehicles and equipment
IAW Movement Plan and UMO's instructions.

i.
Employs safety procedures IAW TSOP and applicable publications.

*3. Convoy, Serial, and March commanders and leaders organize
convoy for movement to A/SPOE.

a.
Assign vehicle positions with the heavier, slower vehicles
placed first.

b.
Assign recovery vehicle(s) positions, where they can move
to disabled vehicles without disrupting convoy movement.

NOTE: Unit will assign MTS equipped vehicles as control vehicles, if
available.

5-55
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
c.
Assign sufficient number of recovery vehicles and mechanics to trail party element.

d.
Provide trail maintenance party with minimum quantities of packaged POL supplies and Class IX ASL/PLL parts to support the convoy IAW FM 55-65.

e.
Provide vehicle position listing with location of all vehicles to the trail party leader.

f.
Open radio net(s) as specified in the Movement Plan.

*4. Convoy, Serial, and March commanders and leaders conduct premovement inspections.
a.
Inspect personnel and their equipment for compliance with Movement Directive, Movement Plan, and commander's instructions.

b.
Inspect organizational equipment for accountability and serviceability.

c.
Inspect vehicles, trailers, and loads for serviceability, proper stowing, and security.

d.
Forward personnel and equipment status to unit HQ and S2/S3 Section using analog and/or digital communications.

*5. Convoy commander conducts briefings for convoy personnel.
a.
Provides strip maps to each vehicle driver.

b.
Briefs convoy chain of command.

c.
Briefs convoy route.

d.
Prescribes the rate of march and catch-up speeds.

e.
Briefs vehicle intervals.

f.
Identifies scheduled halts.

g.
Briefs safety, accident, and breakdown procedures.

h.
Identifies location of maintenance support.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
i.
Provides location and identification of destination.

j.
Briefs arm/hand signals and SOI, including radio frequencies
and call signs.

6. Unit prepares to cross SP.
a.
Stages vehicles for convoy JAW convoy commander's
instructions.

b.
Notifies convoy commander that vehicles are ready to cross
SP for convoy to A/SPOE using analog and/or digital communications.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS
Task Number Task Title References
01-7300.75-0500 Plan Convoy Operations STP 55-88II-MQS
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
5-57

DODDOA-003821
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK: Conduct Nontactical Road March (63-2-4808) (FM 55-30, FM 4-30.3)
ITERATION 1u2u3u4u5uMu(circle)
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT TuPuUu(circle)
CONDITIONS: Time specified to cross SP for convoy to A/SPOE has arrived. All equipment to be moved by convoy is loaded and vehicles are positioned for departure. The route of march is identified and has been traveled by a reconnaissance party. The convoy, serial, and march commanders have been designated, as applicable. All weight, height, and width restrictions along route of march have been verified. Coordination for rest stops, convoy support facilities, and personnel and maintenance support has been accomplished. A security element has been assigned. RP is within the A/SPOE MA. Convoy operations may be performed during the day or night. Radio and visual signals are used for march column control, as appropriate. The movement plan and deployment OPORD are available. Map and overlays with checkpoints, SP, RP, and critical points are available. Column may conduct halts during movement. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: SP, checkpoints, and RP are crossed at times specified in the movement
plan or times adjusted on the road movement table by the convoy commander.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Convoy commander initiates convoy.

a.
Directs lead vehicle to cross SP at specified time.

b.
Verifies vehicles have crossed the SP.

c.
Forwards SP crossing report to S2/S3 section when unit
elements have crossed the SP using analog and/or digital
communications.

558
-
GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES *2. Convoy commander reports convoy information to higher HQ staff element.
a. Forwards checkpoint(s) clearance report as checkpoints are crossed using analog and/or digital communications.
b Employs current SOI/SSI codes in all transmissions. *3. Convoy commander enforces march discipline.
a.
Places directional guides at all critical intersections along route, if necessary.

b.
Assumes position(s) along march route that provides command presence at critical turns or other points of decision.

c.
Enforces all movement policies defined in the movement plan, with emphasis on formation, distances, speeds, passing procedures, and halts.

d.
Adjusts formation distances and speed consistent with roads and speed limits.


e. Enforces security measures to protect equipment and cargo during halts.

f.
Communicates to unit leaders and operators any violations of march discipline or changes to current orders, using analog and/or digital communications or proper visual signals.

4. Unit employs march discipline.
a.
Maintains designated march speed specified in movement plan or as prescribed by the convoy commander.

b.
Maintains proper vehicle interval as specified in movement plan or as adjusted by the convoy, serial, or march commander.

c.
Obeys vehicle driving regulations and safe driving procedures based on conditions.

d.
Crosses all checkpoints as scheduled.

e.
Reacts correctly to convoy, serial, or march commander's
arm/hand signals.

5-59

DODDOA-003823
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
5. Unit conducts scheduled halt(s).
a.
Stops column at prescribed time and location.

b.
Reports scheduled halt to higher HQ staff element, if appropriate, using analog or digital communications.

c.
Performs during-operation PMCS on vehicles (operators).

d.
Inspects vehicle loads for safety and security.

e.
Begins departure at specified time in the Movement Plan or convoy commander's instructions.

f.
Reports resumption of march to higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications, if appropriate.

6. Unit conducts unscheduled halt(s).
a.
Alerts march column withyrescribed arm/hand signal.

b.
Reports halt and circumstances to S2/S3 Section using analog and/or digital communications, if appropriate.

c.
Resumes march as soon as reason for halt is rectified.

d.
Reports resumption of march to higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications, if appropriate.

7. Trail party recovers disabled vehicle.
a.
Inspects disabled vehicle for repairability.

b.
Repairs disabled vehicle, when possible.

c.
Reports vehicle status to convoy commander using analog and/or digital communications.

d.
Tows disabled vehicle to applicable maintenance facility or destination based on convoy commander's instructions.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*8. Convoy commander monitors unit crossing RP.
a.
Verifies that lead vehicle has crossed RP at specified time.

b.
Verifies the vehicles that have crossed RP.

c.
Forwards SITREP to higher HQ staff element using analog
and/or digital communications.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
ITERATION 1
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
5-61

DODDOA-003825
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK: Perform Sea Port of Embarkation Activities for Deployment (63-2-4809) (FM 100-17, DOD DIR 4500.9, FM 3-100.4, FM 55-65, TM 55-2200-001-12)
Mu(circle)
ITERATION 1u2u3u4u5u
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT TuPuUu(circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit's vehicles are in the SPOE MA. The commander has designated a unit liaison team, unit SPOE team (driver party), and SPOE team OIC. The commander or SPOE team OIC has notified higher HQ, the supporting installation, and port commander representatives of the unit's arrival. PSA officials have requested unit vehicle operator's assistance in off-loading unit vehicles deployed to the SPOE by rail. The railhead is located in the SPOE AO, and the unit's equipment has arrived. Transportation, maintenance, and logistics support are available. The movement plan, deployment SOP, marshalling area plan, and deployment OPORD are available. The unit has a trained officer and NCO appointed as UMO and alternate UMO. The unit is deploying as part of a higher HQ deployment. SPOE activities are performed day or night under all environmental conditions. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: SPOE activities are performed IAW Movement Plan and higher HQ staff
and PSA officials' instructions.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
1. Commander or SPOE Team OIC directs SPOE activities.
a.
Directs team to perform after-operation PMCS checks of
vehicles, upon arrival in the SPOE MA.

b.
Identifies transportation requirements for return to unit area.

c.
Coordinates with supporting installation officials for
transportation, maintenance, and logistics support, as required.

d.
Coordinates with PSA officials to verify SPOE movement
schedules, procedures, and requirements.

e.
Briefs team leaders on SPOE movement schedules,
procedures, and requirements.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
f. Briefs UMO on POC for maintenance support.
..
g.
Directs team to offload and inspect equipment arriving by rail.

h.
Coordinates with PSA to identify number of supercargoes authorized and POC for supercargoes.

i.
Coordinates with supercargoes to ensure they are prepared for • sea movement, to include proper orders and equipment.

j.
Briefs supercargoes on boarding schedule, responsibilities, and POC during sea movement.

k.
Conducts acceptance inspection of vehicles, equipment, and cargo with PSA officials.

1. Directs team to correct deficiencies noted during PSA acceptance inspection.
m.
Transfers custody of vehicles, equipment, and cargo to SPOE officials.

n.
Briefs the higher HQ commander or designated representative on status of SPOE activities.

2. Supercargoes representative performs SPOE activities.
a. Reports to port commander's representative JAW UMO's instructions.
. b. Performs SPOE activities JAW port commander's instructions.
c.
Coordinates with vessel POC for instructions on responsibilities and accommodations.

d.
Loads baggage JAW instructions from vessel POC.

e.
Boards ship JAW instructions from vessel POC.

f.
Employs safety procedures.

5-63
DODDOA-003827
GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
*3. UMO coordinates SPOE activities.
a.
Coordinates with PSA officials to verify loading sequence of vehicles and equipment (ship stow plan).

b.
Monitors PSA acceptance inspection of vehicles and cargo to determine deficiencies.

c.
Coordinates with maintenance support POC for disposition of excess fuel, POL products, and maintenance support, as necessary.

d.
Inspects military shipping labels and markings on vehicles and equipment for compliance with Deployment SOP and PSA officials' instructions.

e.
Coordinates with PSA officials to correct deficiencies in military shipping labels and markings on vehicles and equipment.

f.
Briefs commander and/or SPOE Team OIC on status of SPOE activities.

*4. UMO coordinates rail offloading.
a.
Coordinates with PSA officials and intermediate command UMO for rail offloading schedule and requirements.

b.
Designates personnel to assist in rail offloading activities.

c.
Briefs personnel designated to perform rail offloading activities on schedule and requirementr , .

d.
Supervises rail offloading activities.

e.
Assumes custody of equipment deployed by rail by signing appropriate shipping documents.

f.
Notifies SPOE Team leaders equipment deployed by rail has
arrived in the MA.

g.
Briefs commander/SPOE Team OIC on status of rail
offloading activities.

GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
5. SPOE Team performs rail offloading operations.
a.
Reports to the railhead lAW UMO's instructions.

b.
Offloads equipment from railcars lAW PSA officials' instructions.

c.
Moves equipment to SPOE MA IAW PSA officials' instructions.

d.
Employs safety procedures.

e.
Employs environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

6. SPOE Team performs SPOE MA maintenance.
a.
Performs after operation PMCS JAW Deployment SOP and appropriate TM.

b.
Notifies supervisor of maintenance problems beyond operator's capability.


c. Checks vehicles, cargo, and personal gear for completeness, damage, proper markings, and compliance with loading plans.

d.
Conducts final preparation of vehicles and equipment JAW Deployment SOP.

e.
Adjusts vehicle fuel levels JAW Movement Plan and DSA officials' instructions.

f.
Turns in excess fuel and POL products JAW UMO's instructions.

g.
Verifies placement of placards, labels, and certification documents on hazardous material JAW Deployment SOP, Movement Plan, and PSA officials' instructions.

h.
Corrects deficiencies on vehicles, cargo, and personal gear JAW company leader's instructions.

i.
Moves to SPOE SA, as directed.

5-65

DODDOA-003829
GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
j.
Employs safety procedures.

k.
Employs environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

*7. SPOE Team leaders supervise final preparation of vehicles, equipment, cargo, and personal gear for deployment.
a.
Inspect military shipping labels and markings on vehicles, cargo and equipment for compliance with Deployment SOP, port call message and UMO's instructions.

b.
Inspect vehicles and cargo to ensure deficiencies noted during acceptance inspection have been corrected.

c.
Coordinate maintenance assistance with Commander and/or SPOE Team OIC.

d.
Enforce safety procedures.

e.
Enforce environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

8. SPOE Team performs final preparation of vehicles, equipment, cargo, and personal gear for deployment.
a.
Moves vehicles and equipment to SPOE SA, as directed.

b.
Stages vehicles for loading JAW UMO's and PSA officials' instructions.

c.
Corrects deficiencies in military shipping labels and markings on vehicles and equipment JAW UMO's instructions.

d.
Drives vehicles to call forward area, as directed by PSA officials.

e.
Employs safety procedures.

f.
Employs environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

5-66
(
DODDOA-003830

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*9. UMO updates transportation documentation.
a.
Verifies DEL by conducting physical inspection of
equipment.

b.
Updates DEL, as required.

c.
Verifies the presence of supercargoes by conducting roll call.

d.
Updates supercargo manifest, as required.

10. SPOE Team returns to unit area.
a.
Assembles personnel for return to unit area IAW SPOE
Team OIC's instructions.

b.
Reports to transportation loading area IAW SPOE Team
OIC's instructions.

c.
Loads baggage on vehicles IAW SPOE Team OIC's
instructions.

d.
Boards transportation to return to unit IAW SPOE Team
OIC's instructions.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS: NONE
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
5-67

DODDOA-003831
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Perform Aerial Port of Embarkation Activities for Deployment (63-2-4810) (FM 55-9, DOD DIR 4500.9, FM 100-17, FM 3-100.4, FM 55-10, TM 38-250, TM 55-2200-001-12)
.
4.5.M.(circle)
ITERATION 1.2.3.
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT . T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit arrives at the APOE MA for aerial deployment. Equipment and vehicles not deploying by air have been moved to the SPOE. Equipment TAT by air is present. The ITO or MCA/MCT has a support element at the APOE to assist in APOE activities. Transportation support is available. The Deployment SOP, Movement Plan, port call message, and higher HQ deployment OPORD are available. The unit has a trained officer and/or NCO appointed as UMO and alternate UMO. The unit has analog and digital communications. The unit is deploying as part of a higher HQ deployment. APOE activities are performed day or night under all environmental conditions unless terminated by the DACG. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: APOE activities are performed IAW deployment SOP and movement plan and DACG officials and commander's instructions.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Commander directs APOE activities.

a.
Notifies UMC and DACG officials that the unit has arrived
at the APOE using analog and/or digital communications.

b.
Coordinates with UMC, DACG, and/or supporting
installation officials to verify APOE movement schedules, procedures,
and requirements using analog and/or digital communications.

c.
Provides manifest of unit personnel, equipment to
accompany troops, and Shipper's Declaration of Dangerous Goods to
higher HQ for review by DACG or port MCT.

d.
Briefs unit on APOE duties and responsibilities based on
UMC, DACG, and/or supporting installation officials' instructions.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
e.
Directs unit to conduct fmal preparation of deploying vehicles and equipment JAW deployment SOP and DOD Directive 4500.9.

f.
Conducts acceptance inspection of vehicles and equipment with DACG officials at the alert holding area.

g.
Directs unit to correct deficiencies noted during acceptance •

inspection.
h.
Transfers custody of equipment and cargo to DACG officials JAW Deployment SOP.

i.
Briefs the higher HQ commander on status of APOE activities.

*2. UMO supervises APOE activities.
a.
Coordinates with DACG and/or supporting installation officials for transportation, maintenance, logistics, and other support using analog and/or digital communications, as required. ..

b.
Coordinates with DACG officials to verify APOE movement schedules, procedures, and requirements using analog and/or digital communications.

c.
Coordinates with S4 representative to ensure adequate shoring, dunnage, and floor protection are on hand and readily available for loading using analog and/or digital communications.

d.
Verifies unit vehicles, equipment, cargo, and secondary loads are properly marked and prepared for airlift JAW TALCE/DACG instructions.

e.
Coordinates with DACG to verify loading sequence of vehicles and equipment using analog and/or digital communications.

f.
Verifies that deficiencies noted during DACG acceptance
inspection have been corrected.

g.
Verifies the presence of all manifested personnel by
conducting roll call.

5-69
GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
h.
Provides verified personnel and cargo manifest to DACG at the alert holding area.

i.
Provides load teams to load and tie down unit equipment under supervision of the DACG or loadmaster.

*3. Unit leaders supervise final preparation of vehicles, equipment, cargo, and personal gear for deployment.
a.
Inspect vehicles, equipment, cargo, and personal gear for completeness, damage, and compliance with loading plans IAW MA Plan.

b.
Inspect vehicles, equipment, cargo, and personal gear for proper marking and documentation IAW MA Plan.

c.
Inspect vehicles and cargo to ensure deficiencies noted during acceptance inspection have been corrected.

d.
Coordinate with the UMO for maintenance assistance, as required.

e.
Enforce safety procedures IAW TSOP and applicable publications.

f.
Enforce environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

4. Unit performs APOE MA activities.
a.
Performs after operations PMCS IAW Deployment SOP and appropriate TMs.

b.
Notifies supervisor of maintenance problems beyond operator's capability to repair.

c.
Conducts final preparation of vehicles and equipment IAW
DOD Dir 4500.9 and UMO's instructions.

d.
Adjusts vehicle fuel levels IAW TM 38-250 and UMO's
instructions.

e.
Turns in excess fuel IAW UMOINCO's instructions.

f.
Corrects deficiencies on vehicles, cargo, and personal gear
IAW unit leaders' instructions.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
g.
Corrects deficiencies on placement of placards, labels, and certification documents on hazardous material JAW Deployment SOP, Movement Plan, TM 38-250, and UMO's instructions.

h.
Moves to APOE alert holding area, as directed.

i.
Employs safety procedures JAW TSOP and applicable publications.

j.
Employs environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

5. Unit performs APOE alert holding area activities.
a.
Corrects deficiencies in shipping documents, markings, custom labels, and decontamination tags on vehicles and equipment JAW Deployment SOP and UMO's instructions.

b.
Drives vehicles to call forward area, as directed.

6. Unit performs APOE passenger activities.
a.
Reports to designated location for DACG safety and anti­terrorism briefmg JAW UMO's instructions.

b.
Provides baggage detail, as directed, to load unit baggage on aircraft.

c.
Completes security screen JAW DACG officials' instructions.

d.
Boards aircraft JAW loadmaster's instructions.

5-71
(
TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
ITERATION 1
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS: NONE SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Perform Aerial Port of Debarkation Activities for Deployment (63-2-4811) (FM 100-17, FM 3-100.4, FM 55-10, FM 55-65, FM 55-9, TM 38-250)
.
M.(circle)
ITERATION 1.2.3.4.5..
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: Aircraft carrying main body lands at the APOD. The battalion has advance party personnel at the APOD to assist the unit in APOD activities. Representatives from the battalion advance party and AACG meet the aircraft. AACG officials have requested that unit personnel assist in offloading vehicles and equipment. The AACG has designated a holding area and an MA for the unit to complete APOD activities. Transportation is available to move the unit to the MA, SPOD, and theater staging base. The commander has designated an OIC/NCOIC and equipment reception team to travel to the SPOD and receive unit vehicles and equipment deployed by ship. The deployment SOP is available. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. APOD activities are performed day or night under all environmental conditions.
NOTE: The equipment reception team is an ad hoc group of personnel designated by the unit
commander to receive the unit's equipment once it arrives at the port.
NOTE: All references to the equipment reception team and SPOD do not apply to the IBCT.
Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: APOD activities are performed JAW deployment SOP, AACG officials,
and commander's instructions.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Commander coordinates arrival of personnel.

a.
Coordinates with battalion advance party and PMCT officials
upon arrival for location of holding and MAs, maintenance support,
movement, security, and other special APOD requirements.

b.
Assembles unit in holding area.

c.
Directs unit leaders to establish security, as required.

5-73

DODDOA-003837
GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
d.
Coordinates with higher HQ representative or PMCT for transportation support to APOD MA, SPOD holding area, and TSB using analog and/or digital communications.

e.
Coordinates with S2/S3 representative for tactical intelligence, security requirements, and movement schedule using analog and/or digital communications.

f.
Briefs unit leaders on tactical situation, security requirements, movement schedule, and special APOD requirements.

g.
Directs unit leaders to establish security IAW S2/S3's instructions.

h.
Directs unit leaders to prepare unit for movement TSB. *2. UMO supervises unit movement activities at APOD.

a.
Coordinates with AACG for offloading and movement schedules using analog and/or digital communications.

b.
Briefs unit leaders on offloading and movement schedules.

c.
Provides AACG, supporting installation officials, and S2/S3 representative a copy of DEL.

d.
Coordinates with S4 representatives for fuel and supplies for road movements.

e.
Coordinates with S2/S3 representatives for convoy routes, maps, and timetable for road movements to SPOD and TSB.

f.
Briefs commander on APOD activities. *3. Unit leaders supervise unit activities at APOD.

a.
Inspect personnel, weapons, sensitive items, and MOPP gear for accountability as they exit aircraft.

b.
Brief personnel on location of holding and MA, movement requirements, and special APOD requirements.

c.
Establish security IAW commander's instructions.

d.
Designate personnel to assist in offloading aircraft, as
required.

GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
e.
Inspect personnel and personal gear at the holding area and MA to ensure all personnel have arrived with required personal gear and baggage.

f.
Brief commander on unit activities at APOD.

g.
Enforce safety procedures IAW TSOP and applicable publications.

h.
Enforce environmental stewardship protection program procedures IAW TC 5-400.

4. Unit HQ prepares soldiers for movement to TSB. NOTE: This task step does not apply to the Interim BDE.
a.
Issues individual supplies as needed, such as ammunition, food, water, health, and comfort items.

b.
Coordinates with the AACG for life support for unit personnel in the transit holding area, as needed.

c.
Maintains daily personnel accountability.

5. Main Body performs unit activities at the APOD.
a.
Disembarks aircraft JAW loadmaster's instructions.

b.
Assembles in APOD holding area, as directed.

c.
Performs offloading activities JAW AACG officials and
loadmaster's instructions.

d.
Performs security functions, as directed.

e.
Moves to APOD MA LAW commander's instructions.

f.
Performs security functions, as directed.

g.
Inspects vehicles and equipment to ensure all equipment is
offloaded and serviceable.

h.
Notifies unit leaders of vehicle and/or equipment
deficiencies that cannot be corrected.

5-75
DODDOA-003839
ARTEP 55-718-30-MTP
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES i. Reconfigures vehicles and cargo for road movement, if necessary. j. Loads baggage on transportation for movement to SPOD holding area (equipment reception team) or TSB (main body), as directed. GO NO GO
k. Boards transportation for movement to SPOD holding area or TSB, as directed.
1. Fuels vehicles for convoy to TSB, if appropriate. m. Employs safety procedures IAW TS013 and applicable publications. n. Employs environmental stewardship protection program procedures.
TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO" TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO" TOTAL
"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS: NONE
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE

ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Perform Sea Port of Debarkation Activities for Deployment (63-2-4812) (FM 55-65, FM 100-17, FM 3-100.4, FM 3-4, FM 55-10, TM 55-2200-001-12)
.
2.3.4.5.M.(circle)
ITERATION 1.
.

COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: Unit equipment and supercargoes have arrived at the SPOD. The commander has designated an OIC/NCOIC to accompany the ERT to the SPOD holding area. The ERT has been trained and briefed on duties and responsibilities. The battalion HQ has deployed and the battalion commander and or representatives from the staff are located in the SPOD. A rail loading team chief and rail loading team has been designated and trained. Transportation support is available. Foreign nation or MP security is provided. The PSA has designated an area for equipment to be inventoried and inspected as it is offloaded. Life support is provided at the PSA. Rail and road MA have been designated for the unit to complete SPOD activities and prepare for movement to the TSB. Sufficient railcars and vehicles are available to move the unit to the theater TSB. The unit's main body is located in the TSB. The deployment SOP is available. SPOD activities are performed day or night under all environmental conditions. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: SPOD activities are performed JAW Deployment SOP and PSA officials
and commander's guidance.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. OIC/NCOIC of the equipment reception team directs unit activities
at the SPOD.

a.
Coordinates with higher HQ staff personnel and/or PSA and
PMCT officials upon arrival for location of holding and MA,
maintenance, logistics, and movement support and security, and other
special SPOD requirements.

b.
Coordinates with S4 and/or PSA officials for life support for
unit personnel while at the SPOD.

c.
Identifies amount of PREPO materiel required by the unit, as
applicable.

5-77
GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
d.
Assembles equipment reception team in holding area.

e.
Conducts acceptance inspection with PSA officials.

f.
Notifies battalion commander and S4 representative of missing or damaged equipment.

g.
Assumes custody of equipment and cargo IAW S4 representative and PSA officials' instructions.

h.
Coordinates with S4 representative for transportation support to TSB, if required.

i.
Coordinates with S2/S3 and MCT for movement schedules to the TSB.

j.
Verifies arrival, morale, and welfare of supercargoes.

k.
Reestablishes accountability and responsibility for supercargoes.

1. Directs convoy and rail loading parties to proceed to rail loading or road convoy MA IAW S2/S3 and MCT movement instructions.
m.
Monitors preparation of equipment for road convoy or rail movement to ensure compliance with TSOP.

n.
Briefs unit leaders on SPOD requirements.

o.
Advises unit commander and battalion representative on SPOD activities, as required.

*2. UMO supervises unit activities at SPOD.
a.
Coordinates with S4 representative to identify off-loading schedules, location of holding areas and marshalling areas, location of PREPO vehicles and materiel, availability and location of BBPCT, and other SPOD information, as required

b.
Briefs personnel on off-loading schedules, drawing PREPO vehicles and materiel, special SPOD requirements, and location of MA.

c.
Coordinates with S2/S3 representative to identify equipment,
loading times and sites, and unit loading requirements to prepare
designated equipment for rail movement to TSB.

GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
d.
Coordinates with S2/S3 representatives for convoy routes, maps, tactical intelligence, and timetable for road move to TSB.

e.
Coordinates with S4 representatives for fuel, ammunition, and supplies for road move to TSB.

f.
Provides rail-loading plan to rail loading team chief.

g.
Monitors rail loading procedures to ensure compliance with MCT's instructions.

h.
Monitors preparation of equipment for road convoy to ensure compliance with TSOP.

i.
Briefs equipment reception party on rail-loading and convoy requirements.

j.
Briefs commander on SPOD activities.

k.
Enforces safety procedures.

1. Enforces environmental stewardship protection program procedures.
3. Supercargoes perform SPOD activities.
a.
Disembark ship IAW vessel POC's instructions.

b.
Report to equipment reception team OIC/NCOIC for instructions.

4. Equipment reception team performs equipment reception activities.
a.
Offloads vehicles IAW PSA officials' instructions.

b.
Inspects equipment to ensure all equipment is operational.

c.
Moves vehicles and materiel from PREPO locations to rail or convoy MAs.

d.
Moves unit vehicles and cargo to SPOD rail or convoy MAs.

e.
Performs before operations PMCS on all vehicles and equipment.

5-79

DODDOA-003843
GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
f.
Corrects all vehicle and equipment discrepancies within the operator's capabilities IAW applicable TM.

g.
Reports all deficiencies beyond operator's capability to immediate supervisor.

h.
Reconfigures vehicles and cargo for road movement, if necessary.

i.
Fuels vehicles for convoy to TSB, if appropriate.

j.
Draws weapons, ammunition, and other tactical supplies from S4 representative, if necessary.

k.
Notifies UMO that vehicles are offloaded and operational.

1. Employs safety procedures.
m. Employs environmental stewardship protection program procedures.
*5. Rail loading team chief supervises rail-loading activities.
a.
Coordinates with UMO for rail-loading plans.

b.
Coordinates with UMO to identify special rail-loading requirements.

c.
Verifies the presence of all rail guards by conducting roll call.

d.
Verifies the presence of manifested vehicles and equipment by conducting physical inventory.

e.
Provides a copy of the personnel and cargo manifest to conductor.

f.
Notifies commander when rail loading is completed.

g.
Enforces safety procedures.

-
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
6. Rail loading team performs rail-loading.
a.
Stages vehicles JAW rail-loading plan.

b.
Loads vehicles and equipment on railcars JAW rail-loading
plan and UMO's instructions.

c.
Secures vehicles and equipment JAW rail-loading plan and


UMO's instructions.
d.
Notifies rail-loading Team Chief when rail loading is
completed.

e.
Employs safety procedures.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
5 M TOTAL
ITERATION 1 2 3 4
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS: NONE
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
5-81
DODDOA-003845
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters 3 Truck Platoon Headquarters 6 Truck Squads Maintenance Section 2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters 4 Light Truck Squads Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters Light Truck Squad Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Prepare Equipment Reception Team for Tactical Road March (63-2-4813) (FM 100-17, FM 3-4, FM 3-5, FM 55-30)
.
2.3.4.5.M.(circle)
ITERATION 1.
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT . T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit has received a movement order from S2/S3 to move from the SPOD marshalling area to TSB or TAA. The unit's vehicles have been offloaded from ocean going vessels and are operational. The unit performs PMCS and obtains fuel support from the PSA. Movement can occur in a field or MOUT environment. The MCT has provided routes of march and a movement schedule. Area reconnaissance and coordination for fire support and medical evacuation support has been accomplished by S2/S3 Section. The higher HQ and unit TSOPs are available. The unit convoy, march, and serial commanders have been designated, as appropriate. Strip maps are provided by higher HQ staff element. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Equipment Reception Team is ready to cross SP NLT time prescribed in
movement order. At MOPP level 4, performance degradation factors increase preparation time.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
1. Equipment Reception Team prepares vehicles and equipment.
a.
Removes all unit identification markings on vehicles.

b.
Covers all reflective surfaces of all vehicles or cargo with
available materials.

c.
Hardens all vehicles using sandbags and/or other authorized
materials.

d.
Places antennas at lowest height.

e.
Turns radio volume and squelch to lowest operational setting
consistent with operational requirements.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
f.
Sets squelch setting "on" and call-light "off' when operating at night.

g.
Attaches RF tags to vehicles, as available, IAW local directives.

*2. Convoy commander and leaders organize convoy.
a.
Assign vehicle positions with the heavier, slower vehicles placed first.

b.
Assign control vehicles in convoy without setting a pattern.

NOTE: Convoy commander assigns FBCB2 or MTS equipped vehicles as control vehicles, if available.
c.
Assign recovery vehicle(s) positions where they can move to disabled vehicles without disrupting convoy movement.

d.
Assign hardened vehicle(s) with crew-served weapons interspersed throughout the convoy.

e.
Assign passenger locations where all unit personnel have a position and semi-automatic and automatic weapons are alternated throughout the convoy to cover front, rear, and flanks.

f.
Assign soldiers to air guard duties with specific search sectors covering 360 degrees.

g.
Assign sufficient number of recovery vehicles and mechanics to assign to trail party element.

h.
Provide vehicle position listing with locations of all vehicles to the trail party leader.

i.
Open radio net(s) as specified in the movement order. *3. Convoy commander and leaders conduct premovement inspections.

a.
Inspect personnel and their equipment for compliance with commander's guidance, movement order, and TSOP.

b.
Inspect organizational equipment for accountability and serviceability.

5-83

DODDOA-003847
GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
c.
Inspect vehicles, trailers, and loads for serviceability, proper stowing, and security.

d.
Forward personnel and equipment status to commander and higher HQ staff element.

NOTE: Convoy commander forwards status reports using FBCB2 or MTS , if equipped.
*4. Convoy commander conducts briefings for convoy personnel.
a.
Provides analog or digital strip maps to each vehicle driver, as applicable.

b.
Briefs convoy chain of command.

c.
Briefs convoy route.

d.
Prescribes the rate of march and catch-up speeds.

e.
Briefs vehicle intervals.

f.
Identifies scheduled halts, to include convoy support centers.

g.
Briefs safety, accident, and breakdown procedures.

h.
Briefs immediate action security measures.

i.
Briefs blackout condition procedures.

j.
Identifies location of medical support.

k.
Identifies location of maintenance support.

1. Provides location and identification of destination.
m.
Briefs arm/hand signals.

n.
Briefs radio frequencies and call signs for control personnel,
fire support elements, and medical evacuation support.

GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
5. Equipment Reception Team prepares to cross SP.
a.
Positions all vehicles IAW convoy commander's instructions.

b.
Clears all individual and crew-served weapons.

c.
Posts air guards in positions designated by convoy
commander.

d.
Posts security guards to maintain 360-degree surveillance.

e.
Forwards movement readiness report to S2/S3 Section.
NOTE: Team leader forwards reports using FBCB2, if equipped.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
5-85
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Perform Redeployment Human Resources Actions (63-2-4814) (AR 220-10, AR 600-8-1, AR 600-8-19, AR 600-8-22, AR 600-8-24, DOD 5030.49-R, FM 100-17, FM 12-6, FM 55-10)
.
ITERATION 1.2.3.4.5.M.(circle)
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT . T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit receives a warning order to redeploy to home station. The unit is located in the TAA. Some personnel and administrative actions are initiated in the TAA and completed in the RAA. The unit is redeploying as part of a higher HQ redeployment. The S 1 has provided an SRP schedule to the commander. The S1 has coordinated for ASG contact team support. Transportation to move the unit to the processing center is available. The redeployment movement plan is available. The unit has a trained officer and/or NCO appointed as UMO and alternate UMO. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. Preparation activities for redeployment are performed day or night under all environmental conditions. This task should not be trained in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Redeployment SRP activities are accomplished IAW redeployment
movement plan, Si SRP processing schedule, and commander's guidance.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Commander directs personnel and administrative redeployment
activities.

a.
Coordinates with Si to identify personnel and administrative
requirements for redeployment using analog and/or digital
communications.

b.
Designates higher HQ advance party representatives and
SPOE Team.

c.
Briefs unit leaders on personnel and administrative
requirements for redeployment.

d.
Provides personnel and administrative processing schedule
to unit HQ.

586
-
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
e.
Directs the unit HQ to develop a unit personnel and administrative processing schedule.

f.
Forwards list of personnel unable to redeploy to Si Section using analog and/or digital communications.

g.
Forwards list of personnel redeploying as individuals using analog and/or digital communications.

h.
Directs personnel to complete personnel and administrative requirements for redeployment.

i.
Approves or disapproves award and decoration recommendations, as appropriate.

j.
Coordinates with Si for personnel and administrative support using analog and/or digital communications, as required.

k.
Briefs higher HQ commander on status of personnel and administrative actions.

2. Unit HQ supervises redeployment personnel and administrative actions.
a.
Develops unit personnel and administrative processing schedule based on the redeployment movement plan, Si SRP schedule processing, and commander's guidance.

b.
Distributes unit personnel and administrative processing schedule to platoons and sections.

c.
Monitors personnel and administrative processing to ensure personnel complete actions IAW schedule.

d.
Verifies redeployment records are updated prior to soldier's departure from theater.

3. Unit HQ performs personnel redeployment processing functions.
a.
Identifies COA for soldiers not eligible for redeployment, to include temporary gaining command, transfer procedures, and administrative requirements.

b.
Provides list of soldiers eligible for redeployment and those
scheduled to return as individuals.

5-87
DODDOA-003851
GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
c.
Provides redeploying soldiers medical, dental, and personnel records for redeployment processing.

d.
Provides necessary forms to unit personnel for redeployment processing.

e.
Dispatches all soldier's updated records back to the unit's home station before the soldier departs.

f.
Sends records to home station on different conveyance as soldiers.

g.
Completes personnel and administrative requirements for deployment IAW higher HQ directives.

h.
Prepares tentative passenger manifest.

i.
Processes recommendations for decorations and awards IAW commander's instructions.

j.
Coordinates with the Si Section for personnel and administrative support using analog and/or digital communications, as required.

k.
Inputs status changes and other actions to pay and personnel systems.

1. Coordinates with the S1 Section for personnel and administrative support using analog and/or digital communications, as required.
m. Briefs commander on personnel and administrative actions, as required.
*4. Unit leaders supervise personnel and administrative actions.
a.
Direct personnel to complete personnel and administrative
actions, as required.

b.
Monitor personnel and administrative processing to ensure
personnel complete actions IAW schedule.

c.
Submit performance reports, award and decoration
recommendations, and other personnel actions to the commander for
approval/certification, as required.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES d. Coordinate with unit HQ for personnel and administrative support, as required. e. Submit records and reports to unit HQ IAW the Redeployment Movement Plan and commander's instructions using analog and/or digital communications. f. Brief commander on personnel and administrative actions. GO NO GO
g. Brief personnel on personnel and administrative requirements.
TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO" TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO" TOTAL
"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS: NONE
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE

5-89

DODD0A-003853
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
-
-
-
TASK:.Perform Redeployment Training Activities (63 24815) (FM 100 17, AR 220-10,
AR 350-1, AR 350-41, DOD 5030.49-R)
.
3.4.5.M.(circle)
ITERATION 1.2.
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT . T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit is preparing for redeployment to home station. Sufficient time exists for the unit to conduct redeployment training. Training support is available to train unit personnel in customs and USDA clearance procedures, and other training requirements in support of follow on missions. Training is conducted in the TAA and/or RAA. The commander has designated a training officer and NCO. The Redeployment Movement Plan, higher HQ Redeployment OPORD, and training records are available. The unit has a trained officer and/or NCO appointed as UMO and alternate UMO. The unit is redeploying as part of a higher HQ redeployment. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. Redeployment training activities are performed day or night under all environmental conditions. This task should not be trained in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Redeployment training is accomplished lAW the training schedule and
commander's guidance.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Commander directs redeployment training activities.

a.
Identifies redeployment training requirements by reviewing
the Redeployment Movement Plan and higher HQ Redeployment
OPORD and in coordination with the higher HQ staff personnel.

b.
Directs training officer to develop a unit training schedule to
correct training deficiencies.

c.
Designates personnel to receive redeployment training.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
d.
Briefs higher HQ commander on status of redeployment
training.

e.
Completes verification statement and checklists indicating
the status of the unit.

*2. Training Officer/NCO supervises redeployment training activities.
a.
Develops training schedule based on Redeployment OPORD,
specialized training requirements identified by higher HQ, and
commander's guidance, such as customs, USDA requirements, weapons
control, and stress management.

b.
Coordinates with S2/S3 for training support using analog
and/or digital communications, as required.

c.
Provides training schedule to S2/S3 Section and unit leaders,
as appropriate.

d.
Provides stress control and family support reorientation
briefings IAW higher HQ directives.

e.
Monitors training to ensure appropriate training is provided
to personnel.

f.
Briefs commander on status of redeployment training.

*3. Unit leaders perform redeployment training activities.
a.
Coordinate with UMO for required training support.

b.
Conduct training IAW training schedule, if required.

c.
Annotate training results on individual and team training
records.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
ARTEP 55-718-30-MTP SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Perform Redeployment Supply Activities (63-2-4816) (AR 710-2, AR 220-10, AR 700-84, AR 735-5, DOD 5030.49-R, FM 100-17, FM 3-100.4)
.
3.4.5.M.(circle)
ITERATION 1.2.
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT . T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit is preparing for redeployment to home station. Vehicles, equipment, and supplies are available for reconstitution of redeploying units. Redeployment supply activities are accomplished in the TAA and RAA. The TSOP, Redeployment Movement Plan, and higher HQ Redeployment OPORD are available. The unit is redeploying as part of a higher HQ deployment. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. Redeployment supply activities are performed day or night under all environmental conditions. This task should not be trained in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Redeployment supply activities are accomplished IAW the Redeployment Movement Plan, TSOP, higher HQ Redeployment OPORD, and commander's guidance.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Commander directs redeployment supply activities.

a.
Identifies vehicles and equipment to be left in theater.

b.
Identifies vehicles and equipment required to reconstitute the
unit before or after redeployment.

c.
Coordinates with S4 for issue of vehicles, equipment, and
supplies required to reconstitute the unit.

d.
Identifies supplies and equipment needed to redeploy to
home station by reviewing the Redeployment Movement Plan,
Redeployment OPORD, and coordination with S4.

e.
Directs unit leaders to turn in vehicles, ammunition, supplies,
and equipment to be left in-country.

5-93
DODDOA-003857
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
f.
Directs unit leaders to provide supply and equipment requests to supply section.

g.
Directs supply section to turn-in excess supplies and equipment IAW TSOP and S4 Section's instructions.

h.
Inspects area and facilities to ensure excess vehicles, equipment, and supplies have been turned in.

i.
Briefs higher HQ commander and the-higher HQ staff personnel on supply status, as required.

2. Unit elements perform redeployment supply activities.
a.
Identify shortages of vehicles, supplies, and equipment by conducting inventories and reviewing DEL.

b.
Identify shortages of clothing and personal equipment by inventorying OCIE.

c.
Submit requests for vehicles, supplies, and equipment to supply section TAW TSOP and commander's instructions using analog and/or digital communications.

d.
Employ safety procedures IAW TSOP and applicable publications.

e.
Employ environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

3. Unit HQ provides supply support.
a.
Provides a copy of the DEL to platoons and sections, as required.

b.
Submits request for supplies and equipment to S4 Section IAW TSOP using analog and/or digital communications.

c.
Coordinates with S4 Section to resolve, cancel or validate outstanding requisitions using analog and/or digital communications.

d.
Submits changes of the "ship to" address to reflect home station address for all outstanding requisitions.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
e.
Coordinates with commander or S4 Section for
transportation and MBE support to turn in, pick up, issue, and/or pack
ammunition, equipment, and supplies using analog and/or digital
communications, if necessary.

f.
Coordiriates with S4 for customs•and USDA inspection
schedule and procedures using analog and/or digital communications.

g.
Inspects issued vehicles and equipment for serviceability and
completeness.

h.
Issues vehicles, equipment, and supplies to appropriate
platoons/sections lAW TSOP and commander's instructions.

i.
Secures unissued supplies and equipment lAW TSOP.

j.
Turns in equipment, supplies, and hazardous material to
designated facility, as appropriate.

k.
Briefs commander on supply status.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO" TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO" ITERATION
"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS: NONE
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
5-95
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Perform Redeployment Maintenance Activities (63 -2-4817) (DA Pamphlet 738-750, AR 220-1, AR 700-138, AR 750-1, DA Pamphlet 750-1, DOD 5030.49-R, FM 100-17, FM 3-100.4, FM 4-30.3)
.
3.4.5.M.(circle)
ITERATION 1.2.
.

COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit is preparing for redeployment to home station. The commander has designated a motor officer. Required tools, equipment, repair parts, and personnel are available. MSTs are available in the TAA and RAA. The Maintenance SOP is available. The unit is redeploying as part of a higher HQ redeployment. The unit has analog and digital communications with higher HQ. Redeployment maintenance is performed day or night under all environmental conditions. This task should not be trained in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Redeployment maintenance is accomplished IAW the Maintenance SOP
and commander's guidance.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Commander directs redeployment maintenance activities.

a.
Identifies redeployment maintenance requirements IAW TA
guidance.

b.
Monitors maintenance activities for compliance with the
Maintenance SOP and commander's guidance.

c.
Approves the use of controlled exchange when required
repair parts are not available.

d.
Checks MCSR for accuracy and completeness.

e.
Forwards MCSR to the S4 Section using analog and/or
digital communications.

f.
Coordinates with S4 for maintenance support using analog
and/or digital communications, as required.

. GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
g.
Prioritizes repair of vehicles and equipment.

h.
Enforces safety procedures IAW TSOP and applicable publications.

i.
Enforces environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

*2. Motor officer and/or motor sergeant supervise redeployment maintenance activities.
a.
Identify unit operational readiness levels by reviewing vehicle and equipment status reports, PMCS, and redeployment maintenance checks.

b.
Prepare MCSR IAW AR 220-1 and AR 700-138.

c.
Submit current MCSR to commander.

d.
Submit request for CRTs to commander, as required.

e.
Submit request for controlled exchanges to commander for approval.

f.
Designate unit maintenance personnel to assist MSTs IAW Maintenance SOP, S4 Section, and commander's instructions.

g.
Direct calibration of tools, if required.

h.
Verify PLL inventory by conducting spot checks.

i.
Verify completion of repairs by reviewing maintenance records.

j.
Coordinate with S4 Section to identify status of vehicles and equipment in support maintenance using analog and/or digital communications.

k.
Coordinate with S4 Section for disposition instructions for nonrepairable vehicles using analog and/or digital communications.

1. Brief the commander on maintenance status of vehicles and equipment, as required.
m. Issue and/or reissues military drivers and equipment licenses to unit personnel, as needed.
5-97

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
n.
Enforce safety procedures IAW TSOP and applicable publications.

o.
Enforce environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

3. Unit HQ performs organizational maintenance activities.
a.
Calibrates tools, as required.

b.
Inspects equipment IAW appropriate operator and organizational maintenance TMs.

c.
Records all deficiencies on equipment inspection worksheets.

d.
Corrects unit-level maintenance deficiencies.

e.
Forwards requests for DS maintenance to supporting maintenance facility using analog and/or digital communications.

f.
Requests required repair parts from PLL clerk.

g.
Repairs equipment IAW applicable TM(s).

h.
Requests approval for controlled exchange through motor officer when required repair parts are not available.

i.
Performs controlled exchange IAW motor officer's or sergeant's instructions.

j.
Performs final inspection to ensure quality control of repairs.

k.
Conducts inventory of PLL to confirm shortages IAW PLL listing.

1. Submits request for PLL replenishment to motor sergeant, as required.
m.
Performs technical inspections of replacement equipment IAW appropriate TMs and manufacturer's instructions.

n.
Releases equipment to appropriate platoon or section.

ARTEP 55-718-30-MTP
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES o. Employs safety procedures IAW TSOP and applicable publications. GO NO GO
p. Employs environmental stewardship procedures.
4. Unit HQ conducts transactions with CRTs.
a. Identifies vehicles and equipment that require CRT support.
b. Prepares required documentation for submission to CRT.
c. Delivers vehicles and equipment to CRT.-.; d. Picks up equipment from CRT upon notification repairs are completed.
e. Notifies owning element to pick up vehicles and equipment.
*5. Unit leaders supervise redeployment operator maintenance activities. •
a. Monitor performance of PMCS and redeployment maintenance for compliance with the Redeployment Movement Plan, Maintenance SOP, appropriate TM, and commander's guidance.
b. Inspect vehicles, weapons, and equipment to ensure compliance with Maintenance SOP, appropriate TMs, and commander's guidance.
c. Provide input for MCSR te ittotor officer, as required. --
d. Enforce safety procedures IAW TSOP and applicable publications.
e. Enforce environmental stewardship protection program procedures.
6. Unit performs redeployment operator maintenance.
a. Performs PMCS IAW appropriate TM(s).
b. Notifies supervisor of maintenance problems beyond operator's capabilities.

5-99
a
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES c. Employs safety procedures IAW TSOP and applicable publications. d Employs environmental stewardship protection program procedures. GO NO GO
TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO" TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO" TOTAL
"s" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE

ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Prepare Vehicles and Equipment for Redeployment (63-2-4818) (FM 100-17, AR 220-10, DOD DIR 4500.9, FM 3-100.4, FM 55-30, FM 55-9, TM 55-2200-001-12)
.
(circle)
ITERATION 1.2.3.4.5.M..
T.P.U.(circle)
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT
CONDITIONS: The unit receives a movement directive to redeploy to home station. Preparation of vehicles and equipment for redeployment is performed in the TAA and/or RAA and A/SPOE unit MA. A railhead is available. All personnel are present and have been trained on requirements for preparing vehicles and equipment for redeployment. Packing and Crating, Weighing and Loading, Vehicle and Equipment Cleaning, and Rail Loading Teams have been designated and trained. Transportation support, railcars, weighing scales, packing materials, MHE, shipping containers, inserts, pallets, and other equipment preparation and loading materials are available. The movement directive, Redeployment Movement Plan, and higher HQ Redeployment OPORD are available. The unit has a trained officer and/or NCO appointed as UMO and alternate UMO. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The unit is redeploying as part of a higher HQ redeployment. Equipment preparation is performed day or night under all environmental conditions. This task should not be trained in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Vehicles and equipment are prepared for redeployment and loaded for
movement to A/SPOE lAW the Redeployment Movement Plan and commander's guidance.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Commander directs vehicle and equipment preparation activities.

a.
Identifies equipment and supplies to be redeployed based on
movement directive, DEL, Movement Plan, redeployment OPORD, and
commander's guidance.

b.
Identifies personnel, equipment, and vehicles scheduled to
move to the A/SPOE by road or rail by reviewing Movement Plan and
higher HQ commander or S2/S3's guidance.

c.
Designates a unit MA.

5-101
(
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
d.
Coordinates with S2/S3 for USDA and customs contact team support using analog and/or digital communications.

e.
Coordinates with S4 for transportation support to A/SPOE using analog and/or digital communications, if necessary.

f.
Inspects area to ensure all excess vehicles, equipment, and supplies has been turned in.

g.
Notifies S2/S3 when vehicles and containers are loaded and ready to move using analog and/or digital communications.

h.
Enforces safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications.

i.
Monitors environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

*2. UMO supervises vehicle and equipment preparation activities.
a. Coordinates with MCA/MCT TC-ACCIS site for DEL, military shipping labels, and documents.
NOTE: If the unit did not deploy with a DEL produced by TC-ACCIS, a DEL will be generated based on the unit property book and vehicle and secondary load lists.
b.
Updates AUEL to reflect vehicles, equipment, and supplies to be redeployed based on physical inventory, operational status, and commander's guidance.

c.
Updates AUEL to reflect actual weights based on results of weighing.

d.
Inputs updated AUEL into the MCA/MCT TC-ACCIS station.

e.
Provides MCA/MCT and/or S4 Section with information on oversize and overweight vehicles, equipment, and cargo requiring special handling using analog and/or digital communications, as required.

f.
Coordinates with TC-ACCIS site for DEL, BBPCT material requirements lists, vehicle/rail loading plans and schedules, special hauling permit requests, military shipping labels, and convoy clearance requests produced by TC-ACCIS using analog and/or digital communications.

GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
g.
Coordinates with S4 Section for packing materials, weighing scales, MHE, containers, inserts, pallets, and other equipment preparation and loading materials using analog and/or digital communications, as required.

h.
Coordinates with S4 Section for RF tags for

sensitive/classified cargo using analog and/or digital communications, as required.
i.
Coordinates with USDA and customs contact team leaders for vehicle and equipment packing, loading, and cleaning instructions early in the preparation process using analog and/or digital communications.

j.
Provides unit leaders with a vehicle and equipment cleaning schedule.

k.
Provides unit leaders with redeployment forms, shipping

labels, and documents, as required. •
1. Coordinates container pick-up with S4 Section using analog and/or digital communications.
m.
Provides special instructions to Packing and Crating Teams, if necessary.

n.
Provides container packing schedule to unit leaders and Customs Contact Team.

o.
Identifies transportation support requirements by reviewing Redeployment Movement Plan and current vehicle status reports.

p.
Coordinates with S4 Section for movement of vehicles and equipment to rail loading site using analog and/or digital communications.

q.
Provides rail loading plan to Rail Loading Team Chief.

r.
Provides Rail Loading Team proper tools to conduct rail
loadout.

s.
Coordinates with S4 or MCA/MCT officials for port call
message and verification of Redeployment Movement Plan A/SPOE
requirements and procedures using analog and/or digital
communications.

5-103
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
t.
Briefs commander on status of preparation of vehicles and equipment for deployment.

u.
Enforces safety procedures TAW TSOP and publications.

v.
Enforces environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

*3. Unit leaders supervise preparation of unit elements for redeployment.
a.
- Verify adequate space has been allowed for personal items and secondary loads by reviewing loading plans.

b.
Revise loading plans, as required.

c.
Monitor packing and loading for compliance with the Redeployment Movement Plan and UMO and customs officials' instructions.

d.
Direct personnel to deliver vehicles and equipment to the vehicle and equipment cleaning site TAW UMO's instructions.

e.
Monitor vehicle and equipment cleaning operations to ensure vehicles and equipment are cleaned TAW the Redeployment Movement Plan and USDA officials' instructions.

f.
Inspect area to ensure all equipment to be redeployed has been packed and/or loaded.

g.
Inspect area to ensure all excess vehicles, equipment, and supplies have been turned in.

h.
Inspect internal loads to ensure loads are secure and in compliance with loading plans.

i.
Notify UMO of any load plan revisions.

j.
Enforce safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications.

k.
Enforce environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

5-104
(
DODDOA-003868

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*4. UMO maintains an up-to-date AUEL.
a.
Conducts physical inventory of vehicles and equipment to be redeployed to verify accuracy of AUEL.

b.
Revises AUEL, as required.

c.
Submits AUEL changes to MCA/MCT TC-ACCIS site, if necessary.

5. Packing and Crating Teams prepare equipment for redeployment.
a.
Pack containers IAW loading plans, DEL, and UMO and USDA and customs officials' instructions.

b.
Pack hazardous materials IAW the Redeployment Movement Plan and UMO, USDA, and customs officials' instructions.

c.
Prepare container packing lists and shipping documents IAW UMO's instructions.

d.
Distribute container packing lists and shipping documents IAW UMO and USDA and customs officials' instructions.

e.
Mark containers IAW the Redeployment Movement Plan, UMO, USDA, and customs officials' instructions.

f.
Assist container pick-up crew in loading operations, as required.

g.
Employ safety procedures IAWTSOP and publications.

h.
Employ environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

6. Vehicle and Equipment Cleaning Team cleans vehicles and equipment for redeployment.
a.
Guides vehicles into cleaning site, as directed by cleaning site officials.

b.
Cleans vehicles and equipment IAW and USDA officials' instructions.

c.
Reports completion of vehicle and equipment cleaning operations to UMO.

5-105

DODDOA-003869
GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
d.
Employs safety procedures lAW TSOP and publications.

e.
Employs environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

7. Unit prepares vehicles, equipment, and personal gear for redeployment.
a.
Turns in excess vehicles, equipment, and supplies to supply • sergeant.

b.
Packs personal gear IAW Movement Plan and customs officials' instructions.

c.
Marks and/or tags personal gear and equipment IAW the Redeployment Movement Plan and UMO and customs officials' instructions.

d.
Moves equipment to be packed in containers to the container packing area IAW UMO's instructions.

e.
Loads vehicles TAW the Redeployment Movement Plan, loading plans, and UMO and customs officials' instructions.

f.
Places RF tags on sensitive/classified cargo and/or vehicles as directed by higher HQ.

g.
Delivers vehicles and equipment to the vehicle and equipment cleaning site, as directed.

h.
Moves vehicles to UMA, as directed.

i.
Employs safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications.

j.
Employs environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

8. Weighing and Marking Team weighs and marks vehicles for deployment.
a.
Sets up weighing and marking area in designated area IAW
commander's instructions.

b.
Guides vehicles onto scales as they arrive.

c.
Identifies vehicle gross weight.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
d.
Identifies vehicle axle weights (air movement only).

e.
Computes vehicle center of balance based on axle weights (air movement only).

f.
Marks center of balance on vehicles IAW DOD Dir 4500.9, and UMO's instructions (air movement only).

g.
Reports gross weights for each deploying vehicle to UMO.

h.
Disestablishes weighing and marking area.

i.
Returns vehicle weighing scales IAW owning facility or UMO's instructions.

9. Unit prepares vehicles and equipment for movement to A/SPOE.
a.
Stages vehicles for convoy to A/SPOE or rail loading site IAW UMO's instructions.

b.
Corrects loading deficiencies IAW loading plan, if necessary.

c.
Recomputes center of balance, if necessary (air movement only).

d.
Re-marks center of balance on vehicles, if necessary (air movement only).

e.
Marks vehicles for movement to A/SPOE IAW FM 55-30, UMO, USDA, and customs officials' instructions.

f.
Places military shipping labels on vehicles and equipment IAW UMO's instructions.

g.
Moves designated vehicles and equipment to the rail loading site IAW Movement Plan and UMO's instructions.

5-107
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
h. Prepares convoy for movement to A/SPOE.
NOTE: Depending on tactical situation, see task steps two through five of Task 63-2-4808 (Conduct Nontactical Road March) or Task 63-2-4003 (Conduct Tactical Road March) for detailed convoy preparation procedures.
i. Notifies UMO that vehicles are ready to cross SP for convoy to A/SPOE.
*
10. Rail Loading Team OIC/NCOIC supervises rail loading activities.

a.
Conducts safety briefing for unit personnel at the rail loading site IAW governing regulations and local procedures.

b.
Coordinates with UMO for rail loading plans.

c.
Coordinates with UMO to identify special rail loading requirements.

d.
Verifies the presence of rail guards by conducting roll call, if required.

e.
Verifies the presence of manifested vehicles and equipment by conducting physical inventory.

f.
Provides cargo manifest to conductor.

g.
Inspects vehicles and equipment for military shipping labels and proper markings.

h.
Notifies commander when rail loading is complete, if required.

i.
Enforces safety procedures IANV TSOP and publications.

j.
Enforces environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
11. Rail Loading Team performs rail loading.
a.
Stages vehicles IAW rail loading plan.

b.
Loads vehicles and equipment on railcars IAW rail loading
plan and UMO's instructions.

c.
Secures vehicles and equipment IAW rail loading plan and
UMO's instructions.

d.
Notifies Rail Loading Team OIC/NCOIC when rail loading
is complete.

e.
Employs safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications.

f.
Employs environmental stewardship protection program
procedures.

°
TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
ITERATION
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS: NONE
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
5-109
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters 3 Truck Platoon Headquarters 6 Truck Squads Maintenance Section 2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters 4 Light Truck Squads Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters Light Truck Squad Medium Truck Squad
Perform Sea Port of Embarkation Activities for Redeployment (63-2-4819)
TASK:.
(FM 100-17, AR 220-10, FM 3-100.4, FM 4-30.3, TM 38-250,
TM 55-2200-001-12)
.
1.2.3.4.5.M.(circle)
ITERATION
.

T.P.U.(circle)
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT
CONDITIONS: The unit's equipment arrives at the SPOE MA. The commander has designated a
unit SPOE Team and SPOE Team OIC. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with
higher HQ. Higher HQ has an advance party at the SPOE to assist in coordinating SPOE activities.
Commercial support is not available. The commander or SPOE Team OIC has notified higher HQ
and PSA officials of the unit's arrival. PSA officials have requested unit vehicle operator's
assistance in offloading unit vehicles deployed to the SPOE by rail. The railhead is located in the
SPOE AO. Transportation, maintenance, logistics, and equipment cleaning support are available.
US Customs and USDA clearances are required. A SPOE sterile area has been designated. The
Redeployment Movement Plan and Redeployment OPORD are available. The unit has a trained
officer and/or NCO appointed as UMO and alternate UMO. The unit is redeploying as part of a
higher HQ deployment. A Theater Support Command is in place and has assumed overall
responsibility for all logistics in the theater, to include port operations. SPOE activities are
performed day or night under all environmental conditions. This task should not be trained in
MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: SPOE activities are performed IAW the Redeployment Movement Plan
and higher HQ staff and PSA officials' instructions.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Commander or SPOE Team OIC/NCOIC directs SPOE activities.

a.
Directs team to perform after-operation PMCS of vehicles.

b.
Identifies transportation requirements for return to unit area.

c.
Coordinates with supporting TSC unit for transportation,
maintenance, and logistics support using analog and/or digital
communications, as required.

GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
d.
Coordinates with PSA officials to verify SPOE movement schedules, procedures, safety guidelines, and requirements using analog and/or digital communications.

e.
Briefs team leaders on SPOE movement schedules, procedures, safety guidelines, and requirements.

f.
Directs team to offload and inspect equipment arriving by rail.

g.
Coordinates with PSA to identify number of supercargoes authorized and POC for supercargoes using analog and/or digital communications.

h.
Coordinates with supercargoes to ensure they are prepared for redeployment by sea movement, to include proper orders and equipment.

i.
Briefs supercargoes on boarding schedule, responsibilities, and POC during sea movement.

j.
Conducts acceptance inspection of vehicles, equipment, and cargo with PSA officials.

k.
Directs team to correct deficiencies noted during PSA acceptance inspection.

1. Transfers custody of vehicles, equipment, and cargo to SPOE officials.
m. Briefs the higher HQ commander or designated representative on status of SPOE activities.
2. Supercargoes representative performs SPOE activities.
a.
Reports to port commander's representative IAW UMO's
instructions.

b.
Performs SPOE activities IAW port commander's
instructions.

c.
Coordinates with vessel POC for instructions on
responsibilities and accommodations.

d.
Reports to the customs inspection site IAW port
commander's instructions.

5-111
GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
e.
Loads baggage IAW instructions from vessel POC.

f.
Boards ship IAW instructions from vessel POC. *3. UMO coordinates SPOE activities.

a.
Coordinates with PSA officials to verify loading sequence of vehicles and equipment (ship stow plan).

b.
Monitors PSA acceptance inspection of vehicles and cargo to identify deficiencies.

c.
Coordinates with maintenance support POC for disposition of excess fuel and POL products and maintenance support, as necessary.

d.
Coordinates with PSA officials for vehicle cleaning support and location of SPOE sterile area.

e.
Inspects shipping documents and labels, markings, customs labels, and decontamination tags on vehicles and equipment for compliance with MCA/MCT, customs, USDA officials' instructions, and TM 38-250 instructions.

f.
Coordinates with MCA/MCT, USDA, and/or customs officials to correct deficiencies in shipping documents and labels, customs labels, and decontamination tags.

g.
Briefs commander and/or SPOE Team OIC on status of SPOE activities.

h.
Enforces safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications.

i.
Enforces environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

*4. UMO coordinates rail offloading.
a.
Coordinates with PSA officials for rail offloading schedule and requirements.

b.
Designates personnel to assist in rail offloading activities.

c.
Briefs personnel designated to assist in rail offloading activities on schedule and requirements.

GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
d.
Supervises rail offloading activities.

e.
Assumes custody of equipment deployed by rail by signing appropriate shipping documents.

f.
Notifies SPOE Team leaders equipment deployed by rail has arrived in the MA.

g.
Briefs commander and/or SPOE Team OIC on status of rail offloading activities.

h.
Enforces safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications.

i.
Enforces environmental stewardship protection program procedures. ,

5. SPOE Team performs rail offloading operations.
a.
Reports to the railhead IAW UMO's instructions.

b.
Offloads equipment from railcars IAW PSA officials' instructions.

c.
Moves equipment to SPOE MA IAW PSA officials' instructions.

d.
Employs safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications.

e.
Employs environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

6. SPOE Team performs SPOE MA maintenance.
a.
Performs after-operations PMCS IAW the Redeployment Movement Plan and appropriate TMs.

b.
Notifies supervisor of maintenance problems beyond operator's capability.

c.
Checks vehicles, cargo, and personal gear for completeness, damage, proper markings, contraband, and compliance with loading plans.

d.
Conducts final preparation of vehicles and equipment IAW the Redeployment Movement Plan.

5-113
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
e.
Adjusts vehicle fuel levels IAW port call message and PSA officials and UMO's instructions.

f.
Turns in excess fuel and POL products IAW UMO's instructions.

g.
Verifies placement of placards, labels, and certification documents . on hazardous material IAW PSA officials and UMO's instructions.

h.
Corrects deficiencies on vehicles, cargo, and personal gear JAW SPOE Team leader's instructions.

i.
Moves to SPOE vehicle and equipment cleaning site, as directed.

j.
Employs safety procedures IAW with TSOP and publications.

k.
Employs environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

7. SPOE Team performs USDA cleaning activities.
a.
Performs vehicle cleaning IAW instructions from cleaning site personnel.

b.
Corrects USDA inspection deficiencies JAW USDA officials' instructions.

c.
Moves vehicles and equipment to designated sterile area IAW unit leader's instructions.

d.
Employs safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications.

e.
Employs environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
*8. SPOE Team leaders supervise final preparation of vehicles, equipment, cargo, and personal gear for redeployment by sealift.
a.
Inspect military shipping labels, markings, customs labels, and decontamination tags on vehicles and equipment for compliance with redeployment SOP, port call message, and UMO's instructions.

b.
Monitor customs inspection to ensure deficiencies are corrected.

c.
Inspect vehicles and cargo to ensure deficiencies noted during acceptance inspection have been corrected.

d.
Coordinate maintenance assistance with Commander and/or SPOE Team OIC.

e.
Enforce safety procedures.

f.
Enforce environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

9. SPOE Team performs final preparation of vehicles, equipment, cargo, and personal gear for redeployment.
a.
Moves vehicles and equipment to SPOE SA, as directed.

b.
Stages vehicles for loading IAW UMO and PSA officials' instructions.

c.
Corrects deficiencies in shipping documents, markings, customs labels, and decontamination tags on vehicles and equipment IAW UMO and PSA officials' instructions.

d.
Corrects deficiencies noted during customs inspection.

e.
Drives vehicles, as directed by PSA officials, to call forward area.

f.
Employs safety procedures JAW TSOP and publications.

g.
Employs environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

5-115
GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
*10. UMO updates transportation documentation.

a.
Verifies DEL by conducting physical inspection of
equipment.

b.
Updates DEL, as required.

c.
Verifies the presence of supercargoes by conducting roll call.

d.
Updates supercargo manifest, as required.

e.
Provides changes to DEL and supercargo manifest to PSA
officials, as required.

11. SPOE Team returns to unit area.
a.
Assembles personnel for return to unit area IAW commander
or SPOE Team OIC's instructions.

b.
Reports to transportation loading area IAW SPOE Team
OIC's instructions.

c.
Loads baggage on vehicles IAW SPOE Team OIC's
instructions.

d.
Boards transportation to return to unit IAW SPOE Team
OIC's instructions.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
ITERATION
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS: NONE
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
(
DODDOA-003880
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:MPerform Aerial Port of Embarkation Activities for Redeployment (63-2-4820) (FM 100-17, AR 220-10, DOD DIR 4500.9, FM 3-100.4, TM 38-250, DOD Regulation 4500.9-R)
M
ITERATION 1M2M3M4M5MMM(circle)
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT MTMPMUM(circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit arrives at the APOE MA for aerial redeployment. The higher HQ has an advance party at the APOE to assist in coordinating APOE activities. Transportation support is available. The Redeployment Movement Plan and port call message are available. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The unit has a trained officer and/or NCO appointed as UMO and alternate UMO. The unit is redeploying as part of higher HQ redeployment. A TSC is in place and has assumed overall responsibility for all logistics operations in the theater, to include port operations. APOE activities are performed day or night under all environmental conditions unless terminated by the DACG. This task should not be trained in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: APOE activities are performed IAW the Redeployment Movement Plan
and DACG officials' instructions.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO *1. Commander directs APOE activities.
a.
Notifies higher HQ advance party OIC and/or DACG
representative that the unit has arrived at the APOE using analog and/or
digital communications.

b.
Coordinates with S2/S3, PMCT, DACG, and/or TSC
officials to verify APOE movement schedules, procedures, and
requirements using analog and/or digital communications.

c.
Provides manifest of unit personnel and shipper's declaration
of dangerous goods to higher HQ for review by DACG or PMCT.

5-117
1
GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
d.
Briefs unit on APOE duties and responsibilities, to include reverse manifesting schedule, customs requirements, and transportation of personnel and baggage.

e.
Directs unit to conduct final preparation of vehicles and equipment IAW the Redeployment Movement Plan and DOD Directive 4500.9.

f.
Conducts acceptance inspection of vehicles and equipment • with DACG officials at the alert holding area.

g.
Directs unit to correct deficiencies noted during acceptance inspection.

h.
Transfers custody of equipment and cargo to DACG officials LAW DOD Regulation 4500.9-R.

i.
Briefs the higher HQ commander or designated representative on status of APOE activities.

*2. UMO/NCO supervises APOE activities.
a.
Coordinates with S4 and/or DACG officials for transportation, maintenance, logistics, and other support using analog and/or digital communications, as required.

b.
Coordinates with S2/S3 representative, PMCT, or DACG to verify APOE movement schedules, procedures, and requirements using analog and/or digital communications.

c.
Coordinates with S4 representative to ensure adequate shoring, dunnage, and floor protection is on hand and readily available for loading using analog and/or digital communications.

d.
Verifies unit vehicles, equipment, cargo, and secondary loads are properly marked and prepared for redeployment by air IAW TALCE/DACG.

e.
Coordinates with S2/S3 representative, site coordinator, and/or DACG representative for equipment cleaning support using analog and/or digital communications, if necessary.

f.
Coordinates with DACG to verify loading sequence of vehicles and equipment using analog and/or digital communications.

ARTEP 55-718-30-MTP
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES g. Designates personnel to verify weight and center of balance marks, if required. GO NO GO
h. Briefs designated personnel on weight and center of balance marks verification requirements.
i. Verifies that deficiencies noted during DACG acceptance inspection have been corrected.
j. Verifies the presence of all manifested personnel by conducting roll call.
k. Provides verified personnel and cargo manifest to DACG at the alert holding area.
1. Provides load teams to load and tie down unit equipment under supervision of the DACG or loadmaster.
3. Unit performs APOE MA activities.
a. Performs after-operations PMCS JAW appropriate TMs.
b. Notifies supervisor of maintenance problems beyond operator's capability to repair.
c. Conducts final preparation of vehicles and equipment JAW DOD Directive 4500.9 and UMO's instructions.
d. Adjusts vehicle fuel levels JAW TM 38-250 and DACG officials' instructions.
e. Turns in excess fuel and POL products JAW UMO's instructions.
f. Corrects deficiencies on vehicles, cargo, and personal gear JAW unit leaders' instructions.
g. Corrects deficiencies on placement of placards, labels, and certification documents on hazardous material JAW UMO/NCO, unit leaders, and customs and USDA officials' instructions, if necessary.
h. Moves vehicles and equipment to APOE cleaning site or alert holding area, as directed. .

5-119
DODDOA-003883
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
i.
Employs safety procedures JAW TSOP and publications.

j.
Employs environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

4. Unit processes vehicles and equipment through the APOE cleaning site.
a.
Delivers vehicles to APOE cleaning site JAW UMO's instructions.

b.
Performs vehicle cleaning JAW DACG and USDA officials' instructions.

c.
Returns vehicles and equipment to unit area JAW unit leaders' instructions.

*5. Unit leaders supervise final preparation of vehicles, equipment, sensitive items, cargo, and personal gear for redeployment.
a.
Inspect shipping documents, markings, customs labels, and decontamination tags on vehicles, equipment, cargo, and personal gear for compliance with the Redeployment Movement Plan and UMO's instructions.

b.
Monitor customs inspection to ensure deficiencies are corrected.

c.
Inspect vehicles and cargo to ensure deficiencies noted during acceptance inspection have been corrected.

d.
Coordinate with the UMO for assistance in correcting shipping documentation and maintenance deficiencies, as required.

e.
Enforce safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications.

f.
Enforce environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

6. Unit performs APOE alert holding area activities.
a.
Drives vehicles to call forward area, as directed.

b.
Boards transportation to terminal, as directed.

c.
Employs safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications.

GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
7. Unit performs APOE passenger activities.
a.
Reports to designated location for safety and anti-terrorism
briefing, security screen, and customs inspection IAW UMO's
instructions.

b.
Remains in quarantined area IAW DACG officials'
instructions.

c.
Provides baggage detail, as directed, to load unit baggage on
aircraft.

d.
Boards aircraft IAW loadmaster's instructions.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
ITERATION
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS: NONE
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
5-121
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
Perform Aerial Port of Debarkation Activities for Redeployment (63-2-4821)
TASK:
(FM 100-17, FM 3-100.4, FM 55-30, FM 55-9, TM 38-250, TM 55-2200-001-12)

1M2M3M4M5.M.(circle)
ITERATION
.

(circle)
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT TMPMUM
CONDITIONS: Aircraft carrying main body lands at the APOD. The higher HQ has an advance party at the APOD to assist in coordinating APOD activities. Representatives from the higher HQ advance party, supporting installation, and AACG meet the aircraft. AACG officials request that unit personnel assist in offloading the aircraft. The AACG has designated a holding area and an MA for the unit to complete APOD activities. Transportation is available to move the unit to the MA and home station. The Redeployment Movement Plan is available. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. APOD activities are performed day or night under all environmental conditions. This task should not be trained in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: APOD activities are performed IAW the Redeployment Movement Plan
and AACG officials and commander's instructions.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Commander coordinates arrival of personnel.

a.
Coordinates with higher HQ advance party and AACG
officials upon arrival for USDA and customs inspections, location of
holding and marshalling areas, maintenance support, movement support,
security, and other special APOD requirements using and/or digital
communications.

b.
Assembles unit in holding area.

c.
Briefs unit leaders on APOD requirements and movement
arrangements.

d.
Briefs higher HQ advance party OIC on APOD activities, as
required.

DODDOA-003886
GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
*2. UMO coordinates APOD activities.
a.
Coordinates with AACG for offloading and movement schedules.

b.
Briefs unit leaders on offloading and movement schedules.

c.
Provides AACG, supporting installation officials, and higher HQ staff personnel representative a copy of DEL.

d.
Coordinates with AACG on the temporary storage of sensitive and classified equipment.

e.
Briefs commander on APOD activities. *3. Unit leaders supervise APOD activities.

a.
Inspect personnel and weapons for accountability as they exit aircraft.

b.
Brief personnel on APOD requirements based on commander's instructions.

c.
Monitor USDA and customs inspections to ensure personnel comply with USDA and customs officials' instructions.

d.
Designate personnel to assist in offloading aircraft, as required.

e.
Inspect personnel and personal gear at the holding area and MA to ensure all personnel have arrived with required personal gear.

f.
Brief commander on APOD activities.

4. Unit performs APOD activities.
a.
Disembarks aircraft JAW loadmaster's instructions.

b.
Assembles in APOD holding area, as directed.

c.
Performs offloading activities IAW AACG officials and
loadmaster's instructions.

d.
Moves to APOD MA IAW commander's instructions.

5-123

DODDOA-003887
ARTEP 55-718-30-MTP
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES e. Inspects vehicles and equipment to ensure all equipment is offloaded and serviceable. GO NO GO
f. Notifies unit leaders of vehicle and/or equipment deficiencies that cannot be corrected.
g. Reconfigures, if necessary, vehicles and cargo for road movement.
h. Prepares, if necessary, convoy for movement to home station or demobilization station.
NOTE: See task steps two through five of Task 63-2-4808 for detailed convoy preparation procedures. i. Loads baggage, as directed, on transportation for movement to home station. j. Boards transportation, as directed, for movement to home station. k. Employs safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications. 1. Employs environmental stewardship protection program procedures.
TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO" TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO" TOTAL
"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS: NONE
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
5-124
DODDOA-003888

ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK: Perform Home Station Activities (63-2-4822) (FM 100-17, AR 600-8-1, AR 600-8-19, AR 710-2, AR 735-5, FM 4-30.3)

3M4M5MMM(circle)
ITERATION 1M2M
(circle)
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT TMPMUM
CONDITIONS: The unit main body arrives at home station. The higher HQ main body has arrived and the higher echelon HQ is operational. Unit main body arrives at home station prior to equipment arrival at SPOD. The unit receives notification of ship arrival schedule from the ITO. The Redeployment Movement Plan is available. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. Unit's welcome home reception activities have been coordinated with higher HQ support installations and rear detachment OIC prior to the unit's arrival. Home station activities are performed day or night under all environmental conditions. This task should
not be trained in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Home Station activities are accomplished IAW the Redeployment
Movement Plan and commander's instructions.
GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
*
1. Commander directs home station activities.

a.
Coordinates with higher HQ commander and staff to identify
requirements prior to arrival of equipment using analog and/or digital
communications.

b.
Directs personnel to complete redeployment requirements
based on the Redeployment Movement Plan and higher HQ
commander's instructions.

c.
Coordinates with S2/S3 or ITO to identify unit's SPOD
requirements for returning equipment using analog and/or digital
communications.

d.
Designates an Equipment Reception Team to receive
vehicles and equipment at SPOD.

5-125
GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
e.
Directs personnel to inventory, clean and inspect vehicles, equipment, weapons, sensitive items, and personal gear, as it is redeployed to home station.

f.
Coordinates with S4 for procedures to turn in float and replacement equipment using analog and/or digital communications.

g.
'Coordinates with battalion commander and staff for guidance on reception activities using analog and/or digital communications.

h.
Approves after action reports.

i.
Briefs unit on reception activities.

j.
Enforces safety procedures JAW SOP and publications.

k.
Enforces environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

2. UMO performs home station activities.
a. Coordinates with ITO for transportation support.

b. Briefs Equipment Reception Team Leader on SPOD requirements.

c.
Verifies that all DEL listed vehicles and equipment have been redeployed, by conducting physical inventory.

d.
Notifies commander of discrepancies in DEL, if necessary.

e.
Updates AUEL, as required.

3. Unit HQ performs home station personnel and administrative actions.
a.
Debriefs personnel JAW commander's instructions.

b.
Coordinates reception activities IAW commander's guidance.

c.
Consolidates unit after action reports.

d.
Prepares after action reports IAW the Redeployment
Movement Plan and commander's instructions.

GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
e.
Submits AAR to commander for approval.

f.
Distributes after action reports IAW the Redeployment Movement Plan and commander's instructions.

g.
Maintains after action reports and records IAW the Redeployment Movement Plan and commander's instructions.

h.
Identifies pending personnel actions of redeploying soldiers to determine if any unit and/or soldier actions (such as ratings, awards, financial actions, UCMJ actions, LOD investigations, physicals, and so forth) are needed.

4. Unit HQ performs home station supply activities.
a.
Turns in float and replacement equipment IAW commander's instructions.

b.
Inspects weapons, basic loads, and CTA items for accountability and serviceability.

c.
Enforces safety procedures IAW SOP and publications.

d.
Enforces environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

*5. Unit leaders supervise home station activities.
a.
Inspect vehicles, equipment, weapons, and personal gear for accountability compliance with the Redeployment Movement Plan, Maintenance SOP, and commander's instructions.

b.
Direct personnel, as required, to correct deficiencies in vehicles, equipment, weapons, and personal gear.

c.
Submit AAR to unit HQ IAW commander's instructions.

d.
Enforce safety procedures IAW SOP and publications.

e.
Enforce environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

5-127
DODDOA-003891
GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
6. Equipment Reception Team Leader performs home station
equipment reception activities.

a.
Coordinates with UMO or ITO for transportation support to
SPOD.

b.
Briefs Equipment Reception Team on equipment reception
schedule and requirements.

c.
Supervises movement to SPOD IAW UMO's instructions.

7. Unit performs home station activities.
a. Completes redeployment personnel and administrative
requirements based on the Redeployment Movement Plan and
commander's instructions.


b.
Inventories, cleans and inspects vehicles, equipment,
weapons, and personal gear, IAW the Redeployment Movement Plan,
Maintenance SOP and commander's instructions.

c.
Employs safety procedures IAW SOP and publications.

d.
Employs environmental stewardship protection program
procedures.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS: NONE
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
(

DODDOA-003892
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
Perform Sea Port of Debarkation Activities for Redeployment (63-2-4823)
TASK:M(FM 100-17, FM 3-100.4, FM 4-30.3, TM 55-2200-001-12)
M
MM(circle)
ITERATION 1M2M3M4M5MM
TMPMUM(circle)
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT
CONDITIONS: Unit equipment and supercargoes have arrived at the SPOD. The commander has designated an OIC/NCOIC to accompany the unit Equipment Reception Team to the SPOD holding area. The Equipment Reception Team has been trained and briefed on duties and responsibilities. The Redeployment Movement Plan is available. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. Higher HQ staff element is located in the SPOD to assist in coordinating SPOD activities. Transportation support is available. The PSA has coordinated for ship offloading and designated an area for equipment to be inventoried and inspected as it is offloaded. Rail and road MAs have been designated to prepare vehicles and equipment for movement. Sufficient railcars and vehicles are available to move the unit equipment and designated personnel to home station. SPOD activities are performed day or night under all environmental conditions. This task should not be trained in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: SPOD activities are performed LAW the Redeployment Movement Plan
and PSA officials and commander's guidance.
NOTE: If SPOD is a military seaport, the commander may designate a Rail Loading Team Chief
and Rail Loading Team to perform rail loading activities.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO *1. Equipment Reception Team OIC/NCIOC directs SPOD activities.
a.
Coordinates with higher HQ staff element and PSA officials
upon arrival for USDA and customs inspections, location of holding and
marshaling areas, maintenance support, movement, security, and other
special APOD requirements using analog and/or digital
communications.

b.
Coordinates with higher HQ S4 and/or PSA officials for life
support for unit personnel while at the SPOD using analog and/or digital
communications.

5-129
DODDOA-003893
GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
c.
Assembles Equipment Reception Team in holding area.

d.
Conducts acceptance inspection with PSA officials.

e.
Notifies higher HQ staff element OIC and S4 representative of missing or damaged equipment using analog and/or digital communications.

f.
Assumes custody of equipment and cargo IAW higher HQ • staff personnel representatives and PSA officials' instructions.

g.
Coordinates with S2/S3 to verify arrangements for movement to home station using analog and/or digital communications.

h.
Verifies arrival and morale and welfare of supercargoes.

i.
Reestablishes accountability and responsibility for supercargoes.

j.
Directs Equipment Reception Team to proceed to convoy marshaling area, IAW S2/S3's instructions.

k.
Monitors preparation of equipment for road convoy or rail movement to ensure compliance with TSOP.

1. Briefs Equipment Reception Team leaders on SPOD requirements.
m.
Briefs unit commander and higher HQ staff element OIC on SPOD activities, as required.

n.
Enforces safety procedures IAW SOP and publications.

o.
Enforces environmental protection program procedures. *2. UMO supervises unit activities at SPOD.

a.
Coordinates with S4 representative to identify offloading schedules, location of holding and Mas, and other SPOD information using analog and/or digital communications, as required.

b.
Briefs personnel on offloading schedules, location of MAs and USDA, customs, and other special SPOD requirements.

c.
Coordinates with S4 representative and/or PSA officials to identify loading plans, schedules, and sites for rail movement using analog and/or digital communications, if required.

GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
d.
Provides rail loading plans to Rail Loading Team Chief, if required.

e.
Monitors rail loading procedures to ensure compliance with PSA officials' instructions, if required.

f.
Monitors preparation of equipment for road convoy to ensure compliance with Movement Plan.

g.
Coordinates with S2/S3 representatives for convoy routes, maps, and timetable for road move to home station using analog and/or digital communications.

h.
Coordinates with S4 representatives for fuel and supplies for road move to home station using analog and/or digital communications.

i.
Briefs Equipment Reception Team on convoy requirements.

j.
Briefs commander on SPOD activities.

k.
Enforces safety procedures IAW SOP and publications.

1. Enforces environmental stewardship protection program procedures.
3. Supercargoes representative performs SPOD activities.
a.
Disembarks ship JAW vessel POC's instructions.

b.
Reports to customs inspection site IAW vessel POC's instructions.

c.
Reports to Equipment Reception Team OIC upon completion of customs inspection.

4. Equipment Reception Team performs equipment reception activities.
a.
Offloads vehicles and equipment IAW PSA officials'
instructions.

b.
Inspects equipment to ensure all equipment is offloaded and
operational.

c.
Notifies UMO of deficiencies that cannot be corrected.

5-131

DODDOA-003895
GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
d.
Moves vehicles to USDA and customs inspection site(s)
JAW UMO's instructions.

e.
Moves vehicles to rail loading site, if required.

f.
Performs rail loading activities, if required.

NOTE: See task steps 10 and 11 of Task 63-2-4818 for detailed rail
loading procedures.

g.
Moves vehicles and cargo to SPOD rail or convoy MA.

h.
Reconfigures vehicles and cargo for road movement, as
appropriate.

i.
Fuels vehicles for convoy to home station, if appropriate.

j.
Prepares convoy for movement to home station, if necessary.

NOTE: See task steps two through five of Task 63-2-4807 for detailed
convoy preparation procedures.

k. Notifies commander when Equipment Reception Team is
prepared to move.

1. Employs safety procedures IAW SOP and publications.
m. Employs environmental stewardship protection program
procedures.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step. SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS: NONE SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
DODDOA-003896
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK: Perform Demobilization Station Activities (63-2-4824) (FM 100-17. AR 220-10, AR 700-84)

1M2M3M4M5MMM(circle)
ITERATION
.

PMUM(circle)
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT TM
CONDITIONS: The unit has redeployed to CONUS via airlift and arrived at the designated
demobilization station via prearranged transportation. APOD activities (63-2-4821) have been
completed. The higher HQ has an advance party at the demobilization station to assist in
coordinating demobilization activities. Transportation support is available. The Redeployment
Movement Plan and port call message are available. The unit has a trained officer and/or NCO
appointed as UMO and alternate UMO. The unit is deploying as part of a higher HQ
redeployment. Demobilization station activities are performed day or night under all
environmental conditions. This task should not be trained in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Demobilization station activities are performed IAW the Redeployment
Movement Plan and higher HQ guidance.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Commander directs demobilization station activities.

a.
Verifies accountability of personnel, weapons, and
equipment.

b.
Notifies higher HQ advance party representative that the unit
has arrived at the demobilization station.

c.
Directs unit HQ to coordinate with demobilization station
operations section to verify life support for unit personnel, processing
schedules, procedures and requirements.

d.
Briefs unit on demobilization station duties and
responsibilities.

e.
Directs convoy preparation activities.

5-133
GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
f.
Verifies unit personnel have been fully briefed on entitlements.

g.
Verifies unit has completed reverse SRP process or verified arrangements for holdover personnel.

h.
Coordinates with higher HQ staff elements and rear detachment, if applicable, on status of welcome home activities at home station.

i.
Verifies unit convoy is prepared to cross SP, if applicable.

j.
Briefs the higher HQ commander or designated representative on status of demobilization station activities.

k.
Enforces safety procedures IAW SOP and publications.

1. Monitors environmental stewardship protection program procedures.
*2. UMO supervises demobilization station movement activities.
a.
Prepares and/or updates movement plans for all modes of transportation.

b.
Coordinates with S4 and/or AACG officials for transportation, maintenance, logistics, and other support, as required.

c.
Coordinates with S2/S3 representative, PMCT, or AACG to verify movement schedules, procedures, and requirements.

d.
Supervises off-loading and staging of unit vehicles IAW AACG guidance, if applicable.

e.
Coordinates with S2/S3 representative for convoy clearance.

f.
Supervises preparation of convey for movement to home station, if necessary.

g.
Enforces safety procedures IAW SOP and publications.

NOTE: See task steps two through five of Task 63-2-4808 for detailed convoy preparation procedures.
h. Enforces environmental stewardship protection program procedures.
GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
3. Unit HQ supervises demobilization station activities.
a.
Establishes accountability of personnel, weapons, and equipment.

b.
Verifies life support and logistical support for unit personnel with demobilization station staff elements.

c.
Directs unit to secure weapons, sensitive items, and classified documents in their respective secure storage site(s).

d.
Directs unit to report to designated location for reverse SRP briefing.

e.
Monitors reverse SRP for unit personnel to resolve problems if they occur.

f.
Verifies unit personnel have completed all reverse SRP stations, as necessary.

g.
Verifies transportation arrangements for all unit personnel. •

h.
Enforces safety procedures JAW SOP and publications.

i.
Enforces environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

4. Unit performs demobilization station activities.
a.
Assembles in designated location for reverse SRP briefings.

b.
Performs reverse SRP activities, as directed.

c.
Prepares for departure via convoy and/or government transportation to home station.

d.
Prepares convoy for movement to home station, if necessary.

NOTE: See steps two through five of Task 63-2-4808 for detailed convoy preparation.
e. Loads baggage on transportation for movement to home station, as directed.
5-135

DODDOA-003899
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES f. Boards transportation for movement to home station, as directed. g. Employs safety procedures IAW SOP and publications. h. Employs environmental stewardship protection program procedures. GO NO GO
TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO" TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO" TOTAL
"s" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS: NONE
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE

,„. _
ELEMENT: Company Headquarters
TASK:KConduct Integration Activities (63-2-4825) (FM 100-17-3, AR 220-1, AR 710-2, FM 100-17, FM 20-3, FM 21-10, FM 4-30.3, FM 55-65)

1M2M3M4M5MMM(circle)
ITERATION

TMPMUM(circle)
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT
CONDITIONS: The unit is in the process of deploying following receipt of an OPORD. The unit has arrived at the POD, moved through the designated staging site and has closed in the TAA. Prior to onward movement from the staging area, the unit verified that it met mission readiness criteria. The unit initiates command and control procedures with the gaining command. The unit security plan, unit access rosters, TSOP, and current maps are available. The unit is deploying as part of a higher echelon deployment. Integration activities are performed day or night under all environmental conditions. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Personnel and equipment are combat ready and integrated into the
operational mission of the gaining tactical force commander.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Gaining Commander supervises integration activities.

a.
Directs communications link-up into gaining command net.

NOTE: Communications link-up will be performed through analog
and/or digital means, if so equipped.
b.
Directs unit to occupy area designated by gaining command.

c.
Directs unit HQ to integrate unit security plan into gaining
command's operational force protection measures.

d.
Directs unit HQ to integrate into the gaining command's CSS
system.

e.
Directs unit HQ to submit reports IAW gaining command
SOP/OPLANs.

NOTE: Unit HQ will use analog and/or digital communications, wire or
messenger to submit reports.

5-137

DODDOA-003901
ARTEP 55-718-30-MTP
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES 2. Unit HQ completes integration actions. a. Enters tactical communications net. GO NO GO
NOTE: Unit HQ will enter analog and/or digital communications nets, if so equipped. b. Integrates unit into TAA security plan. c. Clarifies operational mission parameters with S2/S3. d. Submits required reports to gaining command. NOTE: Unit HQ will submit reports using analog and/or digital communications. e. Conducts training as directed by gaining command. f. Coordinates support requirements with gaining command.
NOTE: Unit HQ will submit reports using analog and/or digital communications.
g. Establishes direct support relationships with various support elements in the support structure to include supply, services, maintenance and medical.
h. Assumes missions as directed by gaining command.
TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO" TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO" TOTAL
"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS: NONE
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
5-138
DODDOA-003902

-
-
-
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Conduct Staging Activities (63-2-4826) (FM 100-17-3. AR 220-1, FM 100-17, FM 20-3, FM 21-10, FM 3-100.4, FM 3-4, FM 4-30.3)
.
4.5.M.(circle)
ITERATION 1.2.3.
(circle)
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT . T.P.U.
CONDITIONS: The unit is in the process of deploying to a theater of operations following receipt of an OPORD. The unit has arrived in-theater at the APOD and has moved to the TSB for reuniting with unit equipment. The unit's Equipment Reception Team has just arrived at the TSB from the SPOD with unit equipment. The unit movement plan, security plan, unit access rosters, TSOP and current maps are available. The unit has a trained officer NCO appointed as UMO and alternate UMO. The unit is deploying as part of a higher echelon deployment. Staging activities are performed day or night under all environmental conditions. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Personnel and equipment are mission capable, configured for the specific
mission, and prepared for onward movement to the TAA.
NOTE: Since staging bases are not always available, units should be prepared to move directly to
the TAA or into their AO from the port staging area. When this is necessary, the
marshaling/staging functions are performed in a designated staging area in the vicinity of the port.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Commander supervises staging activities.

a.
Directs accountability be established for unit personnel and
equipment.

b.
Stages unit personnel and equipment in preparation for
onward movement.

c.
Notifies command and control element of the TSB of unit
arrival.

d.
Files initial unit status report as directed.


5-139
GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
e.
Conducts threat brief for all soldiers.

f.
Conducts rules of engagement brief.

g.
Directs movement planning.

h.
Prepares unit for mission.

i.
Receives daily situational briefmgs from higher HQ or TSB command and control element.

j.
Briefs higher HQ or TSB command and control element on status of unit.

k.
Notifies TSB when readiness is achieved.

1.
Monitors environmental stewardship prottction program procedures.

2.
Unit performs marshalling activities.

a.
Establishes command post.

b.
Verifies accountability of personnel and equipment.

c.
Coordinates with TSB command and control element for life support.

d.
Provides information concerning staging area activities based on TSB SOP to element leaders.

e.
Conducts risk assessment for onward movement.

f.
Establishes communications with TSB command and control element and higher-level commands.

g.
Establishes training objectives to be completed in the staging area.

h.
Verifies routes of march and support arrangements.

i.
Reports incremental buildup of combat power IAW TSB SOP.

ARTEP 55-718-30-MTP
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES j. Conducts daily meetings with TSB command and control element. GO NO GO
k. Monitors environmental stewardship protection program procedures.
*3. Unit performs premovement activities.
• a. Stages equipment in correct configuration for onward movement.
b. Plans onward movement to the TAA or location designated by the gaining command.
c. Coordinates with PMCT or MCT for onward movement.
d. Prepares vehicles and equipment for movement.
e. Verifies equipment is properly loaded on vehicles.
f. Identifies convoy support centers on route of march. •
g. Prepares movement order.
h. Briefs convoy personnel.
i. Verifies SP time is established.
j. Monitors environmental protection program procedures.
4. Unit conducts logistics activities.
a. Verifies life support needs are met for unit personnel.
b. Performs maintenance activities to ensure all equipment is serviceable and operational, to include refueling and maintenance checks and services.
c. Uploads equipment and supplies onto vehicles.
d. Inventories all property.
e. Identifies all shortages.

5-141
DOEM0A-003905
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES f. Signs hand receipts, as needed. g. Maintains personnel accountability. h. Draws basic loads of Class I, II, III, IV, V, VI, VIII, and DC and maps as needed. i. Initiates security measures as directed. GO NO GO
j. Performs force protection. k. Conducts training, as needed.
1. Conducts test driving, bore sighting, range activities, as directed.
m. Employs environmental stewardship protection program procedures.
TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO" TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO" TOTAL
"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS: NONE
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE

ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Use Passive Air Defense Measures. (63-2-4307) (FM 44-8, FM 20-3, FM 3-4, FM 44-80, STP 21-1-SMCT, STP 21-24-SMCT)
M.(circle)
ITERATION. 1.2.3.4.5..
T.P.U.(circle)
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT
CONDITIONS: Threat aircraft have been sighted and reported to be in the unit's general area. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD, unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. The higher HQ staff element has issued an air defense weapon status "hold" for the area. The unit is currently providing support for tactical operations. Field expedient and natural shelters are available. This task is performed day or night under all environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and all levels of threat forces attacks. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: All available resources are employed to hide the unit from detection by
air, and to lessen its vulnerability if attacked. At MOPP4, air watch activities are degraded
significantly due to eye-lens distortion.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
1. Unit employs camouflage and concealment techniques.
a.
Covers all shiny items with emphasis on windshields,
mirrors, headlights, and taillights.

b.
Camouflages vehicles, tents, and supplies so they are not
seen from above.

c.
Disperses vehicles, tents, and supplies at distances consistent
with the size of the area to reduce vulnerability to air attacks.

d.
Constructs field fortifications with available materials that
protect personnel and mission-essential equipment.

e.
Establishes attack alarm procedures.

f.
Rehearses alarm procedures.

5-143

GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
*2. Commander and leaders supervise air watch activities.
a.
Direct manning of the OP that provides an early warning of approaching aircraft.

b.
Establish a listening watch on the air defense early warning radio net, if equipment is available.

c.
Depict on the map board current threat aircraft sightings in the immediate area.

d.
Forward all aircraft sightings with direction of flight to the higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications, if time and situation permit.

3. Unit personnel react to aircraft sightings.
a.
Sound prescribed alarm to alert all unit personnel of the presence of threat aircraft.

b.
Occupy predesignated fighting positions and field fortifications.

c.
Maintain constant surveillance of assigned search sector.

d.
Identify threat aircraft visually.

e.
Remain concealed and hold fire to avoid revealing position.

f.
Restrict movement of vehicles or movement of personnel in open areas.

*4. Commander and leaders supervise post-attack activities.
a.
Sound "All Clear" signal as directed by unit HQ.

b.
Forward damage report and personnel status report to higher HQ staff elements using analog and/or digital communications.

c.
Submit PIR to higher HQ staff element using analog and/or
digital communications or messenger.

d.
Coordinate casualty treatment and evacuation with higher
HQ SI using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
e.
Submit casualty forms to the Si within 24 hours.

f.
Direct clearing of mission-hindering destroyed supplies and equipment.

g.
Coordinate changes or delays to support plan caused by air attack with higher HQ S2/S3 and Support Operations Section using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

h.
Coordinate replacement of personnel with higher headquarters Si using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

i.
Coordinate replacement of equipment with higher HQ S4 using analog and/or digital communications.

NOTE: Requisitions for repair parts are made by using ULLS-G. ULLS-S4 is used to request equipment replacements.
j. Direct unit to continue assigned mission.
5. Unit personnel perform post-attack activities.
a.
Treat casualties. NOTE: See Task 08-2-0003.63-0001 for detailed treatment procedures.

b.
Transport casualties.

NOTE: See Task 63-2-4316 for detailed casualty transportation procedures.
c.
Reconstruct damaged fighting positions and field fortifications.

d.
Repair damaged camouflage material.

e.
Move KIA remains and personal effects to a predesignated location.

f.
Report casualties to CP using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

g.
Clear debris from area essential to mission accomplishment.

h.
Continue mission, as directed by the commander.

5-145
TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
M TOTAL
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS
ReferencesTask Number Task Title
-
-

031 503 3008 Implement Mission Oriented Protective STP 21 -24SMCT
Posture 052-191-1501 Perform Individual Camouflage STP 21-1-SMCT 071-331-0815 Practice Noise, Light, and Litter Discipline STP 21-1-SMCT 441-091-1040 Visually Identify Threat Aircraft STP 21-24-SMCT
-
-
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS
TASK: CONDUCT AERIAL RECONNAISSANCE (63-OPFOR-1007)
CONDITION: OPFOR HQ requires intelligence on the location and identification of enemy elements. Aircraft is dispatched to take photographs and conduct a visual inspection of enemy rear area.
STANDARD: 1. Photograph assigned sectors. 2. Make quick visual checks where cloud ceiling is low. 3. Locate enemy positions in the rear area, particularly support and storage bases, and C2 facilities. 4. Report PIR and other information requirements to OPFOR HQ.

DODD0A-003910
_ —
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad..
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Take Active Air Defense Measures Against Hostile Aircraft (63-2-4308) (FM 44-8, FM 3-4, FM 3-5, FM 44-80, STP 21-1-SMCT, STP 21-24-SMCT)
M.(circle)
ITERATION. 1.2.3.4.5..
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit received an early warning of unknown or hostile aircraft in the area.
The unit is tactically deployed supporting combat operations. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. Higher HQ OPORD, the unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. Weapon control status is "WEAPONS HOLD." An air attack has caused casualties and damage to the operating area and facilities. This task is performed day or night under all environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and all levels of threat force attacks. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Unit repulses attacking aircraft. At MOPP4, air search, aircraft
engagement, and post-attack activities are significantly degraded due to protective clothing and
eye-lens distortion.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
1. Unit personnel employ preparatory measures before engaging hostile
aircraft.

a.
Alert all personnel of the presence of hostile aircraft using
analog and/or digital communications and local alarms if situation
permits.

b.
Occupy predesignated fighting positions and field
fortifications.

c.
Search assigned sector for approaching aircraft.

d.
Identify threat aircraft visually.

5-147

DODDOA-003911
.4%
GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
e.
Report all aircraft actions to S3 Section using analog and/or digital communications.

f.
Prepare personnel to fire on orders of senior individual present or automatically return fire, if fired upon by aircraft.

2. Unit engages hostile aircraft.
a.
Places weapon on highest rate of fire. •

b.
Elects proper aim point for type of aircraft and direction of flight.

c.
Engages hostile aircraft with all available small arms until destroyed or warded off.

*3. Commander and leaders supervise post attack activities.
a.
Give "All Clear" signal when hostile aircraft have departed the area.

b.
Forward damage report and personnel status report to Si Section using analog and/or digital communications.

c.
Submit personnel SITREP to Si Section using analog and/or digital communications, including casualty forms within 24 hours.

d.
Coordinate casualty treatment and evacuation with Si Section using analog and/or digital communications.

e.
Direct clearing of mission-hindering destroyed supplies and equipment.

f.
Coordinate changes or delays to support plan caused by air attack with support operations section, battalion support operations section, and supported maneuver battalion S4 Section using analog and/or digital communications.

g.
Coordinate replacement of personnel with the Si Section
using analog and/or digital communications.

h.
Coordinate replacement of equipment with S4 Section using
ULLS-G to request repair parts and ULLS-S4 to request equipment
replacements.

i.
Direct unit to continue assigned mission.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
4. Unit personnel perform post-attack activities.
a.
Treat casualties.
NOTE: See Task 63-2-4517 for detailed treatment procedures.

b.
Report casualties to CP using analog and/or digital
communications or messenger.

c.
Transport casualties.
NOTE: See Task 63-2-4316 for detailed transportation procedures.

d.
Reconstruct damaged fighting positions and field
fortifications.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"s" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS Task Number Task Title References
071-311-2007 Engage Targets With an M I 6A1 or M16A2 STP 21-1-SMCT
Rifle 071-312-3031 Engage Targets With an M60 Machine Gun STP 21-1-SMCT 441-091-1040 Visually Identify Threat Aircraft STP 21-24-SMCT
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
5-149

DODDOA-003913
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS
TASK: CONDUCT AIR ATTACKS (63-OPFOR-1006)
CONDITION: OPFOR elements in the rear area have forwarded the positions of enemy support sites and/or the locations of road march elements to OPFOR HQ. OPFOR aircraft have been dispatched to attack enemy installations or convoys.
STANDARD: 1. Locate command and control site(s) or convoys. 2. Conduct attack runs on designated target(s). 3. Destroy enemy equipment, supplies, vehicles, and personnel.
ELEMENTS: Medium Truck Squad
Light Truck Squad
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
TASK:.Set Up Truck Platoon (55-2-0007) (FM 55-30, FM 20-3, FM 21-10, FM 24-35, FM 24-35-1, FM 90-10)
5.M.(circle)
ITERATION. 1.2.3.4.
.

(circle)COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT
CONDITIONS: The quartering party guides have escorted the truck platoons into their respective locations at the new field or MOUT operating site. The operating areas for truck platoon HQ have been identified in the commander's layout plan. Selected personnel from the main body have been assigned to primary fighting positions to area security. TSOP is available. This task will be performed under all environmental conditions. The platoons may be subject to attack by threat Level I forces, NBC attack, or radiological fallout. Some iterations of this task should be
performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: All truck platoons are set up IAW the TSOP or commander's layout plan
and within prescribed time frame.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Platoon leader or sergeant directs setup operations.

a.
Enforces OPSEC procedures.

b.
Enforces safety procedures.

c.
Directs diFpersion of platoon vehicles and equipment.

d.
Supervises camouflage and concealment of unit.

e.
Maintains communications with the CP.

f.
Maintains security in designated area of responsibility.

2. Platoon sets up headquarters area.
a.
Positions equipment.

b.
Marks vehicle parking area.

5-151

DODDOA-00391 5
GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
c.
Establishes communication with the CP.

d.
Camouflages all equipment and vehicles.

3. Platoon sets up platoon areas.
a.
Positions equipment.

b.
Establishes platoon areas.

c.
Disperses platoon vehicles.

d.
Establishes field sanitation facilities.

e.
Camouflages the area.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
ITERATION
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS Task Number Task Title References
101-524-3257 Supervise Field Kitchen Sanitation STP 10-92G25-SM-TG
Operations
101-92G-3257 Supervise Field Kitchen Sanitation STP 10-92G25-SM-TG

Operations
551-721-1399 Camouflage a Vehicle STP 55-88M12-SM
551-721-3358 Implement Truck Company Base of STP 55-88M34-SM-TG

Operation Plan
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE

DODDOA-003916
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Cross A Radiologically Contaminated Area (63-2-4005) (FM 3-3, FM 3-4, STP 21-1-SMCT, STP 21-24-SMCT)
.
1.2.3.4.5.M.(circle)
ITERATION
.

U.(circle)
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT T.P.
CONDITIONS: Orders are received from higher HQ staff element to cross a radiologically contaminated area. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD, the unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. The unit is conducting a tactical road march. NBC reconnaissance, survey, and survey control teams have been designated. The location of the contaminated area has been identified. The area cannot be bypassed without unacceptable delay to the move. Higher HQ staff element coordinates for additional NBC decontamination support. Assembly areas may be in concealed locations or alongside roads as the tactical situation dictates. This task is performed day or night under all environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and ground Level I threat forces attack. This task is always performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Unit crosses contaminated area by shortest route possible. At MOPP4,
performance degradation factors increase time required to cross contaminated area.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
1. Leading convoy element employs immediate protective measures.
a.
Covers nose and mouth with handkerchief or clean rag.

b.
Dons designated MOPP gear to reduce skin exposure.

c.
Covers all equipment, munitions, fuel, and water containers.

d.
Zeros dosimeters.

e.
Wears individual dosimeters (selected personnel).

f.
Performs basic soldier skill decontamination.

g.
Occupies closed vehicles (nonessential personnel).

5-153
GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
*2. March commander relays NBC information to convoy elements.
a.
Plots contamination area on map overlay(s).

b.
Notifies all march elements of reported location and type of
contamination using analog and/or digital communications.

c.
Designates assembly area(s) for convoy elements to
complete preparations to cross area.

d.
Directs required protective measures and MOPP level for
assembly area(s).

e.
Reports locations of assembly area(s), halt time, and tentative
resumption time to the higher HQ staff element using analog and/or
digital communications.

f.
Forwards NBC 4 nuclear reports to the higher HQ staff
element using analog and/or digital communications.

g.
Directs recording of dose rates IAW time intervals
established in the TSOP.

3. March elements occupy assembly area(s).
a.
Move into assembly area without stopping on the route of
march.

b.
Establish perimeter security with 360-degree surveillance
and crew-served weapons positioned along likely avenues of approach.

c.
Employ camouflage and concealment techniques with
emphasis on overhead concealment, mirrors, and windshields.

d.
Perform during-operations . PMCS IAW applicable TM.

4. Designated personnel perform monitoring activities.
a. Record dose rates IAW time intervals specified in the TSOP.
NOTE: During actual fallout, dose rates must be recorded at a
minimum of every 15 minutes.

b. Establish correlation factor.

GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
c.
Record correlation factor.

d.
Report correlation factor figures to the unit defense team.

e.
Record dose rate at 30-minute intervals after peak dose rate has been reported.

*5. March commander organizes radiological reconnaissance team(s).
a.
Identifies possible routes through contaminated area by map reconnaissance.

b.
Tasks convoy elements for vehicles, personnel, and equipment.

c.
Prepares overlays and/or strip maps to guide reconnaissance team(s) on assigned routes.

d.
Briefs reconnaissance team(s) on route, mission, and reporting procedures.

*6. March commander selects a crossing route.
a.
Employs correlation factor to determine ground dose rates from reconnaissance survey reports.

b.
Identifies contamination levels for tentative routes from NBC 5 report and/or radiological survey reports.

c.
Forwards radiological survey data to higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications.

d.
Establishes new exposure limits from OEG based on survey reports and in coordination with the higher HQ staff element.

e.
Selects best route that reduces exposure and permits the fastest travel based on METT-TC.

f.
Requests route clearance and approval from higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications.

5-155
DODDOA-003919
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*7. March commander supervises crossing preparation activities.
a.
Maintains situational awareness at all times using analog and/or digital communications.

b.
Assigns crossing time(s) for all convoy elements.

c.
Assigns assembly area location(s) for all convoy elements on the other side of the contaminated area for hasty decontamination.

d.
Directs placement of extra shielding consistent with available materials.

e.
Directs precautionary measures and MOPP level required for crossing.

f.
Coordinates Call For Support with higher HQ staff element for hasty and deliberate decontamination support using analog and/or digital communications.

8. NBC reconnaissance team(s) conduct a radiological route survey.
a.
Employ MOPP level 4.

b.
Employ additional shielding for non-armored vehicles.

c.
Inspect serviceability of all radiacmeters and other reconnaissance equipment.

d.
Plot checkpoints and distance intervals along route on overlays, based on tactical situation and time available.

e.
Employ radiacmeters and dosimeters to measure dose-rate readings inside the vehicle(s) at selected intervals between the checkpoints along the route.

f.
Employ radiacmeters to measure dose-rate readings outside the vehicle(s) to determine the correlation factor.

g.
Report survey data to convoy commander using analog and/or digital communications or radio.

h.
Place entrance markers at boundary of contaminated area.

NOTE: Markers should face away from the contaminated area in order to facilitate identification by convoy lead vehicle.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
i.
Report location of contaminated areas to convoy commander via NBC 4 nuclear report format.

j.
Report reading, time, and location of contamination detection to the higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications.

k.
Terminate radiological survey activities when tumback dose or turnback dose rate is reached, or when the specified area has been reconnoitered.

9. Unit prepares to cross contaminated area.
a.
Employs MOPP level 4.
b Employs equipment and cargo protection measures.

c.
Closes all air vents and windows on vehicles.

d.
Employs extra shielding for non-armored vehicles.

10. Unit crosses contaminated area.
a.
Follows route as marked by reconnaissance party or by overlay.

b.
Employs precautions that reduce dust.

c.
Avoids low ground, overhead branches, and heavy brush.

d.
Moves as quickly as possible across contaminated area without unnecessary halts and delays.

e.
Verifies that all vehicles have crossed the contaminated area and are out of the affected area before stopping.

f.
Forwards crossing report to march commander using analog and/or digital communications.

5-157

DODDOA-003921
GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
*
11. March commander supervises crossing of contaminated area.

a.
Establishes extended interval or staggered parallel routes to minimize radioactive dust pickup.

b.
Monitors convoy elements crossings to ensure compliance with TSOP.

c.
Maintains communications with all march elements during crossing using analog and/or digital communications.

d.
Directs dropping of all expendable covering materials at the edge of the contaminated area.

e.
Forwards crossing report to the higher HQ staff element when all convoy elements have crossed the contaminated area using analog and/or digital communications.

*
12. March commander supervises decontamination measures.

a.
Identifies level of decontamination required in coordination with higher HQ staff element.

b.
Directs implementation of basic soldier skill decontamination based on level of contamination, weather, and tactical situation.

c.
Directs implementation of hasty decontamination based on level of contamination, weather, and the tactical situation.

d.
Enforces OPSEC measures during decontamination operations.

e.
Records radiation level readings from selected personnel wearing dosimeters.

f.
Forwards radiation exposure status to higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications.

g.
Coordinates Call For Support for detailed decontamination support with higher HQ staff using analog and/or digital communications.

h.
Monitors personnel for symptoms of radiation sickness.

GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
13. Unit performs radiological decontamination.
a.
Locates radiological contamination using unit radiacmeter.

b.
Performs personal wipedown technique on individual equipment within 15 minutes of contamination by brushing, scraping, or shaking dry contaminant from equipment, if possible.

c.
Washes exposed area of skin with soap and water.

d.
Wipes off mask; hood, helmet, gloves, footwear covers, and other personal equipment with soapy water.

e.
Disposes of contaminated dust and articles IAW prescribed techniques in higher HQ OPORD and the battalion and unit TSOP.

f.
Measures level of residual radiation using radiacmeters to determine if contamination is negligible.

g.
Assists in hasty decontamination of equipment (vehicle washdown). •

h.
Conducts deliberate decontamination.

i.
Constructs sumps and runoff ditches to control contaminated drainage.

*14. March commander coordinates resumption of road march.
a.
Designates SP location and times for all convoy elements.

b.
Reschedules checkpoint and RP crossing times in coordination with higher HQ staff element.

c.
Provides new march instructions to all convoy elements.

d.
Directs covering and marking of contaminated runoff areas.

e.
Affixes locations of contaminated runoff areas on map overlay(s).

f.
Forwards march resumption reports to the higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications.

5-159
I

GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
15. Unit performs march resumption activities.
a.
Covers areas used for decontamination.

b.
Marks entrance and exit to contaminated area.

c.
Records radiation dose readings of areas used for
decontamination operations.

d.
Crosses new SP at time prescribed by the convoy
commander.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
2 .3 4 5 M TOTAL
ITERATION 1
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS References
Task Number Task Title
031-503-1007 Decontaminate Your Skin and Personal STP 21-1-SMCT
Equipment Using an M258A1
Decontamination Kit

031-503-1015 Protect Yourself From NBC STP 21-1-SMCT
Injury/Contamination With Mission-
Oriented Protective Posture (MOPP) Gear

031-503-1018 React to a Nuclear Hazard STP 21-1-SMCT
031-503-1023 Protect Yourself From NBC STP 21-1-SMCT
Injury/Contamination When Changing
Mission-Oriented Protective Posture
(MOPP) Gear

031-503-2004 Prepare and Submit NBC 4 Reports STP 21-24-SMCT
031-503-3004 Supervise the Crossing of a Contaminated STP 21-24-SMCT

Area
031-503-3006 Supervise Radiation Monitoring STP 21-24-SMCT
031-503-3008 Implement Mission-Oriented Protective STP 21-24-SMCT

Posture
031-503-3009 Lead MOPP Gear Exchange STP 21-24-SMCT

SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
DODDOA-003924
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS
TASK: DISRUPT ENEMY MOVEMENT AND OPERATIONS USING TACTICAL NUCLEAR WEAPONS (63-0PFOR-1002)
CONDITION: Tactical nuclear weapons are employed against key locations in the rear area.
STANDARD: 1. Disrupt or delay movement of equipment and supplies to forward areas. 2. Destroy enemy equipment and supplies. 3. Inflict nuclear casualties among enemy troops. 4. Deny enemy use of specified areas. 5. Contaminate enemy equipment and supplies.
5-161
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
• Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Defend Convoy Elements (63-2-4006) (FM 55-30, FM 3-4, FM 44-8, STP 21-1-SMCT, STP 21-24-SMCT)
.
ITERATION 1.2.3.4.5.M.(circle)
.
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: Threat forces attack the march column. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD with all annexes and overlays, unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. The unit is conducting a tactical road march. CAS sorties and indirect fire support have been allocated, but with low priority. Pyrotechnics are available for signaling and marking locations. This task is conducted day or night under all environmental conditions. The threat is capable of launching air, NBC, and ground Level I threat forces attack. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Attacks are repelled by proper immediate action techniques and march is resumed IAW TSOP and movement order. At MOPP4, performance degradation factors increase response times.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Convoy commander supervises reaction to sniper fire.

a.
Locates approximate location of sniper incident on map from
convoy element reports using analog and/or digital communications or
individual reports.

b.
Identifies whether area is a free fire zone or restricted fire
zone.

c.
Authorizes return fire only if sniper(s) are located.

d.
Directs march elements to increase march speed and interval
between vehicles until they have cleared the area using analog and/or
digital communications or visual signals.

GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
e.
Provides instructions to follow-on convoy elements using analog and/or digital communications.

f.
Forwards incident report to higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications.

2. Unit takes action against sniper fire.
a.
Maintains situational awareness using analog and/or digital communications.

b.
Reports sniper fire to convoy commander immediately upon contact.

c.
Returns fire immediately that kills snipers or suppresses their fire (designated personnel only).

d.
Increases column rate of march and vehicle interval.

*3. Convoy commander supervises defense against ambush, road blocked, or road not blocked.
a.
Identifies location of ambush site on map with map overlay using analog and/or digital communications.

b.
Directs convoy elements under attack to employ correct protective actions as prescribed in higher HQ movement order and TSOP.

c.
Provides instructions on halt points and security requirements to all convoy elements.

d.
Forwards initial incident report to higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications.

e.
Directs hardened vehicles with automatic fire capability into position to lay down concentrated fire on threat position(s).

f.
Directs the convoy elements ahead and convoy element following to organize security teams to attack flanks of threat ambush party.

g.
Maintains constant communications with all convoy
elements engaging threat to immediately make adjustments to tactical
situation using analog and/or digital communications.

5-163

DODDOA-003927
GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
h.
Forwards subsequent SITREP reports to higher HQ staff element as situation changes using analog and/or digital communications.

i.
Requests immediate CAS and/or indirect fire support from higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications.

j.
Directs use of pyrotechnics for signaling or marking areas.

k.
Develops contingency plans to displace elements not under attack and withdraw elements under attack.

4. Unit defends against ground ambush (road not blocked).
a. Reports ambush to convoy commander immediately upon
contact using analog and/or digital communications. •
b.
Identifies threat location(s).

c.
Returns fire immediately that kills threat and suppresses their fire (non-driving personnel).

d.
Stops vehicles (not in kill zone).

e.
Increases rate of march until out of kill zone (vehicles in kill zone).

f.
Keeps roadway clear by pushing disabled vehicles aside.

g.
Organizes security element(s) of soldiers not in kill zone (senior member present).

h.
Directs fire and maneuver of security elements to allow

remaining vehicles to pass through kill zone (senior member present). ,
i. Forwards SITREP to convoy commander using analog and/or digital communications.
5. Unit defends against ground attack (road blocked).
a.
Reports ambush to convoy commander immediately upon
contact.

b.
Dismounts vehicles on opposite side of direction of ambush.

GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
c.
Returns fire immediately which kills threat or suppresses their fire (soldiers in kill zone).

d.
Takes up firing positions while awaiting orders (soldiers not in kill zone).

e.
Organizes security element(s) of soldiers not in kill zone (senior member present).

f.
Directs fire and maneuver of security elements to allow removal of road block (senior member present).

g.
Forwards SITREP to convoy commander using analog and/or digital communications.

*6. Convoy commander requests indirect fire support.
a.
Requests fire support lAW instructions in the higher HQ movement order or TSOP using analog and/or digital communications.

b.
Identifies grid direction to threat location. •

c.
Identifies threat target location using grid coordinates or shift from a known point.

d.
Transmits call for fire in proper sequence using analog and/or digital communications.

e.
Transmits fire adjustment information in proper sequence to the fire support element, if an "adjust fire" mission is required, using analog and/or digital communications.

f.
Transmits "end of mission" and surveillance report if fire was
sufficient using analog and/or digital communications.

*7. Convoy commander requests CAS.
a.
Verifies threat position(s).

b.
Requests CAS by means prescribed in higher HQ movement
order using analog and/or digital communications.

c.
Supervises preparation of unit personnel for friendly strike.

5-165

DODDOA-003929
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
d.
Directs marking of friendly unit location(s) with prescribed colored smoke.

e.
Communicates strike effectiveness to higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications.

8. Unit employs passive defense measures against air attack.
a.
Provides the prescribed signal to alert column. •

b.
Staggers vehicles to avoid linear patterns.

c.
Drives vehicle in shadows or wood line.

d.
Assumes firing positions.

e.
Fires only upon command.

f.
Reports all aircraft actions to higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications.

9. Unit employs active defense measures against air attack.
a.
Employs the prescribed signal to alert march elements.

b.
Identifies threat aircraft visually.

c.
Disperses vehicles to concealed locations.

d.
Assumes firing positions.

e.
Prepares crew-served weapons for firing.

f.
Fires weapons at attacking aircraft only if fired upon or on command.

*10. Convoy commander supervises reorganization after attack.
a.
Identifies status of all personnel, equipment, and cargo through convoy element reports using analog and/or digital communications.

b.
Coordinates requirements within march elements for load transfer, vehicle repairs, mortuary affairs, and medical evacuation using analog and/or digital communications.

GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
c.
Requests emergency destruction authorization from higher HQ staff element for unrepairable items using analog and/or digital communications.

d.
Forwards SITREP to higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications.

11. Unit reorganizes after the attack.
a.
Maintains 360-degree surveillance.

b.
Treats casualties. NOTE: See Task 63-2-4517 for detailed treatment procedures.

c.
Reports casualties using analog and/or digital communications.

d.
Requests air ambulance support through convoy commander.

e.
Reestablishes chain of command, if necessary.

f.
Secures landing zone, if air ambulance is required.

g.
Evacuates casualties.

NOTE: See Task 63-2-4316 for detailed casualty evacuation procedures.
h.
Performs mortuary affairs functions. NOTE: See Task 63-2-4513 for detailed mortuary affairs procedures.

i.
Assesses damage to vehicles and cargo to determine operability and repairability.

j.
Performs BDAR for recoverable vehicles.

k.
Removes critical items from unrecoverable vehicles.

1. Requests emergency destruction of vehicles and non-medical
equipment from march commander using analog and/or digital
communications.

5-167
DODDOA-003931
-
-
-
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
m.
Forwards SITREP to convoy commander using analog
and/or digital communications.

n.
Reorganizes convoy elements.

o.
Resumes march.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
M TOTAL
ITERATION. -1 2 3 4 5
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED -
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS
Task Number Task Title References
061-283-6003 Adjust Indirect Fire STP 21-24-SMCT 071-311-2007 Engage Targets With an M16A1 or M16A2 STP 21-1-SMCT
Rifle 071-312-3031 Engage Targets With an M60 Machine Gun STP 21-1-SMCT 071-326-0503 Move Over, Through, or Around Obstacles STP 21-1-SMCT
(Except Minefields).2 081-831-0101 Request Medical Evacuation STP 21-24-SMCT 081-831-1026 Apply a Dressing to an Open Chest Wound STP 21-1-SMCT 101-515-1900 Perform Mortuary Affairs Operations STP 21 -1 -SMCT 441-091-1040 Visually Identify Threat Aircraft STP 21-24-SMCT
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS
TASK: CONDUCT HASTY AMBUSH (63-OPFOR-1003)
CONDITION: OPFOR element is moving in a wooded area when an enemy march element is seen moving along a nearby route.
STANDARD: 1. Prepare ambush site before arrival of enemy element. 2. Surprise enemy forces. 3. Inflict casualties within the designated kill zone. 4. Inflict damage to vehicles and equipment within the designated kill zone. 5. Delay enemy march element from reaching its destination for a specified period. 6. Withdraw, on order, within two minutes of ambush initiation. 7. Report actions
to superiors.
TASK: CONDUCT DELIBERATE AMBUSH (63-0PFOR-1004)
CONDITION: OPFOR element is operating along an enemy MSR. OPFOR intelligence has reported that an enemy element is conducting a road march along the route. OPFOR has set up an ambush. The march element is approximately 15 minutes from the ambush point. OPFOR element possesses automatic weapons, antiarmor weapons, and command detonated mines. OPFOR HQ has ordered complete destruction of march element.
STANDARD: 1. Prepare ambush site before arrival of enemy element. 2. Surprise enemy forces.
3. Force enemy march element to halt in kill zone. 4. Initiate ambush on order of the OPFOR leader. 5. Kill, wound, or capture enemy personnel and destroy specified vehicles and equipment in the kill zone. 6. Engage enemy reinforcements and security elements. 7. Consolidate and withdraw from the area on order. 8. Report all specified PIR and other intelligence requirements.
TASK: CONDUCT SNIPER OPERATIONS (63-0PFOR-1005)
CONDITION: OPFOR has assigned snipers, regular and/or irregular elements, in the enemy rear
area along MSR and near support sites.
STANDARD: 1. Set up well-concealed location(s). 2. Engage vehicle drivers or personnel on foot with short bursts of semi-automatic fire. 3. Kill or wound selected target. 4. Prevent position from being discovered by enemy forces. 5. Evacuate the area without being spotted. 6. Report all specified PIR and other intelligence requirements to OPFOR HQ.
5-169

DODDOA-003933
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Set Up Unit Defense (63-2-4011) (FM 10-27-2, FM 10-27-3, FM 21-75, FM 3-100.4, FM 3-4, FM 7-10, STP 21-1-SMCT, STP 21-24-SMCT)
.
1.2.3.4.5.M.(circle)
ITERATION
.

(circle)
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT
CONDITIONS: The unit is required to complete the setup of the unit defense IAW the time limit set by the commander. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD with all annexes and overlays, the unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. Unit defense plan is available. All fighting positions, locations of obstacles, and early warning devices are selected. This task is performed day or night under all environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and ground Level I threat forces attack. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: All preparations are completed for the defense within the time specified
and IAW the defense plan. At MOPP4, performance degradation factors increase response times.
GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
*
1. Unit leaders supervise setup of element defensive sector.

a.
Assign all personnel to primary fighting positions based on
type of weapon as prescribed in the defense plan.

b.
Assign sectors of fire for each primary position as prescribed
in the defense plan.

c.
Assign alternate and supplementary positions for each
primary position.

d.
Assign sectors of fire for each supplementary position.

e.
Verify sectors of fire, range cards, aiming stakes, and
possible dead space before authorizing construction of positions.

5170
-
GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
f.
Supervise construction of individual fighting positions within the element's sector.

g.
Supervise clearing of fields of fire.

h.
Supervise construction of obstacles IAW the defense plan.

i.
Supervise construction of OP/LP.

j.
Supervise emplacement of expedient warning device and position barriers.

k.
Assign personnel to unit internal reaction force IAW defense plan.

1. Prepare defensive sector sketch showing the location and sector of fire for each weapon, all known dead space, and the location and estimated ranges to prominent terrain features within the assigned
area.
m.
Forward sector sketch to unit leader using analog and/or • digital communications or messenger.

n.
Enforce safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications.

o.
Enforce environmental stewardship protection program procedures IAW TC 5-400.

2. Unit personnel construct primary fighting positions.
a.
Identify position location and sector of fire as directed by unit leader.

b.
Dig an initial hasty fighting position at least one-half meter
(18 to 20 inches) deep and with partially cleared fields of fire.

c.
Walk sector to determine ranges and dead space using buddy
system.

d.
Improve hasty fighting position to a two-man position.

e.
Install sector of fire stakes to identify area directed by unit
leader.

f.
Prepare appropriate range card by sighting in automatic
weapons, anti armor weapons, and grenade launchers on the assigned
engagement area.

5-171
GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
g.
Dig position to fit the natural cover available at least armpit
deep using dirt to build a parapet (front cover) at least 18 inches thick.

h.
Dig two trench grenade sumps, one at each end of the two­man position, and sloped toward the sumps.

i.
Complete clearing fields of fire, using foliage for camouflage.

j.
Construct overhead and flank cover for fighting position as • time permits.

k.
Camouflage position to prevent easy detection from 35
meters.

1. Report completion of primary positions to the unit leader.
m.
Mark alternate and supplementary positions as directed by
unit leader.

n.
Employ safety procedures LAW TSOP and publications.

o.
Employ environmental stewardship protection program
procedures LAW TC 5-400.

3. Unit personnel emplace obstacles and early warning devices.
a.
Place PEWS into operation at location(s) directed by the
element leader.

b.
Emplace man-made barriers, concertina wire, and field
expedient devices in locations directed by the unit leader.

c.
Position trip flares and field-expedient noise devices in
locations directed by the unit leader.

d.
Camouflage all obstacles and devices.

e.
Report completion of barrier emplacements to the unit leader
using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

f.
Employ safety procedures LAW TSOP and publications.

g.
Employ environmental stewardship protection program
procedures LAW TC 5-400.

GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
*4. Unit leaders supervise set up of defensive sector.
a.
Consolidate element defense sketches, after verification of compliance, into a unit defensive sector sketch.

b.
Forward unit's defensive sector sketch to unit CP within one hour after arrival at the new site using analog and/or digital communications or messenger. .

.
c.
Inspect unit positions to ensure structure, camouflage, and location comply with the unit defense plan and TSOP.

d.
Verify interlocking fires, dead space, and sector of fire for key weapon positions.

e.
Inspect OP/LP and personnel for communications, camouflage, and knowledge of withdrawal route.

f.
Inspect obstacles to ensure compliance with unit defense plan and TSOP.

g.
Report completion of sector set up to CP using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

h.
Enforce safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications.

i.
Enforce environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

5. Unit personnel establish OP/LP.
a.
Position OP/LP within effective small arms range of unit
elements.

b.
Establish communications (analog and/or digital means) with
nearest unit element and the CP.

c.
Camouflage OP/LP to prevent it from being detected within
35 meters.

d.
Establish withdrawal route that provides adequate cover and
concealment.

5-173

DODD0A-003937
GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
*6. Commander supervises set up of the unit's defensive sector.
a.
Inspects defensive preparation to ensure compliance with the
defense plan.

b.
Consolidates element sector defense sketches, after
verification of compliance, into the unit sector sketch.

c.
Forwards unit sector sketch to the battalion S2/S3 element
using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

d.
Maintains sector sketch in the CP using digital device and/or
analog displays.

e.
Directs establishment of centrally located ammunition
resupply and casualty collection point in the unit area.

f.
Enforces safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications.

g.
Enforces environmental stewardship protection program
procedures.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
3 4 5 M TOTAL
ITERATION 1 2
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS
Task Number Task Title References
052-191-1501 Perform Individual Camouflage STP 21 -1 -SMCT 071-312-3007 Prepare a Range Card for an M60 Machine STP 21-1-SMCT
Gun 071-326-0513 Select Temporary Fighting Positions STP 21-1-SMCT 071-326-5703 Construct Individual Fighting Positions STP 21 -1 -SMCT
ARTEP 55-718-30-MTP
Task Number Task Title References
071-326-5704 Supervise Construction of a Fighting STP 21-24-SMCT
Position
071-326-5705 Establish an Observation Post STP 21-24-SMCT
071-326-5770 Prepare a Platoon Sector Sketch STP 21-24-SMCT
071-331-0852 Clear a Field of Fire STP 21-1-SMCT
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE

5-175
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters 3 Truck Platoon Headquarters 6 Truck Squads Maintenance Section 2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters 4 Light Truck Squads Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters Light Truck Squad Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Prepare Unit For Nuclear, Biological, and Chemical Conditions (63-2-4013) (FM 3-4, AR 350-41, FM 3-100.4, FM 3-3, STP 21-1-SMCT, STP 21-24-SMCT)
.
ITERATION 1.2.3.4.5.M.(circle)
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT .T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: An NBC threat exists. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD, unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. The CP, bivouac and operational areas, and perimeter defenses are set up. Unit and individual NBC defense equipment are available. The unit commander has provided his guidance. Threat has the capability to deliver chemical/biological agents and nuclear weapons. NBC vulnerability analysis is performed by the higher HQ NBC officer/NCO and distributed to the unit. This task is performed day or night under all environmental conditions. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: All NBC defense preparatory tasks are completed IAW the TSOP and
OPORD and within the time set forth by the higher HQ staff personnel. At MOPP4, performance
degradation factors increase time required to perform this task.
, TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Commander and leaders plan unit NBC defense preparatory
activities.

a.
Identify stated policies and procedures by reviewing the
TSOP and OPORD.

b.
Identify current NBC threat and recommended
countermeasures in coordination with the higher HQ staff element and
unit NBC specialist.

c.
Identify location(s) of natural shelters consistent with NBC
threat.

d.
Identify location(s) for construction of protective shelters, if
required or available.

GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
e.
Identify location(s) for placement of automatic alarm systems.

f.
Provide instructions on improvement of individual and crew-served weapons fighting positions.

g.
Identify the availability of personnel to perform tasks.

h.
Designate MOPP level as prescribed by the higher HQ staff element.

i.
Establish decontamination priorities for operational sites in coordination with the higher HQ staff element.

j.
List tasks to be performed and time limits for each task.

k.
Disseminate NBC defense preparation plan to all subelements using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

1. Task elements to provide NBC equipment operators.
m.
Conduct MOPP analysis.

n.
Provide guidance for the protection of food, water, and mission essential supplies.

*2. Element leaders implement NBC defense plan and preparatory tasks.
a.
Conduct inventory of all element NBC defense equipment.

b.
Request issue of shortages from the unit supply facility.

c.
Direct placement of automatic alarm system(s) located in element areas.

d.
Direct improvement of individual fighting positions with consideration for blast, thermal, and nuclear radiation, electromagnetic pulse, transient radiation effects on electronics, and blackout.

e.
Supervise construction of protective shelters in assigned area.

f.
Assign each element member to a protective shelter.

g.
Forward roster of all element NBC defense equipment operators to the CP using appropriate BFACS.

5-177
GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
h.
Provide instructions on audio and visual NBC alarms, MOPP level, and protective shelters.

i.
Inspect all NBC defense equipment for proper fit, serviceability, and accountability.

j.
Enforce field sanitation and personal hygiene measures.

k.
Inspect all element personnel for compliance with measures • prescribed by the battalion and unit TSOP, OPORD, and commander's directives.

1. Foiward element completion report to CP using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.
m.
Enforce safety procedures IAW TSOP and applicable publications.

n.
Enforces environmental protection program procedures IAW TC 5-400.

3. Unit personnel perform NBC defense preparatory tasks.
a.
Construct protective shelters at locations designated by element leaders.

b.
Improve fighting positions with consideration for blast, thermal, and radiation effects.

c.
Perform PMCS on all survey equipment, monitoring equipment, and chemical detection equipment.

d.
Zero all dosimeters using appropriate charger.

e.
Inspect protective masks and clothing for serviceability and accountability.

f.
Identify assigned protective shelters or defensive positions in case of an attack.

g.
Carry protective mask with hood, skin decontamination kit, and detector paper (as permitted by designated MOPP level).

h.
Store overgarments, overboots, and gloves within reach while at workstation (as permitted by designated MOPP level).

GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
i.
Employ field sanitation and personal hygiene measures.

j.
Employ safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications.

k.
Employ environmental stewardship protection program
procedures IAW TC 5-400.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
3 4 5 M TOTAL
ITERATION 1 2
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS
Task Number Task Title References
031-503-1004 Protect Yourself From Chemical and STP 21-1-SMCT Biological Injury/ Contamination Using Your M17-Series Protective Mask With Hood
031-503-1006 Protect Yourself From NBC STP 21-1-SMCT Injury/Contamination When Drinking From Your Canteen While Wearing Your Protective Mask
031-503-1012 Protect Yourself From Chemical and STP 21-1-SMCT Biological Injury/Contamination Using Your M24 or M25-Series Protective Mask With Hood
031-503-1015 Protect Yourself From NBC STP 21-1-SMCT Injury/Contamination With Mission-Oriented Protective Posture (MOPP) Gear
031-503-1018 React to a Nuclear Hazard STP 21-1-SMCT 031-503-1019 React to Chemical or Biological STP 21-1-SMCT Hazard/Attack 031-503-1024 Replace Canister on Your M40-Series STP 21-1-SMCT Protective Mask 031-503-1026 Maintain Your M40-Series Protective Mask STP 21-1-SMCT With Hood
5-179

DODDOA-003943
ARTEP 55-718-30-MTP
Task Number Task Title References
031-503-2013 .031-503-2020 .031-503-3006 031-503-3008 031-503-3010 031-504-3001 031-506-1052 850-001-3001 Use and Perform Operator Maintenance on the IM 174-Series Radiacmeter Series Charger Use and Perform Operator Maintenance on the 1M93 or 1M147 Dosimeter and PP1578-Supervise Radiation Monitoring Implement Mission-Oriented Protective Posture Supervise Employment of Nuclear, Biological, or Chemical Markers Supervise Positioning of the Chemical Agent Alarm Protect Yourself and Others From Chemical and Biological Injury/Contamination By Using (Entering or Exiting) a Collective Protection Shelter Control Mission Safety Hazards STP 21-24-SMCT STP 21-24-SMCT STP 21-24-SMCT STP 21-24-SMCT STP 21-24-SMCT STP 21-24-SMCT STP 21-1-SMCT STP 21-24-SMCT
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE

ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Employ Operations Security Measures (63-2-4016) (AR 530-1, AR 380-19, AR 380-19-1, AR 380-5, TRADOC PAM 525-6)
.
M.(circle)
ITERATION 1.2.3.4.5.
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT . T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: Company operations are commencing. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD with all annexes and overlays, unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. Support operations are being carried out JAW the support plan. The unit and higher HQ OPSEC plan are available. Threat forces are capable of intelligence gathering by electronic, visual, and audio means. Directed energy devices may be used in the area. This task is performed day or night in all environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and all levels of threat forces attacks. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: The unit's location is not compromised by electronic, visual, or auditory
means. The unit prevents the threat from learning its strength, disposition, and intentions. At
MOPP4, performance degradation factors increase the implementation time for OPSEC measures
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Commander and leaders supervise OPSEC activities.

a.
Inspect guard post and dismount point(s) to ensure
compliance with TSOP or other written/oral instructions.

b.
Inspect unit's camouflage to ensure compliance with TSOP
and command guidance.

c.
Monitor information security measures to ensure compliance
with TSOP and command guidance.

d.
Monitor signal security measures to ensure compliance with
TSOP and command guidance.

5-181

DODDOA-003945
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
e.
Monitor employment of counter- and counter-counter­surveillance measures to ensure procedures are taken IAW TSOP and command guidance.

f.
Monitor employment of automated systems security and defense against DE devices preventive measures to ensure compliance with TSOP and command guidance.

g.
Perform "on-the-spot correction" when OPSEC weaknesses or violations are discovered.

2. Unit personnel employ information security measures.
a. Account for all OPORDs and annexes by requiring receipt signature during distribution.
NOTE: OPORDs should be sent by secure analog and/or digital means when possible to reduce the number of written copies.
b.
Account for all SOIs/SSIs at all times.

c.
Control all operational information on a need-to-know basis.

d.
Maintain all classified information and materials in an authorized security container.

e.
Maintain emergency destruction instructions IAW applicable regulations and the TSOP.

f.
Maintain details of military activities separate from personnel activities.

3. Unit personnel employ SIGSEC measures.
a. Transmit mission essential information by secure radio or secure digital means only.
NOTE: If situation permits, information should be transmitted by secure analog and/or digital device to minimize detection and voice transmissions.
b.
Employ authentication and encryption codes specified in the SOI/SSI.

c.
Employ code names for persons, equipment, units, and locations when transmitting over nonsecure means IAW SOUS SI.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
d.
Transmit messages for no longer than 20 seconds.

e.
Report all COMSEC discrepancies/violations to higher HQ communications personnel.

NOTE: Encryption may not be necessary with SINCGARS radios and digital communication.
4. Unit personnel employ electronic protection.
a.
Tune equipment to assigned frequencies specified in current SOI/SSI.

b.
Observe, as directed, all radio silence periods.

c.
Employ correct anti-jamming procedures.

d.
Forward MIDI Feeder Voice Template Report to battalion communications personnel within 10 minutes of the incident using analog and/or digital communications.

5. Unit personnel employ counter-surveillance measures.
a Employ litter prevention measures that keep area free of trash, litter, or personal items.
b.
Employ measures that prevent creating footpaths and vehicle tracks between elements in the unit area.

c.
Set radio volumes and squelches to lowest possible setting.

6. Unit personnel employ automated systems security.
a.
Position computers within an enclosure that provides controlled access.

b.
Secure all electrical facilities that support the system.

c.
Restrict access to the computer by use of classified passwords.

d.
Control all log-ons and file access by the use of unique operator passwords.

e.
Destroy all printouts of reports and lists as new ones are printed.

5-183

DODDOA-003947
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
7. Unit personnel employ defense against DE devices.
a.
Position unit equipment and vehicles in covered or concealed
locations.

b.
Cover glass or mirrors within line-of-sight of known threat
locations.

c.
Wear laser safety goggles when laser devices are used in the • immediate area.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"
"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS
TASK: CONDUCT AERIAL RECONNAISSANCE (63-OPFOR-1007)
CONDITION: OPFOR HQ requires intelligence on the location and identification of enemy elements. Aircraft is dispatched to take photographs and conduct a visual inspection of enemy rear area.
STANDARD: 1. Photograph assigned sectors. 2. Make quick visual checks where cloud ceiling is low. 3. Locate enemy positions in the rear area, particularly support and storage bases, and C2 facilities. 4. Report PIR and other information requirements to OPFOR HQ.
TASK: GATHER INTELLIGENCE (63-0PFOR-1008)
CONDITION: Small OPFOR elements, operating in the rear area, are planning attacks on enemy bases. Information is needed to complete plans.
STANDARD: 1. Identify all PIR and other intelligence requirements. 2. Pass through any outpost, defensive wire, or warning devices undetected. 3. Move to an OP that offers cover and concealment and is close enough to gather PIR and other intelligence requirements. 4. Gather all PIR and other intelligence requirements. 5. Withdraw from area undetected. 6. Report all information to OPFOR HQ.
TASK: CONDUCT ELECTRONIC WARFARE (63-OPFOR-1012)
CONDITION: OPFOR employs a large number of radio detection finding sets, along with ground and airborne communications analysts, to monitor enemy forces for loose communications security practices.
STANDARD: 1. Locate the positions of enemy command, intelligence, and logistics radio nets. 2. Forward locations to OPFOR HQ. 3. Use jamming signals against enemy radio receivers. 4. Monitor enemy radio nets for intelligence information.
5-185
DODDOA-003949
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters 3 Truck Platoon Headquarters 6 Truck Squads Maintenance Section 2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters 4 Light Truck Squads Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters Light Truck Squad Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Perform Operational Decontamination (63-2-4018) (FM 3-5, FM 3-100, FM 3-100.4, FM 3-3, FM 3-4, STP 21-1-SMCT, STP 21-24-SMCT)
.
1.2.3.4.5.M.(circle)
ITERATION
.

COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit has recently been attacked with a persistent chemical agent(s). Personnel are currently in MOPP4. Unit personnel and equipment have been contaminated. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD with all annexes and overlays, unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. Replacement overgarments, M291 (skin) and M295 (individual equipment) decontamination kits, super tropical bleach, brooms, mops, and/or other expedient chemical defense items are on hand. This task is performed day or night under all environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and ground Level I threat forces attack. This task is always performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Unit personnel perform operational decontamination within 15 minutes
after attack. At MOPP4, performance degradation factors increase decontamination times.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
1. Unit personnel perform essential decontamination.
a.
Complete skin decontamination within one minute of attack
or contamination.

b.
Conduct personal equipment wipe down with super tropical
bleach.

c.
Employ safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications.

d.
Employ environmental stewardship protection program
procedures.

GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
2. Unit personnel exchange MOPP gear.
a.
Perform individual decontamination of load-bearing
equipment.

b.
Remove contaminated hoods and outer garment using the
buddy system.

c.
Don fresh overgarments, overshoes, and gloves by using the
buddy system.

d.
Secure hood using the buddy system.

e.
Secure individual load-bearing equipment.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
ITERATION •
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS
Task Number Task Title References
031-503-1007 Decontaminate Your Skin and Personal STP 21-1-SMCT Equipment Using an M258A1 Decontamination Kit
031-503-1023 Protect Yourself From NBC STP 21-1-SMCT Injury/Contamination When Changing Mission-Oriented Protective Posture (MOPP) Gear
031-503-1024 Replace Canister on Your M40-Series STP 21-1-SMCT Protective Mask
031-503-1025 Protect Yourself From Chemical and STP 21-1-SMCT Biological Injury/ Contamination Using Your M40-Series Protective Mask With Hood
5-187

DODDOA-003951
ARTEP 55-718-30-MTP
Task Number Task Title References
031-503-1033 031-503-1034 031-503-2012 031-503-3009 031-507-3003 Decontaminate Your Skin Using the M291 Skin Decontaminating Kit (SDK) Decontaminate Your Individual Equipment Using the M295 Individual Equipment Decontamination Kit (IEDK) Supervise the Fitting of Protective Masks Lead MOPP Gear Exchange Supervise Hasty Decontamination STP 21-1-SMCT STP 21-1-SMCT STP 21-24-SMCT STP 21-24-SMCT STP 21-24-SMCT
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE

ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Perform Thorough Decontamination (63-2-4019) (FM 3-5, FM 3-100, FM 3-100.4, FM 3-3, FM 3-4, STP 21-1-SMCT, STP 21-24-SMCT)
.
1.2.3.4.5.M.(circle)
ITERATION
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT . T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit has completed operations in a contaminated area. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD with all annexes and overlays, unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. The tactical situation allows the unit time to conduct a thorough equipment decontamination. The higher HQ power-driven decontamination equipment and crew are available. Only those personnel directly involved in decontamination are in MOPP4. This task is performed day or night under all environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and ground Level I threat forces attack. This task is always performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Contamination removal allows personnel to operate equipment safely for
extended periods at reduced MOPP levels.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
1. Unit HQ coordinates for detailed equipment decontamination.
a. Coordinates Call For Support for additional decontamination
support requirements with higher HQ staff element using analog or
digital communications or messenger.

. b. Coordinates time and location with higher HQ staff element
or supporting decontamination element using analog or digital
communications or messenger...

c.
Dispatches an advance party to rendezvous with
decontamination elements at the decontamination site.

d.
Provides security and traffic control at the decontamination
site.

5-189

DODDOA-003953
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
2. Unit prepares for decontamination.
a.
Completes basic soldier skill decontamination prior to leaving old AO.

b.
Prioritizes vehicles based on commander's guidance.

c.
Closes all windows and flaps on vehicles.

d.
Removes all items from inside vehicle that cannot be decontaminated by using DS2.

e.
Moves vehicles and equipment to the decontamination site.

3. Unit processes vehicles and equipment through the decontamination site.
a.
Processes vehicles and equipment JAW directions of the decontamination element during decontamination operations.

b.
Moves vehicles to unit motor pool area after decontamination is completed.

c Employs safety procedures JAW TSOP and publications.
d. Employs environmental stewardship protection program procedures.
4. Unit clears the decontamination site.
a.
Provides assistance to decontamination element, as required.

b.
Employs safety procedures JAW TSOP and publications.

c.
Employs environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

d.
Forwards completion report to higher HQ staff element using analog or digital communications.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
ITERATION
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS
References
Task Number Task Title
031-503-1007 Decontaminate Your Skin and Personal STP 21-1-SMCT
Equipment Using an M258A1

. Decontamination Kit
031-503-1034 Decontaminate Your Individual Equipment STP 21-1-SMCT
Using the M295 Individual Equipment
Decontamination Kit (IEDK)

031-503-3009 Lead MOPP Gear Exchange STP 21-24-SMCT
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
5-191
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
• Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Respond to the Initial Effects of a Nuclear Attack (63-2-4020) (FM 3-5 FM 3-4, STP 21-1-SMCT, STP 21-24-SMCT)
.
M.(circle)
ITERATION 1.2.3.4.5..
(circle)
COMMANDERJLEADER ASSESSMENT T.P.U.
CONDITIONS: A brilliant light flashes across the horizon. Intelligence reports from higher HQ indicate the possible use of tactical nuclear weapons by threat forces. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD with all annexes and overlays, unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. The unit is supporting operations. All nonessential equipment is stowed for protection. Positions and equipment are hardened. MOPP level 2 is designated. The unit has all authorized NBC defense equipment on hand. This task is performed day or night under all environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and ground Level I threat forces attack. This task is always performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Unit personnel take immediate protective actions and reorganize the area
as prescribed by the OPORD and TSOP. At MOPP4, performance degradation factors increase
protective action implementation times.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
1. Unit personnel employ immediate protective actions.
a.
Seek cover after dismounting wheeled vehicle.

b.
Lie face down on ground with head toward blast.

c.
Drop to the floor or under a desk or table, if in a shelter or
building.

d.
Cover eyes and exposed skin.

e.
Place hands or fingers over ears.

f.
Stay concealed and covered until blast wave passes and
debris stops falling.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
g.
Don protective mask with hood within 15 seconds after flash and blast have passed.

h.
Commence continuous monitoring.

i.
Protect all food, water, and mission essential supplies from contamination.

j.
Continue to improve positions prior to the arrival of fallout.

k.
Request permission to move out of the expected hazard area, if mission permits, using analog and digital communications.

1.
Report radiation exposure status to S2/S3 using analog and/or digital communications.

2.
Unit personnel reorganizes unit area.

a.
Inspects immediate area for casualties and damaged equipment.

b.
Forwards NBC 4 nuclear report to higher HQ using analog and/or digital communications.

c.
Performs ADC operations.

d.
Treats casualties. NOTE: See Task 08-2-0003.63-0001 for detailed treatment procedures.

e.
Transports casualties.

NOTE: See Task 63-2-4316 for detailed casualty transportation procedures.
f.
Reestablishes chain of command.

g.
Resumes operational mission within time established by the higher HQ.

h.
Forwards casualty reports to higher HQ using analog and/or digital communications.

5-193

DODDOA-003957
TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
ITERATION
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"
"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS
ReferencesTask Number Task Title
031-503-1018 React to a Nuclear Hazard STP 21-1-SMCT 031-503-2004 Pr- •are and Submit NBC 4 R- sorts STP 21-24-SMCT 031-503-3005 Pr- •are and Submit NBC 1 R- sorts STP 21-24-SMCT 031-503-3006 Su . ervise Radiation Monitorint STP 21-24-SMCT 031-503-3008 Implement Mission-Oriented Protective STP 21-24-SMCT
Posture
850-001-3001 Control Mission Safety Hazards STP 21-24-SMCT
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS
TASK: DISRUPT ENEMY MOVEMENT AND OPERATIONS USING TACTICAL NUCLEAR WEAPONS (63-OPFOR-1002)
CONDITION: Tactical nuclear weapons are employed against key locations in the rear area.
STANDARD: 1. Disrupt or delay movement of equipment and supplies to forward areas. 2. Destroy enemy equipment and supplies. 3. Inflict nuclear casualties among enemy troops. 4. Deny enemy use of specified areas. 5. Contaminate enemy equipment and supplies.
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Defend Against a Level I Attack (63-2-4021) (FM 21-75, FM 3-3, FM 3-4, FM 7-10, STP 21-24-SMCT)
.
5.M.(circle)
ITERATION 1.2.3.4.
.

T.P.U.(circle)
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT
CONDITIONS: Automatic weapons fire is heard in the area. The unit is currently conducting its assigned mission. Intelligence reports from higher HQ indicate small threat elements are operating in the general area. Unit perimeter guards report that three to five individuals with automatic weapons and satchels are attempting to infiltrate unit defensive positions. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD with annexes and overlays, unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. The unit is at a moderate perimeter manning level. S2 has designated the threat at Level I. Enemy attack causes casualties and damage to unit facilities. This task is performed day or night under all environment conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and ground Level I threat forces attack. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: The unit defeats Level I threat actions using techniques outlined in the unit TSOP.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Commander and leaders direct response against a Level I attack.

a.
Forward incident report to the S2/S3 using analog and/or
digital communications.

b.
Notify all sub-elements of threat presence using analog
and/or digital communications or messenger.

c.
Increase perimeter manning to appropriate levels.

d.
Direct unit fire and maneuver to defeat and drive intruders
from the unit area.

e.
Direct internal reaction forces to critical command and
control areas.

5-195

GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
f.
Report current situation to S2/S3 as changes occur using analog and/or digital communications.

g.
Provide "All Clear" signal as soon as attack is over.

h.
Decrease perimeter manning level as tactical situation permits.

i.
Direct reorganization until unit returns to normal operational level.

j.
Forward casualty and battle damage reports to appropriate staff elements using analog and/or digital communications.

2. Unit responds to a Level I attack.
a.
Sounds prescribed attack alarm.

b.
Occupies fighting positions, as directed.

c.
Continues normal operational mission with weapons and protective mask within reach, as directed.

d.
Assembles at predesignated rally point (internal reaction force).

e.
Employs challenge and password to all personnel on CP defensive lines during night operations.

f.
Engages Level I threat with all available fire until threat is
defeated and driven from the CP area.

g.
Identifies casualties and weapon systems/equipment damages.

h.
Forwards SITREP to unit CP using analog and/or digital
communications or messenger.

3. Unit responds to the effects of a Level I attack.
a.
Replaces key injured personnel.

b.
Replaces weapon systems that are destroyed during
engagement.

GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
c.
Relocates compromised fighting positions.

d.
Camouflages positions.

e.
Treats casualties.
NOTE: See Task 08-2-0003.63-0001 for detailed treatment procedures.

f.
Transports casualties.

NOTE: See Task 63-2-4316 for detailed casualty transportation
procedures.

g.
Performs ADC operations.
NOTE: See Task 63-2-4028 for detailed ADC procedures.

h.
Inspects communication lines for breaks or tampering.

i.
Forwards personnel and equipment status report to unit CP
using analog and digital communications or messenger.

j.
Assembles KIAs and personal effects at designated location.
NOTE: See Task 10-2-4513 for detailed MA procedures.

k.
Moves all EPW to a designated collection area.
NOTE: See Task 63-2-4304 for details on EPW processing.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
ITERATION
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
5-197
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS
Task Number Task Title References
071-430-0002 Conduct a Defense By a Squad STP 21-24-SMCT
071-430-0003 Consolidate a Squad Following Enemy STP 21-24-SMCT
. Contact While in the Defense
071-430-0004 Reorganize a Squad Following Enemy STP 21-24-SMCT
Contact While in the Defense
071-430-0006 Conduct a Defense By a Platoon STP 21-24-SMCT

OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS TASK: CONDUCT RAID (63-OPFOR-1009) CONDITION: OPFOR element has occupied an objective rally point and has orders to conduct a
raid on a CSS base. STANDARD: 1. Surprise enemy forces. 2. Assault enemy support base and accomplish assigned tasks. 3. Destroy specified equipment and supplies. 4. Avoid decisive engagement. 5. Withdraw all
personnel from objective area(s) within time prescribed. 6. Obtain all PIR from raid site. TASK: CONDUCT TERRORIST AND SABOTEUR ATTACKS (63-OPFOR-1013) CONDITION: OPFOR dispatches small teams into enemy rear area to disrupt CSS operations.
STANDARD: 1. Locate rear support bases and C2 facilities. 2. Delay and disrupt CSS operations through probes. 3. Infiltrate CSS bases to conduct sabotage and terrorist activities. 4. Inflict casualties. 5. Destroy supplies and equipment.
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Prepare Unit for Level IUM Threat (63-2-4022) (FM 7-10, FM 21-75, FM 3-100, FM 3-4)
3.5.(circle)
ITERATION. 2.4.M.
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT. T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit is notified of a company-sized threat unit operating in the rear area. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD, the unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. The higher HQ CP has ordered a defensive posture level increase and has moved the protective posture to MOPP2. Defense plans are prepared. Fighting positions, obstacles, and warning devices are emplaced or constructed. The unit continues to provide limited support to higher HQ tactical operations. This task is conducted day or night under all environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and all levels of threat forces attacks. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Unit is prepared to engage threat as prescribed in the TSOP and OPORD.
At MOPP4, performance degradation factors significantly increase defensive posture preparation
time.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Commander and leaders direct preparation for threat engagement.

a.
Plot threat force locations on the situation map as
SPOTREPs are received.

b.
Disseminate current tactical situation to all subordinate
elements using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

c.
Direct mustering of internal response forces at predesignated
rally point(s).

d.
Direct increase in defensive position manning levels.

e.
Shift internal defense forces to Level II perimeter positions.

5-199

DODDOA-003963
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
f. Coordinate defense preparations with adjacent units analog
and/or digital communications.
g. Direct preliminary loading of nonessential equipment and
supplies.
h. Direct positioning of vehicles for immediate exit.
2. Unit performs pre-engagement activities.
a. Occupies fighting positions (designated soldiers only).
b. Employs MOPP2, as a minimum.
c. Moves response force to predesignated positions within the
nearest cluster.
d. Moves supplies to predetermined positions within the nearest
cluster.
e. Loads all nonessential equipment and supplies.
f. Positions vehicles for rapid dispersion.
g. Maintains surveillance of assigned sector(s).
h. Maintains NBC surveillance.
i. Maintains strict light and noise discipline.
TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"
"*" indicates a leader task step.

SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS
Task Number Task Title References
031-503-1015 Protect Yourself From NBC STP 21-1-SMCT
Injury/Contamination With Mission-
Oriented Protective Posture (MOPP) Gear
031-503-2012 Supervise the Fitting of Protective Masks STP 21-24-SMCT
031-503-3008 Implement Mission-Oriented Protective STP 21-24-SMCT
Posture
071-326-0513 Select Temporary Fighting Positions STP 21-1-SMCT
071-326-5704 Supervise Construction of a Fighting STP 21-24-SMCT
Position
071-328-5301 Inspect Personnel/Equipment STP 21-24-SMCT
071-331-0815 Practice Noise, Light, and Litter Discipline STP 21-1-SMCT

OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE

5-201
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
Conduct Hasty Displacement (63-2-4023) (FM 7-10, FM 21-75, FM 3-3, FM 3-4,
TASK:.STP 21-1-SMCT, STP 21-24-SMCT)
.
4.5.M.(circle)ITERATION 1.2.3.
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT . T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The BCOC has directed the unit to displace its CP to a new location. The unit
has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD, the unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. Threat force contact is expected to occur within a specified period of time. Pre-engagement activities have been completed. Threat force may arrive before displacement is completed. Indirect fire and smoke support , if required, has been
coordinated to cover displacement. The commander has designated a small rear security party and
vehicles necessary for their transportation. Initial displacement preparations were made during
defense buildup. Destruction of supplies, documents, and equipment has been coordinated with the
BCOC. This task is performed under all day and night environmental conditions. The unit is
subject to air, NBC, and all levels of threat forces attacks. Some iterations of this task should be
performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Unit relocates within time specified in the order. Under MOPP4,
displacement times are increased threefold.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO *1. Commander and leaders organize unit for hasty displacement.
a.
Assemble soldiers at designated area.

b.
Brief hasty displacement procedures to soldiers.

c.
Assign elements tasks and responsibilities.

d.
Designate vehicles to transport casualties.

e.
Coordinate Call For Support with S2/S3 for possible aero-
medical evacuation using analog and/or digital communications.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
f.
Coordinate for indirect fire and smoke support with S2/S3 using analog and/or digital communications.

g.
Brief rear security party.

h.
Brief location of new assembly area and designated route.

2. Unit prepares for hasty displacement.
a. Dismantles tentage, antennas, and other equipment as directed by the chain of command.
NOTE: This performance measure is executed emphasizing speed rather than standard procedures.
b.
Loads equipment lAW commander's guidance.

c.
Positions vehicles for departure on notice.

d.
Maintains local security while awaiting orders to move.

3. Unit destroys non-medical supplies, equipment, and documents that have been designated for abandonment.
a.
Destroys documents lAW TSOP.

b.
Destroys supplies IAW appropriate TM and TSOP.

c.
Renders equipment inoperative IAW appropriate TM.

4. Unit departs area.
a.
Conducts orderly departure from area without excessive noises.

b.
Moves elements to new assembly area via prescribed route.

5. Rear security party provides security for unit displacement.
a.
Occupies fighting positions.

b.
Exits area as soon as last element has departed.

NOTE: If threat elements are in the area and must be engaged, delete existing subparagraph "b" above and insert the following performance measures. b. Engages threat, when sighted, with all available weapons.
c. Performs disengagement under fire to supplementary positions. d. Exits area by available means.
TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS
Task Number Task Title References
061-283-6003 Adjust Indirect Fire STP 21-24-SMCT 071-325-4407 Employ Hand Grenades STP 21-1-SMCT 071-326-0503 Move Over, Through, or Around Obstacles STP 21-1-SMCT
(Except Minefields) 071-326-0510 React to Indirect Fire While Dismounted STP 21-1-SMCT
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS
TASK: MAINTAIN CONTACT (63-0PFOR-1011)
CONDITION: OPFOR element is tactically engaged with enemy base defense forces. Enemy forces are withdrawing under pressure.
STANDARD: 1. Engage enemy forces decisively. 2. Advance own unit or forces as enemy withdraws. 3. Inflict casualties.
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
Defend Unit Area (63-2-4024) (FM 7-10, FM 21-75, FM 3-3, FM 3-4, FM 3-5,
TASK:.STP 21-1-SMCT, STP 21-24-SMCT)
.
ITERATION 1.2.3.4.5.M.(circle) .
U.(circle)
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT T.P.
CONDITIONS: OP reports a threat element is approaching the unit's defensive sector. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD, the unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. The unit has completed defensive preparations, including preplanned fire support coordination. Enemy attacking elements can be engaged with indirect fire before they reach the unit's defensive perimeter. The BCOC has tasked the unit to assist in directing artillery fire and CAS in its assigned area of defense. Higher HQ staff element has directed all but "priority" CSS to be discontinued and all available personnel be assigned to defensive perimeter duties. This task is performed under all day and night environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and all levels of threat forces attacks. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Threat force is repelled or delayed until the unit is relieved by MP or TCF. At MOPP4 performance degradation factors increase reaction times.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
1. Commander and leaders direct reaction to threat elements.
a.
Direct suspension of support activities.

b.
Direct employment of maximum defensive level.

c.
Recall all OP personnel, if not detected by threat forces.

d.
Maintain map surveillance of all threat activity in the unit's
sector.

e.
Forward SPOTREPs to S2/S3 using analog and/or digital
communications.

5-205

DODDOA-003969
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
f.
Forward SHELLREPs to S2/S3 using analog and/or digital communications.

g.
Maintain communications with the S2/S3 using analog and/or digital communications.

h.
Direct unit by fire and maneuver to repel and/or delay penetration of threat forces into the CP area.

i.
Maintain current situation map with all known friendly and threat locations using analog and/or digital communications.

2. Unit personnel react to threat.
a.
Sound attack alarm.

b.
Occupy defensive positions.

c.
Forward SALUTE report to CP using analog and/or digital communications.

d.
Engage threat with organic weapons without compromising positions.

e.
Conduct tactical fire and maneuver to repel and/or delay penetration into CP defense.

f.
Forward SITREP to CP using analog and/or digital communications.

g.
Treat casualties with life-threatening wounds or injuries first.

h.
Replace injured key personnel.

i.
Replace weapons systems that are destroyed during the engagement.

3. Unit personnel react to indirect fire.
a.
Sound alarm by shouting "incoming" and following TSOP and/or leader's commands.

b.
Seek overhead cover protection of fighting position.

c.
Don protective masks within 9 seconds (with hood, within 15
seconds).

GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
d.
Forward SHELLREP to unit CP using analog and/or digital communications.

e.
Conduct standard unmasking procedures, if chemical detector kit or detector paper is not available.

*4. Commander and leaders coordinate indirect fire support.
a.
Coordinate preplanned fires with the S2/S3 fire support element using analog and/or digital communications.

b.
Establish communications with fire support operations center using analog and/or digital communications.

c.
Request fire support using proper procedures and terminology using analog and/or digital communications as time permits.

d.
Adjust fires on target, as necessary.

e.
Terminate fire mission using analog and/or digital • communications as time permits.

f.
Report effects of fires to S2/S3 using analog and/or digital communications.

*5. Commander and leaders direct CAS.
a.
Coordinate CAS mission through the S2/S3 using analog and/or digital communications.

b.
Coordinate communications with CAS strike leader through the S2/S3 using analog and/or digital communications.

c.
Prepare unit area for CAS strikes.

d.
Identify friendly positions by use of colored smoke.

e.
Identify targets to strike leader.

f.
Adjust air strikes on target(s).

g.
Terminate CAS mission.

5-207
DODDOA-003971
GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
h.
Report strike effects to S2/S3 using analog and/or digital
communications.

i.
Forward SITREP to S2/S3 using analog and/or digital
communications.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
M TOTAL
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO" I

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS
ReferencesTask Number Task Title
031-503-3008 Implement Mission-Oriented Protective STP 21-24-SMCT
Posture 061-283-6003 Adjust Indirect Fire STP 21-24-SMCT 071-311-2007 Engage Targets With an M16A1 or M16A2 STP 21-1-SMCT
Rifle 071-312-3031 Engage Targets With an M60 Machine Gun STP 21-1-SMCT 071-325-4407 Employ Hand Grenades STP 21-1-SMCT 071-326-0510 React to Indirect Fire While Dismounted STP 21-1-SMCT 071-430-0002 Conduct a Defense By a Squad STP 21-24-SMCT
DODDOA-003972
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS
TASK: CONDUCT AIR ATTACKS (63-OPFOR-1006)
CONDITION: OPFOR elements in the rear area have forwarded the positions of enemy support sites and/or the locations of road march elements to OPFOR HQ. OPFOR aircraft have been dispatched to attack enemy installations or convoys.
STANDARD: 1. Locate command and control site(s) or convoys. 2. Conduct attack runs on designated target(s). 3. Destroy enemy equipment, supplies, vehicles, and personnel.
TASK: ATTACK (63-0PFOR-1010)
CONDITION: Enemy rear area CSS base has been located by OPFOR element. PIR and other intelligence requirements have been obtained by OPFOR patrols. OPFOR element has automatic and anti-armor weapons, and light mortars. OPFOR element is the size of approximately two
platoons.
STANDARD: 1. Develop an attack plan. 2. Initiate attack using a scheme of maneuver that exploits enemy flanks, gaps, and identified weaknesses. 3. Use covered and concealed routes to approach enemy forces flanks, gaps, or weakly held areas. 4. Employ indirect fire to support attack.
5. Penetrate enemy defenses. 6. Destroy all equipment and supplies. 7. Inflict heavy casualties. 8. Isolate the CSS base by blocking reinforcements. 9. Force enemy units to displace. 10. Withdraw before CSS base is reinforced with tactical combat forces.
TASK: MAINTAIN CONTACT (63-0PFOR-1011)
CONDITION: OPFOR element is tactically engaged with enemy base defense forces. Enemy
forces are withdrawing under pressure.
STANDARD: 1. Engage enemy forces decisively. 2. Advance own unit or forces as enemy withdraws. 3. Inflict casualties.
5-209
DODDOA-003973
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters 3 Truck Platoon Headquarters 6 Truck Squads Maintenance Section 2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters 4 Light Truck Squads Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters Light Truck Squad Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Perform Withdrawal Under Fire (63-2-4025) (FM 7-10, FM 21-75, FM 3-4, FM 3-5)
.
4.5.M.(circle)ITERATION 1.2.3.
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT . T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit is currently engaging threat elements along its defensive sector. The S2/S3 has directed withdrawal to supplementary fighting positions. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD, the unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. Execution times have been established for relocation activities, including indirect fires to cover withdrawal operations. The unit is required to furnish internal smoke screening in addition to pre-planned smoke-screen fires from support artillery. This task is performed under all day and night environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and all levels of threat forces attacks. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Supplementary positions are occupied and unit is prepared to engage threat. Withdrawal actions are performed using techniques outlined in the unit TSOP and OPORD. At MOPP4 performance degradation factors increase time required for withdrawal under fire.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Commander and leaders supervise disengagement under fire.

a.
Maintain situational awareness using analog and/or digital
communications or messenger.

b.
Identify disengagement method to be used.

c.
Designate movement element (first element).

d.
Designate base of fire element (second element).

e.
Brief element leaders on disengagement phases and
procedures.. •

5-210
DODDOA-003974
‘,•

GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
f.
Monitor execution of disengagement for compliance with
commander's directives.

g.
Forward completion report to S2/S3 using analog and/or
digital communications or messenger.

2. Unit performs fire and movement to rear.
a. Coordinates for execution of fire and movement among
elements (all elements).

b Employs smoke grenades that provide a screen to cover
disengagement.

c.
Lays down a base of fire with all available weapons (second
element).

d.
Moves from primary to supplementary fighting positions
(first element).

e.
Lays down a base of fire with all available weapons (first
element).

f.
Moves from primary to supplementary fighting positions
(second element).

g.
Reestablishes sectors of fire within 10 minutes of move.

h.
Forwards completion report to the CP using analog and/or
digital communications or messenger.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
ITERATION
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
5-211
(
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS
TASK: MAINTAIN CONTACT (63-0PFOR-1011)
CONDITION: OPFOR element is tactically engaged with enemy base defense forces. Enemy
forces are withdrawing under pressure.
STANDARD: 1. Engage enemy forces decisively. 2. Advance own unit or forces as enemy
withdraws. 3. Inflict casualties.
DODDOA-003976
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Reorganize Unit Defense (63-2-4026) (FM 7-10, FM 20-3, FM 21-75, STP 21-1-SMCT, STP 21-24-SMCT)
.
4.5.M.(circle)
ITERATION 1.2.3.
.

T.P.U.(circle)
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT
CONDITIONS: The unit has successfully defended its area during an attack by threat elements. The attacking elements have broken contact and withdrawn from the immediate area. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD, unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. The unit maintains a high state of readiness. The unit has sustained casualties and damages to defensive positions. This task is performed under all day and night environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and all levels of threat forces attacks. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Unit defenses are reorganized within the time prescribed by the
commander. At MOPP4, performance degradation factors increase defense reorganization
completion times.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO *1. Commander and leaders supervise reorganization of unit defenses.
a.
Maintain situational awareness using analog and/or digital
communications or messenger.

b.
Identify status of personnel, weapons, and equipment.

c.
Fill key leadership positions.

d.
Reassign personnel to weapon systems most critical to unit
defense.

e.
Supervise distribution or redistribution of ammunition.

f.
Request ammunition resupply through the S4 element using
analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

5-213
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES g. Reassign fighting positions and sectors of fire. GO NO GO
h. Supervise replacement and/or reconstruction of fighting positions, camouflage, and obstacles.
i. Prepare updated unit defense sketch.
j. Forward sketch to the S2/S3 using digital/analog device or messenger. • •
k. Forward personnel, weapons, and equipment status report to the Si and S4 using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.
2. Unit performs defensive reorganization activities.
a. Mans all critical weapon systems.
b. Redistributes ammunition to all fighting positions.
c. Reports ammunition status to CP using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.
d. Occupies newly assigned fighting positions.
e. Establishes new sectors of fire.
f. Performs PMCS on assigned weapons.
g. Reconstructs fighting positions.
h. Reconstructs obstacles and warning devices.
i. Replaces damaged camouflage.
j. Reports all threat activities to CP using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.
k. Treats casualties.
NOTE: See Task 08-2-0003.63-0001 for detailed treatment procedures.

DODDOA-003978

-
GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
1. Transports casualties.
NOTE: See Task 63-2-4316 for detailed casualty transportation
procedures.

in. Reports all casualties to CP using analog and/or digital
communications or messenger.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
ITERATION
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS
ReferencesTask Number Task Title
031 5033009 Lead MOPP Gear Exchange STP 21-24-SMCT 071-430-0004 Reorganize a Squad Following Enemy STP 21-24-SMCT
Contact While in the Defense 081-831-1000 Evaluate a Casualty STP 21-1-SMCT 093-401-5000 Identify Unexploded Ordnance (UXO) STP 21-1-SMCT
Hazards 191-377-5250 Handle Enemy Personnel and Equipment STP 21-24-SMCT
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
5-215
DODDOA-003979
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters 3 Truck Platoon Headquarters 6 Truck Squads Maintenance Section 2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters 4 Light Truck Squads Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters Light Truck Squad Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Execute Battle Handover (63-2-4027) (FM 7-10, FM 21-75, FM 3-4)
.
ITERATION 1.2.3.4.5.M.(circle) .
T.P.U.(circle)COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT
CONDITIONS: The S2/S3 has issued a FRAGO directing the unit to prepare to hand the current engagement over to the TCF or MP area security elements. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD, unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. TCF or MP units are located in an assembly area awaiting deployment. Contact with the enemy has been broken. Indirect fire and smoke have been coordinated to cover disengagement and handover operations. TCF or MP elements are required to assume responsibility for defensive operations until the unit defense is released again to the commander. This task is performed under all day and night environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and all levels of threat forces attacks. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Battle handover operations are conducted IAW the TSOP and current
FRAGO and are undetected by threat. At MOPP4, battle handover operations are significantly
degraded.
_ TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES _ GO NO GO
*
1. Commander and leaders supervise battle handover assistance.

a.
Maintain situational awareness using analog and/or digital
communications.

b.
Coordinate with S2/S3 location of battle handover line and
contact points in the unit's assigned area.

c.
Coordinate with S2/S3 for information on indirect fire and
smoke support using analog and/or digital communications.

d.
Disseminate battle handover information to subordinate
elements using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
e.
Redeploy troops to assist in handover using analog and/or
digital communications or messenger.

f.
Maintain communication with TCF or MP elements using
analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

g.
Exchange tactical information with TCF or MP element
counterpart using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

h.
Forward handover completion report to S2/S3 using analog
and/or digital communications.

2. Unit provides battle handover assistance.
a.
Establishes contact points.

b.
Establishes overwatch positions.

c.
Marks TCF or MP unit routes.

d.
Guides TCF or MP units along specified routes.

e.
Provides overwatch for TCF or MP.

f.
Forwards handover completion report to CP using analog
and/or digital communications.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMAR f BLOCK
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
5-217
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS

Task Number Task Title References
071-329-1001 Identify Terrain Features on a Map STP 21-1-SMCT
071-329-1008 Measure Distance on a Map STP 21-1-SMCT

SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS
TASK: ATTACK (63-OPFOR-1010)
CONDITION: Enemy rear area CSS base has been located by OPFOR element. PIR and other intelligence requirements have been obtained by OPFOR patrols. OPFOR element has automatic and anti-armor weapons, and light mortars. OPFOR element is the size of approximately two platoons.
STANDARD: 1. Develop an attack plan. 2. Initiate attack using a scheme of maneuver that exploits enemy flanks, gaps, and identified weaknesses. 3. Use covered and concealed routes to approach enemy forces flanks, gaps, or weakly held areas. 4. Employ indirect fire to support attack.
5. Penetrate enemy defenses. 6. Destroy all equipment and supplies. 7. Inflict heavy casualties. 8. Isolate the CSS base by blocking reinforcements. 9. Force enemy units to displace. 10. Withdraw before CSS base is reinforced with tactical combat forces.
TASK: MAINTAIN CONTACT (63-0PFOR-1011)
CONDITION: OPFOR element is tactically engaged with enemy base defense forces. Enemy forces are withdrawing under pressure.
STANDARD: 1. Engage enemy forces decisively. 2. Advance own unit or forces as enemy withdraws. 3. Inflict casualties.
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Perform Area Damage Control Functions (63-2-4028) (FM 100-14, FM 21-16, FM 3-100.4, FM 3-3, FM 3-4, STP 21-1-SMCT, STP 21-24-SMCT)
1.2.3.4.5.M.(circle)
ITERATION.
.

(circle)
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT
CONDITIONS: The unit is relieved of a threat encounter or threat forces have completely withdrawn from the area. The attack has caused heavy damage to the unit area. The commander and/or higher HQ has required a damage assessment be performed. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD, the unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. Higher level HQ Control and Assessment CP has been established and is manned by control and assessment team personnel. ADC resources are not expended to remove or repair materials or structures that have no impact on mission accomplishment. Assistance is provided to supported elements, as required. This task is performed under all day and night environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and all levels of threat forces attacks. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: All mission-hindering debris and safety hazards are cleared and marked. ADC is conducted IAW the higher HQ TSOP and OPORD. At MOPP4, performance degradation factors minimally increase ADC activities completion times.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO *1. Commander and leaders supervise unit ADC activities.
a.
Identify damage to CP area.

b.
Forward ADC SITREP to Control and Assessment CP using
analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

c.
Identify ADC policies and procedures by reviewing
appropriate annex of the TSOP and higher HQ rear operations annex.

d.
Identify danger areas and inform subordinate elements.

5-219
DODDOA-003983
GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
e.
Supervise unit restoration activities.

f.
Coordinate additional support requirements with Control and Assessment CP using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

g.
Coordinate dispatch of ADC teams with Control and Assessment CP using analog and/or digital communications.

*2. Commander and leaders organize unit ADC teams.
a.
Assemble required team members and equipment IAW the higher HQ OPORD and TSOP.

b.
Dispatch control and assessment team personnel and equipment to Control and Assessment CP.

c.
Organize decontamination squad(s) and light rescue squad(s) as prescribed by TSOP and higher HQ S4 guidance.

d.
Brief decontamination and rescue squads.

e.
Dispatch decontamination and rescue squads as directed by Control and Assessment CP.

3. Unit performs restoration activities.
a.
Establishes barrier and/or checkpoints that deny access to danger areas such as those containing unexploded ordnance, POL fires, and damaged structures.

b.
Treats casualties. NOTE: See Task 08-2-0003.63-0001 for detailed treatment procedures. .c. Transports casualties.

NOTE: See Task 63-2-4316 for detailed casualty transportation procedures.
d.
Relocates major items of equipment and supplies to safe areas.

e.
Conducts fire fighting operations until all threatening fires are extinguished.

GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
f.
Employs NBC defense measures.

g.
Removes rubble, debris, and inoperative vehicles and
equipment (mission essential only).

h.
Reports locations of fires and unexploded ordnance to
control and assessment team using analog and/or digital
communications.

i.
Employs safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications.

j.
Employs environmental stewardship protection program
procedures.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
4 5 M TOTAL
ITERATION 1 2 3
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"s" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS
Task Number Task Title References
031-503-3010 Supervise Employment of Nuclear, STP 21-24-SMCT Biological, or Chemical Markers 071-430-0007 Consolidate a Platoon Following Enemy STP 21-24-SMCT Contact While in the Defense 071-430-0008 Reorganize a Platoon Following Enemy STP 21-24-SMCT
Contact While in the Defense 081-831-0101 Request Medical Evacuation STP 21-24-SMCT 081-831-1000 Evaluate a Casualty STP 21 -1-SMCT 081-831-1005 Prevent Shock STP 21-1-SMCT 081-831-1007 Give First Aid for Burns STP 21-1 -SMCT 081-831-1016 Put on a Field Or Pressure Dressing STP 21-1-SMCT 081-831-1017 Put on a Tourniquet STP 21 -1-SMCT 081-831-1025 Apply a Dressing to an Open Abdominal STP 21-1-SMCT
Wound 081-831-1026 Apply a Dressing to an Open Chest Wound STP 21-1-SMCT 081-831-1033 Apply a Dressing to an Open Head Wound STP 21-1-SMCT 081-831-1034 Splint a Suspected Fracture STP 21-1-SMCT
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
5-221
DODDOA-003985
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Cross a Chemically Contaminated Area (63-2-4226) (FM 3-3, FM 3-100, FM 3-4, FM 3-5, STP 21-1-SMCT, STP 21-24-SMCT)
.
5.M.(circle)
ITERATION 1.2.3.4.
.

T.P.U.(circle)
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT
CONDITIONS: Orders have been received from the higher HQ staff element to cross a chemically contaminated area. The area cannot be bypassed without unacceptable delay to the move. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD, unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. The unit is currently located in an assembly area that provides concealment. MOPP level 2 has been designated and NBC reconnaissance, survey, and control teams are prepared for their respective missions. The location of the contaminated area and the type of contamination will be confirmed by the unit's NBC teams during reconnaissance. The higher HQ staff element has coordinated for additional chemical decontamination support. Assembly areas will be designated in concealed areas or road networks, as the tactical situation dictates. This task is performed in all day and night environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and ground Level I threat forces attack. This task is always performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Unit crosses contaminated area by quickest route possible. At MOPP4,
performance degradation factors increase task performance times.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
1. Leading convoy element employs immediate protective measures.
a.
Assumes MOPP level 4.

b.
Conducts individual basic soldier skill decontamination, as
necessary.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*2. Convoy commander relays NBC information to march element(s).
a.
Notifies convoy element(s) of exact location and type of chemical contamination using analog and/or digital communications.

b.
Plots contaminated area on map overlays and in digital device.

c.
Provides required protective measures and MOPP level designation to march element(s).

d.
Designates assembly area for each element for preparation of crossing the contaminated area.

e.
Directs required protective measures and MOPP level for assembly areas.

f.
Reports locations of assembly areas, halt time, and tentative resumption time to the higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications.

g.
Forwards NBC 1 chemical report to higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications.

3. Convoy elements occupy assembly area(s).
a.
Move into assembly area without halting on the route of march.

b.
Establish perimeter security with 360-degree surveillance and crew-served weapons positioned along likely avenues of approach.

c.
Employ camouflage techniques, with emphasis on positioning mirrors toward the ground and parking vehicles in an area with overhead cover.

d.
Perform essential after-operation PMCS IAW applicable TM.

5-223
DODDOA-003987
GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
*4. Convoy commander selects crossing route.
a.
Identifies possible routes by conducting a map reconnaissance of contaminated area.

b.
Conducts comparative analysis of chemical data received from higher HQ staff element, terrain analysis, and time factors for a route selection.

c.
Selects route that minimizes chemical contamination.

d.
Requests approval of selected route from higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications.

*5. Convoy commander supervises crossing preparation activities.
a.
Briefs reconnaissance team on mission, communications, and actions to be performed on other side of the contaminated area.

b.
Directs reconnaissance team in the donning of full MOPP4 protective garments.

c.
Dispatches reconnaissance team to verify type of contamination and size of contaminated area.

d.
Directs precautionary measures and MOPP level required for crossing.

e.
Assigns crossing time(s) for each march element.

f.
Assigns assembly area on the other side of contaminated area for each convoy element to perform operational decontamination.

6. Chemical reconnaissance team conducts route survey.
a.
Selects distances between recon checkpoints based on tactical situation and time available.

b.
Selects recon checkpoints at locations where chemical agents are likely to collect as prescribed in FM 3-3.

c.
Detects chemical vapors by using M256 kit.

d.
Checks presence of liquids with M8/9 detector paper.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
e.
Marks route with predetermined material.

f.
Records recon information, as collected.

g.
Forwards all recon information to the convoy commander after completion of survey.

7. Unit prepares to cross contaminated area.
a.
Places all externally stored equipment inside vehicles.

b.
Covers equipment with available material.

c.
Closes all vehicle air vents and windows.

d.
Positions chemical detector paper as prescribed in FM 3-4.

e.
Dons MOPP4 protective gear.

8. Convoy elements cross contaminated area.
a.
Follow route as marked by the reconnaissance party.

b.
Avoid low ground, overhead branches, and heavy brush.

c.
Move as quickly as possible across contaminated area without unnecessary halts and delays.

d.
Verify that all vehicles have crossed the contaminated area before stopping.

e.
Forward crossing report to the higher HQ staff element when all convoy elements have crossed the contaminated area using analog and/or digital communications.

*9. Convoy commander supervises decontamination measures.
a.
Identifies level of required decontamination in coordination with higher HQ staff element.

b.
Directs implementation of basic soldier skills and/or hasty decontamination based on type of contamination, weather, and tactical situation.

5-225
DODDOA-003989
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
10. Unit performs chemical decontamination.
a.
Initiates skin decontamination techniques within one minute of exposure to liquid contamination.

b.
Completes personal wipedown within 15 minutes of exit from contaminated area.

c.
Completes operator's spraydown within 15 minutes of

.personal wipedown.
d.
Employs safety measures to ensure DS2 does not touch personal or protective clothing.

e.
Decontaminates only those areas that would cause further contamination of personnel or equipment.

f.
Conducts MOPP gear exchange, if required.

g.
Forwards decontamination status report to higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications. •

*
11. Convoy commander coordinates resumption of road march.

a.
Designates SP for all convoy elements to resume march.

b.
Reschedules check point and RP crossing times in coordination with higher HQ staff element.

c.
Provides new march instructions to all convoy elements.

d.
Directs covering and marking of contaminated runoff areas.

e.
Affixes locations of contaminated runoff areas on map overlays.

f.
Coordinates detailed decontamination with higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications, if required.

g.
Forwards road march resumption report to higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications.

ARTEP 55-718-30-MTP
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES 12. Unit performs movement march resumption activities. GO NO GO
a. Covers area(s) used for decontamination.
b. Marks contaminated runoff areas.
c. Decontaminates the decontamination personnel. d. Crosses new SP at time prescribed by the convoy commander. •

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
3 4 5 M TOTAL
ITERATION 1 2
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS
Task Number Task Title References
031-503-1007 Decontaminate Your Skin and Personal STP 21-1-SMCT Equipment Using an M258A1 Decontamination Kit
031-503-1034 Decontaminate Your Individual Equipment STP 21-1-SMCT Using the M295 Individual Equipment Decontamination Kit (IEDK)
031-503-3004 Supervise the Crossing of a Contaminated STP 21-24-SMCT
Area 031-503-3005 Prepare and Submit NBC 1 Reports .STP 21-24-SMCT 031-503-3008 Implement Mission-Oriented Protective STP 21-24-SMCT
Posture 031-503-3009 Lead MOPP Gear Exchange STP 21-24-S MCT
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
5-227
DODDOA-003991
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS
TASK: DISRUPT ENEMY MOVEMENT AND OPERATIONS USING PERSISTENT AND NON-PERSISTENT CHEMICAL WEAPONS (63-0PFOR-1001)
CONDITION: OPFOR units deliver chemical agents by means of conventional artillery weapons or aircraft along selected routes and key bases in the rear area.
STANDARD: 1. Deliver chemical agents in low lying and/or densely wooded areas. 2. Delay movement of enemy supplies and equipment to forward areas by disrupting C2 system. 3. Restrict enemy units movement in rear area. 4. Channel movement into predesignated ambush areas. 5. Contaminate enemy supplies and equipment. 6. Inflict casualties on enemy forces.
DODDOA-003992
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Employ Physical Security Measures (63-2-4306) (FM 3-19.30, AR 190-13, FM 3-100.4, FM 3-4, STP 21-1 -SMCT)
.
ITERATION 1.2.3.4.5.M.(circle)
.
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: Guard posts are established at strategic locations in the unit's area. Guards report that one to three unidentified individuals have been sighted attempting to infiltrate the area. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD, unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. Higher HQ support operations have commenced. The intrusion may cause personnel casualties and damage to unit equipment. This task is performed in all day and night environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and ground Level I threat forces attack. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Unit elements are not surprised by threat intrusion and the attack is repelled using techniques and procedures outlined in higher HQ TSOP and OPORD. At MOPP4, performance degradation factors may increase reaction times.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Commander and leaders prepare physical security plan.

a.
Develop procedures for dismount point to control entry of
vehicles into the unit area.

b.
Develop procedures for selecting and manning defensive
positions.

c.
Develop procedures for reporting threat intrusions or
sightings.

d.
Integrate adjacent unit plans into the physical security plan.

e.
Forward physical security plan to the higher HQ staff
element for approval using analog and/or digital communications or
messenger.

5-229
DODDOA-003993
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
2. Unit HQ supervises guard force.
a.
Tasks unit elements to man guard posts in the unit area.

b.
Establishes communication network that permits access to all guard posts.

3. Unit performs guard duty functions.
a.
Mans positions or guard posts as designated by leader or special orders.

b.
Observes assigned sector.

c.
Employs challenge and password procedures as prescribed in the TSOP and SOI/SSI.

d.
Reports all suspicious activities to the guard commander or as prescribed in special orders.

*4. Commander and leaders direct response(s) against saboteurs or terrorists.
a.
Forward incident report to the higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

b.
Direct perimeter manning level increases as prescribed by the TSOP.

c.
Maintain a current operations status of the situation.

d.
Provide continuous situation updates to the higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

e.
Direct shifting of response force from assembly areas to threat contact area(s).

f.
Sound "All Clear" signal as soon as attack is over and intruders have been eliminated.

g.
Direct decrease in manning levels consistent with the tactical situation.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
5. Unit responds to saboteur or terrorist intrusions.
a.
Occupies predesignated fighting positions (designated personnel only).

b.
Reports to unit CP (personnel selected for response force).

c.
Recons assigned sector for threat activities.

d.
Fires at any target in area as prescribed by rules of engagement.

e.
Treats casualties. NOTE: See Task 08-2-0003.63-0001 for detailed treatment procedures.

f.
Transports casualties.. •

NOTE: See Task 63-2-4316 for detailed casualty transportation procedures.
g.
Performs mortuary affairs operations. NOTE: See Task 10-2-4513 for detailed mortuary affairs procedures. *6. Commander supervises post-attack activities.

a.
Forwards casualty and damage report(s) submitted by subelements to the higher HQ Si, S2/S3, and S4 using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

b.
Coordinates life support requirements caused by destruction of supplies, equipment, or personnel with the higher HQ staff Si and S4 using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

c.
Coordinates replenishment of destroyed equipment and supplies with the higher HQ S4 using analog and/or digital communications.

NOTE: The unit requisitions equipment and supplies using ULLS-S4.
d. Directs unit elements to continue their assigned missions.
5-231
DODDOA-003995
TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"s" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS Task Number Task Title References
071-331-0801 Challenge Persons Entering Your Area STP 21-1-SMCT
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS
TASK: CONDUCT TERRORIST AND SABOTEUR ATTACKS (63-OPFOR-1013)
CONDITION: OPFOR dispatches small teams into enemy rear area to disrupt CSS operations.
STANDARD: 1. Locate rear support bases and C2 facilities. 2. Delay and disrupt CSS operations

through probes. 3. Infiltrate CSS bases to conduct sabotage and terrorist activities. 4. Inflict casualties. 5. Destroy supplies and equipment.
-
-
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Respond to a Chemical Attack (63-2-4334) (FM 3-3, FM 3-100, FM 3-4, STP 21-1-SMCT, STP 21-24-SMCT)
.
1.2.3.4.5.M.(circle)
ITERATION
.

T.P.U.(circle)
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT
CONDITIONS: The sound of automatic alarms or color changes in chemical detector paper indicates the presence of contaminants. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD, the unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. The unit is tactically deployed at MOPP2. Intelligence reports from the higher HQ staff element indicate that the threat is capable of attacking with chemical weapons. This task is performed under all day and night environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and ground Level I threat
forces attack. This task is always performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Unit personnel react to the chemical alarm within 15 seconds, assume
MOPP4 within 2 to 4 minutes, and perform testing and unmasking procedures until unit is
reorganized and reduced MOPP level functions are reinstated.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
1. Unit personnel employ protective measures.
a.
Don protective mask within 9 seconds, with hood within 15
seconds.

b.
Initiate appropriate alarms (vocal and nonvocal).

c.
Don protective gloves within 45 seconds of alarm.

d.
Conduct skin decontamination within 2 minutes of alarm.

e.
Identify type of agent using chemical agent detector kits.

5-233
DODDOA-003997
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
f.
Conduct operator spraydown and personal equipment decontamination within 15 minutes of alarm.

g.
Continue mission unless directed otherwise.

2. Unit personnel protect equipment.
a.
Cover all exposed equipment and supplies.

b.
Implement procedures to prevent further contamination lAW the TSOP.

c.
Monitor the area to determine contamination levels by testing with detector kits and paper.

*3. Unit leaders provide NBC reports to the higher HQ S2/S3.
a.
Forward initial NBC 1 chemical report as soon as tactical situation permits using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

b.
Request permission to move, if mission permits, using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

c.
Coordinate with higher HQ S4 on for hasty or deliberate decontamination support using analog and/or digital communications.

d.
Forward follow-up NBC 1 chemical report within 20 minutes after the attack using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

*4. Unit leaders initiate unmasking procedures (if chemical agent detector kits indicate negative results).
a.
Direct two individuals to conduct unmasking procedures.

b.
Observe directed individuals for 10 minutes for symptoms of illness.

c.
Observe directed individuals for delayed symptoms.

d.
Initiate "All Clear" signal, if no symptoms of chemical poisoning are detected.

e.
Report results to higher HQ S2/S3 using analog and/or

digital communications or messenger. systems. •
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
5. Unit personnel employ unmasking procedures (chemical agent detector kits indicate negative results).
a.
Break the seal in a shady area (directed personnel).

b.
Remain unmasked for five minutes (directed personnel).

c.
Remask and clear masks (directed personnel).

NOTE: Task steps 6 and 7 are performed only if chemical agent detector kits are not available.
*6. Unit leaders initiate unmasking procedures (using M8/M9 detector paper).
a.
Check area for physical signs of liquid contamination using M8/M9 detector paper.

b.
Direct two individuals to conduct unmasking procedures.

c.
Observe directed individuals for 10 minutes for symptoms of chemical incapacitation.

NOTE: Wait 5 minutes after directed individuals have unmasked.
d.
Observe directed individuals for another 10 minutes after they unmask again, for symptoms of chemical incapacitation.

e.
Initiate "All Clear" signal, if no symptoms appear.

f.
Report results to higher HQ S2/S3 using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

7. Unit personnel employ unmasking procedures (using M8 detector paper).
a.
Check area for physical signs of liquid contamination using M8/M9 detector paper.

b.
Break mask seal in a shady area (directed individuals).

c.
Keep eyes open for 15 seconds (directed individuals).

d.
Clear mask (directed individuals).

5-235
DODDOA-003999
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES • GO NO GO
e.
Reseal mask (directed individuals).

f.
Remain masked for 10 minutes (directed individuals).

g.
Unmask for five minutes (directed individuals).

h.
Remask for 10 minutes (directed individuals).

i.
Initiate "All Clear" if no symptoms appear. .

..j. Repeat unmasking procedures, steps b through i above, for
remaining unit personnel.

k. Report results to higher HQ S2/S3 using analog and/or
digital communications or messenger.

*8. Commander and leaders reorganize unit area.
a.
Establish Situational Awareness.

b.
Reestablish chain of command.

c.
Coordinate required unit MOPP level with the higher HQ
S2/S3 using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

d.
Inspect unit personnel to ensure that individuals remain at
the directed MOPP level.

e.
Direct periodic chemical monitoring in the unit area.

f.
Supervise the request and distribution of replacement
chemical defense equipment and supplies.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
DODDOA-004000
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS
Task Number Task Title References
031-503-1004 Protect Yourself From Chemical and STP 21-1-SMCT
Biological Injury/ Contamination Using
Your M17-Series Protective Mask With
Hood
031-503-1012 Protect Yourself From Chemical and STP 21-1-SMCT
Biological Injury/Contamination Using
Your M24 Or M25-Series Protective Mask
With Hood
031-503-1015 Protect Yourself From NBC STP 21-1-SMCT
Injury/Contamination With Mission-
Oriented Protective Posture (MOPP) Gear
031-503-3002 Conduct Unmasking Procedures STP 21-24-SMCT
031-503-3005 Prepare and Submit NBC 1 Reports STP 21-24-SMCT
031-503-3008 Implement Mission-Oriented Protective STP 21-24-SMCT
Posture

OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS
TASK: DISRUPT ENEMY MOVEMENT AND OPERATIONS USING PERSISTENT AND NON-PERSISTENT CHEMICAL WEAPONS (63-OPFOR-1001)
CONDITION: OPFOR units deliver chemical agents by means of conventional artillery weapons or aircraft along selected routes and key bases in the rear area.
STANDARD: 1. Deliver chemical agents in low lying and/or densely wooded areas. 2. Delay movement of enemy supplies and equipment to forward areas by disrupting C2 system. 3. Restrict enemy units movement in rear area. 4. Channel movement into predesignated ambush areas. 5. Contaminate enemy supplies and equipment. 6. Inflict casualties on enemy forces.
5-237
DODDOA-004001
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters 3 Truck Platoon Headquarters 6 Truck Squads Maintenance Section 2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters 4 Light Truck Squads Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters Light Truck Squad
TASK:.Destroy Supplies and Equipment (63-2-4522) (TM 750-244-3, DA PAM 385-1, FM 100-14, FM 3-100.4, FM 3-4, FM 3-5, TM 43-0002-33, TM 750-244-2, TM 750-244-6, TM 750-244-7)
.
(circle)
ITERATION 1.2.3.4.5.M..
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The commander has been ordered to evacuate the position and destroy or disable those items of equipment and supplies the unit cannot evacuate. The unit has analog and digital communications with higher HQ. Tactical operations are underway IAW the OPORD, the unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOPs. A threat force penetration of the unit's position is expected to occur within a specified period of time. Initial hasty displacement preparations were made during the defense buildup. Destruction of supplies and equipment has been previously coordinated with higher HQ staff element and EOD personnel. Unit destruction plan, applicable publications, supplies, and equipment are available. This task is performed under all day and night environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and ground Level I threat forces attack. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: The unit evacuates its position within the time specified by the higher HQ staff element and destroys or disables selected supplies, equipment, documents, COMSEC/IEW equipment and other critical items that cannot be evacuated (medical items must not be destroyed). At MOPP4, performance degradation factors increase the time required to destroy supplies and equipment.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO *1. Commander directs selected supplies and equipment be destroyed or disabled.
a.
Identifies critical equipment and supplies that must be
destroyed or disabled.

b.
Identifies computer and computer related hardware and
software that must be destroyed.

c.
Prioritizes destruction and disablement of selected equipment
based on denying its value to the enemy.

GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
d.
Briefs platoon and section leaders on situation and destruction priorities.

e.
Consolidates requests for EOD or engineer support received from the platoons and sections.

f.
Follows guidelines contained in the destruction plan, company and battalion TSOPs, and EOD or engineer publications.

g.
Assigns tasks and responsibilities.

h.
Requests EOD or engineer support through S2/S3 Section, as required.

i.
Consolidates destruction reports received from the platoons and sections.

j.
Provides consolidated destruction report to S2/S3 Section IAW TSOP.

k.
Enforces safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications.

1. Enforces environmental stewardship protection program procedures.
*2. Platoon and section leaders supervise destruction or disabling of supplies and equipment.
a.
Identify supplies and equipment to be destroyed or disabled.

b.
Identify destruction or disabling method.

c.
Direct destruction or disabling of supplies and equipment.

d.
Report completed destruction to commander.

e.
Enforce safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications.

f.
Enforce environmental stewardship protection program
procedures.

5-239
DODDOA-004003
GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
3. Platoon and section personnel destroy or disable tracked and wheeled vehicles (to include construction equipment).
a.
Drain the engine oil.

b.
Drain equipment hydraulic systems and cut hydraulic hoses.

c.
Slash all tires.

d.
Run engines until they seize, as applicable.

e.
Burn hoses, belts, and so forth, as applicable.

f.
Destroy vital elements, such as the gearbox, starter, engine block, transmission, instrument panel, and any communication equipment.

g.
Employ safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications.

h.
Employ environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

4. Platoon and section personnel destroy or disable all critical supplies, computer and non computer related communications equipment, and COMSEC/IEW materiel.
a.
Record all COMSEC/JEW materiel identified for destruction or disablement.

b.
Destroy analog and/or digital communication components IAW with applicable TM.

c.
Burn COMSEC/EW codes, keys, password lists, software,
and any other perishable classified items.

d.
Destroy ETMs and other automated or non automated
documents JAW TSOP.

e.
Destroy or render computer and computer related hardware
and software inoperative IAW appropriate TM.

f.
Destroy supplies IAW appropriate TM and TSOP.

GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
g.
Employ safety procedures IAW with applicable reference.

h.
Employ environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

*5. Platoon and section leaders arrange for destruction of supplies and equipment with explosives.
a.
Identify items for destruction.

b.
Review explosive detonation procedures.

c.
Estimate type and amount of explosive material required.

d.
Provide commander with explosive material requirement estimate.

e.
Request EOD or engineer support, through commander, as required.

*6. Platoon and section leaders submit status reports to the commander.
a.
Submit certificate of destruction of supply items destroyed by class of supply.

b.
Submit certificate of destruction of tracked and wheeled vehicles, construction equipment, and special purpose vehicles destroyed or disabled.

c.
Submit certificate of destruction of analog and/or digital communication equipment destroyed or disabled.

d.
Submit certificate of destruction of COMSEC/IEW items destroyed.

e.
Submit certificate of destruction of computer hardware and software destroyed.

f.
Submit report of platoon and section's capability to continue
with assigned missions.

5-241
DODDOA-004005
TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS: NONE
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Treat Casualties (08-2-0003.63-0001) (FM 21-11, AR 600-8-1, FM 3-4, FM 3-5, FM 8-10, FM 8-10-6, FM 8-10-7, FM 8-285, FM 8-55)
.
1.2.3.4.5.M.(circle)
ITERATION
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT . T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit has sustained casualties. The unit has no organic medical personnel. Threat force contact has been broken. Soldiers have been wounded and may have chemical contamination or non-battle injuries. Some unit personnel have been assigned the additional duty of combat lifesavers. Unit personnel are performing self-buddy aid and combat lifesavers are providing advance treatment until medical treatment personnel arrive. Higher HQ TSOP and OPORD are available.
NOTE: This task should not be trained in MOPP 4 except when treating NBC casualties. Some
iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Unit personnel provide treatment for casualties IAW FM 21-11, FM 8­
285, and combat lifesavers certification standards. At MOPP 4, performance degradation factors
increase the time required to provide treatment and limits the type of treatment provided.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Commander and leaders supervise treatment of casualties.

a.
Develop treatment plan.

b.
Monitor treatment for compliance with FM 21-11 and to
ensure all casualties are treated.

c.
Direct employment of combat lifesavers to treat casualties.

d.
Report casualties, as required.

e.
Coordinate replenishment of Class VIII supplies with the
supporting unit IAW the TSOP.

5-243
— — -
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
f.
Direct distribution of Class VIII supplies and equipment JAW the TSOP.

g.
Enforce procedures for Class VDT items issued to control team elements.

2. Unit elements survey each casualty.
a.
Check for responsiveness.

b.
Check for breathing

c.
Check for bleeding.

d.
Check for head injury.

e.
Check for shock.

f.
Check for fractures, to include cervical spine and back fractures.

g.
Check for burns.

3. Unit elements administer life-saving treatment.
a.
Clear all objects from throat of casualty.

b.
Use jaw thrust method to open airway if cervical spine injury is suspected.

c.
Perform mouth-to-mouth resuscitation to restore casualty's breathing IAW CPR procedures.

4. Unit elements control hemorrhage. . a. Apply manual direct pressure to wound.
b.
Elevate extremities.

c.
Apply pressure dressing to wound.

d.
Apply digital pressure to pressure points

e.
Apply tourniquet as last resort.

GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
5. Unit elements dress wounds.
a, Apply occlusive dressing to an open chest wound, if possible.
b.
Apply dressing to an open abdominal wound.

c.
Apply dressing to an open head wound.

6. Unit elements splint suspected fractures.
a.
Employ available materials to splint injury.

b.
Splint fracture in position found.

c.
Restrict movement of extremities.

d.
Check circulation for impairment.

7. Unit elements treat casualties with burns.
a.
Extinguish thermal burn agents.

b.
Remove chemical burn agent(s).

c.
Eliminate electrical burn source.

d.
Uncover burn unless stuck to clothing or a chemical
environment exists.

e.
Apply field dressing.

8. Unit elements treat environmental injuries.
a.
Administer first aid for heat injuries.

b.
Administer first aid for heat stroke

c.
Administer first aid for frost bite.

9. Unit elements treat chemical casualties.
a.
Take immediate protective steps to protect self and warn
others IAW FM 8-285.

b.
Protect casualty from further contamination.

5-245
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
c. Administer nerve agent antidote IAW FM 21-11 and FM 8-
285.
d. Decontaminate casualty IAW FM 8-285, if necessary.
10. Unit elements prevent shock.
a.
Position casualty in the correct anti-shock position IAW FM 21-11.

b.
Loosen clothing and equipment.

c.
Prevent casualty from chilling and overheating.

d.
Calm casualty by reassuring him.

11. Unit combat lifesavers perform advanced treatment.
a.
Evaluate casualty for condition and type treatment needed.

b.
Measure casualty's vital signs.

c.
Record casualty's vital signs.

NOTE: Vital signs are monitored throughout treatment for abnormalities and required immediate action.
d.
Insert oropharyngeal airway in an unconscious casualty.

e.
Apply a splint to a fractured limb.

f.
Administer first aid to chemical agent casualties.

g.
Initiate an intravenous infusion for hypovolemic shock.

h.
Identify environmental injuries.

i.
Treat environmental injuries.

j.
Manage BF casualties.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
M
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS
ReferencesTask Number Task Title
081-831-1000 Evaluate a Casualty STP 21-1 -SMCT 081-831-1003 Clear an Object From the Throat of a STP 21 -1 -SMCT Conscious Casualty
081-831-1005 Prevent Shock STP 21 -1 -SMCT 081-831-1007 Give First Aid for Bums STP 21 -1 -SMCT 081-831-1008 Give First Aid for Heat Injuries STP 21 -1 -SMCT 081-831-1009 Give First Aid for Frostbite STP 21 -1 -SMCT 081-831-1016 Put On a Field or Pressure Dressing STP 21 -1 -SMCT 081-831-1017 Put On a Tourniquet STP 21 -1 -SMCT 081-831-1025 Apply a Dressing to an Open Abdominal STP 21-1-SMCT
Wound 081-831-1026 Apply a Dressing to an Open Chest Wound STP 21-1-SMCT 081-831-1031 Administer First Aid to a Nerve Agent STP 21 -1 -SMCT
Casualty (Buddy-Aid) 081-831-1033 Apply a Dressing to an Open Head Wound STP 21-1-SMCT 081-831-1034 Splint a Suspected Fracture .STP 21 -1 -SMCT 081-831-1042 Perform Mouth-to-Mouth Resuscitation STP 21-1-SMCT
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
5-247
DODDOA-004011
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Perform Unit Mortuary Affairs Operations (10-2-4513) (J1 1'P 4-06, AR 40-66, DOD MFFIMS, FM 10-64, FM 3-100.4, FM 3-4, FM 3-5, STP 21-1-SMCT)
.
ITERATION 1.2.3.4.5.M.(circle)
.
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit has sustained fatalities. The unit may have the capability to perform an air reconnaissance. Some remains may be contaminated. Non-mortuary affairs personnel may perform this task. The commander has assigned search and recovery team leader(s) and personnel. Theater commander authorizes emergency burials. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD, the unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. This task is performed under all day and night environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and all levels of threat forces attacks. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Search, recovery, evacuation, and emergency burial operations are
performed IAW the TSOP and OPORD. At MOPP4, performance degradation factors increase
time required for performing mortuary affairs.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
I. Search and recovery team leader(s) prepare for the search.
a.
Review all reports concerning the incident.

b.
Perform a map, terrain, or aerial reconnaissance of the search
area.

c.
Coordinate map reconnaissance with higher headquarters.

d.
Identify resource requirement for the mission.

e.
Arrange for search team's transportation to and from
recovery site.

f.
Identify additional support requirements.

DODDOA-004012
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
g.
Request additional support requirements from the S4 Section using analog and/or digital communications or messenger, and following up with a requisition for additional supplies.

h.
Coordinate NBC and EOD assistance with the unit HQ using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

i.
Coordinate security of search area with unit HQ using analog

and/or digital communications messenger. •
j.
Brief personnel.

k.
Relay the last known location (grid coordinates) of the remains if the recovery cannot be performed to higher headquarters.

2. Search and recovery team leader(s) prepare for movement to recovery site.
a.
Conduct pre-deployment inspection of all vehicles, soldier's personal equipment, and mission-essential equipment and forms.

b.
Develop a load plan.

c.
Supervise loading of equipment in accordance with load plans.

d.
Verify route.

3. Search and recovery team(s) move to the recovery site.
a.
Conduct movement based upon tactical situation.

b.
Adhere to appropriate convoy or road-march procedures.

4. Search and recovery team leader(s) supervise search, recovery, and evacuation operations.
a.
Determine the best search methods to use in the particular area.

b.
Ensure search is conducted during the daylight hours.

c.
Brief search and recovery team(s) on operational procedures.

d.
Ensure soldiers are wearing appropriate protective gear.

5-249
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
e.
Issue personal effects bags, human remains pouches, if available, and NBC agent tags.

f.
Assign areas of search to each team of which the sum equals the entire search area, as directed by the commander.

g.
Assign a portion of the search area to an individual team member.

h.
Monitor search and recovery team(s)-operations for compliance with TSOP and the commander's guidance.

5. Search and recovery team(s) conduct the search.
a.
Search assigned areas for remains and personal effects.

b.
Mark locations of remains, portions, and personal effects with color-coded pin flags IAW FM 10-64.

c.
Initiate FMC for each remains IAW AR 40-66.

d.
Prepare recovery site sketch indicating locations where remains and personal effects were found.

6. Search and recovery team(s) recover remains.
a.
Inspect immediate area for booby traps and NBC contaminants.

b.
Ensure remains are covered or shrouded at all times when not being examined.

c.
Verify that DD Form 1380 is attached to the remains.

. d. Ensure DD Form 567 is prepared for each remains or to document mission if no remains are found.
e.
Ensure DD Form 565 is completed, if unit personnel knew the deceased.

f.
Ensure the areas around the remains are searched for personal effects and possible disassociated personal effects.

g.
Perform procedures for initial identification.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
h. Attach to contagious remains a tag marked with a large "C", and the identity of each contagion and contaminant.
NOTE: Remains found in a contaminated area are to be handled IAW procedures set forth m JTIP 4-06 and evacuated directly to the MADCP.
i. Place personal effects into a personal effects bag, if available, and attach to remains.

j.
Prepare a sketch of the recovery site showing major landmarks.

k.
Prepare a map overlay of the recovery site using analog and/or digital devices or manually.

1. Forward SITREP IAW TSOP to the unit HQ using analog and digital communications or messenger.
m. Employ environmental stewardship protection program procedures.
7. Search and recovery team(s) evacuate remains to the nearest MACP.
a.
Coordinate evacuation of recovered remains to collection points with the support operations section using analog and digital communications.

b.
Ensure all records prepared at the recovery site are complete and accurate before departing the area.

c.
Ensure the remains are transported feet first.

d.
Ensure remains awaiting evacuation are shrouded from public view and guarded or escorted.

e.
Transport the remains in the most expedient manner possible to the nearest MACP.

f.
Ensure all transportation assets can provide cover for the remains while being transported.

5-251
DODDOA-00401 5
GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
g. Ensure a summary report is submitted to higher headquarters
to document the search and recovery mission.

NOTE: Remains should only be transported in an ambulance as a last
resort.

NOTE: If remains cannot be evacuated to a MACP in a timely manner,
perform steps 8 and 9.

8. Search and recovery team(s) leader supervise isolated interments.
a.
Identify specific isolated interment site in coordination with
the unit HQ usiag analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

b.
Supervise isolated interment marking IAW r.ri P-4-06, FM
10-64, TSOP, and current directives

c.
Supervise the burial of all recovered remains and their
personal effects.

d.
Report burial data to unit HQ using analog and/or digital
communications or messenger.

e.
Employ environmental stewardship protection program
procedures.

9. Search and recovery team(s) perform isolated interments.
a.
Prepare the isolated interment site(s) IAW appropriate
J11P4-06, FM 10-64, TSOP, and current directives.

b.
Mark all interment sites JAW FM 10-64.

c.
Employ environmental stewardship protection program
procedures.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
DODDOA-004016
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS ReferencesTask Number Task Title
101-515-1900 Perform Mortuary Affairs Operations STP 21-1-SMCT
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
5-253
DODDOA-004017
ELEMENT: Maintenance Section
TASK:.Perform Maintenance Control Functions (43-2-0050) (DA PAM 738-750, DA PAM 710-2-1, DA PAM 710-2-2, FM 3-4, FM 3-5)
.
3.4.5.M.(circle)
ITERATION 1.2.
.

T.P.U.(circle)
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT
CONDITIONS: The unit is providing maintenance support and repair parts supply, in support of operations from its established field or MOUT location. Supported unit equipment density listings and the location of supported units have been identified. The unit's internal and external SOPs and TSOP have been developed and distributed to the repair sections and supported units. Repair time guidelines and the amount of backlog to be held by the unit is established and adjusted by the higher HQ staff element. All required technical publications are available. This task will be performed under all environment conditions. The unit may encounter threat level I activity, NBC attack, or be subject to radiological fallout. Some iterations of this task should be performed in
MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: All repair sections are workloaded at or near their capacity. The overall backlog is maintained at a level not to exceed that established by the higher HQ staff element. At MOPP Level 4, performance degradation factors increase maintenance control activity completion times.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Maintenance officer/NCOIC supervises the operations of the
maintenance control section.

a.
Directs inspection program.

b.
Directs internal shop supply operations.

c.
Directs production control system operations.

d.
Enforces safety procedures.

e.
Forwards personnel and equipment status reports to company
headquarters.

f.
Enforces environmental stewardship procedures.

5254
-
DODDOA-004018
GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
2. Maintenance control section implements production control procedures.
a.
Provides a work order number for each customer work request received.

b.
Establishes maintenance repair priorities.

c.
Distributes maintenance requests to the appropriate sections for their action.

d.
Monitors current status of all work requests throughout the work flow process.

e.
Manages all repair resources.

f.
Coordinates the evacuation of equipment to supporting maintenance company.

g.
Monitors the quality control program for compliance with internal SOP.

h.
Forwards reports to higher HQ staff element.

3. Maintenance control section's inspection element performs inspections.
a.
Performs initial acceptance inspections on all equipment submitted for repair.

b.
Identifies equipment requiring evacuation based on complexity/level of repair or exceeding backlog and repair time guidelines established by higher HQ staff element.

c.
Identifies resources to perform required repairs.

d.
Provides update equipment status information to the
production control system.

e.
Performs random in-process inspections of equipment
undergoing repair.

f.
Performs final/quality control inspections on repaired
equipment prior to its return to customer units.

g.
Provides technical assistance and guidance as required.

5-255
DODDOA-004019
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
4. Maintenance control section's supply element provides repair parts for DS maintenance operations.
a.
.Obtains parts identified by inspection element for performance of DS maintenance repairs.

b.
Maintains status on all open requests and requisitions.

c.
Updates status in production control system for all jobs awaiting parts.

d.
Stores parts received for each work request until they are released by maintenance officer/NCOIC to maintenance section performing the repair.

e.
Maintains stockage level of selected repair parts items authorized as shop or bench stock.

f.
Protects all repair parts items from weather and pilferage.

g.
Processes unserviceable recoverable items or excess repair • parts items for turn-in to DS supply support activity.

*5. Maintenance control officer/NCOIC supervises repair sections.
a.
Inspects section operations.

b.
Enforces shop safety procedures.

c.
Directs performance of on-site maintenance.

d.
Verifies job status information provided by repair sections for timeliness and accuracy.

e.
Directs cross-leveling of repair assets as priorities change.

f.
Implements actions that accelerate work flow process, if unacceptable backlog develops.

ARTEP 55-718-30-MTP GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
*6. Maintenance control officer/NCOIC maintains liaison with
supported units.

a.
Performs technical assistance visits.

b.
Coordinates maintenance support for tactical operations.

c.
Verifies effectiveness of support provided to supported units.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
3 4 5 M TOTAL
ITERATION 1 2
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step. SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS: NONE SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
5-257
ELEMENT: Maintenance Section
TASK:.Provide Repair Parts Supply Support (43-2-0096) (AR 710-2, FM 10-15) .
3.4.5.M.(circle)
ITERATION 1.2.
.

T.P.U.(circle)
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT
CONDITIONS: The unit is providing support maintenance and repair parts supply in support of operations from its established field or MOUT location. Supported unit equipment density listings are available, and locations of support units are known. Unit SOPs are available, and have been distributed to supported units. Supply accounts have been established. The supply system is receiving repair parts from external supply sources, and supported unit turn-ins. Repair parts stocks are available. The warehouse storage and location system has been developed. Customers are requesting and receiving repair parts supplies. This task is performed under all environmental conditions during day or night operations. The unit is subject to attack by threat level I forces, NBC attack, or radiological fallout. This task is always performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: All repair parts supply operations are conducted IAW applicable references and internal/external SOPs. At MOPP level 4, performance degradation factors increase time required to perform repair parts supply support.
GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
*
1. Supply platoon leader/NCOIC supervises platoon operations.

a.
Verifies all receipts are processed.

b.
Supervises storage operations to safeguard repair parts from
pilferage and environmental conditions.

c.
Manages issue operations to verify parts are provided to
correct customer units.

d.
Supervises location surveys.

e.
Verifies accuracy of reports and records.

f.
Enforces safety procedures.

g.
Provides technical assistance.

h.
Forwards equipment and personnel status reports to unit HQ.

i.
Enforces environmental stewardship procedures.

DODDOA-004022
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*2. Supply Elements Section Chiefs supervises Section Operations.
a.
Verifies accuracy of reports and records.

b.
Provides technical assistance.

c.
Forwards daily equipment and personnel status reports to platoon HQ.

d.
Coordinates section operations with platoon HQ.

e.
Enforces environmental stewardship procedures.

f.
Enforces safety procedures.

3. Receiving element receives repair parts.
a.
Verifies actual quantities received against receipt documents to ensure quantity shipped arrived at the section.

b.
Inspects items for damage.

c.
Reports discrepancies to section supervisors.

d.
Separates items received due to incorrect routing.

e.
Separates items received for warehouse storage from those received for issue to customer units.

f.
Identifies storage locations for:replenishment items or bin locations for customer units.

g.
Forwards serviceable RX items to RX section.

h.
Maintains documentation lAW the repair parts supply procedures in the internal maintenance SOP.

i.
Forwards transaction data to the MMC for posting of repair parts transaction records.

j.
Employs environmental stewardship procedures.

k.
Employs safety procedures.

5-259
DODDOA-004023
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
4. Supply storage element stores repair parts/RX/QSS.
a.
Checks items received against due outs to customer units for issue.

b.
Places repair parts in correct storage location or customer pickup bin.

c.
Prepares items, which are designated for shipment to customer unit locations.

d.
Maintains documentation JAW repair parts supply procedures in the internal maintenance SOP.

e.
Performs location surveys and inventories as directed to verify accuracy of locator files.

f.
Employs safety procedures.

g.
Employs environmental stewardship procedures.

h.
Safeguards repair parts from pilferage and environmental conditions.

5. Supply Issuing element issues RX/QSS items.
a.
Identifies the location of the requested item.

b.
Selects the correct item and quantity from the storage location.

c.
Employs correct procedures JAW appropriate references when requesting items or quantity requested is not available.

d.
Enforces safety procedures.

e.
Prepares items, which are designated for shipment to
customer unit locations.

f.
Employs safety procedures.

g.
Employs environmental stewardship procedures.

DODDOA-004024
GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
h.
Maintains documentation IAW repair parts supply procedures in the internal maintenance SOP.

i.
Forwards transaction data to MMC for posting of repair parts transaction records.

6. The transportation section NCOIC supervises the section operations.
a.
Supervises PMCS and services on section equipment.

b.
Provides technical assistance.

c.
Plans transportation operations.

d.
Briefs transportation missions to drivers.

e.
Supervises the use of material handling equipment.

f.
Coordinates section operations with platoon HQ.

g.
Provides daily personnel and equipment status reports to platoon HQ.


h. Employs environmental stewardship procedures.

i.
Employs safety procedures.

7. The transportation section transports supplies from external supply sources to the receiving section.
a.
Loads supplies.

b.
Inspects load to determine its security for transport. .

c.
Transports supplies to the receiving section for processing.

d.
Unloads supplies.

e.
Moves supplies to designated locations within the storage
area.

f.
Employs environmental stewardship procedures.

g.
Employs safety procedures.

5-261
DODDOA-004025
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES 8. The transportation section transports supplies to supported units. a. Loads supplies. GO NO GO •
b. Inspects load to determine its security for transport.
c. Transports repair parts to supported unit locations.
d. Unloads supplies.
e. Loads any supplies to be returned from supported units.
f. Unloads returned supplies.
area. g. Moves supplies to designated locations within the storage
h. Employs safety procedures.
i. Employs environmental stewardship procedures.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
ITERATION
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step. SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS: NONE SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
DODDOA-004026
ELEMENT: Maintenance Section
TASK:.Perform Recovery Operations (43-2-4071) (DA PAM 738-750, DA PAM 750-35, FM 21-305, FM 4-30.3, TC 5-400)
.
ITERATION 1.2.3.4.5.M.(circle) .
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit is providing field maintenance in support of tactical operations from its established field or MOUT location. The section has analog and digital communications with the Maintenance Control Office. The higher HQ OPORD, with all annexes and overlays, has been forwarded to the unit commander's digital device. Unit and higher TSOPs are available. This task is performed under all day and night environmental conditions. The unit is subject tc air, NBC, and ground Level I threat forces attack. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Equipment is returned to battle or recovered to the combat repair team or the Brigade Support Area for repair. At MOPP4, performance degradation factors increase time required to perform maintenance and repair parts supply support and task completion times.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Maintenance Control Officer/NCOIC/CRT NCOIC prepares to
dispatch a recovery team using analog or digital communications.

a.
Coordinates with the customer unit to verify the location of
the disabled vehicle using analog or digital communications.

b.
Identifies personnel required to perform the recovery
operation.

c.
Identifies equipment required to perform the recovery
operation.

d.
Briefs the recovery team leader on the tactical situation and
the recovery operation.

e.
Monitors recovery team analog and digital communications
for a request for additional support.

f.
Coordinates mission status with Support Operations using
analog or digital communications.

g.
Enforces safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications.

h.
Enforces environmental stewardship protection program
procedures JAW TC 5-400.

5-263
DODDOA-004027
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*2. Recovery vehicle supervisor coordinates the recovery operation
with the unit using analog or digital communications.

a.
Identifies best route to vehicle location given the tactical
situation.

b.
Coordinates indirect fire support along the route with the
S2/S3 section using analog and digital communications..

c.
Organizes recovery team personnel.

d.
Briefs recovery team on the tactical situation and the
recovery operation.

e.
Enforces safety procedures lAW TSOP and publications.

f.
Enforces environmental stewardship protection program
procedures IAW TC 5-400.

3. Service/Recovery Section performs the recovery operation.
a.
Maintains security while en route to the recovery site.

b.
Establishes local security at the recovery site.

c.
Removes casualties from the vehicle.

d.
Treats causalities.
NOTE: See Task 63-2-4517 for detailed treatment procedures.

e.
Requests medical assistance, if required.

f.
Transports casualties, if required.
NOTE: . See Task 63-2-4316 for detailed transportation procedures.

g.
Identifies method of recovery to be used in the recovery
operation.

h.
Recovers equipment lAW established recovery procedures.

i.
Performs battle damage assessment to determine if repairs are
required.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES 'GO NO GO
j.
Performs repairs or BDAR on site, if possible.

k.
Operates automated data computer IAW applicable ETMs.

1. Recovers non-reparable equipment back to UMCP.
m. Employs safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications.
n Employs environmental stewardship protection program • procedures IAW TC 5-400.
4. Service/Recovery Section destroys unrecoverable equipment.
a.
Requests disposition of unrecoverable equipment from the
Maintenance Control Section using analog or digital communications.

b.
Conducts salvage operations to remove all useable
equipment.

c.
Prepares vehicle and equipment for destruction IAW the
TSOP and applicable TM.

d.
Destroys vehicle on order from the commander or designated
representative.

e.
Employs safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications.

f.
Employs environmental stewardship protection program
procedures IAW TC 5-400.

"'*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS: NONE
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
5-265
DODDOA-004029
ELEMENT: Maintenance Section
TASK:.Maintain Records and Publications (43-2-4392) (DA PAM 738-750, DA PAM 710-2-2, AR 710-2, AR 725-50)
.
5.M.(circle)
ITERATION 1.2.3.4.
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT . T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit is operational and is processing materiel. In a field or MOUT location, the unit needs access to proper manuals to correctly diagnose, inspect, and repair equipment. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: All records are maintained LAW DA Pam 738-750, DA Pam 710-2, DA
Pam 710-2-2, AR 735-5, and other applicable references. Reports will be submitted as directed by
the local commander.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
1. Unit personnel prepare and maintain records and reports.
a.
Prepare reports JAW DA Pam 738-750 and AR 710-2.

b.
Forward reports required by DA Pam 738-750 to appropriate
activities.

2. Unit maintains component and repair parts required list.
a.
Obtains list of projects and required parts from MMC and
GS units.

b.
Uses report to determine routing and classification of
materiel.

3. Unit maintenance section maintains quality and production control
records.

a.
Maintains DA Form 2405, Maintenance Report Register.

b.
Initiates DA Form 2407, Maintenance Request, for
processing individual items or groups of like items.

c.
Indicates routing and other instructions (for example,
disassembly or what parts to remove) using a DA Form 2407-1,
Maintenance Request Continuation Sheet.

d.
Retains DA Form 2407 and completes, as necessary, upon
return of annotated DA Form 2407-1.

ARTEP 55-718-30-MTP
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES 4. Unit maintains stock records and accounting system. a. Maintains records on all items in storage showing, at minimum, the NSN, date entered, nomenclature, quantity, and location. b. Maintains records are maintained IAW AR 710-2, AR 725-50, and DA Pam 710-2-2. GO NO GO
5. Unit maintains publications library. a. Maintains DS/GS level technical manuals for maintenance operations and parts identification for all items of equipment inspected and repaired, as necessary. b. Maintains supply manuals for repair accountability and logistic related ARs to adequately follow Army policy. c. Uses DA Pam 25-30 (electronic publications and blank forms) to check accuracy of publication and form titles and dates.
"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS: NONE
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE

5-267
DODDOA-004031
ELEMENT: Maintenance Section
TASK:.Perform Controlled Exchange of Repair Parts (43-2-4394) (DA PAM 738-750, DA PAM 710-2-1, DA PAM 710-2-2, DA PAM 750-1)
.
1.2.3.4.5.M.(circle)
ITERATION . COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The task force is in contact with the enemy and several vehicles have been damaged. The commander has directed that a repair part be taken from a NMCS vehicle in order to return other vehicles to full mission capable status. This task is performed under all day and night environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and ground level I threat forces attack. Some iterations of this task should be performel in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Parts or components taken from the donor item of equipment must return the item of equipment back to a fully mission capable status. At MOPP Level 4, performance degradation factors increase times of maintenance activities.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
1. Platoon leader directs controlled exchange.
a.
Ensures that the item to be exchanged is within the unit level
of maintenance responsibility and approved by the commander.

b.
Ensures required repair parts cannot be obtained through the
local supply system.

2. Team chief records controlled exchange transaction.
a.
Notifies records clerk of controlled exchange transaction.

b.
Ensures DA Form 2064 (Document Register for Supply
Actions) is posted.

c.
Ensures DA Form 3318 (Records of Demands - Title Insert)
is posted.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
ITERATION
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS: NONE
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
5-269
DODDOA-004033
ELEMENT: Maintenance Section
TASK:.Perform Combat Repair Teams Functions (43-2-4508) (FM 4-30.3, DA PAM 750-1, TC 5-400)
.
3.4.5.M.(circle)
ITERATION 1.2.
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT . T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The MCS/Platoon HQ and Combat Repair Teams have analog and digital communications with the Maintenance Platoon HQ, BSC, and Engineer battalion. The Maintenance Platoon and BSC OPORDs with all annexes and overlays have been forwarded to each maintenance supervisor's digital device. TSOPs and required publications are available. The unit receives a request to provide a team to support designated forward deployed units. The unit is deployed and operational in its field or MOUT location. This task is performed under all day and night environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and ground Level I threat forces attack. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: CRT provides on site repair, diagnostics, and LRU replacement support to units in their operational area. At MOPP4, performance degradation factors increase the time required to perform maintenance support.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Maintenance Control Officer/NCO coordinates on site field
maintenance support for supported element using analog and digital
communications.

a.
Identifies personnel required to perform on site maintenance.

b.
Identifies required tools, diagnostic equipment, LRUs, repair
parts, and transportation to perform maintenance.

c.
Briefs CRT Maintenance Supervisor on tactical situation and
mission.

d.
Inspects CRT personnel for proper uniform, equipment, and
combat spares needed to facilitate repairs forward.

e.
Dispatches CRT to requesting element's location.

GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
*2. CRT Maintenance Supervisor supervises field maintenance support.
a.
Verifies that security elements are appropriately positioned
during CRT's movement to the support location.

b.
Disseminates location and status of field maintenance effort
to MCS/Platoon HQ using analog and digital communications.


c.
Establishes team support area in locations designated by unit
requesting on site field maintenance support.

d.
Coordinates for life support with unit requesting on site

•support using analog and digital communications.
3. CRT repair personnel conduct on site field maintenance support.
a.
Perform on site BDAR.

b.
Perform on site diagnostics of inoperable equipment.

c.
Perform system maintenance through replacement of LRU
consistent with repair capability.

d.
Provide limited recovery assets to assist in evacuation of
equipment to the UMCP.

e.
Verify that all section equipment is serviceable and
maintained.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
ITERATION
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS: NONE
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
5-271
DODDOA-004035
ELEMENT: Maintenance Section TASK:.Supervise Maintenance Platoon Operations (43-2-4535) (FM 4-30.3, AR 750-1, DA PAM 385-1, DA PAM 738-750, FM 100-14, TC 5-400) 4.5.M.(circle)
ITERATION 1.2.3.
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The platoon is providing maintenance support to supported units. The maintenance platoon has analog and digital communications with Maintenance Control Office/Platoon HQ and supported units. The unit and higher HQ OPORDs with all annexes and overlays have been forwarded to the platoon leader's digital device. The unit and higher HQ TSOPs are available. The platoon receives messages from higher, adjacent, and lower echelons by radio, telephone, courier, and digital communications. This task is performed under all day and nigh environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and ground Level I threat forces attack. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Maintenance is provided IAW TSOP and commander's guidance. Reports to company HQ are accurate and timely. At MOPP4, performance degradation factors increase time required to supervise maintenance functions.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Platoon Leader and Platoon Sergeant perform platoon
administrative functions.

a.
Inspect platoon members for proper uniform and equipment.

b.
Inspect platoon living area for cleanliness.

c.
Monitor control of weapons and ammunition for security and
accountability.

d.
Supervise PMCS on all organic platoon equipment.

e.
Coordinate platoon activities with company HQ.

f.
Enforce OPSEC measures.

g.
Provide daily personnel and equipment status reports to
company HQ using analog and digital communications or messenger.

h.
Enforce safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications.

i.
Enforce environmental stewardship protection program
procedures 1AW TC 5-400.

5-272
DODDOA-004036
c?

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
2. Platoon HQ performs platoon defensive functions.
a.
Coordinates platoon defense with adjacent platoons using
analog and digital communications or messenger.

b.
Checks plitoon sector for proper camouflage.

c.
Supervises manning of platoon defensive positions.

d.
Enforces safety procedures lAW publications.

e.
Enforces environmental stewardship protection program
procedures JAW TC 5-400.

*3. Platoon Leader supervises operation of platoon sections.
a.
Supervises unit internal production control.

b.
Provides technical assistance to repairers.

c.
Coordinates repair section operations with the Maintenance
Control Section/Platoon HQ.

d.
Enforces safety standards IAW TSOP and publications.

e.
Enforces environmental stewardship protection program
procedures IAW TC 5-400.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
5-273
DODDOA-004037
ELEMENT: Maintenance Section
Set up Maintenance Platoon Headquarters and Sections (43-2-4570) (FM 4-30.3
TASK:.DA PAM 385-1, FM 100-14, FM 20-3, FM 21-10, TC 5-400)
.
M.(circle)
ITERATION 1.2.3.4.5..
T.P.U.(circle)
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT
CONDITIONS: Advance/quartering party guides escort company main body into their respective locations at new MOUT location. The unit has analog and digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD with all annexes and overlays has been forwarded to the unit commander's digital device. The unit and higher HQ TSOP are available. Areas for maintenance platoons are identified in the commander's layout plan. Selected personnel from mair body are assigned to hasty fighting positions to reinforce area security already established by advance/quartering party. Sanitation facilities are required for the new area. Although company operations areas are established simultaneously with company defense, company defense have priority. This task is performed under all day and night environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and ground Level I threat forces attack. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Maintenance Platoon HQ and Sections are set up IAW company
commander's layout plan and TSOP.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Platoon Leaders finalizes internal layout plan for platoon HQ and
sections.

a.
Adjusts traffic pattern to facilitate movement of equipment
within Platoon areas.

b.
Adjusts location of sections or equipment to improve
workflow or security.

c.
Designates areas for conducting inspections.

d.
Designates holding area for supported unit equipment
awaiting pickup, repair or evacuation.

e.
Designates sleeping areas for platoon HQ personnel and
sections.

f.
Forwards a copy of layout to higher HQ using analog or
digital communications or messenger.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
g.
Enforces safety procedures IAW TSOP and applicable publications.

h.
Enforces environmental stewardship protection program procedures TAW TC 5-400.

2. Maintenance Sections and CRT sets up their AO.
a.
Positions equipment for mission operations.

b.
Establishes analog and digital communications with MCS/Platoon HQ and company HQ.

c.
Designates a holding area for customer unit equipment awaiting shop with adequate camouflage and concealment.

d.
Employs power generation equipment. .•

e.
Establishes sleeping area.

f.
Camouflages area to include customer equipment consistent with tactical situation.

g.
Employs safety procedures JAW TSOP and applicable publications.

h.
Employs environmental stewardship protection program procedures JAW TC 5-400.

3. Maintenance Control Section sets up AO.
a.
Positions equipment for mission operations.

b.
Establishes analog and digital communications with company HQ.

c.
Employs power generation equipment.

d.
Establishes sleeping area.

e.
Camouflages area consistent with tactical situation.

5-275
DODDOA-004039
GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
f.
Employs safety procedures LAW TSOP and applicable
publications.

g.
Employs environmental stewardship protection program
procedures IAW TC 5-400.

4. Classification Section sets up AO.
a.
Positions equipment for mission operations.

b.
Establishes analog and digital communications with
MSC/Platoon HQ.

c.
Employs power generation equipment.

d.
Establishes sleeping area.

e.
Camouflages area consistent with tactical situation.

f.
Employs safety procedures IAW TSOP and applicable
publications.

g.
Employs environmental stewardship protection program
procedures IAW TC 5-400.

5. Service/Recovery Section sets up AO.
a.
Positions equipment for mission operations.

b.
Establishes analog and digital communications with
MSC/Platoon HQ.

c.
Employs power generation equipment.

d.
Establishes sleeping area.

e.
Camouflages area to include customers' equipment consistent
with tactical situation.

f.
Employs safety procedures IAW TSOP and applicable
publications.

g.
Employs environmental stewardship protection program
procedures IAW TC 5-400.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
ITERATION
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS: NONE
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
5-277
ELEMENTS: 3 Truck Platoon Headquarters 6 Truck Squads 2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters 4 Light Truck Squads Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters Light Truck Squad Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Transport Personnel and Cargo (55-2-0011) (FM 55-30, FM 24-35, FM 24-35-1, FM 3-4, FM 3-5, FM 90-10, STP 55-8811-MQS, STP 55-88M12-SM, STP 55-88M34-SM-TG)
.
(circle)
ITERATION 1.2.3.4.5.M.
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT . T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: Tactical operations have begun. The platoons has reported to the designated area for loading personnel, equipment, or supplies. The unit is equipped with MTS. The opposing force has NBC capability. SOP's, OPORD, and Movement Plan from higher HQ and unit commander are available. Iterations of training on this task should be performed in various levels of MOPP. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Transport personnel, equipment, and supplies (cargo) without causing
injury or damage TAW higher HQ and commander's guidance. As MOPP level increases,
performance degradation factors increase preparation time.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. The platoon leader/sergeant or squad leader reports to the shipper
for transporting personnel and cargo.

a.
Coordinates with shipper to determine where to spot vehicle
and trailers for loading.

b.
Ensures shipper has documentation for loads.

c.
Ensures shipper provides all tie-down devices, dunnage,
blocking, and bracing material and special tools required to secure
loads.

2. The platoon leader/sergeant or squad leader monitors operators
loading troops and their equipment (duffel bags) onto the vehicle cargo
bed or semi-trailer.

a.
Enforces safety to prevent injury during loading.

b.
Ensures tailgates are lowered.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES c. Ensures soldiers mounting the vehicle with weapon passes it to someone on board or to a person behind waiting to mount. GO NO GO
d. Ensures equipment not needed on march is loaded on separate truck or trailer (if available).
e. Ensures soldiers do not mount with duffel bag on their backs.
f. Ensures duffel bags are stacked or placed under the seat.
g. Ensures trucks have proper ventilation to protect the soldiers from exhaust gases.
h. Ensures operators brief soldiers to stay seated with all parts of their bodies inside the truck.
i. Fastens safety strap.
NOTE: Under emergency conditions, 35 seated soldiers may be transported per semi-trailer.
3. The platoon leader/sergeant or squad leader monitors the driver supervising the shipper loading equipment and classes of supplies and the supervisor monitors the driver operating the LHS. •
a. Ensures current safety regulations and policies are met prior to loading specific types of hazardous materials.
b. Ensures drivers, assisted by the assistant driver, load flatracks using load handling system IAW technical manual.
cargo. c. Supervises shipper loading containers and non-containerized
d. Ensures shipper places pallets on the floor of vehicle cargo beds prior to loading class I.
e. Supervises loading vehicle trailer to ensure heavier supplies are placed at the bottom of the load and distributed evenly over the cargo floor.
f. Ensures loads are not distributed loosely or built up too high.
g. Ensures barrel and drum are loaded either upright or placed on their sides parallel with the length of the truck.

5-279
DODDOA-004043
1.1
GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
h.
Ensures sacked cargo is loaded separately so that it cannot be punctured by odd-shaped items.

i.
Ensures sacked cargo is stacked in overlapping layers to prevent shifting.

j.
Ensures trailers loaded with crates and boxes are packed with like items or items of compatible shapes and/or transportability codes.

k.
Inspects loads and trailers at trailer transfer point or hub.

1. Ensures equipment and supplies are properly blocked and braced.
m.
Ensures tarpaulins are placed over cargo to protect against sun, dust, rain, and pilferage.

n.
Signs and receives documentation for cargo.

NOTE: Vehicle and Trailers are loaded IAW equipment technical manual.
4. The platoon leader/sergeant or squad leader organizes drivers, conducts inspection on vehicle loads, and leads convoy to destination.
a.
Inspects loads for proper blocking and bracing.

b.
Checks loads documentation.

c.
Places trucks hauling soldiers separated from any vehicle hauling hazardous cargo by at least one buffer vehicle hauling general cargo..•

d.
Conducts convoy briefing to operators on using effective protective measures, to include maintaining the prescribed vehicle interval, radio discipline, and driving during night convoys.

e.
Conducts tactical road march (see task 071-326-3013).

f.
Directs convoy defense operations (see task 551-721-3352).

g.
Reorganizes platoon.

h.
Provides unit with SITREP and continues with mission.

GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
i.
Monitors MTS.

j.
Maintains communications as directed.

5. The platoon leader/sergeant or squad leader receives a radio transmission that a vehicle has become disabled or mired.
a.
Directs remainder of the convoy to continue mission.

b.
Directs drivers behind disabled vehicle to stagger vehicle and dismount and take a defensive position (if vehicle is disabled in road and the road is block).

c.
Directs recovery operation.

d.
Designates personnel for security if road is not block.

e.
Instructs recovery operator not to push or tow vehicle carrying explosives except to move off the road and recover vehicle.

f.
Informs the unit commander and/or operation section on platoon status and continues mission.

6. The platoon arrives at destination and the platoon leader/sergeant or squad leader reports to the destination consignees.
a.
Establishes communicates with the consignee to determine where to spot vehicles and trailers for off-loading and loading for backhaul.

b.
Ensures driver, assisted by the assistant driver, unload
flatracks using load handling system IAW technical manual.

c.
Supervises consignee off -loading vehicles.
d.Ensures driver lowers tailgate.

e.
Ensures the soldiers dismounting the vehicle with a weapon
passes it to someone who has dismounted or a person behind waiting to
dismount vehicle.

f.
Provides the consignee with documentation and has the
consignee sign for the loads and retains copy for unit files.

g.
Coordinates for back hauls as directed by unit CP.

5-281
DODDOA-004045
GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
h.
Supervises the consignee to load vehicle to ensure vehicle is
properly loaded, blocked, and braced.

i.
Signs for and receives documentation for loads.

j.
Delivers load to destination and supervises off loading of
cargo.

k.
Receives customer signature and is released to return back to
field location.

1. Supervises soldiers performing after-operations PMCS,
completing trip records, and ensures trip records and documentation are
provided to dispatcher.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL..
ITERATION
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS
References
Task Number Task Title
101-519-2311 Supervise Operator Loading and STP 10-77F15-SM-TG(A)
Dispensing of Products From Assigned
Vehicles

STP 10-77F15-SM-TG(R)
551-721-1314 Couple Semitrailer STP 55-88M12-SM
551-721-1315 Uncouple Semitrailer STP 55-88M12-SM

551-721-1352 Perform Vehicle Preventive Maintenance STP 55-88M12-SM
Checks and Services (PMCS)
551-721-1355 Prepare Vehicle for Inclement Weather STP 55-88M12-SM

Operation
551-721-1359 Drive Vehicle in a Convoy STP 55-88M12-SM
551-721-1360 Drive Cargo Vehicle on Side Roads and STP 55-88M12-SM

Unimproved Roads
551-721-1361 Drive Cargo Vehicle On Snow/Ice STP 55-88M12-SM

DODDOA-004046
Task Number
551-721-1362
551-721-1363
551-721-1367
551-721-1368 .
551-721-1372
551-721-1373 551-721-1378 551-721-1379 551-721-1380 551-721-1381 551-721-1383 551-721-1384 551-721-1386 551-721-1389 551-721-1409 551-721-3334
551-721-3336 551-721-3338 551-721-3341 551-721-3342 551-721-3343
551-721-4322 551-721-4326 551-721-4327
Task Title
Drive Cargo Vehicle in Sand Drive Vehicle With or Without Trailer/Semitrailer in Blackout Conditions Back Vehicle With Semitrailer Drive Vehicle With Semitrailer On Side
Roads and Unimproved Roads Assist in Loading Cargo and Equipment Onto Vehicle/Trailer or Semitrailer Assist in Unloading Cargo and Equipment Off Vehicle/Trailer or Semitrailer Protect Vehicle Load in Inclement Weather Transport Classified/Sensitive Cargo Transport General Cargo in Trailer/Semitrailer Assist in Loading Ammunition On a Transporter Transport Dangerous/Ha7Rrdous Cargo in Vehicle and Semitrailer Perform as Wheeled Vehicle Ground Guide Day or Night Transport Passengers in a Truck Self-Recovery Wheeled Vehicle Use Maps in Motor Transport Operations Supervise Preventive Maintenance Checks and Services Enforce Driver Safety Rules and Techniques Supervise Personnel Performing Vehicle Recovery Supervise Personnel Loading Equipment and Cargo Onto Vehicle and Semitrailer Supervise Personnel Unloading Equipment and Cargo Off Vehicle Supervise Personnel Loading Ammunition On Vehicle, Trailer, and Semitrailer Manage Preventive Maintenance Checks and Services Perform Duties as Convoy Commander Conduct Road Reconnaissance of Convoy Route
References
STP 55-88M12-SM
STP 55-88M12-SM STP 55-88M12-SM STP 55-88M12-SM
STP 55-88M12-SM • STP 55-88M12-SM
STP 55-88M12-SM STP 55-88M12-SM STP 55-88M12-SM STP 55-88M12-SM STP 55-88M12-SM STP 55-88M12-SM STP 55-88M12-SM
STP 55-88M12-SM STP 55-88M12-SM STP 55-88M34-SM-TG
STP 55-88M34-SM-TG STP 55-88M34-SM-TG STP 55-88M34-SM-TG STP 55-88M34-SM-TG STP 55-88M34-SM-TG
STP 55-88M34-SM-TG
STP 55-88M34-SM-TG
STP 55-88M34-SM-TG
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE

5-283
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS
TASK: CONDUCT HASTY AMBUSH (63-OPFOR-1003)
CONDITION: OPFOR element is moving in a wooded area when an enemy march element is seen moving along a nearby route.
STANDARD: 1. Prepare ambush site before arrival of enemy element. 2. Surprise enemy forces. 3. Inflict casualties within the designated kill zone. 4. Inflict damage to vehicles and equipment within the designated kill zone. 5. Delay enemy march element from reaching its destination for a specified period. 6. Withdraw, on order, within two minutes of ambush initiation. 7. Report actions
to superiors
TASK: CONDUCT SNIPER OPERATIONS (63-OPFOR-1005)
CONDITION: OPFOR has assigned snipers, regular and/or irregular elements, in the enemy rear
area along MSR and near support sites.
STANDARD: 1. Set up well-concealed location(s). 2. Engage vehicle drivers or personnel on foot with short bursts of semi-automatic fire. 3. Kill or wound selected target. 4. Prevent position from being discovered by enemy forces. 5. Evacuate the area without being spotted. 6. Report all specified PIR and other intelligence requirements to OPFOR HQ.
TASK: CONDUCT AIR ATTACKS (63-OPFOR-1006)
CONDITION: OPFOR elements in the rear area have forwarded the positions of enemy support
sites and/or the locations of road march elements to OPFOR HQ. OPFOR aircraft have been
dispatched to attack enemy installations or convoys.
STANDARD: 1. Locate command and control site(s) or convoys. 2. Conduct attack runs on
designated target(s). 3. Destroy enemy equipment, supplies, vehicles, and personnel.
ELEMENTS: 2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
6 Truck Squads
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Transport Dry and Refrigerated Containerized Cargo (55-2-0038) (FM 55-30 FM 24-35, FM 24-35-1, FM 3-4, FM 3-5, FM 90-10)
.
5.M.(circle)
ITERATION 1.2.3.4.
.

T.P.U.(circle)
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT
CONDITIONS: Transportation commitments are received from unit headquarters. Transportation operations may be conducted in a field or MOUT environment. Some vehicles may already be committed for external transportation requirements. Personnel and cargo is transported from one location to another during night or through urban areas. Platoons may be required to perform special support operations and to transport hazardous cargo. Convoy may encounter a hostile attack or cross an NBC contaminated area. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Cargo is transported to prescribed designation according to the unit SOP. NOTE: At MOPP 4, only those tasks deemed mission essential by the commander are performed.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Convoy commander plans transport of dry and refrigerated
containerized cargo.

a.
Identifies requirements for transporting specific types of
cargo.

b.
Schedules briefing with higher HQ staff element.

c.
Marks map with all pertinent information collected in the
higher HQ staff briefing.

d.
Prepares checklist for use in identifying all convoy
requirements.

e.
Conducts a map reconnaissance to select and mark routes
and sites not already designated by higher HQ staff element.

f.
Conducts a ground reconnaissance to attain additional route
information if time permits.

g.
Arranges fire support with higher HQ staff element.

5-285
DODDOA-004049
GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
h.
Coordinates support requirements with escort and security elements, fire support, air cover, and communications.

i.
Establishes convoy organization that supports mission requirements.

j.
Identifies weapons and ammunition to be carried for countering potential threat.

k.
Identifies material for hardening vehicles for protecting personnel and cargo.

1. Identifies individual protective equipment to be worn.
m.
Establishes counter ambush actions to take in the event of a hostile attack.

n.
Coordinates maintenance and recovery of disabled vehicles with maintenance section.

o.
Identifies actions to take at RP.

p.
Conducts convoy operations briefing with higher HQ staff element.

q.
Enforces safety procedures at all times.

2. Truck platoon(s) prepare to transport dry and refrigerated containerized cargo.
a.
Perform PMCS on vehicles to identify deficiencies and shortcomings.

b.
Repair minor deficiencies before operating.

c.
Report deficiencies that are beyond the operator's repair capability to the maintenance section.

d.
Load cargo without exceeding vehicle capability.

e.
Check cargo for distribution to enhance safety and prevent
vehicle damage.

f.
Secure cargo according to FM 55-30.

GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
g.
Secure payload tie-downs.

h.
Obtain a copy of a completed motor vehicle inspection checklist, hazardous cargo only.

i.
Sign for cargo and obtain a copy of the TCMD.

j.
Position hazardous cargo placards (HAZARDOUS CARGO ONLY).

3. Truck platoon organizes convoy for transportation commitment.
a.
Assign!, vehicle positions, which minimize targets of opportunity.

b.
Positions pacesetter vehicles at the head of each march element.

c.
Positions recovery or bobtail vehicles at the rear of the convoy.

d.
Positions control vehicles without setting a pattern.

e.
Positions one hardened or armored vehicle near the head of the convoy.

f.
Positions remaining escort vehicles where they can provide maximum protection.

g.
Maintains communications with control vehicles. *4. Convoy commander conducts a final inspection.

a.
Inspects vehicle for compliance with appropriate TM and SOP.

b.
Inspects vehicle loads for compliance with TM and SOP.

c.
Inspects refrigerator unit for deficiencies and shortcomings.

d.
Inspects personnel and their equipment for compliance with TSOP.

e.
Reports final inspection results to unit CP.

5-287
DODDOA-004051
GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
5. Platoon executes transportation commitments.
a.
Conducts convoy commander's briefing with platoon personnel.

b.
Crosses SP at the time specified to eliminate highway congestion.

c.
Reports convoy location to unit CP.

d.
Conducts scheduled halt(s) at prescribed times and locations.

e.
Conducts unscheduled halt(s) when applicable.

f.
Conducts convoy under blackout conditions to minimize threat observation.

g.
Conducts self- and like-vehicle recovery operations.

6. Truck platoon conducts truck convoy defense.
a.
Defends against road blocked/not blocked.

b.
Defends against mines and booby traps.

c.
Defends against air attack.

d.
Defends against indirect fire and sniper fire.

e.
Crosses a radiologically contaminated area by the shortest route possible without receiving radiological casualties and spreading contamination.

f.
Crosses a chemically contaminated area by the shortest route possible without receiving chemical casualties and spreading contamination.

g.
Adjusts formation distances and speed consistent with NBC
conditions.

h.
Forwards SITREP to unit CP.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
7. Truck platoon reorganizes after attack.
a.
Treats casualties using current treatment procedures.

b.
Evacuates the casualties according to current MEDEVAC
procedures.

c.
Assesses vehicles and cargo to determine extent of damage.

d.
Removes critical items from unrecoverable equipment
according to special instructions for the motor vehicle driver.

e.
Redistributes ammunition to replace previous expended
rounds.

f.
Redistributes remaining drivers among existing equipment.

g.
Performs emergency destruction of inoperative equipment
upon receipt of authorization from convoy commander.

h.
Forwards destroyed vehicle location report to unit CP and
higher HQ staff element.

8. Truck platoon completes commitment.
a.
Arrives at the specified location at a designated time.

b.
Accounts for all personnel and equipment.

c.
Performs cargo accountability by transferring TCMD
between consignees.

d.
Uncouples or unloads cargo (whichever is applicable).

e.
Performs after-operation PMCS, if applicable.

f.
Picks up return (retrograde) loads as directed by unit CP.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
5-289
DODDOA-004053
Task Number
071-430-0008

551-721-1314
551-721-1352

551-721-1353
551-721-1356 551-721-1363
551-721-1371 551-721-1372 551-721-1373 551-721-1380
551-721-1381 551-721-1389 551-721-1408
551-721-1410 551-721-3336 551-721-3341 551-721-3342 551-721-3343 551-721-3348 551-721-3349
551-721-3350 551-721-3352
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS

Task Title
Reorganize a Platoon Following Enemy Contact While in the Defense Couple Semitrailer Perform Vehicle Preventive Maintenance Checks and Services (PMCS)
Perform Preventive Maintenance Checks and Services (PMCS) on a Trailer Prepare Vehicle for Blackout Operations Drive Vehicle With or Without Trailer/Semitrailer in Blackout Conditions
Perform Dispatcher Duties Assist in Loading Cargo and Equipment Onto Vehicle/Trailer or Semitrailer Assist in Unloading Cargo and Equipment Off Vehicle/Trailer or Semitrailer Transport General Cargo in Trailer/Semitrailer Assist in Loading Ammunition On a Transporter Self-Recovery Wheeled Vehicle Implement Defensive Procedures When Under Enemy Attack or Ambush in a Truck Convoy Operate a Vehicle in a Contaminated Area Enforce Driver Safety Rules and Techniques Supervise Personnel Loading Equipment and Cargo Onto Vehicle and Semitrailer Supervise Personnel Unloading Equipment and Cargo Off Vehicle Supervise Personnel Loading Ammunition On Vehicle, Trailer, and Semitrailer Perform Duties as Serial/March Unit Commander
Supervise Preparation of Vehicle for Tactical Operations Conduct a Convoy in an NBC Environment Direct Convoy Defense Operations
References
STP 21-24-SMCT
STP 55-88M12-SM STP 21-1-SMCT STP 55-88M12-SM
STP 55-88M12-SM
STP 55-88M12-SM STP 21-1-SMCT STP 55-88M12-SM
STP 55-88M12-SM STP 55-88M12-SM STP 55-88M12-SM STP 55-88M12-SM
STP 55-88M12-SM STP 55-88M12-SM STP 21-1-SMCT
STP 55-88M12-SM STP 55-88M34-SM-TG STP 55-88M34-SM-TG STP 55-88M34-SM-TG STP 55-88M34-SM-TG
STP 21-24-SMCT STP 55-88M34-SM-TG STP 55-88M34-SM-TG
STP 55-88M34-SM-TG STP 21-24-SMCT
Task Number Task Title References
551-721-4326 551-721-4327 Perform Duties as Convoy Commander Conduct Road Reconnaissance of Convoy Route STP 55-88M34-SM-TG STP 21-24-SMCT STP 55-88M34-SM-TG
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE

5-291
DODDOA-004055
ELEMENT: 6 Truck Squads
TASK: Transport Bulk Water (55-2-0040) (FM 55-30, AR 600-55, FM 10-115, FM 10-52, FM 21-305, FM 24-35, FM 24-35-1, FM 3-100, FM 3-19.30, FM 3-4, FM 3-5, FM 5-34, FM 5-170, FM 90-10, TM 5-5430-212-13&P, TM 5-5430-213-13&P)

ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M (circle)
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT T P U (circle)
CONDITIONS: Transportation commitments are received from unit HQ. The unit transporting is attached to a QM battalion (water supply). The unit and platoons are located in base(s). Platoons may or may not be collocated with the unit HQ. The platoons may operate in blackout conditions
and under conditions of limited visibility. The platoons may encounter Level I threat activity. The platoons may be subject to radiological fallout. This task is performed simultaneously with other tasks of the transport bulk water mission. This task may be conducted in a field or MOUT
environment. Some vehicles may already be committed for external transportation requirements.
Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Bulk water is transported to prescribed designation according to the unit
TSOP and operational instruction. NOTE: At MOPP 4, only those tasks deemed mission essential
by the commander are performed.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Convoy commander plans transport of bulk water.

a.
Calculates number of vehicles based on quantity of water to
be transported.

b.
Schedules convoy commander's briefing with higher HQ
staff element.

c.
Marks map with all pertinent information collected in the
higher HQ staff briefing.

d.
Prepares convoy commander's checklist for identifying all
convoy requirements.

e.
Conducts a map reconnaissance to select and mark routes
and sites not already designated by higher HQ staff element.

f.
Conducts a ground reconnaissance to attain additional route
information if time permits.

g.
Arranges fire support with higher HQ staff element.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
h.
Coordinates support requirements with escort and security elements, fire support, air cover, and communications.

i.
Establishes convoy organization that supports mission requirements.

j.
Identifies weapons and ammunition to carry for use in countering potential threat.

k.
Identifies material for hardening of vehicles for protecting personnel and cargo.

1. Identifies individual protective equipment to be worn.
m.
Establishes counterambush actions to take in the event of a hostile attack.

n.
Coordinates maintenance and recovery of disabled vehicles with maintenance section.

o.
Identifies actions to be taken at RP.

p.
Conducts convoy operations briefing with higher HQ staff element.

q.
Enforces safety procedures at all times.

2. Truck platoon prepares to transport bulk water.
a.
Performs PMCS on prime mover tractor to identify deficiencies and shortcomings.

b.
Repairs minor deficiencies before operating.

c.
Reports deficiencies beyond the operator's repair capability to the maintenance section.

d.
Couples prime mover (tractor to semitrailer) according to FM 21-305.

e.
Lays out the SMFT on the semitrailer.

f.
Performs PMCS on the SMFT according to applicable TM.

5-293
DODDOA-004057
_
-. -.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
g.
Fills SMFT with water. (Tank must be completely filled.)

h.
Ties down the SMFT.

i.
Secures SMFT tie-downs.

j.
Enforces safety procedures at all times.

3. Truck platoon organizes convoy for transportation commitment.
a.
Assigns vehicle positions, which minimize targets of opportunity.

b.
Positions pacesetter vehicle at the head of each march element.

c.
Positions recovery or bobtail vehicles at the rear of the convoy.

d.
Positions control vehicles without setting a pattern.

e.
Positions one hardened or armored vehicle near the head of the convoy.

f.
Positions remaining escort vehicles where they can provide maximum protection.

g.
Maintains communications with control vehicles. *4. Convoy commander conducts a final inspection.

a.
Inspects vehicle for compliance with appropriate TM and SOP.

b.
Inspects vehicle distribution and security of cargo according to the TM or SOP. (Tank must be completely filled.)

c.
Inspects personnel and their equipment for compliance with TSOP.

d.
Reports final inspection results to unit CP.

GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
5. Truck platoon executes transportation commitments.
a.
Conducts convoy commander's briefmg with platoon personnel.

b.
Crosses SP at the time specified to eliminate highway congestion.

c.
Reports convoy location to unit CP.

d.
Conducts scheduled halt(s) at prescribed time and location.

e.
Conducts unscheduled halt(s) when applicable.

f.
Conducts convoy under blackout conditions to minimize threat observation.

g.
Conducts self- and like-vehicle recovery operations.

6. Truck platoon conducts truck convoy defense.
a.
Defends against road blocked or not blocked.

b.
Defends against mines and booby traps.

c.
Defends against air attack.

d.
Defends against indirect fire and sniper fire.

e.
Crosses a radiologically contaminated area by the shortest route possible without receiving radiological casualties or spreading contamination.

f.
Crosses a chemically contaminated area by the shortest route possible without receiving chemical casualties or spreading contamination.

g.
Adjusts formation distances and speed consistent with NBC conditions.

h.
Forwards SITREP to unit CP.

5-295
DODDOA-004059
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
7. Truck platoon reorganizes after attack.
a.
Treats casualties according to the current treatment procedures.

b.
Evacuates the casualties according to the current MEDEVAC procedures.

c.
Assesses damage to vehicles and cargo to determine the extent of damage.

d.
Removes critical items from unrecoverable equipment according to special instructions for motor vehicle drivers.

e.
Redistributes ammunition to replace previously expended rounds.

f.
Redistributes remaining drivers among existing equipment.

g.
Performs emergency destruction of inoperative equipment upon receipt of authorization from convoy commander.

h.
Eorwards destroyed vehicle location report to unit CP and higher HQ staff element.

i.
Continues mission.

8. Truck platoon completes commitment.
a.
Arrives at the specified location at a designated time.

b.
Accounts for all personnel and equipment.

c.
Empties water from the SMFT unless the site is a dry water point.

d.
Folds up and stores the tank on and removes from the semitrailer.

e.
Uncouples semitrailer if the site is a dry water point.

f.
Performs cargo accountability by transferring TCMD between consignees.

DODDOA-004060
, _ .
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
g.
Performs after-operation PMCS if applicable.

h.
Picks up return (retrograde) loads as directed by unit CP.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK

ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS
Task Number Task Title References
071-430-0008 Reorganize a Platoon Following Enemy STP 21-24-SMCT
Contact While in the Defense 551-721-1314 Couple Semitrailer STP 55-88M 12-SM 551-721-1352 Perform Vehicle Preventive Maintenance STP 55-88M12-SM
Checks and Services (PMCS) 551-721-1359 Drive Vehicle in a Convoy STP 21-1-SMCT 551-721-1363 Drive Vehicle With or Without STP 21-1-SMCT
Trailer/Semitrailer in Blackout Conditions 551-721-1371 Perform Dispatcher Duties STP 55-88M12-SM 551-721-1380 Transport General Cargo in STP 55-88M12-SM
Trailer/Semitrailer
551-721-1408 Implement Defensive Procedures When STP 21-1-SMCT Under Enemy Attack or Ambush in a Truck Convoy
551-721-3334 Supervise Preventive Maintenance Checks STP 55-88M34-SM-TG and Services 551-721-3336 Enforce Driver Safety Rules and STP 55-88M34-SM-TG Techniques 551-721-3341 Supervise Personnel Loading Equipment STP 55-88M34-SM-TG and Cargo Onto Vehicle and Semitrailer 551-721-3348 Perform Duties as Serial/March Unit STP 21-24-SMCT Commander STP 55-88M34-SM-TG 551-721-3349 Supervise Preparation of Vehicle for STP 55-88M34-SM-TG Tactical Operations
5-297
_ _._
ARTEP 55-718-30-MTP
Task Number Task Title References
551-721-3350 551-721-3352 551-721-4326 551-721-4327 551-88M-0005 Conduct a Convoy in an NBC Environment Direct Convoy Defense Operations Perform Duties as Convoy Commander Conduct Road Reconnaissance of Convoy Route Operate a Vehicle in a Convoy STP 55-88M34-SM-TG STP 21-24-SMCT STP 21-24-SMCT STP 55-88M34-SM-TG STP 21-1-SMCT
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE

ELEMENT: 6 Truck Squads
TASK:.Transport Bulk Petroleum (55-2-0041) (FM 10-67-1, FM 10-67, FM 24-35, FM 24-35-1, FM 3-4, FM 3-5, FM 55-30, FM 90-10, TM 9-2330-356-14)
.
1 2 3 4 5 M (circle)
ITERATION
.

COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT T P U (circle)
CONDITIONS: Transportation commitments are received from unit headquarters. Transportation operations may be conducted in a field or MOUT environment. Some vehicles may already be committed for external transportation requirements. Personnel and cargo are transported from one location to another during day or night or through urban areas. Platoons may be required to perform special support operations and to transport hazardous cargo. Convoy may encounter a hostile attack or cross an NBC contaminated area. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Bulk petroleum is transported to prescribed designation according to unit TSOP and operational instructions. NOTE: At MOPP-4, only those tasks deemed mission essential by the commander are performed.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Convoy commander plans transport of bulk petroleum.

a.
Identifies requirements for transporting specific types of
cargo.

b.
Schedules convoy commander's briefing with higher HQ
staff element.

c.
Marks map with all pertinent information collected in the
higher HQ staff elemert briefing.

d.
Prepares convoy commander's checklist for use in
identifying all convoy requirements.

e.
Conducts a map reconnaissance to select and mark routes
and sites not already designated by higher HQ staff element.

f.
Conducts a ground reconnaissance to obtain additional route
information if time permits.

g.
Arranges fire support with higher HQ staff element.

h.
Coordinates support requirements with escort and security
elements, fire support, air cover, and communications.

i.
Establishes convoy organization that supports mission
requirements.

5-299
DODDOA-004063
GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
j.
Identifies weapons and ammunition to carry for use in countering potential threat.

k.
Identifies material for hardening of vehicles for the protection of personnel and cargo.

1. Identifies individual protective equipment to be worn.
m.
Establishes counter ambush actions to take in the event of a hostile attack.

n.
Coordinates maintenance and recovery of disabled vehicles with maintenance section.

o.
Identifies actions to be taken at RP.

p.
Conducts convoy operations briefing with higher HQ staff element.

q.
Enforces safety procedures at all times.

2. Truck platoon prepares to transport bulk petroleum.
a.
Performs PMCS on vehicles to identify deficiencies and shortcomings according to the applicable TM.

b.
Repairs minor deficiencies before operating.

c.
Reports deficiencies that are beyond the operator's repair capability to the maintenance section.

d.
Couples prime mover (trailer) to fuel tanker according to the applicable TM.

e.
Loads cargo without exceeding vehicle capability.

f.
Secures cargo according to the unit TSOP.

g.
Secures payload tie-downs (when applicable).

h.
Obtains a copy of a completed motor vehicle inspection
checklist, hazardous cargo only.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
i.
Signs for cargo and obtains copies of TCMD.

j.
Positions hazardous cargo placards (HAZARDOUS CARGO ONLY).

3. Truck platoon organizes convoy for transportation commitment).
a.
Assigns vehicle positions, which minimize targets of opportunity.

b.
Positions pacesetter vehicle at the head of each march element.

c.
Positions recovery or bobtail vehicles at the rear of the convoy.

d.
Positions control vehicles without setting a pattern.

e.
Positions one hardened or armored vehicle near the head of the convoy.

f.
Positions remaining escort vehicles where they can provide maximum protection.

g.
Maintains communications with control vehicles. *4. Convoy commander conducts a final inspection.

a.
Inspects vehicle for compliance with the appropriate TM and TSOP.

b.
Inspects vehicle loads for compliance with TSOP.

c.
Inspects placement of fuel placards.

d.
Inspects personnel and their equipment for compliance with TSOP.

e.
Reports final inspection results to the unit CP.

5. Truck platoon executes transportation commitments.
a.
Conducts convoy commander's briefing with platoon personnel.

b.
Crosses SP at the time specified to eliminate highway congestion.

ARTEP 55-718-30-MTP GO NO GO

5-301
DODDOA-004065
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
c.
Reports convoy location to unit CP.

d.
Conducts scheduled halt(s) at prescribed time and location.

e.
Conducts unscheduled halt(s) whenever applicable.

f.
Conducts convoy under blackout conditions to minimize threat observation.

g.
Conducts self- and like-vehicle recovery operations.

6. Truck platoon conducts truck convoy defense.
a.
Defends against road blocked or not blocked.

b.
Defends against mines and booby traps.

c.
Defends against air attack.

d.
Defends against indirect fire and sniper fire.

e.
Crosses a radiologically contaminated area by the shortest route possible without receiving radiological casualties or spreading contamination.

f.
Crosses a chemically contaminated area by the shortest route possible without receiving chemical casualties or spreading contamination.

g.
Adjusts formation distances and speed consistent with NBC conditions.

h.
Forwards SITREP to unit CP.

7. Truck platoon reorganizes after attack.
a.
Treats casualties according to the current treatment procedures.

b.
Evacuates the casualties to the nearest medical or collection facility according to current MEDEVAC procedures.

c.
Assesses damage to vehicles and cargo to determine the extent of damage.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
d.
Removes critical items from unrecoverable equipment
according to the special instructions for motor vehicle drivers.

e.
Redistributes ammunition to replace previously expended
rounds.

f.
Redistributes remaining drivers among existing equipment.

g.
Performs emergency destruction of inoperative equipment
upon receipt of authorization from convoy commander.

h.
Forwards destroyed vehicle location report to unit CP and
higher HQ staff element.

8. Truck platoon completes commitment.
a.
Arrives at the specified location at a designated time.

b.
Accounts for all personnel and equipment.

c.
Performs cargo accountability by transferring TCMD
between consignees.

d.
Uncouples or unloads tanker (whichever is applicable).

e.
Performs after-operation PMCS if applicable.

f.
Picks up return (retrograde) loads as directed by the unit CP.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
5-303
DODDOA-004067
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS

Task Number Task Title References
551-721-1352 Perform Vehicle Preventive Maintenance STP 21-1-SMCT
Checks and Services (PMCS)
551-721-1356 Prepare Vehicle for Blackout Operations STP 55-88M12-SM
551-721-1359 Drive Vehicle in a Convoy STP 21-1-SMCT
551-721-1363 Drive Vehicle With or Without STP 21-1-SMCT
Trailer/Semitrailer in Blackout Conditions
551-721-1408 Implement Defensive Procedures When STP 21-1-SMCT
Under Enemy Attack or Ambush in a Truck
Convoy
551-721-3336 Enforce Driver Safety Rules and STP 55-88M34-SM-TG
Techniques
551-721-3348 Perform Duties as Serial/March Unit STP 21-24-SMCT
Commander
551-721-3349 Supervise Preparation of Vehicle for STP 55-88M34-SM-TG
Tactical Operations
551-721-3350 Conduct a Convoy in an NBC Environment STP 55-88M34-SM-TG
551-721-3352 Direct Convoy Defense Operations STP 21-24-SMCT
551-721-4326 Perform Duties as Convoy Commander STP 21-24-SMCT
551-88M-0005 Operate a Vehicle in a Convoy STP 21-1-SMCT

SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
ELEMENT: Company Headquarters
TASK:.Provide Human Resources Support (63-2-4015) (AR 600-8-104, AR 220-1, AR 380-5, AR 600-8-1, AR 600-8-19, AR 600-8-2, FM 12-6, STP 21-24-SMCT)
.
M.(circle)
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5..
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT T P U (circle)
CONDITIONS: The higher HQ Si requires a personnel daily summary report. The unit has
analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD, the unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. The unit HQ is required to continuously support combat operations over a prolonged period of time. Unit personnel may have been killed, wounded, captured, and/or missing. Replacements are arriving and administrative issues need to be resolved. The tactical situation allows time for personnel and administrative actions. This task is performed simultaneously with other support and operational tasks. Field-expedient and natural shelters are available. This task is performed under all day and night environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and all levels of threat forces attacks. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Personnel and administrative support services are provided as prescribed by TSOP and OPORD. At MOPP4, personnel and administrative support is reduced to minimal essential actions.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
1. Unit HQ processes casualty reports.
a.
Maintains situational awareness using analog and/or digital
communications.

b.
Verifies reports for completeness and accuracy.

c.
Forwards 100 percent accurate reports and witness
statements to higher HQ staff element within 24 hours of incident using
analog and/or digital communications.

d.
Updates unit battle roster to reflect 100 percent accuracy.

5-305
DOEM0A-004069
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
2. Unit HQ performs strength accounting.
a.
Consolidates elements' personnel status reports.

b.
Forwards personnel status report to the higher HQ staff element NLT time specified in the OPORD and TSOP using analog and/or digital communications.

c.
Updates battle roster to reflect 100 percent accuracy.

3. Unit HQ performs equipment status reporting.
a.
Consolidates elements' equipment status reports.

b.
Forwards equipment status reports to higher HQ staff element NLT time specified in the OPORD and TSOP using analog and/or digital communications.

4. Unit HQ processes replacements.
a.
Inspects all replacement personnel for proper weapons, • MOPP gear, equipment, clothing, and shot records.

b.
Briefs replacements on tactical situation.

c.
Briefs replacements on chain of command and specific duties.

d.
Issues required supplies and equipment.

e.
Escorts unit replacements to assigned area.

f.
Records replacement data on battle reports.

g.
Coordinates transportation for movement of replacement individuals for supported unit to the gaining activity using analog and/or digital communications.

h.
Coordinates with support medical element for required immunizations using analog and/or digital communications.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
5. Unit HQ provides administrative support.
a.
Forwards 100 percent accurate personnel and finance support requests to higher HQ staff element within 24 hours using analog and/or digital communications.

b.
Coordinates UCMJ actions with the battalion legal clerk using analog and/or digital communications.

c.
Administers unit awards program LAW procedures prescribed in the higher HQ TSOP.

d.
Provides unit-level mail service as prescribed by appropriate regulations and unit TSOP.

e.
Maintains classified materials IAW appropriate regulations.

6. Unit HQ implements microcomputer and ULC security procedures (Digital Units Only).
a.
Establishes "controlled access" procedures to ULC and microcomputer area(s).

b.
Restricts access to computers by use of classified passwords.

c.
Rotates operator passwords every 30 days or earlier if compromise is suspected.

d.
Monitors ULC and microcomputers for proper usage.

e.
Establishes computer report distribution procedures.

7. Unit HQ provides health, welfare, and morale support.
a.
Coordinates for the distribution of specialty packs and sundry items JAW higher HQ OPORD and TSOP using analog and/or digital communications.

b.
Monitors unit field feeding for compliance with the TSOP.

c.
Monitors unit sleep and rest plan for compliance with the TSOP.

d.
Supervises physical conditioning program.

5-307
DODDOA-004071
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
e.
Coordinates laundry and shower exchange support with the
S4 section using analog and/or digital communications.

f.
Coordinates for religious activity support using analog and/or
digital communications.

g.
Disseminates health, welfare, and morale support
information to all subelements using analog and/or digital
communications.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
ITERATION 1
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"s" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS
Task Number Task Title References
081-831-0102 Supervise Unit Preventive Medicine and STP 21-24-SMCT Field Sanitation Procedures 121-030-3534 Report Casualties STP 21-24-SMCT
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
---
TASK:.Combat Battlefield Stress (63 -2-4303) (FM 2251, FM 10014, FM 622.5)
ITERATION. 1 2 3 4 5 M (circle) .
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT T P U (circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit has been involved in operations over a prolonged period of time and personnel are exhibiting signs of battlefield stress. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD, unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. The commander has directed that battlefield stress management procedures be implemented. The unit's sleep plan and TSOP to manage BF soldiers has been developed. Personnel have been cross-trained on critical tasks. This task is performed under all day and night environment conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and all levels of threat forces attack. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Unit applies techniques that counter battlefield stress. Techniques used prevent degradation of morale, training, and physical condition of unit personnel.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO *1. Commander and leaders perform stress prevention leader actions.
a.
Issue warning orders, OPORDs, and FRAGOs to the lowest
possible level using analog and/or digital communications.

b.
Provide soldiers an accurate assessment of the friendly and
enemy situation.

c.
Brief leaders' intention to all unit personnel.

d.
Speak positively concerning the unit's missions, purpose, and
abilities.

e.
Encourage a positive attitude throughout the unit.

f.
Institute an information dissemination plan designed to quell
and prevent rumors.

5-309
DODDOA-004073
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
g.
Inform personnel of availability of religious support.

h.
Implement buddy system to observe signs of stress or BF among the soldiers and leaders.

*2. Commander and leaders implement sleep plan.
a.
Provide a safe and secure area away from vehicles and other high-noise activities.

b.
Adjust sleep plan as dictated by tactical situation.

c.
Enforce the sleep plan JAW the TSOP. *3. Leaders implement task rotation or restructuring procedures.

a.
Alternate cross-trained unit personnel on critical tasks, as required.

b.
Rotate unit personnel between demanding and non-demanding tasks. •

c.
Assign two soldiers to function independently on tasks requiring a high degree of accuracy.

d.
Adjust task rotation policies and procedures to the tactical situation.

*4. Leaders implement stress-coping and management techniques.
a.
Integrate new unit members into the unit immediately.

b.
Assist soldiers in resolving family/home-related problems.

c.
Provide instruction on relaxation technique to all personnel prior to deployment.

d.
Conduct routine after-action stress debriefings.

e.
Conduct unit award, decoration, recognition and memorial ceremonies.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*5. Commander and leaders implement stress control techniques.
a.
Implement a plan to deal with mild, seriously stressed, or BF
cases.

b.
Assign soldiers who show signs of stress or BF to simple
tasks.

c.
Direct personnel to be supportive of BF or stressed soldiers.

d.
Refer soldiers showing signs of serious stress or BF to
supporting MTF for medical evaluation. .

...._
e. Reintegrate RTD soldiers into their specific element.
6. Unit personnel employ stress prevention measures.
a.
Maintain a positive attitude concerning the unit's mission,
purpose, and abilities.

b.
Comply with the commander's sleep plan.

c.
Identify other soldiers with signs of stress or BF.

d.
Provide immediate buddy aid support.

e.
Report signs of stress or BF in other soldiers to immediate
supervisor.

f.
Accept new unit members immediately.

g.
Practice relaxation techniques at appropriate times and
places.

h.
Participate in buddy system and after-action stress
debriefings.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
5-311

DODDOA-004075
CHAPTER 6
EXTERNAL EVALUATION
6-1. GENERAL. An external evaluation is conducted to evaluate the unit's ability to perform its critical wartime mission. This chapter is a guide for preparing an external evaluation. The unit may modify the evaluation, as deemed appropriate by the commander, based on METT-T and other considerations. The unit will be evaluated using standards of selected T&EOs contained in Chapter 5 of this MTP. The evaluation will evaluate the total unit. The evaluation should employ the use of a realistic OPFOR and the use of MILES. At the completion of the evaluation, the • commander should be able to identify the strengths and weaknesses of the unit which can form the basis for future training and resource allocation.
6-2. PREPARING THE EVALUATION. To ensure that the evaluations accurately measure unit capabilities, the commander must standardize evaluation procedures.
a. Preparing the Evaluation Instrument. The sample evaluation scenario outlined in Figure 6-1, pages 6-2 and 6-3, contains the missions as well as the appropriate tasks necessary to develop and execute the evaluation. Since it is not possible or desirable to evaluate every task, selective tailoring is required. The following procedures should be considered when developing the evaluation.
(1) Based on previous training guidance, identify the missions to be evaluated, using Table 2-1 in this MTP. Record the selected missions on the Unit Proficiency Worksheet,
.
Figure 6-2, page 6-4.
(2)
List each mission on a separate Task Summary Sheet (see Figure 6-3, page 6­5; Figure 6-4, pages 6-6 and 6-7; Figure 6-5, pages 6-8 and 6-9; Figure 6-6, pages 6-10 and 6-11; Figure 6-7, page 6-12; and Figure 6-8, page 6-13).

(3)
Select the tasks to be evaluated in the performance of every mission. List the selected tasks on the Task Summary Sheet. The evaluators use these sheets to record the results of the evaluation.

(4)
Compile the selected missions and tasks in the order that they will logically occur in the detailed scenario. Group the selected missions and tasks in modules, as shown in Figure 6-1, to allow for continuous operations which can be interrupted at logical points for assessment of casualties and the conduct of in-progress AAR.

b.
Forecasting and Requisitioning Resources. Depending on the evaluation, adequate training, ammunition, equipment, and supplies must be forecasted and requisitioned. A consolidated list of support requirements for this evaluation is at Table 6-1, page 6-14. This consolidated listing is the result of experience with the scenario presented in Figure 6-1. The evaluating HQ will have to prepare its own consolidated support list.

6-1
(
EVENT ACTION DURATION TIME FRAME
1. Conduct • re-evaluation action 8 hr Before start
2. Receive warnin: order 1 hr Da 1, 0600
MODULE 1
3. Develo s dis • lacement • Ian 40 min 0640
4. Coordinate sus sort r •uirements 20 min 0700
5. lat iligiwallill 10 mm 0710
6. Conduct reconnaissance 1 hr 15 min 0825
7. Brief suarterin: mart 15 min 0840
8. Dis • atch • uarterin: 'art 5 min 0845
9. Conduct convo
10. Pr -.are vehicles and - • uisment 50 min 0935
11. Dismantle oseration site 40 min 1015
12. Conduct AAR 30 min 1045
_ 1105
13. Or . anize convo 20 min
14. Brief convo • ersonnel 15 min 1120
15. Cross SP 10 min 1130
16. Conduct convo 45 min 1215
17. Cross contaminated area 45 min 1300
18. Threat interdiction 30 min 1330
19. Conduct AAR 30 min 1400
20. Continue convo 45 min 1445
21. Cross RP 15 min 1500
22. Conduct AAR 30 min 1530
MODULE 2
23. Pr-.are area for occusanc 3 hr 1830
24. Conduct AAR 30 min 1900
25. Establish initial communications 30 min 1930
26. Escort convo elements to new area 45 min 2015
27. Establish unit defense 1 hr 15 min 2130
28. Set-us unit heads uarters and o.eratin' site 5 hr 0125
29. Conduct AAR 30 min 0155
MODULE 3 Da _, 0800
*30. Receive/issue trans • ortation re. uest 1 hr 0900 *31. Or• anize • latoons for mission 30 min 0930
32. Provide truck trans sortation services
Figure 6-1. Sample evaluation scenario
DODDOA-004077
EVENT ACTION DURATION TIME FRAME

MODULE 3 (continued)
33. Conduct AAR 30 min 1000 *34. Perform personnel and administrative support *35. Perform health and welfare measures *36. Perform unit-level maintenance *37. Perform internal supply
38. Level I attack occurs 30 min 1030
39. NBC attack occurs 45 min 1115
40. Perform decontamination and monitor operations 1 hr 30 min 1245
41. Conduct AAR 30 min 1315
MODULE 4 Day 3, 0800
42. Receive alert message 15 min 0815
43. Occupy fighting positions 10 min 0825
44. Assemble reaction forces 15 min 0840
45. Detect threat 5 min 0845
46. Increase perimeter manning 10 min 0855
47. Receive threat indirect fire 15 min 0910
48. Engage threat 1 hr 1010
49. Request indirect fire or CAS 15 min 1025
50. Adjust defense 50 min 1115
51. Reorganize defense 35 min 1150
52. Disengage threat 10 min 1200
53. Conduct AAR 30 min 1230
54. Hand over battle to TCF/MPs 30 min 1300
55. Conduct AAR 30 min 1330
56. Reorganize unit 30 min 1400
57. Conduct ADC 45 min 1445
58. Conduct hasty displacement 1 hr 1545
59. Move to AAR site and conduct final AAR 3 hr 1845
TOTAL ESTIMATED TIME:46 hours 08 min
*Event occurs simultaneously with other events.
NOTE: Events will be performed to standards, not time limitations. The time to train an event will vary based on METT-T factors and the training proficiency of the Transportation Motor Transport Companies.
Figure 6-1. Sample evaluation scenario (continued)
6-3

UNIT PROFICIENCY WORKSHEET
.
UNIT EVALUATION
MISSION
Deploy Unit to a New Theater of Operations . GO NO GO
Relocate Unit to a New Operating Site
Establish Unit Area of Operations
Provide Truck Transportation
Defend Assigned Area
Redeploy Unit to Home Station
Evaluator's Comments:

Evaluator's Signature Figure 62. Suggested format for unit proficiency worksheet
-
DODDOA-004079
_._ _
TASK SUMMARY SHEET
MISSION: Deploy Unit to a New Theater of Operations
.
T&EO EVALUATION
TASK NUMBER GO NO GO
Perform Deployment Alert Activities 63-2-4801 Perform Personnel and Administrative Predeployment Activities 63-2-4802 Perform Predeployment Training Activities 63-2-4803 Perform Predeployment Supply Activities 63-2-4804 Perform Predeployment Maintenance Activities 63-2-4805 Prepare Vehicles and Equipment for Deployment 63-2-4806 Prepare Unit for Nontactical Move 63-2-4807 Conduct Nontactical Road March 63-2-4808 Perform Sea Port of Embarkation Activities for Deployment 63-2-4809 Perform Aerial Port of Embarkation Activities for Deployment 63-2-4810 Perform Aerial Port of Debarkation Activities for Deployment 63-2-4811 Perform Sea Port of Debarkation Activities for Deployment 63-2-4812 Prepare Equipment Reception Team for Tactical Road March 63-2-4813 Perform Demobilization Station Activities 63-2-4824 Conduct Integration Activities 63-2-4825 Conduct Staging Activities 63-2-4826 Employ Operations Security Measures 63-2-4016 Employ Physical Security Measures 63-2-4306 Combat Battlefield Stress 63-2-4303 Perform Risk Management Procedures 63-2-4326 Plan Unit Mobilization in a Peacetime Environment 63-2-4827 Plan Unit Deployment Activities Upon Receipt of a Warning Order 63-2-4828
TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"
Evaluator's Signature
Figure 6-3. Task summary sheet, deploy unit to a new theater of operations
6-5
DODDOA-004080
TASK SUMMARY SHEET
MISSION: Relocate Unit to a New Operating Site
TASK
Prepare Unit to Move Conduct Tactical Road March Perform Advance/Quartering Party Activities Use Passive Air Defense Measures Take Active Air Defense Measures Against Hostile Aircraft Cross a Radiologically Contaminated Area Defend Convoy Elements Employ Operations Security Measures Perform Operational Decontamination Perform Thorough Decontamination Respond to the Initial Effects of a Nuclear Attack Cross a Chemically Contaminated Area Employ Physical Security Measures Respond to a Chemical Attack Treat Casualties Transport Personnel and Cargo Combat Battlefield Stress Process Enemy Prisoners of War Process Captured Documents and Equipment Transport Casualties Perform Risk Management Procedures Perform Unit-Level Maintenance Plan Unit Move
T&EO NUMBER EVALUATION
GO.NO GO
63-2-4002 63-2-4003 63-2-4008 63-2-4307 63-2-4308 63-2-4005 63-2-4006 63-2-4016 63-2-4018 63-2-4019 63-2-4020 63-2-4226 63-2-4306 63-2-4334 08-2-0003.63-0001 55-2-0011 63-2-4303 63-2-4304 63-2-4305 63-2-4316 63-2-4326 63-2-4552 63-2-4001
Figure 6-4. Task summary sheet, relocate to a new operating site
-
-
-
TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
ITERATION
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

Evaluator's Signature
Figure 6-4. Task summary sheet, relocate to a new operating site (continued)
6-7
TASK SUMMARY SHEET

MISSION: Establish Unit Area of Operations
.
T&EO.EVALUATION
TASK NUMBER GO.NO GO
Perform Advance/Quartering Party Activities 63-2-4008 Occupy New Operating Site 63-2-4009 Use Passive Air Defense Measures 63-2-4307 Take Active Air Defense Measures Against Hostile Aircraft 63-2-4308 Set Up Truck Platoon 55-2-0007 Set Up Unit Defense 63-2-4011 Prepare Unit for Nuclear, Biological, and Chemical Conditions 63-2-4013 Employ Operations Security Measures 63-2-4016 Respond to the Initial Effects of a Nuclear Attack 63-2-4020 Prepare Unit for Level MI Threat 63-2-4022 Employ Physical Security Measures 63-2-4306 Set Up Unit Headquarters and Bivouac Areas 63-2-4518 Treat Casualties 08-0003.63-0001 Supervise Maintenance Platoon Operations 43-2-4535 Set Up Maintenance Platoon Headquarters and Sections 43-2-4570 Provide Personnel and Administrative Support 63-2-4015 Combat Battlefield Stress 63-2-4303 Process Enemy Prisoners of War 63-2-4304 Process Captured Documents and Equipment 63-2-4305 Perform Field Sanitation Functions 63-2-4315 Transport Casualties 63-2-4316 Perform Risk Management Procedures 63-2-4326 Perform Unit-Level Maintenance 63-2-4552 Supervise Truck Platoon Operations 55-2-0010 Plan Occupation of New Area of Operations 63-2-4007 Plan Unit Defense 63-2-4010 Plan Area Damage Control Operations 63-2-4014 Maintain Communications 63-2-4017 Establish Communications 63-2-4040
Figure 6-5. Task summary sheet, establish area of operations
TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
1 2 3 4 5 M TOTALITERATION
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO" TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"
Evaluator's Signature
Figure 65. Task summary sheet, establish area of operations (continued)
-
6-9
DODDOA-004084
TASK SUMMARY SHEET
MISSION: Provide Truck Transportation
TASK
Conduct Tactical Road March Use Passive Air Defense Measures Take Active Air Defense Measures Against Hostile Aircraft Cross a Radiologically Contaminated Area Defend Convoy Elements Employ Operations Security Measures Perform Operational Decontamination Respond to the Initial Effects of a Nuclear Attack Cross a Chemically Contaminated Area Employ Physical Security Measures Respond to a Chemical Attack Treat Casualties Perform Maintenance Control Functions Provide Repair Parts Supply Support Perform Recovery Operations Maintain Records and Publications Perform Controlled Exchange of Repair Parts Perform Combat Repair Teams Functions Supervise Maintenance Platoon Operations Transport Personnel and Cargo Transport Dry and Refrigerated Containerized Cargo Transport Bulk Water Transport Bulk Petroleum Combat Battlefield Stress Process Enemy Prisoners of War Process Captured Documents and Equipment Transport Casualties Perform Risk Management Procedures Provide Unit Supply Support Perform Unit-Level Maintenance Provide Command and Control of Transportation Operations Supervise Truck Platoon Operations Maintain ITV, Redirect Operators, and Provide Commitments Using MTS Maintain Communications
T&EO NUMBER EVALUATION
GO.NO GO
63-2-4003 63-2-4307 63-2-4308 63-2-4005 63-2-4006 63-2-4016 63-2-4018 63-2-4020 63-2-4226 63-2-4306 63-2-4334 08-2-0003.63-0001 43-2-0050 43-2-0096 43-2-4071 43-2-4392 43-2-4394 43-2-4508 43-2-4535 55-2-0011 55-2-0038 55-2-0040 55-3-0041 63-2-4303 63-2-4304 63-2-4305 63-2-4316 63-2-4326 63-2-4515 63-2-4552 55-2-0009 55-3-0010 55-2-0016
63-2-4017
Figure 6-6. Task summary sheet, provide truck transportation
DODDOA-004085
TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

Evaluator's Signature
Figure 6-6. Task summary sheet, provide truck transportation (continued)
6-11
TASK SUMMARY SHEET

MISSION: Defend Assigned Area
TASK
Use Passive Air Defense Measures Take Active Air Defense Measures Against Hostile Aircraft Employ Operations Security Measures Respond to the Initial Effects of a Nuclear Attack Defend Against a Level I Attack Conduct Hasty Displacement Defend Unit Area Perform Withdrawal Under Fire Reorganize Unit Defense Execute Battle Handover Perform Area Damage Control Functions Employ Physical Security Measures Respond to a Chemical Attack Destroy Supplies and Equipment Treat Casualties Perform Unit Mortuary Affairs Operations Combat Battlefield Stress Process Enemy Prisoners of War Process Captured Documents and Equipment Transport Casualties Perform Risk Management Procedures Plan Unit Defense
T&EO NUMBER EVALUATION
GO.NO GO
63-2-4307 63-2-4308 63-2-4016 63-2-4020 63-2-4021 63-2-4023 63-2-4024 63-2-4025 63-2-4026 63-2-4027 63-2-4028 63-2-4306 63-2-4334 63-2-4522 08-2-0003.63-0001
10-2-4513 63-2-4303 63-2-4304 63-2-4305 63-2-4316 63-2-4326 63-2-4010
TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

Evaluator's Signature
Figure 6-7. Task summary sheet, defend assigned area
TASK SUMMARY SHEET
MISSION: Redeploy Unit to Home Station
.
T&EO EVALUATION
TASK NUMBER
GO NO GO
Conduct Tactical Road March 63-2-4003' Prepare Unit for Nontactical Move 63-2-4807 Conduct Nontactical Road March 63-2-4808 Perform Redeployment Personnel and Administrative Actions 63-2-4814 Perform Redeployment Training Activities 63-2-4815 Perform Redeployment Supply Activities 63-2-4816 Perform Redeployment Maintenance Activities 63-2-4817 Prepare Vehicles and Equipment for Redeployment 63-2-4818 Perform Sea Port of Embarkation Activities for 63-2-4819 Redeployment Perform Aerial Port of Embarkation Activities for 63-2-4820 Redeployment Perform Aerial Port of Debarkation Activities for 63-2-4821 Redeployment
Perform Home Station Activities 63-2-4822 Perform Sea Port of Debarkation Activities for Redeployment 63-2-4823 Perform Demobilization Station Activities 63-2-4824 Employ Operations Security Measures . 63-2-4016 Employ Physical Security Measures 63-2-4306 Combat Battlefield Stress 63-2-4303 Perform Risk Management Procedures 63-2-4326 Plan Unit Move 63-2-4001 Plan Unit Redeployment 63-2-4829
TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

Evaluator's Signature
Figure 68. Task summary sheet, redeploy to new area of operations
-
6-13
DODDOA-004088
Table 6-1. Consolidated support requirements

AMMUNITION BASIC LOAD
5.56-mm SAW (blank) 150 rounds/wpn
5.56-mm (blank) 30 rounds/wpn
7.62-mm (blank) 100 rounds/wpn
.40-mm (blank) 192 rounds/wpn
.45 cal (blank) 30 rounds/wpn
50 cal (blank) 100 rounds/wpn
Blank adapter 1 set/wpn
Miles 1 set/wpn
Smoke grenades 4 unit
2 OPFOR
ATWESS 2 per LAW
FUEL

Multiply the pieces of equipment times the amount of fuel per mile or hour times the tentative operating mileage or hour.
NBC EQUIPMENT
AN/ODR-TI (Radiac Set) 1 each M72A2 Chemical Stimulant 2 each CS Grenades 3 each IM 174 Radiac Meter 4 each IM 93/UD Dosimeter 3 each
OTHER
MREs 3 per man, per day War wound moulage set 1 each Aircraft for simulated air attack 1 each Fire Marker Control System (when available)
c.
Selecting and Preparing the Field Evaluation Site. When selecting an evaluation site, consider size, type of terrain, OPFOR requirement, and administrative requirements. For this evaluation, an area measuring 1.5 by 1.5 kilometers was selected. The OPFOR positioning is according to the Soviet doctrine. In addition, the site provides for the establishment of an administrative area required to support the evaluation.

d.
Planning Indirect Fire Simulation. Indirect fire weapons greatly influence the outcome of battles. Reaction to indirect fire is an important consideration of the evaluation. Indirect fire simulation requires a considerable amount of planning to achieve the desired realism.

(1) The fire marker control system outlined in TC 25-6 is a recommended method of simulating indirect fire. However, this method may be difficult to support due to the amount of resources required.
DODDOA-004089
(2) The unit may use the evaluation control HQ method or the simulation without OPFOR method of evaluating the unit's ability to react to indirect fire. If the evaluation control HQ method is used, the OPFOR will make a call for fire to the evaluation control HQ which would simulate the tactical FDC. The control HQ would then relay the delivery data to the evaluators who would mark the impact of the round with artillery simulators and assess appropriate casualties. If an OPFOR is not used, the evaluator may simply ignite artillery simulators and observe the unit's reactions. FM 25-4 provides assessment and computation tables which may be used to determine casualties. Indirect fire simulation must be realistic and limited to what the unit could reasonably expect under combat conditions.
6-3. SELECTING THE EVALUATORS.
a.
Evaluators must know the unit missions, organization, equipment, and employment. Evaluators should be at least equal in grade to the rank of the company commander and subordinate leaders. They should have performed previously in that specific or similar TOE position.

b.
The following are desired minimum rank and experience requirements for evaluators:

(1)
Unit evaluator. This will be an officer (captain) with company commander experience.

(2)
Platoon evaluators. This will be a lieutenant or NCO with platoon leader experience.

(3)
Recorder. This will be an officer or NCO at the evaluation control HQ to receive "kill" information/results and time data from the evaluators.

(4)
OPFOR team leader. The OPFOR team leader is also considered an evaluator in that he must provide input for the unit evaluators.

6-4. TRAINING THE EVALUATORS. To ensure standardized administration of the evaluation, evaluators must understand three functional areas.
a.
Evaluation Design. Each module is designed to evaluate specific critical missions or tasks within the overall scenario. The evaluators must know the evaluation thoroughly and precisely to implement it correctly.

b.
Equipment and Weapons. Each evaluator, regardless of position, must have full knowledge of the unit weapons and equipment. It is the unit's responsibility to ensure that all equipment is functional before each evaluation module is performed.

6-15
c. Evaluation Control System. The evaluation control system is used to ensure that the evaluation is administered in a consistent and standardized manner and that correct data is collected for the final evaluation. It includes the following elements:
(1)
Rules of engagement.

(2)
Evaluator duties and responsibilities.

(3)
The communication system.

(4)
Evaluation data collection plan.

d.
Safety. During any training event, all soldiers and leaders must be safety conscious. Evaluators must ensure that all events are conducted within established safety constraints. Prior to the beginning of each event, all personnel will be briefed on specific safety measures that are to be taken during execution.

6-5. RECORDING EXTERNAL EVALUATION INFORMATION.
a.
The evaluating HQ develops the data recording instruments for the evaluators. The Unit Data Sheet (Figure 6-9) presents demographic information, which may reflect on the unit's performance. The Environmental Data Sheet (Figure 6-10, page 6-18) presents weather information so that a comparison of missions conducted under differing environmental conditions can be made. The Personnel and Equipment Loss Report (Figure 6-11, page, 6-19) presents information which reflects on the unit's degree of success during engagements with the OPFOR.

b.
The senior evaluator has overall responsibility for preparation of the external evaluation. He accomplishes this through the input provided to him by the subordinate evaluators in each of their respective areas. Subordinate evaluators use the task evaluation criteria (T&EOs from Chapter 5 and Task Summary Sheet) to determine overall proficiency in their particular areas. However the senior evaluator must compile the external evaluation results as prescribed by the evaluating HQ commander. Deviations from the mission/task accomplishment standard assessed by the unit evaluator may be addressed in the senior evaluator comments portion of the mission accomplishment summary.

UNIT DATA SHEET
1.
UNIT DESIGNATION: .

2.
UNIT LEADERS: (Circle most correct answer)

POSITION RANK TIME IN UNIT (MONTHS)
COMMANDER CPT 1LT 1-3 3-6 6-12 12-18 more 1SG MSG SFC 1-3 3-6 6-12 12-18 more PLT LDR 1LT 2LT •.1-3 3-6 6-12 12-18 more PLT SGT SFC SSG 1-3 3-6 6-12 12-18 more SQD/SEC LDR SSG SGT 1-3 3-6 6-12 12-18 more
3.
UNIT STRENGTH (excluding leaders): .

4.
EQUIPMENT SHORTAGE (List major items):

Figure 6-9. Suggested format for unit data sheet
6-17
DODD0A-004092
ENVIRONMENTAL DATA SHEET
MODULE NUMBER AND DESCRIPTIONS: . DATE/TIME MODULE STARTED: . DATE/TIME MODULE ENDED: .
1.
WEATHER CONDITIONS: (Circle appropriate description) Clear, Partly Cloudy, Cloudy, Hazy, Raining, Snowing, Fog Other (Describe): . Temperature: .

2.
GROUND CONDITIONS: (Circle appropriate description.) Dry.Wet Ice Snow Other: .

3.
LIGHT CONDITIONS: (Circle appropriate description.)

A. Day.Night
B. Moon Phase:.None.1 /4.1 /2.3/4.Full
4. TERRAIN: (Circle appropriate description.)
A. Flat.Rolling.Mountainous.Jungle.Desert.MOUT.Arctic Other (Describe): .
B. Top soil composition:
Sandy.Rocky.Clay.Other (describe): .

C. Average range of visibility due to terrain: .
5. REMARKS
Figure 6-10. Suggested format for environmental data sheet
6-18
DODDOA-004093
4

PERSONNEL AND EQUIPMENT LOSS REPORT
UNIT IDENTIFICATION:
Mission Title or.Date and Time Friendly.Enemy.Vehicles
Task Number.Enemy Contact.MA.MA.Destroyed

COMMENTS:
Figure 6-11. Suggested format for personnel and equipment loss report
6-19
DODDOA-004094
6-6. SELECTING AND TRAINING OPFOR. The selection and training of an OPFOR is crucial to the success of a standardized evaluation. The OPFOR is one of the control measures that influences the conditions under which the evaluation is administered. The unit should face an opponent which is consistent in portraying threat doctrine.
a.
Selection. Any qualified Skill Level 1 or 2 soldier can serve as a member of the OPFOR. Ideally, the OPFOR should be a small cohesive unit under the control of their normal leader or commander.

b.
Training. The OPFOR must understand five major areas:

(1)
OPFOR weapons and equipment if available.

(2)
Installation and operation of the MILES devices for OPFOR weapons.

(3)
Rules of engagement.

(4)
Threat small unit tactics.

(5)
Training scenarios.

c.
OPFOR Strength.

(1)
Offense. Generally, the OPFOR should be outnumbered three to one or more if an attack is to have a good chance using MILES. If the OPFOR is stronger than this ratio, only the most exceptional unit will overcome them. Conversely, the OPFOR should not be so weak that they are quickly overcome. They must also be armed with weapons capable of defeating any of the unit's assets. A general rule is that the OPFOR should be strong enough to offer the unit realistic challenges but one that the unit can overcome if they employ proper tactics.

(2)
Defense. The OPFOR, at a minimum, should have a three-to-one ratio of superiority, since anything less will not effectively challenge the unit when defending. The OPFOR should have sufficient weapons and ammunition to conduct a successful attack. They must be more than a series of targets to be destroyed. The OPFOR should be allowed to plan their own attack for each mission and not be forced into a "canned" attack that the unit will quickly defeat. Once the OPFOR establishes their plan, they must use the same plan for that event in order to maintain the objectivity and standardization of the evaluation.

6-7. CONDUCTING THE EVALUATION. Conduct of the evaluation is divided into three distinct areas, each requiring preparation and coordination.
a. Pre-evaluation.
(1) Reconnoitering the evaluation area. The senior evaluator and all other evaluators must make a reconnaissance of the evaluation area. They must know the location of the unit boundary, the location of OPFOR dispositions, and the most likely avenues of approach throughout the field evaluation site area of operations.
DODDOA-004095
(2)
Preparation of orders. OPORDs and FRAGOs to be used to control the exercise must be prepared. An order must be prepared for every mission in the evaluation scenario. These can be prepared, using the skeleton orders contained in the STXs and FTX found in Chapter 4.

(3)
Unit preparatory activities. Installing and troubleshooting MILES equipment, loading vehicles, conducting inspections, and performing administrative actions, are included in unit preparation activities.

(4)
Positioning OPFOR. While the unit is conducting its preparatory activities, the OPFOR is placed in position and briefed. .-

(5)
Issue the operations orders. In this evaluation scenario, the unit is issued a march order to move. During movement preparation, the battalion OPORD is issued. Once the commander has issued his OPORD and time has been allotted for issuing the platoon or section order, the evaluators should make a last functional check of the equipment.

b.
Evaluation.

(1)
Controlling the exercise. The evaluation team controls the evaluation in two ways. First, it controls the evaluation using measures established in paragraph 3 and 5 of the OPORD or FRAGO. Second, the team controls the evaluation through the battalion team commander(simulated by the senior evaluator for this evaluation) on the battalion team net. Simply stated, the evaluation team does not control in the traditional sense, but merely accompanies the unit. Only the senior evaluator has direct verbal contact with the commander; all other evaluators do not speak, aid, give advice, point out positions, or in any way influence the unit performance, except in case of a safety emergency. Evaluators are neutral and must remain so throughout the evaluation.

(2)
Beginning the first module. Once the senior evaluator has issued the battalion team OPORD, the commander executes the mission/tasks prescribed in the first module of the evaluation scenario within the prescribed time constraints. From this point on, all successive modules begin with a battalion team FRAGO or an OPORD.

(3)
Terminating the module. The senior evaluator should terminate a module when the unit has completed all the missions/tasks in that module or has suffered so many casualties or so much damage that the assigned missions or tasks cannot be completed. If the latter is the reason for termination, the evaluator must record the reasons for the termination in the margin of the evaluator's T&EO worksheet and report his action to the evaluation control HQ. In the evaluation scenario, the completion of each mission or task is indicated by "conduct sustaining operations." During this period, the senior evaluator will direct the unit to remain in position while "replacements" (personnel and equipment designed as killed or destroyed) are sent forward to reconstitute the unit. At this time, evaluators must perform the following actions:

(a)
Promptly inspect all MILES equipment, record kill codes, and then reset equipment. Replace any damaged or inoperative MILES equipment.

6-21
DODDOA-004096
(b) Promptly resolve all casualty data to determine the time, place,
number, and cause of casualties. Report this information to the recorder in the evaluation control HQ..
(c) Debrief the unit to clear up any questions. The senior evaluator will then direct the unit to continue its mission once a battalion team FRAGO or OPORD for the next module has been issued.
(4) Guidelines for evaluator.
(a) Report major kills (vehicles, groups).
(b)
Report major weapons firing. Both significant firings and hits will be reported to the evaluation control HQ.

(c) Enforce rules of engagement.

(d)
Observe critical tactical events of time. Evaluators must be alert to spot and record any action that might have an effect on later performance or mission outcome.

(e) Record routes of travel and unit location.

(f)
Inform OPFOR controller of the unit location, direction, and intent. This is necessary to enable OPFOR actions to be controlled in accordance with the desired sequence of events.

(g)
Enforce safety.

(h)
Terminate mission.

c.
Post-evaluation. Once the evaluation has been terminated, the unit should be moved to an assembly area and the following actions performed before the unit moves back into garrison.

(1)
The unit evaluator must debrief subordinate evaluators and compile all data (evaluator packets) for the evaluation.

(2)
The unit evaluator must complete the task summary sheets.

(3)
The unit evaluator must turn in all completed evaluators packets (with the evaluators scoring system) to control HQ for recording and analysis.

(4)
The unit evaluator must conduct an AAR of the unit performance.

(5)
Each subordinate evaluator should conduct an AAR of his element's performance.

6-8. AFTER-ACTION REVIEW.
a. General. At the completion of each module and the total evaluation, feedback should be provided to the unit and platoon/sections in order to increase and reinforce learning.
622
-
DODDOA-004097
b.
Feedback. Because all members of the unit participate in an AAR, each member becomes a source of feedback. This participation provides a richer "data base" for key points. For example, based on the assessment of the situation, only a leader knows the basis for his decisions. The AAR leader tries to draw this information out so that it becomes an important part of the discussion and forms the context for discussing alternative courses of action.

c.
Preparing the AAR. The AAR preparation involves the following four steps:

(1) Review training orders and objectives. Training objectives are the focus of the discussion of the exercise results. The FRAGOs and OPORDs included in the exercise design implement these objectives. The evaluator should be familiar with the objectives, FRAGO, and OPORD so that he can note orders given by leaders of the unit that either implement these
objectives or 'deviate from them.
(2)
Observe the exercise. This is an active process. The emphasis is on noting the actions that make the difference between a unit's success and failure. The evaluator need not remain overly close to the commander, since more can be seen from high ground near the lead element's location, or along the unit's route when moving. Since unit orders may identify important activities, checkpoints, and so forth, the evaluator must be present when the orders are issued. Therefore, the evaluator should position himself so that he can best observe anticipated critical events. Examples of critical events include the following:


Plan Unit Move.


Prepare Unit Move.


Perform Risk Management Procedures.


Conduct Convoy.


OPFOR Activities.


Cross RP.


Establish Unit Area of Operations.


Support Transshipment Operations.


OPFOR Patrolling Occurs.


Main Attack Occurs.


Area Damage Control Operations.

(3)
Select the site and assemble the participants. After the exercise, select a site
for the AAR. If possible, hold the AAR where the majority of action occurred, where the most
critical events took place, or where the terrain can be observed. Most often the OPFOR or unit
objectives will be suitable to use for assembling the players and conducting AARs.

(4)
Debrief the evaluators. While the unit is moving to the selected site, the
evaluators should be debriefed. The senior evaluator must have a complete understanding of what
happened in the exercise. Therefore, the fourth step in AAR preparation is to obtain a detailed
description of the exercise's major tactical events in the order in which they occurred. The unit
evaluators and the OPFOR leader/controller will provide a description when they are debriefed.
After the senior evaluator has a sound understanding of what happened during the exercise, he
reviews the critical events and ranks them in terms of their relevance to the exercise training
objectives and their contributions to the exercise outcome. He then selects as many critical events
as can be covered in detail during the time allowed for the AAR and places them in chronological
order.

6-23
DODDOA-004098
d. Conducting the AAR. Conducting the AAR requires the following four steps:
(1)
Organize the participants. When the evaluator/AAR leader assembles the participants, he groups them in the exercise according to their organization. Each subordinate element's evaluator is with the element he evaluated.

(2)
State the training objectives. The AAR leader makes a brief, specific statement of the training objectives for the exercise. The AAR leader also states any additional teaching points that he intends to cover during the AAR. He limits these teaching points to three or four key points to keep the AAR focused and to prevent it from becoming too long.

(3)
Lead the discussion. The AAR leader guides the discussion of the major tactical events in the order they occur. He uses diagrams to help players visualize the exercise development. Each major event should be discussed in detail to make teaching points about the unit performance during the event. In an effective AAR, the AAR leader:


Avoids giving a critique or lecture.


Guides the discussion by asking leading questions.


Have the players describe what happened in their own terms.


Has the players discuss not only what happened, but also how it happened, and how it could have been done better.


Focuses the discussion so that important tactical lessons are made explicit.


Relates tactical events to subsequent results.


Avoids detailed examination of events not directly related to major training objectives.

• Encourages the participants to use diagrams to illustrate teaching points.


Prohibits players from offering self-serving excuses for inappropriate tactical actions.

(4) Summarize key points. The AAR leader briefly summarizes teaching points in terms of training objectives covered in the AAR. After the summary, the AAR leader can have a private conversation with the unit leader regarding his strengths and weaknesses and what he can do to further improve his performance and that of the unit. A good AAR ensures the following:

Order and discipline are maintained.


Training objectives are reviewed.


A discussion of the important events is held. (The discussion addresses events as they occurred and how the unit could have done better. The AAR leader guides the discussion. The leader avoids a detailed examination of events not directly related to the training objective.)


The AAR leader traces the chain of events so that all the participants understand the mistakes.

• Tactical events are clearly related to teaching points.


Attention of the participants is held, and they are involved in the discussion.


The summary and new training objectives are clear and concise. Sketches, diagrams, or terrain models are used to reinforce points made in the AAR.

DODDOA-004099
APPENDIX A
COMBINED ARMS TRAINING STRATEGY
A-1. PURPOSE. This appendix provides, as part of the CATS, the Combined Arms Command's recommended strategy for training a company/detachment. This appendix has three parts. The first part describes CATS and explains how CATS fits into the training planning process as described in FM 25-101. The second part explains how to read the strategies and the third part explains how to integrate CATS into the long-range and near-term planning process.
Section I. CATS AND THE TRAINING PLANNING PROCESS
TRAINING PLANNING PROCESS. FM 25-101 describes a three-step process, based
A-2.
on the unit METL and ending in training execution. Figure 1-1 is a graphic representation of the process.
METL ASSESSMENT COMMANDER'S TRAINING
GUIDANCE PLANS

Basis for
TRAINING EXECUTION
Figure 1-1. Training planning process
The CATS does not replace this process. It is a training tool that enhances the commander's ability to use the training planning process to manage his training and to optimize the use of scarce training resources. The CATS unit strategies describe recommended training events and the event frequency. Your unit may train all or some of these events. Your training frequency may or may not match that in the CATS strategy. Whatever a units training requirements, CATS provides a framework for use in making decisions on the training to be conducted. The training strategy outlined in CATS is designed to help commanders at all levels develop and execute a more efficient training program. Any given strategy addresses all units Army-wide of the same TOE. The specific makeup of the unit's training program is dependent upon--its METL; guidance from higher headquarters, and the resources available at the installation or training environment. It is descriptive in nature and is intended for use as a guide for the commander.
A-1
DODD0A-004100
3. CATS. CATS is the Army's training strategy that integrates combined arms training for--

heavy, light, and special operations forces, the active and reserve components, in the unit and institution environments. It provides an azimuth to guide Army training and identifies the resources required to support that training. It enables the Army to identify, manage and program the acquisition of training resources. CATS evolved from the need for more efficient training, based on expected resource constraints. At US Army level, CATS gives the rationale for acquiring training resources through the development of unit and institutional training strategies. The strategies provide recommended training frequencies and identify the training resources needed to
support the strategy.
A-4. TERMS. The information in this paragraph explains the terms listed in Figure 1-1. For information on the training planning process, see FM 25-101.
a.
The METL is an unconstrained, unprioritized statement of the tasks required to complete the war time mission. It is the source of training planning activities.

b.
Assessment is the beginning of the training planning process. It is the commander's evaluation of the unit's training level on the METL.

c.
Commander's Guidance consists of long-range planning calendars and CTG issued to the battalion from the division. It serves to focuS the training efforts of the battalion in accordance with the division commander's priorities. The battalion in turn issues CTG for its subordinate companies.

d.
Training Plans are a collection of schedules and other supporting documents that carry out the commander's guidance.

e.
Training Execution is the actual performance of the training scheduled in the training plans portion of the training planning process.

A5. APPLYING CATS. The information in this paragraph explains how to apply CATS to
-
the training planning process. Figure 1-2 is a graphic representation of the process.
METL
Applied
[ASSESSMENT COMMANDER'S CATS TRAINING
GUIDANCE PLANS
to

Basis for
TRAINING
EXECUTION

Figure 1-2. Training planning process
DODDOA-004101
a. The commander determines the exact events and tasks to be trained based on his METL and guidance from higher headquarters.
(1)
The unit trains tasks during events established in FM 25-100, FM 25-101, and CATS.

(2)
The company/detachment trains its METL by training soldiers, squads, sections and platoons in their wartime tasks. The company/detachment applies CATS to its training plans by applying the training events, frequencies and critical gates contained in strategies to the CTG in developing its training plans. The company commander and training officer/NCO uses the critical gates identified in the strategies to ensure that basic tasks are trained prior to moving on to training more complex or resource intensive tasks. The performance of training gate tasks is always evaluated by the commander and serves as the basis of additional training efforts. For example, a TEWT should be used to train METL tasks prior to conducting a complex and resource intensive event like a CFX. The collective training tasks trained in the TEWT are evaluated by the commander and serve as the basis for additional squad/section/platoon training or another TEWT prior to the execution of a CFX.

(3)
TADSS based training uses a mix of TADSS and live fire/field training. The strategies show those TADSS within the Army's system or year projected for fielding. The TADSS may not be available at your installation or training environment.

b.
The strategies can be viewed as training plans for generic type units. The strategy for the company/detachment is based on the TOE for the Motor Transport/Terminal/Watercraft /Movements Control company/detachment. It does not address environmental factors that apply to specific companies (such as MTOE, mission, particular training weaknesses and strengths, or the group/battalion commander's guidance).

c.
By inserting an extra step into the training planning process, commanders apply the components of their unit CATS strategies to their particular training programs and environments. Commanders evaluate and apply the information contained in the strategies to their training environments. The optimal frequencies identified in the strategies may have to be adjusted based upon a unit's training status or its resourcing.

Section II. STRATEGY ORGANIZATION AND INTERPRETATION
A-6. UNIT TRAINING STRATEGIES. This paragraph explains the strategy organization and explains how to use it. The unit training portion of CATS is a series of separately generated training strategies. These strategies describe the events, frequencies, and resources recommended to train to standard. As part of the unit training strategy development process, TRADOC established a standard format to depict unit training strategies. The unit training strategy is a descriptive strategy for training and sustaining soldier and collective task proficiency. The tasks to be trained at a particular unit will be based on the unit's METL. The unit strategy in this appendix covers all transportation companys/units. The unit training strategies have three major components--Maneuver, Gunnery, and Soldier.
A-3
a. The Maneuver strategy is descriptive. It provides recommended training frequencies for collective training events in a unit. The events come from FM 25-100, 25-101 or the glossary of this MTP. It helps a unit maintain MTP standards and depicts the resources required to support
training events.
b.
The Gunnery Component has Individual/crew served weapons strategies that the Infantry school developed. These strategies also can be found in DA Pam 350-38 and DA Pam 350-39 or appropriate weapons FMs.

c.
The Soldier Component is a descriptive strategy for training individual soldier skills. It lists the resources required to support soldier training and links with and supports a collective training strategy.

A-7. ELEMENTS OF THE UNIT STRATEGIES. The unit training strategies are in matrix formats. The matrix lists the unit size levels, training events or training exercises, training event frequencies for both the active and reserve components, critical gates, and training resources.
a.
Training levels are units, training elements or echelons (such as individual through corps) that execute specific training events.

b.
Training events are types of collective training exercises identified in FM 25-101 or the glossary of this MTP. Training events identify the recommended exercises that units should conduct to train to MTP standard. Units normally conduct events in a progressive and sequential manner. For example; a TEWT should be conducted before conducting a CFX. A CPX should be conducted before conducting a FTX.

c.
Training event frequencies are the suggested number of times that an event should be trained during a training cycle to attain or maintain MTP standards. AC units use an annual cycle and RC units conduct training on a 4-year cycle.

d.
A critical gate is a training event that must be done and evaluated before moving onto a more complex, resource intensive, or hazardous event. MACOM or field commanders may direct performance of critical gate training tasks to an established standard prior to performing more complex or resource intensive tasks.

e.
The unit training strategies identify the resources that will be used to support each training event. These resources are:


OPTEMPO


Ammunition


TADSS


Training Land


Training Ranges

The resources listed in the strategies represent those that are available now.
A4
-
(1)
OPTEMPO figures reflect the annual operating miles/hours required for the base vehicle or system for a particular unit, per event. The OPTEMPO figures come from the BLTM manual. When no BLTM was available, an estimated OPTEMPO required to support all the annual iterations of that training event; were developed by the proponents.

(2)
Ammunition figures reflect the ammunition required to support training events and come from DA Pam 350-38, Standards in Weapons Training The maneuver/collective strategies reflect blank ammunition requirements. Live ammunition appears on the Gunnery strategies. Pyrotechnics appear on the maneuver/collective component.

(3)
TADSS are training aids, devices, simulators and simulations that support specific training events. TADSS listed are those in the system and non-system TADSS that are fielded. In this strategy, Battalion and BBS are identified as a primary TADSS to support battalion staff and headquarters company/detachment's CPX training

(4)
Training Land is a resource category that will list the recommended training land in kilometers by event to conduct maneuver training. The reference is TC 25-1. The actual amount of training land needed by a particular unit will be determined by METT-T and the characteristics or condition of the training land available to the unit.

(5)
Training Range is a resource requirement that supports weapons training events. The information comes from TC 25-8.

A-8. GUIDE TO THE UNIT STRATEGIES. This paragraph provides a guide to reading the collective, gunnery, and soldier components.
a. We will use the Battalion Staff and Headquarters company/detachment as our example (Figure A-1).
(1)
The top of the maneuver strategy lists the major training events. The order in which the events appear, from left to right, is not prescriptive. The events do follow a logical progression of how a unit might process through an annual training cycle. Explanations of these events are in FM 25-101 or the glossary of this MTP.

(2)
On the left side of the maneuver strategy is the column titled levels. This
column lists the units covered by the strategy. The strategy in this appendix addresses the
Battalion Staff and Headquarters Company/detachment and the Battalion HI-IC. There is a
separate row for AC and RC units. Each column depicts the recommended frequency that a unit
should conduct a specific training event within a year. For example, look at the training event,
STAFFEX. Here, the recommended frequency for an AC, battalion staff to conduct a STAFFEX
is 12 times a year.

b.
The M16 Al/A2 matrix will be used for the gunnery/weapon strategy example.

NOTE: Gunnery/weapon strategies in the MTP cover only branch specific weapon systems. Some units, like the battalion staff, will not have specific gunnery/weapon strategies.
A-5
DODDOA-004104
(1) Gunnery/weapon strategies were developed by TRADOC schools that the STRAC manual identifies as the weapon's proponent. Because the Infantry branch is the proponent for the M16, the Infantry school developed this strategy and it applies to all branches.
.
(2)
Training events are in the top position of the gunnery/weapon strategy. The levels or echelons that will train these tasks are on the left. On the M16 strategy, qualification for the M16 is conducted at the soldier level. The critical gates to be completed, before M16 qualification, are in FM 23-9. The unit commander will ensure that the soldier trains those requirements before moving on to qualification.

(3)
Frequency depicts how often the tasks listed in the upper part of the strategy should be conducted annually. Per guidance provided in the STRAC manual, the frequency block for the M16 has two categories. Category I applies to soldiers with either an 11 B or an 11 M MOS assigned to an infantry rifle squad or a 19D or 11B assigned to a scout squad or long-range

surveillance detachment. Category 11 applies to all combat arms, combat support and combat service support soldiers not assigned to rifle or infantry squads.

(4)
These two categories are subdivided by TRC IAW the STRAC manual. They are: TRC A = AC Units, TRC L = Light Infantry, Air Assault and Airborne Units, TRC S = Special Reaction Teams (AC, MP Teams), TRC C = RC Units, TRC D = USAR Training Division, Reception Stations and Separate Training Brigades, and NGB Training Cadre.

(5)
Training categories and training readiness conditions provide an all encompassing set of training frequencies. The M16 strategy recommends that a light infantry squad conduct three live fire exercises per year. The reserve component squads have no recommended frequency.

(6)
OPTEMPO is not identified for M16 training.

(7)
Figures for ammunition are per DA Pam 350-38 (STRAC). Qualification with the M16 requires 160 rounds of ball and 20 rounds of tracer ammunition per weapon per year.

c.
The final component is the soldier strategy.

(1)
The soldier strategy focuses on training common skills in a particular CMF or can be focused on a single MOS.

(2)
Training events selected for the 88- are across the top of the strategy. The left column shows the recommended annual event frequency. The letter "A" represents AC soldiers. The letter "R" represents RC soldiers. Thus, in this example, the recommendation is for daily physical training for the active component 88- and monthly for the reserve component soldier.

Section M. INTEGRATION OF CATS IN THE PLANNING PROCESS
A-9. INTEGRATING CATS. This portion of the appendix explains how to integrate CATS into the planning process. It focuses on long range planning that conducted at brigade and above. To understand how CATS fits into this process, a brief summary of Chapter 3 (Planning) from FM 25-101 has been provided.
A-10. THE PLANNING PROCESS.
a. Long-range Planning
(1)
Assessment. Assessment is the start of the long range planning process. Using their evaluations, the input of subordinate leaders and the results of training evaluations, commanders assess their unit's training level on METL tasks. The assessment serves as the basis for the commander's training strategy for sustainment and improvement training. Commanders at all levels do this assessment function. An integral part of the assessment is the identification of required training resources and shortfalls. The commander also must synchronize the actions of supporting units and agencies to ensure proper training execution.

(2)
In creating their training strategy, commanders ensure that training:


Is METL focused.


Incorporates combined arms.


Identifies who, when, and where to train.


Has a logical sequence of execution.


Identifies the type of exercise to be trained.


Determines the frequencies of a given task.


Coordinates all events.


Matches resources to requirements.

The strategy that meets these requirements results in the commander's training guidance.
(3)
Senior commanders (brigade and above) provide subordinate commanders
with long range training calendars, the commander's training guidance, resources to train, and
protection from training distorters. Commanders often provide recommended training events
frequency.

b.
Short-range Planning. The short-range planning process refines the guidance that
results from the long-range planning process. Subordinate commanders use this guidance to create
their training calendars. Guidance on the short-range training process can be found in the CATS
appendix in the. unit's MTP.

A-11. CATS AND THE PLANNING PROCESS. The CATS serves the company commander
as a training management and training resource identification tool. As a training management tool,
it allows the company commander to more efficiently manage his training program, with limited
resource availability. As a training resource identification tool, it identifies the resources within
the Army's inventory to conduct training. The availability of those resources will vary, depending
on your location.

A-7
DODDOA-004106
a. Long-range Planning
(1)
Assessment.

(2)
The CATS strategy-


Is METL focused.


Incorporates combined arms.


Identifies who, when, and where to train.


Has a logical sequence of execution.


Identifies the type of exercise to be trained.


Determines the frequencies of a given task.


Coordinates all events.


Matches resources to requirements.

(3)
CATS provides a convenient vehicle for the transmission of the commander's training guidance. It serves as the basis for the long-range calendar. It provides subordinate commanders with recommended frequencies of training events.

(4)
EXECUTION. The following example shows how CATS could fit into the long-range training process.

b.
The Company/Detachment Maneuver Training Strategy lists the recommended frequencies for required annual training events. In particular, for the STX it lists 10 iterations. The optimal training frequency is for the company/detachment staff to train this event 10 times in a given year, 1 STX per month for 10 months. The frequencies listed in CATS would be trained as follows: 2 events per year—semiannual training; 4 events per year--quarterly training; 6 events per year—bimonthly training.

c.
Naturally, the training year may not support such a neat breakdown of training events. CATS gives you the flexibility to adjust the events to meet your particular requirements. A key point here is the idea of critical gates. As you can see, STX is a critical gate for FTX. You should conduct any event that is a critical gate, before conducting the more complex task. Gates serve to ensure that basic tasks essential to the successful performance of complex tasks are trained and evaluated prior to the performance of complex tasks. Critical gates may also serve as a type of preview or "rehearsal" for a follow-on training event.

d.
Assume that your commander has identified platoon leadership as a particular
weakness in your unit. Your commander decides that he wants to run platoon STX exercises twice
a month to train the platoon/section/crew/squad leadership elements.

e.
Using this guidance you simply go the company strategy and substitute 24 for 12. If the
frequencies for the other events are acceptable, you now have a completed commander's strategy.
In this manner a CATS base strategy is tailored to meet a commander's assessment and training
needs.

f.
Short-range Planning. The application of CATS Battalion Staff and Headquarters
Company/Detachment's unit training strategies to battalion short range planning and the battalion
quarterly training calendar is seen as follows.

DODDOA-004107
ARTEP 55-718-30-MTP
Recommended Company/Detachment Calendar Using CATS Maneuver Strategy.
1ST MONTH
WEEK 1 Drill Training (1)
WEEK 2 Cell/Staff/Section Training (1)
WEEK 3 Cell/Staff/Section Training (1)
WEEK 4 STX (2)
NOTES:

1.
The collective tasks trained during the weekly Cell/Staff/Section training periods support company METL tasks and are trained according to the commander's assessment and his priorities for staff training outlined in the CTG. Soldier training tasks trained during this month are soldier/leader supporting performance of the collective tasks to be trained during the weekly staff training sessions or the monthly STX.

2.
Performance of the STX substitutes for Cell/Staff/Section Training in week four (4).

2ND MONTH

WEEK 1 Cell/Staff/Section Training (1)
WEEK 2 Cell/Staff/Section Training (1)
WEEK 3 TOCEX (2)
WEEK 4 Cell/Staff/Section Training (3)

NOTES:
1.
Training during these weekly periods concentrates on staff METL tasks identified as priority in the CTG. Training time here could also be spent training tasks evaluated as NO GO during the 1st month's training period. Training exercises such as a LCXs or MCX can be used to drive training during these periods. LCXs and MCXs can also be used to enhance staff coordination.

2.
Performance of the TOCEX substitutes for performance of the monthly STAFFEX that would be conducted here. Commanders may have to modify or extend the training period of the TOCEX to include training tasks that would have been normally performed in the STAFFEX.

3.
Tasks trained here can be tasks rated as NO GO during the previous week's TOCEX.

3D MONTH .
WEEK 1 Cell/Staff/Section Training
.
WEEK 2 TEWT (1)
.
WEEK 3 Cell/Staff/Section Training
.
WEEK 4 CPX (2)
A-9
DODDOA-004108
NOTES:
1.
This TEWT substitutes for performance of the Cell/Staff/Section training that would normally be performed this week. Ideally, the TEWTs discussion points and learning objectives would be developed to support/reinforce collective tasks trained in the previous month's Cell/Staff/Section, STAFFEX OR TOCEX training periods. The commander may also structure the TEWT to train staff coordination and integration tasks as key for the upcoming CPX.

2.
Substitutes for performance of the STAFFEX that would normally be performed during the month.

As seen in the above, the commander structures his training program using recommended CATS training events, frequencies and critical gates to support METL training Weekly or monthly training events can be conducted independently or integrated into other collective training exercises.
In scheduling training, the commander should take maximum advantage of higher headquarters directed events to accomplish his recommended CATS training events.
g. Horizontal and Vertical Integration. In executing this training strategy, the commander vertically integrates his training requirements with the battalion's/group's training requirements. Additionally, the company's training strategy is horizontally integrated with other companies in the battalion to ensure that combined arms training is effected.
APPENDIX B
BATTLEFIELD OPERATING SYSTEMS
B-1. MANEUVER. The employment of forces on the battlefield through movement and direct fires in combination with fire support, or fire potential to achieve a position of advantage in respect to enemy ground forces in order to accomplish the mission. This includes direct fire systems (such as small arms, tank guns, and attack helicopter fires).
a. Move. To position or reposition forces (units and equipment) relative to the enemy to secure or retain positional advantage making full use of terrain and formation. It is the dynamic element of combat—the means of concentrating forces at the critical point to achieve the surprise, psychological shock, physical momentum, and moral dominance which enables smaller forces to defeat larger ones. Units supporting combat maneuver units are included since they are expected to go wherever the combat unit goes.
NOTE: Movement of cargo, equipment, and personnel is covered under the Combat Service Support BOS.
b.
Engage Enemy. To enter into conflict or combat on the ground with the enemy using direct fire or close combat. Note: Air targets are covered in the Air Defense BOS.

c.
Control Terrain. To dominate an area to prevent enemy occupation of the position through fire, fire potential, or occupation of the terrain.

B-2. FIRE SUPPORT. The collective and coordinated use of target acquisition data, indirect fire weapons, armed aircraft (less attack helicopters) and other lethal and nonlethal means against ground targets in support of maneuver force operations (FM 6-20). It includes artillery, mortar and other non line-of-sight fires, naval countermeasures.
a.
Process Ground Targets. To select targets and match the appropriate response to them, taking account of operational requirements and capabilities.

b.
Engage Ground Targets. To enter into conflict with the enemy using fire support systems.

B-3. AIR DEFENSE. All measures designed to nullify or reduce the effectiveness of attack by hostile aircraft or missiles after they are airborne (FM 44-100).
a.
Process Air Targets. To select targets and match the appropriate response to them, taking account of operational requirements and capabilities.

b.
Attack Enemy Aircraft. To intercept, engage, destroy or neutralize enemy aircraft and missiles in flight.

c.
Deny Airspace. To prevent enemy use of airspace through fire potential or other means without direct attack of air targets (for example, deliberate smoke, barrage balloons).

B-1
B-4. COMMAND AND CONTROL. The exercise of authority and direction by a properly designated commander over assigned forces in the accomplishment of the mission. Command and control functions are performed through an arrangement of personnel, equipment, facilities, and
procedures employed by a commander in planning, directing, coordinating, and controlling forces and operations in the accomplishment of the mission.
a.
Acquire and Communicate Information and Maintain Status. To gain possession of information, on the METT-T and weather, by or for the commander or his staff. Information must be translated into usable form in order to retain and disseminate it.

b.
Assess Situation. To continuously evaluate information received through reports or the personal observations of the leader or commander to decide whether different actions are required from those that would result from the most recent orders issued.

c.
Determine Actions. To conduct the continuous process of making estimates and decisions for assigned or projected tasks. This function involves a detailed and systematic examination of all aspects of contemplated operations including deciding to alter planned or ongoing actions. This function also includes the formulation of the commander's concept and intent.

d.
Direct and Land Subordinate Forces. To provide direction to subordinate forces so that they understand and can contribute effectively and efficiently to the attainment of the commander's concept and intent. This function includes the preparation and completion of orders.

B-5. INTELLIGENCE. Knowledge of the enemy, weather, and geographical features are
required by a commander in order to plan and conduct combat operations. It is derived from an
analysis of information on the enemy's environments (FM 101-5-1).
a.
Collect Information. To obtain information in any manner possible way he can.

b.
Process Information. To convert information into intelligence thought through collation, evaluation, analysis, integration, and interpretation.

c.
Prepare Intelligence Reports. To develop and produce standard reports and IPB products for the commander's use the report intelligence or information, to task intelligence assets, or to receive information, intelligence orders, or instructions.

B-6. MOBILITY AND SURVIVABILITY. The capability of the force, which permits
freedom of movement relative to the enemy while retaining the ability, to fulfill its primary
mission. It also includes those measures that the force takes to remain viable and functional by
protection from the effects of enemy weapon systems and natural occurrences.
a.
Provide Mobility. To provide freedom of movement, without delays due to terrain
obstacles, for personnel and equipment on the battlefield.

b.
Provide Countermobility. To delay, channel, or stop offensive movement by the
enemy in order to destroy his forces directly or indirectly by enhancing the effectiveness of
friendly indirect and direct weapon systems.

DODDOA-004111
Enhance Survivability. To protect personnel, equipment, and supplies from enemy systems and natural occurrences, while simultaneously deceiving the enemy.
c.
7. COMBAT SERVICE SUPPORT. The support and assistance provided to sustain forces,

primarily in the fields of logistics, personnel services, and health services.
a.
Arm. To provide munitions to weapon systems. This encompasses all types of ammunition to include mines and demolition munitions.

b.
Fuel. To provide fuel and petroleum products (petroleum, oils, and lubricants) for weapon systems and other equipment.

c.
Fix. To preserve the availability of weapon systems and equipment. It includes providing repair parts and end items at the right place and time, and all the actions taken before, during, and after battle to keep equipment operational.

d.
Man the Force. To provide all support to the individual soldier as well as provide healthy, fit soldiers to units.

e.
Distribute. To provide, by employing transportation and supply services, various classes of supplies to military units.

f.
Provide Sustainment Engineering. To repair and construct facilities and lines of communications.

g.
Provide Military Police Support. To provide enemy prisoner of war collection, evacuation and internment, and to enforce military law and order.

B-3
DODDOA-004112
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
d.
Updates air load plan based on current inission(s).

e.
Prepares movement binders with key data, to include checklists, the current copy of the AUEL, the DEL, and strip maps.

f.
Identifies hazardous and sensitive/classified cargo and handling procedures.

g.
Identifies BBPCT material requirements.

h.
Coordinates ground movement plan to designated ports with supporting ITO and local authorities, if required.

i.
Verifies personnel identified for deployment equipment teams, super cargoes and advance parties are deployable.

j.
Coordinates tactical information and security requirements with the S2/S3 Section.

*5. Commander reviews unit readiness status.
a.
Validates requisitions for all equipment shortages.

b.
Directs unit supply to conduct an inventory of UBL items.

c.
Identifies unit training status for deployment mission, to include individual/crew served weapons, NBC, driver certification, special equipment, rail teams, air load/pallet build team, BBPCT team, and HAZMAT handlers.

d.
Directs unit HQ to coordinate unit SRP with S1 or supporting installation, as appropriate.

e.
Directs unit to maintain mobilization packet for each soldier IAW directives (RC).

f.
Directs personnel section to screen members not available for deployment.

g.
Resolves nondeployable personnel issues.

h.
Maintains unit liaison with Mobilization Station.

i.
Directs maintenance section to identify maintenance affecting readiness.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
j.
Initiates action to resolve unit maintenance problems affecting readiness.

k.
Directs unit Safety Officer to prepare risk assessment of the deployment operation.

*6. Unit leaders prepare for mobilization.
a.
Update section portions of the RSOP and TSOP.

b.
Update section portions of the unit battle book, to include the, unit mission, organization, locations of mobilization station and ports and extracts from the applicable OPLANs.

c.
Provide input to commander for update of unit METL.

7. Unit HQ plans for deployment.
a.
Identifies rear detachment requirements.

b.
Plans for property transfer, turnover and control procedures.

c.
Verifies family support group program has been established and key personnel are available.

d.
Prepares plan for storing personnel property and POVs.

e.
Coordinates accreditation of Automated Information Systems (RC).

f.
Identifies key personnel to be ordered to duty in advance of the unit (RC).

g.
Coordinates with S1 for all unit personnel to go through SRP.

h.
Maintains a mobilization packet for each soldier IAW directives (RC).

i.
Coordinates update of RSOP and TSOP by section.

j.
Prepares communications plan.

k.
Identifies force protection measures.

1. Prepares risk assessment of the deployment operation.
5-383
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES 8. Unit conducts deployment training. GO NO GO
a. Conducts load out test as directed.
b. Trains load teams, such as rail loading teams, packing and . crating teams, blocking and bracing teams, aerial/sea port load teams in specific team operations. c. Conducts mobilization status briefing for all unit personnel (RC). d. Conducts test of alert notification plan.
e. Conducts HAZMAT training as needed.
TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK ITERATION. -.• 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO" TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO" TOTAL
"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS: NONE
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE

ELEMENT: Company Headquarters
TASK:.Plan Unit Deployment Activities Upon Receipt of a Warning Order (63-2-4828) (FM 100-17, AR 220-1, AR 220-10, AR 350-41, AR 710-2, FM 4-30.3, TM 55-2200-001-12)
.
ITERATION 1.2.3.4.5.M.(circle) .
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit is at a normal state of deployment readiness and receives a warning order to prepare for deployment. The unit must plan unit deployment activities upon receipt of a warning order. The CQ or 1 SG has notified the commander. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. This task occurs concurrently with the task (Perform Deployment Alert Activities. The movement plan, recall plan, security plan, unit access rosters, and current maps are available. The unit has a trained officer and/or NCO appointed as UMO and alternate UMO. The unit is deploying as part of a higher echelon deployment. Deployment planning activities are performed under all day or night environment conditions, except NBC. This task should not be trained in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Movement plan is completed TAW governing regulations and higher HQ directions.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Commander analyzes mission:

a.
Identifies tasks in the deployment warning order.

b.
Identifies documented relocation policies and procedures
form the TSOP and movement order.

c.
Issues warning notice to unit leaders.

d.
Coordinates mission parameters and details with higher HQ
using analog and/or digital communications.

e.
Briefs unit leaders on deployment and mission requirements.
*2. Commander reviews unit readiness status.

a.
Identifies equipment shortages.

b.
Requests assistance from higher HQ to rectify equipment
shortages using analog and/or digital communications.

5-385
DODDOA-004116
GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
c.
Directs unit supply to conduct an inventory of on-hand UBL items.

d.
Identifies unit training status for deployment mission, to include for individual/crew served weapons, NBC, driver certification, special equipment, rail teams, air load/pallet build team, BBPCT team, Automated Airload Planning System, HAZMAT certified personnel, and other automated systems operators.

e.
Directs unit HQ to coordinate unit SRP with Si or with supporting installation, as appropriate.

f.
Directs maintenance section to identify maintenance issues affecting readiness.

g.
Initiates action to resolve unit maintenance problems affecting readiness.

h.
Directs unit HQ to review personnel status.

i.
Initiates action to resolve nondeployable personnel issues. • *3. Commander directs deployment planning.

a.
Directs UMO to update movement plan based on current mission guidance.

b.
Directs unit leaders to update battle book, to include the unit mission, organization and extracts from the applicable OPLANs:

c.
Coordinates mission parameters and details with higher HQ using analog and/or digital communications.

d.
Directs unit Safety Officer to prepare risk assessment of the deployment operation.

e.
Identifies deployment training requirements. *4. UMO updates unit movement plan.

a.
Identifies the administrative, logistics and coordinating requirements for the plan based on the current mission.

b.
Verifies load plans are current and entered into the AUEL.

DODDOA-004117
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
c.
Updates DEL based on current mission.

d.
Updates air load plan based on current mission.

e.
Updates movement binders with current mission data.

f.
Identifies hazardous and sensitive cargo to be deployed.

g.
Verifies hazardous and sensitive/classified cargo handling • procedures with installation unit movement coordinator.

h.
Updates BBPCT materiel requirements.

i.
Verifies ground movement plan to designated ports is current. NOTE: Performance measure "i" does not apply to the IBCT.

j.
Verifies personnel listed for deployment equipment teams, supercargoes and advance parties are deployable.

NOTE: "Supercargoes" in performance measure does not apply to IBCT.
k. Coordinates tactical information and security requirements with the S2/S3 Section using analog and/or digital communications.
5. Unit HQ plans for deployment.
a.
Identifies rear detachment requirements based on current mission.

b.
Identifies advance party personnel requirements.

c.
Plans for property transfer, turnover and control procedures.

d.
Verifies family support group program key personnel are available.

e.
Verifies unit deployment team personnel are available.

f.
Requests commander assign additional and/or replacement personnel for deployment teams and advance party.

g.
Prepares plan for storing personal property and POVs.

5-387
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO , NO GO
h.
Prepares communications plan.

i.
Identifies force protection measures for each step of the
deployment process.

j.
Identifies required reports to higher HQ during deployment
process.

k.
Identifies rules of engagement for gaining theater.

1. Performs risk assessment of deployment operation.
TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS: NONE
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
ELEMENT: Company Headquarters
TASK:.Plan Unit Redeployment (63-2-4829) (FM 100-17 AR 220-1, AR 220-10, AR 710-2, FM 4-30.3, TM 55-2200-001-12)
.
ITERATION 1.2.3.4.5.M.(circle) .
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit receives a warning order to deploy to home station. The unit is located in the TAA. Some personnel and administrative actions are initiated in the TAA and completed in the RAA. The unit has analog and digital communications with higher HQ. The unit is redeploying as part of a higher HQ redeployment. The Redeployment Movement Plan is available. The unit has a trained officer or NCO appointed as UMO. Preparation activities for redeployment are performed under all day or night environmental conditions. This task should not be trained in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: The Redeployment Movement Plan is completed IAW governing regulations and higher HQ directions. The redeployment OPORD is completed.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Commander analyzes redeployment mission.

a.
Identifies tasks in the deployment warning order.

b.
Identifies all documented redeployment policies and
procedures from the TSOP, Redeployment Plan, movement order,
OPLANs, and OPORDs.

c.
Issues warning notice to unit leaders.

d.
Coordinates mission parameters and details with higher HQ
using analog and/or digital communications.


.e. Identifies redeployment criteria required for unit validation.

f.
Verifies unit follow-on mission, if appropriate.

g.
Briefs unit leaders on redeployment and mission
requirements.

*2. Commander reviews unit readiness status.
a.
Identifies equipment shortages.

b.
Inventories UBL items.

5-389

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
c.
Identifies training status of individual/crew-served weapons,
NBC, driver certification, special equipment, rail teams, air load/pallet
build team, BBPCT team, automated air-land planning system,
HAZMAT certified personnel, and other automated system operators.

d.
Identifies unit maintenance problems.

e.
Directs unit HQ to review personnel status.

f.
Requests support to correct readiness-deficiencies.
*3. Commander directs redeployment planning.

a.
Directs UMO to update redeployment movement plan based
on current mission guidance and timeline from higher HQ.

b.
Directs unit leaders to update battle book, to include the unit
mission, organization, redeployment ports information and extracts from
the applicable OPLANs.

c.
Directs Unit Safety Officer to prepare a risk assessment of
the deployment operation.

d.
Issues redeployment OPORD.
*4. UMO updates Redeployment Movement Plan.

a.
Updates the administrative, logistics, and coordinating
requirements for the plan based on current mission.

b.
Updates Redeployment Movement Plan based on current
mission guidance.

c.
Verifies load plans are current and entered into the AUEL.

d.
Updates DEL based on current missions.

e.
Updates movement binders with mission specific
information.

f.
Identifies hazardous and sensitive/classified handling
procedures for each mode of transport and each port.

g.
Updates BBPCT materiel requirements.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
h.
Verifies status of personnel listed for redeployment
equipment teams, supercargoes, and advance parties.

i.
Coordinates tactical information and security requirements
with the support operations section using analog and/or digital
communications.

5. Unit HQ plans for redeployment.
a.
Plans steps to meet redeployment validation criteria.

b.
identifies force protection measures in the AAs and MAs.
...

c.
Incorporates redeployment family reunion requirements into
planning timeline.

d.
Plans media contact for return to home station.

e.
Initiates planning for welcome home ceremony.

f.
Identifies requirements and plan for stress control briefings.

g.
Provides rear detachment with information on redeployment
for dissemination to families.

h.
Performs risk assessment on redeployment operations.

i.
Coordinates security of sensitive items.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS: NONE
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
5-391
DODDOA-004122
ARTEP 55-718-30-MTP
GLOSSARY
AA.assembly area
AACG.arrival airfield control group
AAR.after action report
AC.active component
ADC.area damage control
AIT.automated information technology
AM.amplitude modulation
AO.area of operations
APOD.aerial port of debarkation
APOE.aerial port of embarkation
AR.Army Regulation
• ARTEP.Army Training and Evaluation Program
arty.artillery
ASG.area support group
ASL.authorized stockage list
ATTN.attention
ATWESS.antitank weapon system simulator
AUEL.automated unit equipment list
BBPCT.blocking, bracing, packing, crating, and tie down
BBS.battalion/brigade simulation
BCOC.Base Cluster Operations Center
BDAR.battle damage assessment and repair
BF.battle fatigue
BFACS.Battlefield Functional Area Control System
BLTM.battalion level training manual
BN.battalion
BOS.Battlefield Operating System
BSC.base support company
C2.command and control
cal.caliber
CAS.close air support
CATS.Combined Arms Training Strategy
Cdr.commander
CFX.command field exercise
CGO.cargo
CHS.combat health support
CMF.career management field
CO.commanding officer
COA.course(s) of action
COMEX.communication exercise
COMSEC.communication security
CONPLAN.contingency plan
CONUS.continental United States
CP.command post
CPR.cardiopulmonary resuscitation
CPT.captain
CPX.command post exercise
CQ.charge of quarters
Glossary-1
DODDOA-004123

CRT.combat or component repair team CSS.combat service support CTA.common tables of allowances CTG.command training guidance DA.Department of the Army DACG.departure airfield control group DC.District of Columbia DD.Department of Defense DEL.deployment equipment list DIR.directive DOD.Department of Defense DODAAC.Department Of Defense Activity Address Code DS2.decontamination solution number 2 DS.direct support ECCM.electronic counter countermeasures ELSEC.electronic security EOD.explosive ordnance disposal
EPW.enemy prisoners of war
ERT.Equipment Reception Team ETA.estimated time of arrival ETM.electronic technical. manual EW.electronic warfare F.Fahrenheit FASCAM.family of scatterable mines FBCB2.Force XXI Battle Command, Brigade and Below FDC.Fire Direction Center FM.field manual; frequency modulated FMC.field medical card 1LT.First Lieutenant 1SG.First Sergeant FAD.Force Activity Designator FRAGO.fragmentary order FST.field sanitation team FTX.field training exercise GS.general support
HAZMAT.hazardous material
HHC.Headquarters and Headquarters Company
HN.host nation
HQ.headquarters
hr. hour(s)
IAW.in accordance with
IBCT.Initial Brigade Combat Team IEW.intelligence and electronic warfare INTSUM.intelligence summary ITO.Installation Transportation Officer ITV.in-transit visibility JTTP.joint tactics, techniques, and procedures KIA •.killed in action LAW.light anti-weapon LCX.logistical coordination exercise
Glossary-2
LDR.leader LHS.Load Handling System LIN.line item number LOD.line of duty LP.listening post LRU.line replaceable unit LTA.local training area MA.marshaling area MACOM.major Army command MACP.Mortuary Affairs Collection Point MADCP.Mortuary Affairs Decontamination Collection Point MAPEX.map exercise MCA.Movement Control Agency MCSR.Materiel Condition Status Report MCT.Movement Control Team MCX.movement coordination exercise MED.medium MEDEVAC.medical evacuation METL.mission essential task list METT-T.mission, enemy, terrain, troops, and time available METT-TC.Mission, Enemy, Terrain, Troops, Time, Civilians MILE.materials handling equipment MIDI.meaconing, intrusion, jamming, and interference MIL.master incident list MILES.Multiple Integrated Laser Engagement System min.minute(s) mm.millimeter MMC.Material Management Center MOBPLAN.mobilization plan MOPP.mission-oriented protection posture MOS.military occupational specialty MOUT.military operation on urban terrain MP.military police MQS.military qualification standard MRE.meal, ready-to-eat MSC.Maintenance Support Center MSG.master sergeant MSR.main supply route MST.maintenance support team MTF.medical treatment facility MTOE.modified table of equipment MTP.mission training plan MTS.Movement Tracking System NBC.nuclear, biological, and chemical NCO.noncommissioned officer NCOIC.noncommissioned officer in charge NCS.net control station NGB.National Guard Bureau NLT.not later than NMCS.nonmission capable supply
Glossary-3
No..number NSN.national stock number OC.observer controller OCIE.organizational clothing and individual equipment OCONUS.outside continental United States OEG.operational exposure guidance OIC.officer in charge OP.observation post OPFOR.opposing force OPLAN.operation plan OPORD.operation order OPSEC.operations security OPTEMPO.operating tempo Pam.pamphlet PEWS.Platoon Early Warning System PIR.priority intelligence requirement PLL.prescribed load list PLT.platoon PMCS.preventive maintenance checks and services PMCT.Port Movement Control Team POC.point of contact POD.port of debarkation POL.petroleum, oil, and lubricants POV.privately-owned vehicle PREPO.pre-positioning PSA.port support activity QC.quality control
quartermaster
QM.
QSS.quick supply store RAA.redeployment assembly area RC.reserve component RF.radio frequency RP.release point RSOP.redeployment standing operating procedures RTD.return to duty RX.reparable exchange Si.adjutant (US Army) S2.intelligence officer (US Army) S3.operations and training officer (US Army) S4.supply officer (US Army) S6.communications/electronics officer SALUTE.size, activity, location, unit, time, and equipment SAW.squad automatic weapon 2LT.Second Lieutenant SEC.section SFC.sergeant first class SGT.sergeant SHELLREP.shelling report SIGSEC.signal security SINCGARS.Single Channel Ground to Air Radio System SITREP.situation report
Glossary-4
DODDOA-004126

SL.skill level SM.soldier's manual SMCT.Soldier's Manual of Common Tasks SMFT.semi-mounted fabric tank SOI.signal operating instructions SOP.standing operating procedure SP.start point SPOD.sea port of debarkation SPOE.sea port of embarkation SPOTREP.spot report SQD.squad SQDS.squads SRP.soldier readiness processing SSA.supply support activity SSG.staff sergeant SSI.signal supplemental instructions STAFFEX.staff exercise STP.soldier training publication STRAC.Standards in Training Commission STX.situational training exercise T&EO.training and evaluation outline TAA.tactical assembly area TADSS.training aids, devices, simulators, and simulations TALCE.Tactical Airlift Control Element TAMMS.The Army Maintenance Management System TAT.to accompany troops TC.training circular TC-ACCIS.Transportation Coordinator-Automated Command and Control Information
System TCF.tactical combat force TCMD.transportation control movement document TEMPEST.compromising emanations controls TEWT.training exercise without troops TG.trainer's guide TOCEX.tactical operations center exercise TOE.table of organization and equipment TM.technical manual TMT.transportation motor transport tng.training TRADOC.Training and Doctrine Command TRC.training readiness conditions TSB.theater staging base TSC.Theater Support Command TSOP.tactical standing operating procedures UBL.unit basic load UCMJ.Uniform Code of Military Justice ULC.unit-level computer ULLS.Unit Level Logistics System UMA.unit marshaling area UMC.unit movement coordinator
Glossary-5
DODDOA-004127
UMCP UMO US USA USACASCOM USAR USAREUR USDA USR VA WARNO WESTCOM
wpn XO -
Unit Maintenance Collection Point
unit movement office(r)
United States (of America)
United States Army
United States Army Combined Arms Support Command
United States Army Reserve
United States Army, Europe
United States Department of Agriculture unit status report Virginia warning order Western Command weapon executive officer
Glossary-6
REFERENCES

AR 40-5. Preventive Medicine (This Item is Included on EM 0001). 15 October 1990 AR 40-66. Medical Record Administration and Health Care Documentation (This Item is Included on EM 0001). 3 May 1999 AR 190-13. The Army Physical Security Program (This Item is Included on EM 0001). 30 September 1993
AR 220-1. Unit Status Reporting (This Item is Included on EM 0001). 1 September 1997
AR 220-10. Preparation for Oversea Movement of Units (POM). 15 June 1973
AR 350-1. Army Training (This Item is Included on EM 0001). 1 August 1981
AR 350-41. Training in Units (This Item is Included on EM 0001). 19 March 1993 AR 380-5. Department of the Army Information Security Program (This Item is Included on EM 0001). 29 September 2000 AR 380-19. Information Systems Security (This Item is. Included on EM 0001). 27 February 1998 AR 380-19-1. (C) Control of Compromising Emanations (U). 17 September 1990 AR 380-40. (0) Policy for Safeguarding and Controlling Communications Security (COMSEC) Material (U). 30 June 2000 AR 530-1. Operations Security (OPSEC). 3 March 1995 AR 600-8-1. Army Casualty Operations/Assistance/Insurance. 20 October 1994 AR 600-8-2. Suspension of Favorable Personnel Actions (FLAGS) (This Item is Included on EM 0001). 30 October 1987 AR 600-8-19. Enlisted Promotions and Reductions (This Item is Included on EM 0001). 2 October 2000 AR 600-8-22. Military Awards (This Item is Included on EM 0001). 25 February 1995 AR 600-8-24. Officer Transfers and Discharges (This Item is Included on EM 0001). 21 July 1995 AR 600-8-104. Military Personnel Information Management/Records. 27 April 1992 AR 600-55. The Army Driver and Operator Standardization Program (Selection, Training, Testing, and Licensing). 31 December 1993 AR 700-84. Issue and Sale of Personal Clothing (This Item is included on EM 0001). 15 May 1983 AR 700-138. Army Logistics Readiness and Sustainability (This Item is Included on EM 0001). 16 September 1997 AR 710-2. Inventory Management Supply Policy Below the Wholesale Level (This Item is on EM 0001). 31 October 1997 AR 725-50. Requisition, Receipt, and Issue System (This Item is Included on EM 0001). 15 November 1995 AR 735-5. Policies and Procedures for Property Accountability (This Item is Included on EM 0001). 31 January 1998 AR 750-1. Army Material Maintenance Policy and Retail Maintenance Operations (This Item is Included on EM 0001). 1 August 1994 DA Form 2028. Recommended Changes to Publications and Blank Forms (This Item is Included on EM 0001). 1 February 1974 DA Form 2064. Document Register for Supply Actions. January 1982 DA Form 2401. Organization Control Record for Equipment. 1 April 1962 -ULLS DA Form 5982-E DA Form 2404. Equipment Inspection and Maintenance Worksheet (This Item is Included on EM 0001). 1 April 1979 -ULLS DA Form 5988-E DA Form 2405. Maintenance Report Register. 1 April 1962 DA Form 2407. Maintenance Request. July 1994
References-1
DA Form 2407-1. Maintenance Request Continuation Sheet. July 1994
DA Form 3318. Records of Demands - Title Insert. January 1982
DA Pamphlet 25-30. Consolidated Index of Army Publications and Blank Forms.
DA Pamphlet 350-38. Standards in Weapon Training (This Item is Included on EM 0001).

3 July 1997
DA Pamphlet 350-39. Standards in Weapons Training (Special Operations Forces) (This Item is Included on EM 0001). 3 July 1997 DA Pamphlet 385-1. Small Unit Safety Officer/NCO Guide. 22 September 1993 DA Pamphlet 710-2-1. Using Unit Supply System (Manual Procedures) (Standalone Pub) (This Item is on EM 0001). 31 December 1997 DA Pamphlet 710-2-2. Supply Support Activity Supply System: Manual Procedures.
30 September 1998
DA Pamphlet 738-750. Functional Users Manual for The Army Maintenance Management System (TAMMS) (This Item is Included on EM 0001). 1 August 1994 DA Pamphlet 750-1. Leader's Unit Level Maintenance Handbook (This Item is Included on EM 0001). 15 February 1994 DA Pamphlet 750-35. Guide for Motor Pool Operations (This Item is Included on EM 0001).
1 August 1994
DD Form 314. Preventive Maintenance Schedule and Record (This Item is Included on EM 0001). 1 December 1953 -ULLS DA Form 5986-E DD Form 565. Statement of Recognition of Deceased (EGA) (This Item is Included on EM 0001).
July 1998
DD Form 567. Record of Search and Recovery (EGA) (This Item is Included on EM 0001).
July 1998 DD Form 1380. US Field Medical Card. December 1991 DD Form 1970. Motor Equipment Utilization Record. 1 April 1981 -ULLS DA Form 5987-E DOD Directive 4500.9. Transportation and Traffic Management. 26 January 1989 DOD MFFIMS. Mortuary Affairs Users Guide. 18 March 1994 DOD Regulation 4500.9-R, Part III. Defense Transportation Regulation (Mobility). April 1997 DOD Regulation 5030.49-R. Customs Inspection. 27 May 1977 FM 3-3. Chemical and Biological Contamination Avoidance (FMFM 11-17). 16 November 1992 FM 3-4. NBC Protection (FMFM 11-9). 29 May 1992 FM 3-5. .NBC Decontamination (MCWP 3-37.3). 28 July 2000 FM 3-19.30. Physical Security. 8 January 2001 FM 3-100. Chemical Operations Principles and Fundamentals (MCWP 3-3.7.1). 8 May 1996 FM 3-100.4. Environmental Considerations in Military Operations. 15 June 2000 FM 4-30.3. Maintenance Operations and Procedures. 1 September 2000 FM 5-34. Engineer Field Data. 30 August 1999 FM 5-103. Survivability (This Item is Included on EM 0028). 10 June 1985 FM 5-170. Engineer Reconnaissance. 5 May 1998 FM 6-20. Fire Support in the Airland Battle. 17 May 1988 FM 6-22.5. Combat Stress (MCRP 6-11C; N7TP 1-15M). 23 June 2000 FM 7-8. Infantry Rifle Platoon and Squad (This Item is Included on EM 0028). 22 April 1992 FM 7-10. The Infantry Rifle Company. 14 December 1990 FM 7-20. The Infantry Battalion (This Item is Included on EM 0028). 6 April 1992 FM 8-10. Health Service Support in a Theater of Operations. 1 March 1991 FM 8-10-6. Medical Evacuation in a Theater of Operations, Tactics, Techniques, and Procedures.
• 14 April 2000
FM 8-10-7. Health Service Support in a Nuclear, Biological, and Chemical Environment.
22 April 1993
References-2
FM 8-55. Planning for Health Service Support. 9 September 1994 FM 8-285. Treatment of Chemical Agent Casualties and Conventional Military Chemical Injuries (This Item is Included on EM 0028). 22 December 1995 FM 9-43-2. Recovery and Battlefield Damage Assessment and Repair (FMFRP 4-34; TO 36-1-181). 3 October 1995
FM 10-15. Basic Doctrine Manual for Supply and Storage. 12 December 1990
FM 10-27-1. Tactics, Techniques, and Procedures for Quartermaster General Support Operations. 20 April 1993 FM 10-27-2. Tactics, Techniques and Procedures for Quartermaster Direct Support Supply and Field Service Operations. 18 June 1991 FM 10-27-3. Tactics, Techniques and Procedures for Quartermaster Headquarters Operations
30 October 1990
FM 10-27-4. .Organizational Supply and Services for Unit Leaders. 14 April 2000
FM 10-52. Water Supply in Theaters of Operation. 11 July 1990
FM 10-64. Mortuary Affairs Operations. 16 February 1999
FM 10-67. Petroleum Supply in Theaters of Operations. 16 February 1983
FM 10-67-1. Concepts and Equipment of Petroleum Operations. 2 April 1998
FM 10-115. Quartermaster Water Units. 15 February 1989
FM 11-32. Combat Net Radio Operations. 15 October 1990
FM 12-6. Personnel Doctrine. 9 September 1994
FM 19-4. Military Police Battlefield Circulation Control, Area Security, and Enemy Prisoners of War Operations. 7 May 1993 FM 19-40. Enemy Prisoners of War, Civilian Internees, and Detained Persons (This Item is Included on EM 0028). 27 February 1976
FM 20-3. Camouflage, Concealment, and Decoys. 30 August 1999
FM 21-10. Field Hygiene and Sanitation (This Item is Included on EM 0028). 21 June 2000
FM 21-10-1. Unit Field Sanitation Team. 11 October 1989 FM 21-11. First Aid For Soldier. 27 October 1988 FM 21-16. Unexploded Ordnance (UXO) Procedures (FMFM 13-8-1). 30 August 1994 FM 21-26. Map Reading and Land Navigation (This Item is Included on EM 0028). 7 May 1993 FM 21-75. Combat Skills Of The. Soldier (This Item is Included on EM 0028). 3 August 1984 FM 21-305. Manual For The Wheeled Vehicle Driver (AFMAN 24-306) (This Item is Included on
EM 0028). 27 August 1993 FM 22-51. Leader's Manual for Combat Stress Control (This Item is Included on EM 0028).
29 September 1994 FM 23-9. M16A1 Rifle and M16A2 Rifle Marksmanship. 3 July 1989 FM 24-16. Communications-Electronics Operations, Orders, Records, and Reports. 7 April 1978 FM 24-17. Tactical Records Traffic System (TRTS). 17 September 1991 FM 24-18. Tactical Single-Channel Radio Communications Techniques. 30 September 1987 FM 24-19. Radio Operator's Handbook (This Item is Included on EM 0028). 24 May 1991 FM 24-22. Communications - Electronics Management System (CEMS). 30 June 1977 FM 24-33. Communications Techniques: Electronic Counter-Countermeasures (This Item is
Included on EM 0028). 17 July 1990
FM 24-35. (0) Signal Operation Instructions "The SOI". 26 October 1990
FM 24-35-1. (0) Signal Supplemental Instructions. 2 October 1990
FM 25-4. How to Conduct Training Exercises (This Item is Included on EM 0028).

10 September 1984
FM 25-100. Training The Force (This Item is Included on EM 0028). 15 November 1988
FM 25-101. Battle Focused Training (This Item is Included on EM 0028). 30 September 1990
FM 34-54. Technical Intelligence. 30 January 1998

References-3
DODDOA-004131
FM 44-8. Combined Arms for the Air Defense. 1 June 1999
FM 44-80. Visual Aircraft Recognition. 30 September 1996
FM 44-100. U.S. Army Air and Missile Defense Operations. 15 June 2000
FM 55-9. Unit Air Movement Planning (This Item is Included on EM 0028). 5 April 1993
FM 55-10. Movement Control. 9 February 1999
FM 55-30. Army Motor Transport Units And Operations. 27 June 1997

FM 55-65. Strategic Deployment. 3 October 1995

FM 57-38. Pathfinder Operations (This Item is Included on EM 0028). 9 April 1993
FM 63-2. Division Support Command, Armored, Infantry, and Mechanized Infantry Divisions.

20 May 1991
FM 63-2-1. Division Support Command, Light Infantry, Airborne, and Air Assault Divisions.
16 November 1992 FM 63-20. Forward Support Battalion. 26 February 1990 FM 63-21. Main Support Battalion. 7 August 1990 FM 90-10. Military Operations on Urbanized Terrain (MOUT). 15 August 1979 FM 90-26. Airborne Operations (This Item is Included on EM 0028). 18 December 1990 FM 100-14. Risk Management. 23 April 1998 FM 100-17. Mobilization, Deployment, Redeployment, Demobilization (This Item is Included on EM 0028). 28 October 1992
FM 100-17-3. Reception, Staging, Onward Movement, and Integration. 17 March 1999
FM 101-5. Staff Organization and Operations. 31 May 1997
FM 101-5-1. Operational Terms and Graphics (MCRP 5-2A). 30 September 1997
Joint Publication 4-06. Joint Tactics, Techniques, And Procedures For Mortuary Affairs In Joint Operations. 28 August 1996 OF 346. US Government Motor Vehicle Operator's Identification Card. November 1985
-ULLS DA Form 5984-E. Operator's Permit Record STP 10-77F15-SM-TG. Soldier's Manual and Trainer's Guide, MOS 77F, Petroleum Supply Specialist, Skill Levels 1, 2, 3, 4, and 5. 8 May 1996 STP 10-92G25-SM-TG. Soldier's Manual and Trainer's Guide for Food Service Specialist MOS 92G-Skill Levels 2/3/4/5. 16 February 1999 STP 10-92Y1-SM. Soldier's Manual , MOS 92Y, Unit Supply Specialist. 23 February 1994 STP 10-92Y24-SM-TG. Soldier's Manual and Trainer's Guide for Unit Supply Specialist, MOS 92Y, Skill Levels 2, 3, and 4. 23 February 1994 STP 21-1-SMCT. Soldier's Manual of Common Tasks Skill Level 1. 1 October 1994 STP 21-24-SMCT. Soldier's Manual of Common Tasks (SMCT) Skill Level 2-4. 1 October 1992 STP 55-8811-MQS. Military Qualification Standards II, Transportation Corps (88), Company Grade Officer's Manual. 30 September 1991 STP 55-88M12-SM. Soldier's Manual, MOS 88M, Motor Transport Operator Skill Levels 1/2.
23 December 1993
STP 55-88M34-SM-TG. Soldier's Manual and Trainer's Guide MOS 88M, Motor Transport Operator (Skill Level 3/4). 23 December 1993 TB 55-46-1. Standard Characteristics (Dimensions, Weight, and Cube) for Transportability of Military Vehicles and Other Outsize/Overweight Equipment. 1 January 2001 TC 5-400. Unit Leaders Handbook for Environmental Stewardship. 29 September 1994 TC 24-20. Tactical Wire and Cable Techniques (This Item is Included on EM 0028).
3 October 1988
TC 25-1. Training Land. 25 June 2001
TC 25-6. Force-on-Force Collective Training Using the Tactical Engagement Simulation

Training System. 3 October 1995
References-4
TC 25-8. Training Ranges (This Item is Included on EM 0028). 25 February 1992 TC 25-20. A Leader's Guide to After Action Reviews. 30 September 1993
TM 5-5430-212-13&P. Operator, Organizational, and Direct Support Maintenance Manual for Tank, 5,000 Gallon Fabric, Collapsible, Potable Water, Semi-trailer Mounted. 15 September 1986
TM 5-5430-213-13&P. Operator, Unit and Direct Support Maintenance Manual for Tank, 3,000 Gallon Fabric, Collapsible, Potable Water, Semi-trailer Mounted.
27 October 1986
TM 9-2330-356-14. Operator's, Unit, Direct Support, and General Support Maintenance Manual for Semitrailer, Tank: 5,000 Gallon, Bulk Haul, Self-Load/Unload M967 and M967A1; Semitrailer, Tank: 5,000 Gallon Fuel Dispensing, Automotive M969 and M969A1; Semitrailer, Tank: 5,000 Gallon Fuel Dispensing, Under/Overwing Aircraft M970 and M970A1. 26 October 1990
TM 38-250. Packaging Hazardous Materials for Military Air Shipments (AFJM 24-204; NAVSUP Pub 505; MCO P4030.19G; DLAI 4145.3). 1 March 1997 TM 43-0002-33. Destruction of Conventional Ammunition and Improved Conventional Munitions (ICM) to Prevent Enemy Use (This Item is Included on EM 0162). 15 November 1993 TM 55-2200-001-12. Transportability Guidance for Application of Blocking, Bracing, and Tie-down Materials for Rail Transport (This Item is Included on EM 0130). 31 May 1978 TM 750-244-2. Procedures for Destruction of Electronics Materiel to Prevent Enemy Use (Electronics. Command). 14 March 1972 TM 750-244-3. Procedures for Destruction of Equipment to Prevent Enemy Use (Mobility Equipment Command). 23 September 1969. TM 750-244-6. Procedures for Destruction of Tank-Automotive Equipment to Prevent Enemy Use
(U.S. Army Tank-Automotive Command). 3 October 1972 TM 750-244-7. Procedures for Destruction of Equipment in Federal Supply Class 1000, 1005,
1010, 1015, 1020, 1025, 1030, 1055, 1090, and 1095 to Prevent Enemy Use. 18 June 1970 TRADOC Pamphlet 11-9. Blueprint of the Battlefield. 27 April 1990 TRADOC Pamphlet 525-6. Operations Security, Doctrinal Guidelines for Tactical Units and
Trainers. 1 May 1981
References-5
QUESTIONNAIRE MISSION TRAINING PLAN (MTP) USER FEED
User feedback is an important link in the process of improving training publications. Your recommendations are requested to improve this training publication. To make it easier to make recommendations, a standard questionnaire has been provided. Please answer all questions frankly and mail to Commander, USACASCOM, Training Directorate, ATTN: ATCL-AT, Fort Lee, VA
23801-6000.
DATE.MTP NUMBER. MTP TITLE.
THE FOLLOWING QUESTIONS PERTAIN TO YOU:
1.
What is your position (CO, Plt Sgt. etc.)? .

2.
How long have you served in this position? .

3.
How long have you served in this unit? .

4. What is your component?
5. What is your unit?. A. CONUS.B. USAREUR
C. WESTCOM.D. 8TH USA
E. Other (specify) .

THE FOLLOWING QUESTIONS ARE ABOUT THE MTP IN GENERAL:
6. How do you feel this document has affected training in your unit when compared to other training products?
A. Has made training worse. .
B. Has made training better. .
C. Has had no effect on training. .
D. Do not know or do not have an opinion. .
Questionnaire-1
DODDOA-004134
7. How easy is the document to use, compared to other training products?
A. More difficult. .
B. Easier. .
C. About the same. .
D. Do not know or do not have an opinion. .
8. What part of the MTP document was least useful?
A. Chapter 1, Unit Training. .
B. Chapter 2, Training Matrix. .
C. Chapter 3, Mission Outline. .
D. Chapter 4, Training Exercises. .
E. Chapter 5, Training and Evaluation Outlines. .
F. Chapter 6, External Evaluation. .
G. Do not know or do not have an opinion. .
Questionnaire-2
9. What part of the MTP document was most useful?
A. Chapter 1, Unit Training .
B. Chapter 2, Training Matrix. .
C. Chapter 3, Mission Outline. .
D. Chapter 4, Training Exercises. .
E. Chapter 5, Training and Evaluation Outlines. .
F. Chapter 6, External Evaluation. .
G. Do not know or do not have an opinion. .
10. What is the most difficult part of the MTP to understand?
A. Chapter 1, Unit Training. .
B. Chapter 2, Training Matrix. .
C. Chapter 3, Mission Outline. .
D. Chapter 4, Training Exercises. .
-
-
Questionnaire-3
E. Chapter 5, Training and Evaluation Outlines. .
F. Chapter 6, External Evaluation. .
G. Do not know or do not have an opinion. .
11. What is the easiest part of the MTP to understand?
A. Chapter 1, Unit Training. .
B. Chapter 2, Training Matrix. .
C. Chapter 3, Mission Outline. .
D. Chapter 4, Training Exercises. .
E. Chapter 5, Training and Evaluation Outlines. .
F. Chapter 6, External Evaluation. .
G. Do not know or do not have an opinion. .
Questionnaire-4
THE FOLLOWING QUESTIONS PERTAIN TO THE TRAINING EXERCISES: STX AND FTX.
12. The exercises are designed to prepare the unit to accomplish its wartime mission. In your opinion, how well do they fulfill this intended purpose?
A. They do not prepare the unit at all. .
B. They help but only provide 20 percent or less of my unit's training requirements.
C. They help but only provide 21 to 50 percent of my unit's training requirements.
D. They help but only provide 51 to 80 percent of my unit's training requirements.
E. They provide 81 percent or more of my unit's training requirements.
13.
Would you recommend that any STX or FTX be added or deleted from the MTP (specify FTX or STX)?

14.
What was the greatest problem you experienced with the exercises?

A. Too many pages. .
B. Hard to read and understand. .
Questionnaire-5
DODDOA-004138
C. Needs more illustrations. .
D. Needs more information on how to set up the exercises. .
E. Needs more information on leader training. .
F. Needs more information on how to conduct the exercises. .
G. Needs more information on support and resources. .
H. Needs more information on normally attached elements.
I. Does not interface well with other training products, such as battle drills. .
J. Do not know or do not have an opinion. .
Questionnaire-6
15. What was the second greatest problem you experienced with the exercises?
A. Too many pages. .
B. Hard to read and understand. .
C. Needs more illustrations. .
D. Needs more information on how to set up the exercises. .
E. Needs more information on leader training. .
F. Needs more information on how to conduct the exercises. .
G. Needs more information on support and resources. .
H. Needs more information on normally attached elements. .
I. Does not interface well with other training products. .
J. Do not know or do not have an opinion. .
16. How many STXs or FTXs have you trained personnel in or participated in personally?
Questionnaire-7
THE FOLLOWING QUESTIONS APPLY TO CHAPTERS 5 AND 6 OF THE MTP:
17. What changes would you make to Chapter 5, Training and Evaluation Outlines?
A. Leave it out. .
B. Clarify how to use this chapter with the training exercises. .
C. Clarify how to use this chapter without the training exercises. .
D. The standards are too detailed. .
E. The standards are not too detailed enough. .
F. The standards do not adequately address those elements that are normally attached in wartime.
G. Do not change; chapter is fine. .
H. Do not know or do not have an opinion. .
Questionnaire-8
18. What changes would you make to Chapter 6, External Evaluation?
A. Leave it out. .
B. Clarify how to use this chapter with the training exercises. .
C. Clarify how to use this chapter without the training exercises. .
D. The standards are too detailed. .
E. The standards are not detailed enough. .
F. The standards do not adequately address those elements that are normally attached in wartime. .
G. Do not change; chapter is fine. .
H. Do not know or do not have an opinion. .
19. Additional Comments. .
Questionnaire-9
Questionnaire-10
DODDOA-004143

ARTEP 55-718-30-MTP 2 FEBRUARY 2002
By Order of the Secretary of the Army:
ERIC K. SHINSEKI
General, United States Army Chief of Staff
Official:
F
JOEL B. HUDSON
Administrative Assistant to the Secretary of the Army
0203502
DISTRIBUTION:
Active Army, Army National Guard, and Army Reserve: To be distributed in accordance with the initial distribution number 121169, requirements for ARTEP 55-718-30-MTP.
DODDOA-004144

ARTEP 55-718-30-MTP SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
DODDOA-004145
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Process Enemy Prisoners of War (63-2-4304) (FM 19-40)
.
2.3.4.5.M.(circle)
ITERATION 1.
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT . T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: Threat soldiers are surrendering or being captured. The unit is supporting tactical operations. An EPW collection point has been established in the support area. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD, the unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. This task is performed under all day and night environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and all levels of threat forces attacks. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Unit evacuates EPW to the designated EPW holding area within the time
prescribed in the TSOP and/or higher- HQ directives. At MOPP4, EPW processing and evacuation
times increase significantly.
GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
*
1. Commander and leaders supervise EPW processing in the unit area.

a.
Disseminate designated EPW collection point(s) locations to
all sub-elements using analog and/or digital communications.

b.
Coordinate disposition of EPW with higher HQ staff element
before transporting to the rear using analog and/or digital
communications.

c.
Monitor processing procedures to ensure compliance with
the TSOP and current INTSUM.

2. Unit personnel search EPW.
a.
Remove all weapons and documents.

b.
Return personal items of no military intelligence value.

5-313
GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
c.
Provide EPW a receipt for personal items taken.

d.
Tag each EPW and each item removed with date/time group, location of capture, capturing unit, and circumstances of capture.

3. Unit personnel segregate EPW.
a.
Segregate EPW by rank, sex, deserters, civilians, nationality, and ideology, when possible.

b.
Treat EPW casualties. NOTE: See Task 63-2-4517 for detailed treatment procedures.

c.
Transport EPW casualties. NOTE: See Task 63-2-4316 for detailed transportation procedures.

d.
Report casualties to higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications.

4. Unit personnel silence EPW.
a.
Prevent EPW leaders from giving orders.

b.
Prevent communications between captured personnel.

c.
Conduct no conversations in front of EPW except to issue orders and maintain discipline.

5. Unit personnel transport EPW to the rear.
a.
Remove EPW from dangers of the immediate battle area.

b.
Prevent abuse of EPW by fellow soldiers or local populace.

c.
Transport EPW to the nearest collection point by vehicle.

NOTE: If transportation is unavailable and time and distance factors permit, march EPW to the nearest collection point; if EPWs are held, water and rations must be provided.
TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
ITERATION
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS
Task Number Task Title References
071-331-0820 Analyze Terrain STP 21-24-SMCT
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
5-315
DODDOA-004148
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters 3 Truck Platoon Headquarters 6 Truck Squads Maintenance Section 2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters 4 Light Truck Squads Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters Light Truck Squad Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Process Captured Documents and Equipment (63-2-4305) (FM 34-54
STP 21-24-SMCT)
ITERATION . 1.2.3.4 . (circle)
.

T.P.U.(circle)
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT
CONDITIONS: Threat equipment and documents have been captured. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD, the unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. The unit is supporting tactical operations.. This task is performed under all day and night environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and all levels of threat forces attacks. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Unit processes all captured documents and equipment IAW disposition instructions from the S2/S3 section and the Bn TSOP. At MOPP4, documents and equipment processing and disposition times increase.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
1. Commander and leaders supervise captured document and equipment processing.
a.
Disseminate to all subelements instructions and procedures for processing captured documents and equipment using analog and/or digital communications.

b.
Coordinate disposition of captured documents and equipment with S2/S3 using analog and/or digital communications.

c.
Coordinate with S2/3, Plans-Operations Branch for transportation of equipment to the rear using analog and/or digital communications.

d.
Monitor processing procedures to ensure compliance with the TSOP and Plans-Operations Branch guidance.

-
GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
2. Unit personnel report capture of documents or equipment to S3,
Plans-Operations Branch.

a.
Process reports on documents and equipment IAW FM 34-54
and the TSOP.

b.
Request disposition of captured documents and equipment
from the Plans-Operations Branch, S2/S3, and S4 section using analog
and/or digital communications.

c.
Tag all captured -documents and equipment before
evacuation..,...i

3. Unit executes approved disposition of captured documents and
equipment.

a.
Evacuates captured equipment IAW disposition instructions.

b.
Destroys the captured equipment (less medical) IAW
disposition instructions.

NOTE: If tactical situation does not permit equipment destruction or
evacuation, or other special instructions exist, abandon captured
equipment IAW disposition instructions.

c. Evacuates documents through Plan-Operations Branch to
intelligence personnel.

...
TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
5-317
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS
Task Number Task Title References
191-377-5250 Handle Enemy Personnel and Equipment STP 21-24-SMCT
191-379-4450 Supervise Handling of Enemy Personnel STP 21-24-SMCT
and Equipment at Unit Level
301-337-6001 Process Captured Materiel STP 21-24-SMCT

SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
DODDOA-004151
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Perform Field Sanitation Functions (63-2-4315) (FM 21-10, AR 40-5, FM 21-10-1, FM 3-100.4, FM 3-4, STP 21-24-SMCT)
.
2.3.4.5.M.(circle)
ITERATION 1.
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT .T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit is in the field without permanent sanitation or water facilities. Health hazards exist requiring field sanitation procedures to be employed. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD, the unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. A trained unit field sanitation team is assisting the commander in preventing any health threat. All required sanitation equipment is available. Field sanitation activities are continuous and are performed simultaneously with other operational tasks. This task is performed under all day and night environment conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and ground Level I threat forces attack. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Field sanitation measures are accomplished JAW the TSOP, OPORD, FM 21-10, and FM 21-10-1. FST performs field sanitation activities IAW the TSOP, commander's guidance, FM 21-10, and FM 21-10-1. At MOPP4, only minimal essential field sanitation activities are performed.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO *1. Commander directs field sanitation measures.
a.
Directs field sanitation activities to counter the health threat,
including actions such as the setting up of handwashing stations near
each latrine and ration handling area.

b.
Monitors field sanitation activities for compliance with
TSOP and FM 21-10.

c.
Enforces individual field sanitation measures.

d.
Requests assistance for health related problems from higher
HQ for problems that are beyond the expertise of the FST IAW TSOP,
OPORD, and CHS plan using the appropriate system.

5-319
ARTEP 55-718-30-MTP
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES e. Enforces safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications. GO NO GO
. f. Enforces environmental stewardship protection program procedures.
2. FST supervises unit field sanitation activities.
a. Maintains field sanitation basic load IAW AR 40-5 and FM 21-10-1.
b. Supervises distribution of field sanitation basic load items IAW AR 40-5 and FM 21-10-1.
c. Tests unit water supply for required chlorine residual IAW FM 21-10, FM 21-10-1, and TSOP.
d. Monitors personnel to ensure use of protective measures against arthropods (skin, repellent, bednet, clothing, and bednet repellent) and rodents IAW applicable directives and commander's guidance.
e. Monitors personnel for employment of correct hygiene measures such as handwashing.
f. Supervises installation of appropriate latrine facilities based on terrain and FM 21-10.
g. Inspects latrines and urinals IAW FM 21-10, FM 21-10-1, and TSOP.
h. Inspects latrines and urinals IAW FM 21-10-1 and TSOP.
i. Inspects liquid and solid waste disposal facilities to ensure compliance with FM 21-10, FM 21-10-1, and TSOP.
j. Inspects hand-washing devices IAW TSOP.
k. Inspects transport, storage, preparation, and service of food for compliance with FM 21-10, FM 21-10-1, and TSOP.
1. Provides advice, recommendations, and training requirements to the commander.
m. Enforces safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications.
n. Enforces environmental stewardship protection program procedures.
5-320
DODDOA-004153

-
GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
3. Unit elements employ field sanitation measures.
a.
Maintain prescribed load of water purification materials IAW
AR 40-5, FM 21-10-1, and TSOP.

b.
Prepare nonpotable water for personal use IAW FM 21-10
and TSOP..

c.
Consume only water designated as potable.

d.
Maintain latrines and hand washing facilities IAW FM 21-
10-1 and TSOP.

e.
Employ preventive measures against cold and heat injuries.

f.
Employ personal hygiene measures.

g.
Employ preventive measures against arthropod and rodent
infestation, to include using skin, clothing and bed net repellent.

h.
Report field sanitation deficiencies to FST.

i.
Employ safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications.

j.
Employ environmental stewardship protection program
procedures.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
5-321
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS

Task Number Task Title References
081-831-0102 Supervise Unit Preventive Medicine and STP 21-24-SMCT
Field Sanitation Procedures

SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
DODDOA-004155
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters 3 Truck Platoon Headquarters 6 Truck Squads Maintenance Section 2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters 4 Light Truck Squads Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters Light Truck Squad Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Transport Casualties (63-2-4316) (FM 8-10-6, FM 12-6, FM 21-11, FM 3-100.4, FM 3-4, FM 3-5, FM 57-38, FM 8-10-7, STP 21-1-SMCT, STP 21-24-SMCT)
.
ITERATION 1.2.3.4.5.M.(circle)
.
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: Unit personnel are wounded and some may be chemically contaminated. Threat force contact has been broken. Unit defenses have been reorganized. Some wounded EPW casualties may require evacuation. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD, the unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP.are available. Casualties must be evacuated from fighting positions to designated casualty collection points. All methods of transportation are employed. This task is performed simultaneously with other reorganization tasks. This task is performed under all day and night environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and all levels of threat forces attacks. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Casualties are transported as soon as tactical situation permits IAW TSOP, OPORD, the provisions of the Geneva Convention, and FM 8-10-6. At MOPP4, performance degradation factors increases the time required to evacuate casualties.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Unit commander and leaders supervise transportation of casualties.

a.
Identify casualty collection points using analog and/or digital
communications or messenger.

b.
Identify transportation requirements.

c.
Supervise preparation of casualties for transport.

d.
Coordinate transportation of casualties from unit area with
higher HQ staff element IAW TSOP and FM 8-10-6 using analog and/or
digital communications or messenger.

5-323
DODDOA-004156
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
e.
Coordinate security requirements for the pick-up site with subelements and higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

f.
Disseminate transportation information to unit personnel using analog and/or digital communications.

g.
Forward casualty feeder report and witness statements to higher HQ staff element IAW TSOP and FM 12-6 using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

2. Unit elements prepare casualties for transport.
a.
Treat casualties. NOTE: See Task 08-2-0003.63-0001 for detailed treatment procedures.

b.
Report casualties using analog and/or digital communications or messenger, as required.

c.
Collect classified documents such as SOI/SSI, maps, • overlays, and key lists.

d.
Secure custody of organizational equipment IAW the TSOP.

e.
Forward spot casualty reports to unit HQ IAW TSOP using analog and/or digital communications.

3. Unit elements transport casualties to casualty collection points using manual carries.
a.
Select type of manual carry appropriate to situation and injury.

b.
Transport casualty without causing further injury IAW FM 8-10-6.

4. Unit elements transport casualties to casualty collection points using litter carries.
a.
Identify litter team(s).

b.
Construct improvised litter from available material, as required.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES. GO NO GO
c.
Secure casualty on litter.

d.
Transport casualty without causing further injury IAW FM 8-10-6.

5. Unit elements transport casualties to a MTF using available vehicles.
a.
Load maximum number of casualties with the most seriously injured last IAW FM 8-10-6; this will allow a "last in, first out" • unloading procedure.

b.
Secure casualties in vehicle.

c.
Transport casualties without causing further injury IAW FM 8-10-6.

*6. Commander and leaders request aeromedical transportation, as needed.
a.
Transmit request JAW OPORD, TSOP, and FM 8-10-6 using analog and/or digital communications.

b.
Select landing site that provides sufficient space for helicopter hover, landing, and takeoff IAW FM 8-10-6 and FM 57-38.

c.
Supervise removal of all dangerous objects likely to be blown about prior to aircraft arrival.

d.
Supervise security of landing site IAW the TSOP.

7. Unit elements assist in loading ambulance.
a.
Employ proper carrying and loading techniques JAW FM 8­10-6.

b.
Load casualties in the sequence directed by crew.

c.
Load casualty without causing unnecessary discomfort.

d.
Employ safety procedures IAW the TSOP and FM 8-10-6.

e.
Employ environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

5-325
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES 8. Unit elements transport chemically contaminated casualties. GO NO GO
a. Assume MOPP4.
b. Mark contaminated casualties IAW the TSOP.
c. Notify supporting MTF that contaminated casualties are en route to their location using analog and/or digital communications.
d. Transport casualties directly to a designated decontamination and treatment station.
e. Protect casualty from further contamination during transport.
9. Unit personnel transport EPW casualties.
a. Maintain security of EPW casualties IAW the TSOP.
b. Search EPW casualties for weapons and ordnance prior to transport.
c. Transport EPW casualties LAW the provisions of the Geneva Convention agreements and the TSOP.
TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO" TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO" TOTAL
"*" indicates a leader task step.

SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS
Task Number Task Title References
031-503-1015 Protect Yourself From NBC STP 21-1-SMCT
Injury/Contamination With Mission-
Oriented Protective Posture (MOPP) Gear
081-831-0101 Request Medical Evacuation STP 21-24-SMCT
081-831-1040 Transport a Casualty Using a One-Man STP 21-1-SMCT
Carry
081-831-1041 Transport a Casualty Using a Two-Man STP 21-1-SMCT
Carry or an Improvised Litter
121-030-3534 Report Casualties STP 21-24-SMCT

SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE. OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
5-327
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters 3 Truck Platoon Headquarters 6 Truck Squads Maintenance Section 2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters 4 Light Truck Squads Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters Light Truck Squad Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Perform Risk Management Procedures (63-2-4326) (FM 100-14, DA PAM 385-1, FM 3-100.4)
.
ITERATION 1.2.3.4.5.M.(circle)
.
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit is deployed in a tactical environment supporting operations. Safety hazards for personnel and equipment exist. Hazards increase as operations intensify. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD, unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. This task is performed under all day and night environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and all levels of threat forces attacks. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Potential safety problems for tasks are identified and either reduced or eliminated. At MOPP4 performance degradation factors increase implementation time for risk management procedures.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO *1. Commander and leaders identify risk and or safety hazards.
a.
Maintain situational awareness using analog and/or digital
communications.

b.
Identify specified and implied missions and tasks in the
OPLAN, OPORD, and FRAGO using analog and/or digital
communications or messenger.

c.
Identify all risks associated with specified and implied
missions or tasks.

d.
Integrate safety into every phase of the planning process.

DOEM0A-004161
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
e.
Contrast the benefits of safety measures to the unit's mission versus the potential cost of risk or safety hazards

f.
Conduct continuous assessment of phases of operations for safety and risk reduction.

*2. Commander and leaders evaluate risk or safety hazards identified during operations.
a.
Identify previously executed unsafe acts and their corrective actions.

b.
Identify all unwarranted risks.

c.
Compare identified risk to acceptable risk level stated in the commander's intent and based on the training objective.

d.
Calculate projected equipment and personnel losses from accidents by reviewing historical records.

e.
Describe operations in terms of its risk level (extremely high, high, medium, low).

f.
Prepare courses of action that minimize accidental losses. *3. Commander and leaders eliminate or reduce risk and safety hazards.

a.
Select course of action that maximizes operational effectiveness and minimizes risks.

b.
Develop procedures that reduce risk.

c.
Provide guidance that enhances safety in all phases of operation.

d.
Prescribe safety and protective equipment that enhances safety and reduces risks.

e.
Enforce environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

5-329
DODDOA-004162
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES 4. Unit personnel employ safety enhancement procedures. a. Practice safety procedures during all mission rehearsals and operations. b. Correct unsafe acts on the spot. c. Report to unit safety officer risk or safety violations beyond unit's corrective level. GO NO GO
d. Employ environmental stewardship protection program.
TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO" TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO" TOTAL •
"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE

ELEMENT: Company Headquarters
TASK:.Provide Unit Supply Support (63-2-4515) (FM 10-27-4, AR 710-2, DA PAM 710-2-1, FM 10-27-2, FM 10-27-3, FM 3-100.4, STP 10-92Y1-SM, STP 10-92Y24-SM-TG)
.
ITERATION 1.2.3.4.5.M.(circle) .
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: Unit HQ is receiving requests for supplies from subordinate elements. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD, unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. Equipment and supplies are arriving through supply channels, but additional supplies are required. Extra small arms and ammunition are stored in the supply area. Supply support is a continuous task that is performed simultaneously with other support and operational tasks. This task is performed under all day and night environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and ground Level I threat forces attack. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Supplies, weapons, and ammunition requirements established by the TSOP and/or OPORD are on hand or coordinated for use, when needed. At MOPP4, unit supply support is reduced to minimum essential actions.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Commander directs unit supply operations.

a.
Inspects supply records and status to ensure compliance with
supply regulations, directives, and TSOP.

b.
Verifies ULLS-S4 input, records, and output for accuracy.

c.
Directs inventories of supplies and equipment to calculate
assets on hand by using ULLS-S4-generated hand receipts and
component of end item listings.

NOTE: The commander prepares for inventories by having the supply
sergeant access unit hand receipts and component listings from the
ULLS-S4 main menu and printing out required reports.

d.
Updates the ULLS-S4 database using the annotated
worksheets.

e.
Inspects unit equipment, weapons, and ammunition storage
areas for compliance with supply regulations, directives, and TSOP.

f.
Directs issue of supplies and equipment IAW higher HQ
guidance and/or TSOP sustainment controls.

5-331

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
g.
Forwards routine supply, weapons, and small arms ammunition requirements to higher HQ S4 section by inputting requests into ULLS-S4 and forwarding request data disks to the S4 section.

h.
Forwards emergency supply requests to the higher HQ S4 section using analog and/or digital communications and follow up with a supply request through ULLS-S4.

i.
Anticipates supply needs and requirements of the unit. *2. Supply Sergeant supervises unit 'supply activities.

a.
Verifies supply due-in status from the ULLS-S4 document register.

NOTE: The supply sergeant updates the ULLS-S4 document register regularly with status disks received from the SSA. The supply sergeant accesses the document register from the ULLS-S4 main menu to check statuses.
b.
Conducts inventories to calculate assets on hand using ULLS-S4 generated hand receipts and components of end-items listings.

c.
Develops supply storage plans.

d.
Monitors supply transactions to ensure compliance with established supply procedures.

e.
Supervises control of weapons and ammunition.

f.
Prepares input to Material Condition Status Reports maintained by the maintenance personnel by annotation of the ULLS-G generated equipment status sheets.

g.
Enforces safety procedures JAW TSOP and applicable publications.

h.
Enforces environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
3. Unit HQ requests additional supplies.
a.
Collects requirements from elements using analog and/or
digital communications or messenger.

b.
Calculates resupply requirements.

c.
'Records requests on the ULLS-S4 document register.

d.
Forwards resupply request to higher HQ S4 section using
analog and/or digital communications.

4. Supply personnel receive supplies.
a.
Compare supply quantities and stock numbers requisitioned
against quantities and stock numbers received.

b.
Update the ULLS-S4 document register with quantities and
date received, as well as any new status on partial shipments.

NOTE: Update document register by accessing it from the ULLS-S4
main menu and changing appropriate data fields.

c. Forward supplies to requesting element.
TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
5-333
ELEMENT: Company Headquarters
TASK:.Set Up Unit Headquarters and Bivouac Areas (63-2-4518) (DA PAM 385-1, FM 10-27-2, FM 10-27-3, FM 20-3, FM 21-10, FM 3-100.4, FM 3-4, STP 21-1-SMCT, STP 21-24-SMCT)
.
ITERATION 1.2.3.4.5.M.(circle) .
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit has been directed to move to a new location. The unit has analog and digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD, unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. Quartering party has escorted the unit HQ to the new site. New AO for unit HQ and bivouac areas have been selected in a field site or MOUT environment. Operating sites for unit administrative area, unit supply, and field sanitation have been selected. Quartering party has initially secured the area and established the CP. The layout plan is available. This task is performed under all day and night environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and ground Level I threat forces attack. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: The unit HQ and bivouac areas are set up IAW TSOP and/or layout plan within the prescribed time frame.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Commander/first sergeant direct set up of administrative and
bivouac areas.

a.
Revise layout plan based on current situation.

b.
Designate location of unit elements based on revised layout
plan.

c.
Coordinate the updated layout plan with higher HQ staff
personnel.

d.
Supervise the set-up of unit CP.

e.
Direct set up of bivouac area(s).

f.
Inspect setup to ensure it is IAW the layout plan.

g.
Enforce safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications.

h.
Enforce environmental stewardship protection program
procedures.

ARTEP 55-718-30-MTP
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES 2. Unit HQ personnel set-up the unit administrative area. GO NO GO
TSOP. a. Occupy positions required for local area security JAW unit
b. Position equipment and tentage according to layout plan.
c. devices. Establish unit communications net using analog and digital
d. Enter higher HQ communications nets IAW current communications instructions and TSOP.
points. e. Identify tentative mortuary affairs and EPW collection
f. Mark vehicle parking areas.
g. Mark traffic flow pattern.
h. Camouflage vehicles, shelters, and equipment.
i. Employ safety procedures JAW TSOP and publications.
j. Employ environmental stewardship protection program procedures IAW TC 5-400.
3. Unit HQ personnel set up the unit supply area.
a. Set up required shelters and equipment.
b. Secure weapons and ammunition.
c. Position supply vehicles.
d. Camouflage vehicles and equipment.
e. Employ safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications.
f. Employ environmental stewardship protection program procedures JAW TC 5-400.

5-335
DODDOA-004168
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
4. Unit personnel set up bivouac area.
a.
Locate area away from traffic flow and roadways.

b.
Mark sleep areas.

c.
Pitch individual tentage.

d.
Set-up commander's facilities.

e.
Camouflage all bivouac areas.

f.
Employ safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications.

g.
Employ environmental stewardship protection program procedures IAW TC 5-400.

5. Unit personnel set-up the field sanitation facilities.
a.
Construct latrine(s). . .

b.
Place screen or canvas around latrine(s).

c.
Construct handwashing device for each latrine.

d.
Set up unit water source.

e.
Employ safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications.

f.
Employ environmental stewardship protection program procedures IAW TC 5-400.

DODDOA-004169
GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
6. Commander/first sergeant coordinates internal logistics and CHS
requirements.

a. Coordinates field feeding location and schedule with
supporting unit.

NOTE: For unit without assigned field feeding assets.
b.
Coordinates for maintenance support with supporting unit.
NOTE: For units without assigned maintenance assets.

c.
Coordinates CHS with supporting medical element.
NOTE: For units without medical assets.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
M TOTAL
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"s" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS Task Number Task Title References
071-326-5705 Establish an Observation Post STP 21-24-SMCT 071-329-1019 Use a Map Overlay STP 21-24-SMCT
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
5-337
DODDOA-004170
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters 3 Truck Platoon Headquarters 6 Truck Squads Maintenance Section 2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters 4 Light Truck Squads Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters Light Truck Squad Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Perform Unit-Level Maintenance (63-2-4552) (FM 4-30.3, AR 220-1, AR 750-1, DA PAM 385-1, DA PAM 738-750, DA PAM 750-1, FM 100-14, FM 3-100.4)
.
1.2.3.4.5.M.(circle)
ITERATION
.

U.(circle)
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT T.P.
CONDITIONS: Maintenance areas have been established and unit maintenance personnel are receiving requests to repair or recover inoperative equipment. The unit has digital and analog communications with higher HQ and tactical operations are underway. All required maintenance equipment, tools, and personnel are available. The unit TSOP is on hand. Operators are performing PMCS. Requests for recovery support are being received. Some recovery operations must be performed under fire with injured operators still on board. Unit maintenance is a continuous task, performed simultaneously with other internal support and operational tasks. This task is performed under all day and night environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and ground Level I threat forces attack. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Maintain and recover unit and supported unit equipment according to the
appropriate TMs and TSOP. At MOPP4, performance degradation factors increase completion
times of maintenance activities.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Unit Maintenance Officer directs maintenance program.

a.
Monitors the company and supported unit maintenance
program for compliance with the TSOP and commander's guidance.

b.
Directs proper use of ULLS-G in support of maintenance
functions and activities.

c.
Identifies unit and supported unit operational readiness levels
by inspecting vehicles and equipment status reports.

d.
Identifies current or anticipated maintenance problems
through review and analysis of current reports and historical data.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
e.
Coordinates resolution of maintenance problems with battalion S4.

f.
Directs controlled exchange, IAW command guidance, when required repair parts are not available.

g.
Approves repairs using BDAR procedures.

h.
Prepares materiel condition status reports for input into ULLS-G system.

i.
Enforces safety procedures JAW TSOP and publications.

j.
Enforces environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

*2. Platoon sergeants and leaders supervise operator's maintenance.
a.
Supervise performance of PMCS.

b.
Monitor repair parts supply processes in order to better forecast the availability or nonavailability of equipment.

c.
Inspect vehicles, weapons, and equipment to ensure compliance with TMs, TSOP, and commander's guidance.

d.
Coordinate maintenance assistance with maintenance personnel.

e.
Maintain current maintenance status of all vehicles, weapons, and equipment.

f.
Provide input for materiel condition status reports.

g.
Enforce safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications.

h.
Enforce environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

3. Company personnel perform operator's maintenance.
a.
Perform PMCS on all vehicles and equipment according to the appropriate TM specifications.

b.
Notify supervisor of maintenance problems beyond operator's capabilities.

5-339
DODDOA-004172
GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
c.
Assist maintenance personnel with repairs and services.

d.
Request approval for BDAR from commander through appropriate NCO support channels and chain of command.

e.
Perform BDAR IAW FM 9-43-2.

f.
Employ safety procedures JAW TSOP and publications.

g.
Employ environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

*4. Senior Maintenance Supervisor supervises maintenanc..1. section.
a.
Verifies ULLS-G system operability and operator competency.

b.
Organizes unit maintenance personnel for an efficient workflow.

c.
Requests approval for BDAR from appropriate commander.

d.
Supervises BDAR procedures JAW TSOP and FM 9-43-2.

e.
Supervises TAMMS, PLL procedures for company and supported unit.

f.
Supervises recovery operations for company and supported unit.

g.
Coordinates maintenance status with company and supported unit platoon sergeants and 1 SGs.

h.
Requests controlled exchange approval from appropriate commander.

i.
Provides unit maintenance status to company and supported unit commanders.

j.
Enforces environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

k.
Enforces safety procedures LAW TSOP and publications.

5-340
DODDOA-004173
0

GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
5. Maintenance personnel repair organic and supported unit equipment.
a.
Verify fault diagnosis/category of maintenance.

b.
Request required repair parts.

c.
Repair equipment according to the applicable level TM specifications.

d.
Record completed work on appropriate document(s).

e.
Perform final inspection of completed work.

f.
Notify supervisor upon completion of repairs.

g.
Employ environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

h.
Employ safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications.

6. Maintenance personnel conduct transactions with support maintenance organization.
a.
Identify category of maintenance.

b.
Correct all unit-level maintenance deficiencies.

c.
Prepare required documentation according to the TM and TSOP.

d.
Evacuate equipment to supporting maintenance facilities.

e.
Pick up equipment upon completion of repairs.

f.
Employ safety procedures IAW TSOP and publications.

g.
Employ environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

7. Maintenance personnel react to battle damaged vehicle(s) (recoverable).
a.
Request direct and/or indirect supporting fire, if required.

b.
Move on a concealed route to the disabled vehicle(s).

5-341 ,. .
DODDOA-004174
GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
c.
Treat casualties according to the current treatment procedures.

d.
Remove casualties from the vehicle without causing further injuries.

e.
Request medical assistance, if required.

f.
Evacuate casualties according to medical evacuation procedures.

g.
Tow the vehicle to a concealed location, if required.

h.
Perform BDAR lAW FM 9-43-2.

i.
Repair vehicle if possible.

j.
Evacuate nonrepairable vehicle(s) to unit maintenance collection point(s).

k.
Employ safety procedures IAW TSOP and FM 9-43-2. •

1. Employ environmental stewardship protection program procedures.
8. Maintenance personnel react to battle-damaged vehicle(s) (unrecoverable).
a.
Request direct and/or indirect supporting fire if required.

b.
Move on a concealed route to disabled vehicle(s).

c.
Treat casualties according to the current treatment procedures.

d.
Remove casualties from the vehicle(s).

e.
Request medical assistance if required.

f.
Evacuate casualties according to the medical evacuation procedures.

g.
Perform BDAR LAW FM 9-43-2.

h.
Request disposition of unrecoverable vehicle(s) from appropriate commander.

GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
i.
Conduct salvage operations as directed by the appropriate commander or maintenance supervisor.

j.
Prepare vehicle(s) for destruction.

k.
Destroy vehicle(s) on order from the appropriate commander or designated representative.

1. Employ safety procedures JAW TSOP and publications. •
m. Employ environmental stewardship protection program procedures.
9. Maintenance personnel perforM maintenance administrative and support functions.
a.
Maintain company and supported unit's PLL.

b.
Request repair parts for the company and supported unit's organizational equipment.

c.
Control unserviceable repairable items.

d.
Maintain separate document register(s) for each company according to applicable directives.

e.
Maintain separate maintenance control records for the company and supported unit.

f.
Operate ULLS-G computer according to the appropriate ETM.

g.
Maintain publications, tools, and equipment.

h.
Maintain power generators.

i.
Employ safety procedures JAW TSOP and publications.

j.
Employ environmental stewardship protection program procedures.

5-343
TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
ITERATION 1
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS References
Task Number Task Title
551-721-1352 Perform Vehicle Preventive Maintenance STP 21-1-SMCT Checks and Services (PMCS)
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters 3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
TASK:.Provide Command and Control of Transportation Operations (55-2-0009) (FM 55-30. STP 55-8811-MQS, STP 55-88M12-SM, STP 55-88M34-SM-TG)
.
ITERATION 1.2.3.4.5.M.(circle) .
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: Tactical operations have begun.. The company headquarters operation section is receiving transportation commitments from higher HQ to provide truck transportation support. The unit commander assisted by the unit operation officer and truckmaster will provide command and control of transportation operations. The unit can conduct single, multiple, or a one-time lift for cargo or troops. The unit is equipped with MTS. The opposing force has NBC capability. SOP's, OPORD, and Movement Plan from higher HQ and unit commander are available. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Provide personnel and vehicles to accomplish the unit mission 1AW higher HQ and commander's guidance. As MOPP Level increases, performance degradation factors increase preparation time.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. The unit commander supervises activities of subordinate elements.

a.
Plans and directs transportation requirements through the
unit operation officer and truckmaster.

b.
Assigns specific mission related tasks to subordinate
elements.

c.
Monitors support plans to determine overall effectiveness.

d.
Monitors environmental stewardship protection program
procedures for compliance.

e.
Briefs higher HQ.

2. The operation officer/truckmaster manages transportation assets.
a.
Enforces safety procedures at all times.

b.
Forwards personnel and vehicle status report to higher HQ
staff element for use in allocating missions.

5-345
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
c.
Receives and screens commitments for special handling or oversize load data, security classifications, and complete information about when, where, and to whom the drivers should report.

d.
Identifies what type and quantity of cargo is to be moved to complete the mission.

e.
Identifies the length of time the vehicles are required.

f.
Coordinates back haul with higher HQ staff element for use in planning retrograde operations.

g.
Requests road clearance for convoys to ensure route accessibility.

h.
Coordinates for military police escort (if needed).

i.
Prepares OPORDs and strip maps.

j.
Reroutes task vehicle operator using MTS.

k.
Maintains operational data and fuel consumption report for use in determining current operating status.

1. Coordinates for troop support (Class I, fuel, maintenance, and so on).
m. Briefs unit commander.
3. The truckmaster/assistant truck master conducts operation meeting with key unit personnel.
a.
Briefs truck platoon sergeants on operators that have been rerouted through MTS.

b.
Coordinates with the platoon and maintenance sergeant for an updated status report for available drivers and vehicles.

c.
Assigns workloads and specific operational tasks to truck platoons.

d.
Provides OPORDs, strip maps/grid coordinates to truck platoons.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
4. The assistance truckmaster supervises dispatcher performing
dispatcher duties.

a.
Prepares motor equipment utilization record (DA Form
2401/ULLS DA Form 5982-E).

b.
Reviews vehicle preventive maintenance schedules and
records (DD Form 314/ULLS DA Form 5986-E).

c.
Reviews equipment inspection and maintenance worksheet
(DA Form 2404/ULLS DA Form 5988-E).

d.
Checks drivers US government motor vehicle operators
identification card (OF 346/DA Form 5984-E).

e.
Fills out, correctly, the motor equipment utilization record
(DA Form 2401/ULLS DA Form 5982-E).

f.
Inputs, correctly, and issues driver and vehicle information
on the motor equipment utilization record (DD Form 1970/ULLS DA
Form 5987-E).

g.
Maintains vehicle dispatch board or automated system.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
5-347
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS

Task Number Task Title References
551-721-1371 551-721-3355 551-721-4331 551-721-4334 Perform Dispatcher Duties Instruct the Use of Maps In Motor Transport Operations Prepare Truck Battalion Operation Order (OPORD) Conduct Motor Transport Company Operations STP 55-88M 12-SM STP 55-88M34-SM-TG STP 55-88M34-SM-TG STP 55-88M34-SM-TG

SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
ELEMENTS: 3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Supervise Truck Platoon Operations (55-2-0010) (FM 55-30, FM 24-35, FM 24-35-1, FM 3-3, FM 3-4, FM 3-5, FM 55-30, FM 90-10, STP 55-881I-MQS, STP 55-88M34-SM-TG) .
1.2.3.4.5.M.(circle)
ITERATION
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT .T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit is supporting tactical operations. The truck platoon has received commitments from the unit HQ operations section to provide truck transportation for unit distribution of supplies, equipment, and to transport troops. The platoon also has to furnish vehicles in support of higher HQ displacement. The platoon leader/sergeant must provide command, control, and technical guidance to platoon personnel performing motor transport operations. The platoon vehicles are equipped with MTS. The opposing forces have NBC capability. SOP's, OPORD, and Movement Plan from higher HQ and unit commander are available. Iterations of training on this task should be performed in various levels of MOPP. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Supervise truck platoon operations to provide transportation support IAW
higher HQ and commander's guidance. As MOPP Level increase, performance degradation factors
increase preparation time.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. The platoon leader/sergeant supervises truck platoon operations
(STP 55-88M34-SM-TG: 551-721-4334).

a.
Briefs squad leaders on risk management, safety, and platoon
requirements.

b.
Provides daily personnel and equipment status to the unit
headquarters.

c.
Coordinates with squad leaders to assign operators and
vehicles to fulfill platoon requirement.

d.
Supervises platoon operations to performance driver
maintenance through squad leaders.

5-349
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
e.
Controls weapons and ammunition to prevent pilferage and access by unauthorized personnel.

f.
Supervises platoon defensive positions to ensure adequate camouflage, dispersion, and concealment.

g.
Coordinates platoon activities with unit headquarters to keep them informed of current status.

2. The squad leader directs squad personnel and supervised vehicle preparation for commitments (STP 55-88M34-SM-TG: 551-721-3333/3334/3336/3349/3355; STP 55-88M12-SM: 551-721-1352/1355/1357).
a.
Briefs squad members and assigns operators with mission requirements.

b.
Provides drivers with OPORDs and strip maps/grid coordinates.

c.
Enforces safety procedures at all times.

d.
Supervises the performance of before-operations PMCS on vehicle.

e.
Reports to the platoon leader/sergeant those mechanical defects that are beyond the driver's ability to repair.

f.
Coordinates repair requirements with unit maintenance section on those items that are not repairable by operators.

g.
Supervises vehicle preparation for tactical operations.

h.
Ensures vehicles designated for recovery are equipped with tow-bars.

i.
Ensures the operators receive dispatch and MRE's prior to departure for commitments.

j.
Briefs platoon leader/sergeant.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
M
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS
Task Number Task Title References
01-7300.75-0500 Plan Convoy Operations STP 55-881I-MQS 551-721-1352 Perform Vehicle Preventive Maintenance STP 55-88M12-SM Checks and Services (PMCS) 551-721-1355 Prepare Vehicle for Inclement Weather STP 55-88M12-SM Operation
551-721-1357 Prepare Vehicle for Tactical Operations STP 55-88M12-SM 551-721-3333 Supervise Motor Pool Operations STP 55-88M34-SM-TG 551-721-3334 Supervise Preventive Maintenance Checks STP 55-88M34-SM-TG and Services 551-721-3336 Enforce Driver Safety Rules and STP 55-88M34-SM-TG Techniques 551-721-3341 Supervise Personnel Loading Equipment STP 55-88M34-SM-TG and Cargo Onto Vehicle and Semitrailer 551-721-3349 Supervise Preparation of Vehicle for STP 55-88M34-SM-TG Tactical Operations 551-721-3355 Instruct the Use of Maps in Motor STP 55-88M34-SM-TG Transport Operations 551-721-4322 Manage Preventive Maintenance Checks STP 55-88M34-SM-TG and Services 551-721-4334 Conduct Motor Transport Company STP 55-88M34-SM-TG Operations
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
5-351
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters 3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
TASK:.Maintain ITV, Redirect Operators, and Provide Commitments Using MTS (55-2-0016) (MTS User's Manual)
.
ITERATION 1.2.3.4.5.M.(circle)
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT . T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit is performing line haul and local haul missions to transport cargo, personnel, and equipment to a designated location. The unit operations section has received additional commitments to backhaul retrograde cargo and a message from battalion HQ stating that the receiving unit has relocated to a new area of operations. The operations section, using MTS, must now redirect operators to the new destination. The opposing force has NBC capability. SOP's, OPORD, and movement plan from higher HQ and unit commander are available. Iterations of training on this task should be performed in various levels of MOPP. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Compose and send a message to operators, using the MTS, redirecting vehicle operators to a new location IAW guidance from higher HQ and the unit commander. As MOPP level increases, performance degradation factors increase preparation time.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
1. The operations officer/truclanaster receives a message from higher
HQ to reroute vehicle operators (STP 55-88M34-SM-TG: 551-721-
3336; STP 55-88M 12-SM: 551-721-1386).

a.
Enters message into the message log.

b.
Informs the company commander of eminent changes in
routing drivers.

c.
Determines current location and informs operators, if
necessary, to halt and await further instructions.

d.
Reviews current intelligence and route reconnaissance data.

e.
Plots new route based on information contained in the
message received from higher HQ.

f.
Briefs company commander.

g.
Assists the commander in analyzing the unit's mission based
on current changes and future commitments.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
h.
Receives directives from the company commander concerning changes in support requirements.

i.
Coordinates additional support, as needed, due to change in mission.

2. The commander reviews the message and the new route.
a.
Receives briefing from operations officer/truckmaster.

b.
Determines effect of change in mission on current and future commitments.

c.
Reviews and approves new route.

d.
Notifies battalion operations if diversion of operators has negative impact on current or future commitments. •

e.
Determines additional support requirements to support change in mission based on input from the operations officer/truclanaster.

f.
Directs operations officer/truckmaster to coordinate needed support (for example, fuel, rations, -billeting, and so forth) to sustain health and welfare of drivers and ensure success of the mission.

g.
Briefs battalion operations officer concerning change in mission, effect on operation, and additional support requirements.

h.
Informs destination consignees newly calculated estimated arrival times.

3. The truckmaster conducts meeting with key personnel concerning changes in the mission.
a.
Provides key personnel with new destination, route, and ETA.

b.
Advises platoon leaders/sergeants of impact on current and future missions.

c.
Directs platoons to provide current information on availability of vehicles and drivers in order to support this and future missions.

5-353
GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
d.
Coordinates with the company maintenance section to
determine projected vehicle availability.

e.
Provides the company operations sergeant with the message
to be transmitted to the operators.

4. The operations sergeant supervises the MTS base station operator.
a.
Provides the MTS base station operator with the message to
transmit to the operators for redirecting and/or tasking operators with
additional commitments to backhaul retrograde cargo.

b.
Ensures that the message is correctly transmitted.

c.
Reviews message on screen to confirm that operators have
received message.

d.
Monitors ITV of operators and vehicles to ensure that
instructions are carried out.

e.
Provides vehicle and cargo visibility. •

f.
Briefs unit operations officer and truckmaster.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"11' indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS Task Number Task Title References
551-721-1386 Transport Passengers in a Truck STP 55-88M12-SM 551-721-3336 Enforce Driver Safety Rules and STP 55-88M34-SM-TG Techniques
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
DODDOA-004187
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS
TASK: GATHER INTELLIGENCE (63-OPFOR-1008)
CONDITION: Small OPFOR elements, operating in the rear area, are planning attacks on enemy bases. Information is needed to complete plans.
STANDARD: 1. Identify all PIR and other intelligence requirements. 2. Pass through any outpost, defensive wire, or warning devices undetected. 3. Move to an OP that offers cover and concealment and is close enough to gather PIR and other intelligence requirements. 4. Gather all PIR and other intelligence requirements. 5. Withdraw from area undetected. 6. Report all information to OPFOR HQ.
TASK: CONDUCT ELECTRONIC WARFARE (63-OPFOR-1012)
CONDITION: OPFOR employs a large number of radio detection finding sets, along with ground and airborne communications analysts, to monitor enemy forces for loose communications security practices.
STANDARD: 1. Locate the positions of enemy command, intelligence, and logistics radio nets. 2. Forward locations to OPFOR HQ. 3. Use jamming signals against enemy radio receivers. 4. Monitor enemy radio nets for intelligence information.
5-355
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
-
--
-
-
TASK:.Plan Unit Move (63 2-4001) (FM 55 30, FM 10014, FM 3100.4, FM 3 4,
STP 55-8811-MQS)
.
ITERATION 1.2.3.4.5.M.(circle)
.
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit receives a warning notice from higher HQ of a tentative relocation and must plan a unit move. More details are received prior to completion of this task. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD, the unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. Higher HQ staff element coordinates external support requirements. Tentative new areas forward and rear have been designated by higher HQ staff element in the contingency plans. Movement can occur in a field or MOUT environment. After movement analysis, the commander assembles key leaders who provide current personnel and equipment status reports. The TSOP with movement readiness levels and current loading plans are available. Higher HQ staff element issues maps with tentative locations. Situation changes may cause the unit to echelon its displacement. Support is required at the old site until the new site is operational. This task is performed under all day and night environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and ground Level I threat forces attack. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: The displacement plan is completed based on movement procedures and policies in the TSOP, warning order, and movement order. At MOPP4, performance degradation
factors increase planning completion time.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Commander conducts analysis of the movement.

a.
Identifies all specified and implied movement tasks in the
wanting notice.

b.
Identifies all documented relocation policies and procedures
required from the higher HQ TSOP and movement order, and the unit
TSOP.

c.
Lists all essential tasks required to relocate the unit in one or
more lifts.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
d.
Identifies all movement constraints that can be identified by hard copy or digital tactical map or a map reconnaissance of possible routes from old to new site.

e.
Issues warning notice to all the unit's subordinate elements using analog or digital communications or messenger.

f.
Applies risk management processes as an integrated feature of task performance.

2. Unit HQ coordinates for additional support requirements.
a.
Coordinates convoy marking equipment, vehicles, and other equipment requirements with higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications.

b.
Coordinates tactical information and security requirements with higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

c.
Coordinates CHS requirements with higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

3. Unit HQ prepares and briefs the stay-behind party plan.
a.
Coordinates stay-behind party requirements with higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications.

b.
Identifies stay-behind party leader and composition based on higher HQ staff element requirements.

c.
Identifies all operational limitations and security requirements in coordination with higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications.

d.
Designates assembly area location for stay-behind party that provides cover and concealment and does not interfere with departure of the main body from the area.

e.
Briefs stay-behind party leader on the commander's intent, operational and security requirements, communications, and site close-down procedures.

f.
Forwards location(s) of stay-behind facilities to higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

5-357
GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
*4. Commander and unit leaders prepare a displacement plan.
a.
Calculate unit's operational readiness level by using all
vehicle, equipment, and personnel status reports.

b.
Coordinate repair of inoperable vehicles and equipment and
repair time restrictions with the unit's or supporting maintenance
element.

c.
List sequentially all tasks required to-relocate the unit.

d.
List all equipment required to relocate the unit.

e.
Assign time limitations for the completion of each relocation
task.

f.
Adjust load plans to accommodate current operational
readiness levels.

g.
Designate personnel and equipment for advance/quartering
and reconnaissance parties.

h.
Assign all relocation tasks to specific elements.

i.
Designate uniform, weapons and equipment requirements for
road march.

j.
Designate the march commander to control unit elements
from SP to RP.

k.
Brief relocation plan to higher HQ staff element.

1. Brief all unit personnel on relocation plan.
m. Apply risk management processes as an integrated feature of
task performance.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
DODDOA-004191
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS Task Number Task Title References
--
01 7300.75 -0500 Plan Convoy Operations STP 558811MQS
-
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
5-359
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters 3 Truck Platoon Headquarters 6 Truck Squads Maintenance Section 2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters 4 Light Truck Squads Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters Light Truck Squad Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Plan Occupation of New Area of Operations (63-2-4007) (FM 101-5, AR 530-1, FM 10-27-1, FM 10-27-2, FM 21-26, FM 3-4, FM 55-30)
.
ITERATION 1.2.3.4.5.M.(circle) .
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit has received a warning order requiring movement to a new AO. Planning must begin immediately. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The unit TSOP and higher HQ TSOP are available. The higher HQ OPORD, with annex showing the location and proposed dimensions of the new higher HQ and unit area, is available. Reconnaissance information has been received from the higher HQ reconnaissance party and elements previously located in the general area. Tentative plans are subject to change by the advance/quartering party. Field expedient and natural shelters are available. Higher HQ analysis of the AO is available. This task is performed under all day and night environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and ground Level I threat forces attack. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Occupation plan is completed NLT advance/quartering party departure
and accommodates all unit activities and equipment LAW higher HQ and unit TSOP. At MOPP4, performance degradation factors increase planning completion time.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Commander and leaders verify suitability of new area.

a.
Verify space requirements for number and types of vehicles,
base facilities, and possible augmentations.

b.
Verify area's ability to support weight of vehicles,
equipment, and supplies in various types of weather using the analysis
of the AO.

c.
Inspect area for defensibility.

d.
Inspect area for adequate cover and concealment.

5360
-
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
e.
Verify buildings are located near access road and the areas around the buildings are large enough to meet traffic requirement (MOUT).

f.
Coordinate area limitations, constraints, and possible resolutions with higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications or messenger. •

*2. Commander and leaders formulate a tentative unit layout plan. •
a.
Identify general location of the unit CP.

b.
Identify area of all subelements, including tentative defensive boundaries.

c.
Develop traffic plan that identifies the traffic pattern and dismount point(s).

d.
Develop hasty security plan that identifies tentative guard posts and crew-served weapon positions.

e.
Develop communication plan depicting wire, analog, and/or digital communications diagrams for all subelements.

f.
Provide "runner" instructions until wire communications are operational.

g.
Coordinate tentative layout plan with higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

h.
Brief advance/quartering party on details of layout plan with adjustment options.

*3. Commander and leaders plan advance/quartering party activities.
a.
Identify required advance/quartering party tasks from the TSOP.

b.
Identify advance/quartering party vehicles and personnel constraints as established by higher HQ staff element.

c.
Identify time limitations for completion of advance/quartering party tasks.

d.
List essential advance/quartering party tasks.

5-361
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES e. List equipment required to perform essential tasks within vehicle constraints. GO NO GO
f. Brief advance/quartering party leader on area preparation tasks, available equipment, and possible options due to decreases in personnel or equipment failure.
TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK ITERATION 1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO" TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO" TOTAL
"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE

ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
Plan Unit Defense (63-2-4010) (FM 10-27-3, FM 10-27-2, FM 3-4, FM 7-10,
TASK:.
STP 21-24-SMCT)
.
(circle)
ITERATION 1.2.3.4.5.M.
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT . T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit's defensive area of responsibility has been assigned by a higher HQ staff element and defense of the area must be planned. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD, the unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. The unit commander has conducted a mounted or dismounted reconnaissance of the area. Selected personnel have occupied initial security positions. The unit layout plan is finalized. Automatic weapons are positioned on likely avenues of approach. The unit's administrative and operational areas are established simultaneously with its defensive set up. The detail and complexity of the defense is dependent upon the amount of time the unit is to be at this location. Field expedient and natural shelters are available. This task is performed in all day and night environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and all levels of threat forces attacks. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Defense plan is completed IAN the TSOP and higher HQ guidance and is integrated into the higher HQ defense plan. At MOPP4, performance degradation factors increase unit's planning times.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
1. Commander and leaders perform terrain analysis of unit's area of
responsibility.

a.
Maintain situational awareness using analog and/or digital
communications.

b.
Identify terrain features that provide cover and concealment
or other advantages to the threat force.

c.
Identify likely avenues of approach for mounted and
dismounted forces and threat aircraft.

d.
Identify probable dead space(s) in the unit's area.

5-363
GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
e.
Identify locations of preplanned indirect fire targets and target reference points in coordination with higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications.

f.
Identify locations of restrictive fire zones within or in the immediate vicinity of the unit's area of responsibility.

*2. Commander and leaders prepare preliminary base fire plan.
a.
List available weapon systems and element to which they are assigned.

b.
Calculate each element's personnel assets based on the availability of personnel during normal operations.

c.
Designate subelement boundaries that cover the entire unit area of responsibility based on the normal availability of weapons and personnel.

d.
List probable engagement areas based on terrain analysis of the area of responsibility and data provided by higher HQ staff element.

e.
Establish coordination channels with adjacent units to integrate interlocking fires.

f.
List target areas for each type weapon system in the unit.

g.
List indirect fire and CAS target reference points.

h.
Coordinate fire support coordination measures with higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications.

*3. Commander and leaders prepare preliminary mobility and countermobility plan.
a.
List locations of obstacles and types based on desired engagement areas, dead space, and preplanned indirect fire support using analog and/or digital communications.

b.
Identify available obstacle assets and resources for emplacement.

c.
Coordinate additional obstacle requirements with higher HQ
staff element using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
*4. Commander and leaders prepare preliminary air defense plan.
a.
Identify applicable air defense policies, procedures, and requirements in higher HQ and unit TSOP.

b.
List probable air avenues of approach.

c.
List current weapon control status as received from higher HQ staff element.

d.
Identify air defense warning signals.

e.
Designate locations for air watch positions. *5. Commander prepares reaction force plan.

a.
Lists base cluster reaction force requirements based on higher HQ TSOP or guidance.

b.
Lists internal reaction force requirements based on unit TSOP and personnel availability.

c.
Designates internal reaction force rally point.

d.
Lists subelements' taskings for external and internal reaction forces requirements.

*6. Commander prepares ground early-warning plan.
a.
Designates location for employment of PEWS based on terrain analysis.

b.
Designates location(s) for deliberate OPs and LPs. *7. Commander plans sector defense.

a.
Designates boundaries of subelements based on unit plan.

NOTE: Boundaries should be consistent with deployed weapon systems and personnel available to man the perimeter.
b. Designates crew-served automatic weapon positions with
fields of fire that cover most likely dismounted avenues of approach and
afford maximum cover and concealment.

5-365
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
c.
Designates anti-armor weapon positions, laterally and in depth, that cover most likely mounted avenues of approach and afford maximum cover and concealment.

d.
Assigns sectors of fire to crew-served weapons where their fires overlap, integrate, and mutually support beyond the point of hand grenade range (35 meters).

e.
Assigns armor kill zones for anti-armor weapons within the element.

f.
Assigns grenade launcher positions to cover dead space areas.

g.
Designates individual weapon positions where fires overlap and provide flank security for automatic weapons.

h.
Identifies indirect fire and CAS target reference points within the platoon's sector.

i.
Identifies locations and types of obstacles within the platoon's sector.

j.
Identifies locations of restrictive fire zones within the platoon's sector.

k.
Coordinates integration of interlocking fires with adjacent elements on the left and right.

*8. Section/squad leaders plan sector defense.
a.
Identify all primary positions within the section/squad's sector.

b.
Identify locations of obstacles, target reference points, and restrictive fire zones within the section/squad's defensive sector.

c.
Select alternate positions for each primary position that covers the same sector of fire as the primary position.

d.
Select individual alternate positions based on key weapon alternate positions.

e.
Select alternate positions that provide covered and concealed withdrawal routes.

GO NO GO
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
f. Select supplementary positions that are within 200 meters of
primary positions and are oriented in a different direction from primary
positions.

g.
Designate sectors of fire for each supplementary position that
interlock and provide mutual supporting fire.

h.
Coordinate integration of interlocking fires with adjacent
elements using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
ITERATION
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS
..
ReferencesTask Number Task Title
..
071-331-0820 Analyze Terrain STP 21-24-SMCT
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE

5-367
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters 3 Truck Platoon Headquarters 6 Truck Squads Maintenance Section 2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters 4 Light Truck Squads Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters Light Truck Squad Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Plan Area Damage Control Operations (63-2-4014) (FM 100-14, FM 21-10, FM 3-4, FM 3-5, FM 5-103, FM 63-2, FM 63-2-1, STP 21-24-SMCT)
.
2.3.4.5.M.(circle)
ITERATION 1.
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT . T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The commander has directed that a plan for area damage control be developed. The unit has analog and/or digital communications with higher HQ. The higher HQ OPORD, the unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. The CP, bivouac and operational areas, and perimeter defenses are set up. This plan covers potential damage caused by threat forces or the forces of nature. This task is performed in all day and night environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and all levels of threat forces attacks. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: ADC plan is completed IAW TSOP and OPORD within the time
prescribed by higher HQ staff element. At MOPP4, performance degradation factors increase
planning completion time.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
1. Unit HQ identifies ADC assets and probable requirements.
a.
Identifies static requirements and procedures by reviewing
higher HQ TSOP and OPORD.

b.
Coordinates ADC requirement changes with the higher HQ
staff element using and/or digital communications or messenger.

c.
Identifies on-hand equipment required for ADC operations as
prescribed by higher HQ TSOP.

d.
Identifies personnel available for ADC operations.

e.
Requests equipment to fill shortages through higher HQ staff
element using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES f. Coordinates resolution of equipment and personnel shortages with higher HQ staff element using analog and/or digital communications or messenger. GO NO GO
g. Tasks subelements for ADC personnel and vehicles based on higher HQ TSOP, current mission requirements, and personnel availability during normal operations.
*2. Element leaders provide support to unit ADC plan.
ADC. a. Identify element personnel and equipment to be used for
b. Forward a list of required personnel and equipment to the unit HQ using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.
3. Unit headquarters prepares ADC plan.
a. Organizes light rescue, decontamination, and other teams with equipment as prescribed by the TSOP and OPORD.
b. Identifies ADC priorities of all the CP facilities in coordination with higher HQ staff element.
c. Identifies locations of alternate operational or alert sites in coordination with higher HQ staff element.
d. Provides instructions on hardening support facilities.
e. Forwards ADC plan to the higher HQ for approval using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.
f. Disseminates ADC plan to all subelements upon approval using analog and/or digital communications or messenger.
TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK ITERATION I 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO" TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO" TOTAL
"*" indicates a leader task step.

5-369

SUPPORTING INDIVIDUAL TASKS Task Number Task Title References
031-507-3003 Supervise Hasty Decontamination STP 21-24-SMCT
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Maintain Communications (63-2-4017) (FM 11-32, AR 380-19, AR 530-1, FM 24-16, FM 24-18, FM 24-19, FM 24-22, FM 24-35, FM 24-35-1)
.
5.M.(circle)
ITERATION 1.2.3.4.
.

T.P.U.(circle)
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT
CONDITIONS: The unit must maintain analog and/or digital communications internally, with higher HQ and with other units on the battlefield. Communications equipment has been set up and the SOI/SSI is available. The higher HQ OPORD, the unit TSOP, and higher HQ TSOP are available. Support operations and unit internal operations are conducted by analog and digital communications, telephone, or messenger. Threat is conducting EW and is capable of locating stations with direction finding equipment. This task is performed under all day and night environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and all levels of threat forces attacks. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Unit provides uninterrupted 24-hour analog and/or digital communications through one or more external means. At MOPP4, performance degradation factors increase time required to maintain unit communication system.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES _ GO NO GO
1. Unit HQ operates the unit NCS.
a.
Opens analog and/or digital nets IAW current SOI/SSI.

b.
Challenges all analog and/or digital stations in net as
required by the SOI/SSI.

c.
Controls entry and departure of all stations.

d.
Monitors the net for operability and connectivity of digital
devices.

e.
Reports loss and/or operating difficulties of any analog or
digital station to the chain of command and higher HQ communications
element.

5-371
DODDOA-004204
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
f.
Enforces station and net restrictions.

g.
Monitors the net to detect errors in operating procedures.

h.
Corrects all errors in net operating procedures.

i.
Enforces station listening silence as prescribed by or commander's directive.

j.
Lifts radio listening silence as prescribed by OPORD or commander's directive.

k.
Completes transition to extend range of radio station within 15 minutes, if required.

1. Remotes radio station at least one kilometer, if required.
m.
Directs change to alternate frequency when compromise of primary frequency is suspected.

n.
Closes net JAW the SOUSSI.

2. Operators transmit and receive messages.
a.
Process messages by precedence, date/time group, and IAW the TSOP.

b.
Process incoming messages without errors.

c.
Forward incoming messages to appropriate element/section.

d.
Check outgoing messages for completeness and readability.

e.
Employ approved radiotelephone procedures.

f.
Transmit messages LAW precedence, correct format, and prescribed text.

g.
Employ approved codes and brevity lists when transmitting the names of persons, places, and sensitive information.

h.
Encode all grid coordinates using the current SOUSSI.

i.
Decode all grid coordinates using the current SOUSSI.

TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
j.
Transmit radio messages for no longer than 20 seconds.

k.
Employ lowest operational power setting consistent with operations requirements.

1. Maintain station log.
m.
Troubleshoot radio set as necessary and within operator's capability.

n.
Correct faults (within operator's capability).

o.
Report uncorrectable faults to higher HQ S6 for resolution.

3. Unit operators maintain digital and/or analog communications.
a.
Maintain digital and/or analog communications between the unit CP and all sub-elements.

b.
Maintain digital and/or analog communications with higher HQ and all supported unit elements using analog and/or digital communications.

c.
Notify higher HQ S6 when digital and/or analog communications are partially or completely inoperative.

4. Unit personnel maintain land line communications.
a.
Maintain wire communications between the unit CP and all subelements.

b.
Maintain a hot loop between the unit CP and sub-elements, if switchboard is not available.

c.
Establish messenger runners when land communications are inoperative.

5. Radio operators implement FM remedial ECCM.
a.
Identify if source of interference is internal or external by disconnecting the radio antenna.

b.
Continue to operate in an attempt to communicate through the jamming.

5-373
. GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
c.
Switch to high power on radio transmitter.

d.
Advise distant station to switch to high power.

e.
Relocate radio set (mobile units) to take advantage of terrain features to reduce the effects of jamming.

f.
Relocate the antenna to take advantage of terrain features to reduce the effects of jamming.

g.
Submit initial MITI Feeder Voice Template Report to higher HQ communications branch.

h.
Reroute message traffic using alternate means of communications, such as relay (through another station), AM, or wire.

i.
Request (using alternate means) that the net change to a backup frequency.

6. Radio operators implement AM remedial ECCM.
a.
Identify if source of interference is internal or external by disconnecting the radio antenna.

b.
Continue to operate in an attempt to communicate through the jamming.

c.
Check for intentional or unintentional interference.

d.
Check equipment grounding.

e.
Use radio frequency gain/frequency vernier in an attempt to work through the jamming.

f.
Relocate radio set (mobile units) to take advantage of terrain features to reduce the effects of jamming.

g.
Relocate the antenna to take advantage of terrain features to reduce the effects of jamming.

h.
Submit initial MITI Feeder Voice Template Report to assigned or supporting higher HQ communications personnel or element.

GO NO GOTASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES
i.
Reroute message traffic using alternate means of
communications, such as relay (through another station), FM, or wire.

j.
Request (using alternate means) that the net change to a
backup frequency.

7. Unit headquarters maintains generator power.
a.
Operates generators IAW appropriate TMs.

b.
Constructs sound barrier and screening system to muffle
noise and minimize heat signature.

c.
Constructs a fuel storage and fire control point for all
generators with fire extinguishers as prescribed by the TSOP and
commander's guidance.

8. Unit personnel employ SIGSEC measures.
a.
Employ COMSEC measures to deny friendly
telecommunication information to the enemy.

b.
Employ ELSEC measures to protect electromagnetic
transmissions, other than communication devices, from threat detection.

c.
Evaluate TEMPEST controls to identify emanation
vulnerabilities and implement countermeasures.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
ITERATION
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"*" indicates a leader task step.
SUPPORTING COLLECTIVE TASKS: NONE

5-375
DODDOA-004208
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS
TASK: CONDUCT ELECTRONIC WARFARE (63-OPFOR-1012)
CONDITION: OPFOR employs a large number of radi6 detection finding sets, along with ground and airborne communications analysts, to monitor enemy forces for loose communications security practices.
STANDARD: 1. Locate the positions of enemy command, intelligence, and logistics radio nets. Forward locations to OPFOR HQ. 3. Use jamming signals against enemy radio receivers. 4. Monitor enemy radio nets for intelligence information.
-
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Light Truck Squad
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Establish Communications (63-2-4040) (FM 24-16, AR 380-40, AR 530-1, FM 10-27-2, FM 10-27-3, FM 11-32, FM 24-17, FM 24-18, FM 24-19, FM 24-22, FM 24-33, FM 24-35, FM 24-35-1, TC 24-20)
.
2.3.4.5.M.(circle)
ITERATION 1.
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT . T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: Unit communications personnel have received the mission to accompany the advance/quartering party to a new site and establish analog and/or digital communications. TSOPs, OPORDs, and other required publications and documents are available. The unit advance/ quartering party has arrived at the new site and secured the area. The unit communication plan is available. Equipment and personnel are available. The advance/quartering party has established initial communications. Message service is being provided on a 24-hour basis. This task is performed under all day and night environmental conditions. The unit is subject to air, NBC, and ground Level I threat forces attack. Some iterations of this task should be performed in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: Analog and/or digital communications and generator power are
established IAW the communication plan, OPORD, SOI/SSI, and TSOP. At MOPP4 performance
degradation factors increase time required to establish communications.
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
1. Commander/1SG organizes communications element of the
advance/quartering party.

a.
Selects personnel to perform all communication set-up tasks
at new location.

b.
Selects required vehicles and equipment to establish
communications at the new site IAW movement order or TSOP.

c.
Inspects personnel, weapons, MOPP gear, vehicles, and
equipment for departure for compliance with TSOP and commander's
guidance.

d.
Dispatches communications element to assembly area for
departure.

5-377
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES 2. Advance/Quartering Party establishes wire communications. GO NO GO
a. Identifies locations of all subordinate platoons/sections.
b. Plans wire and telephone installation.
c. Prepares a telephone traffic diagram.
d. Installs telephone switchboard.
e. Lays wire for communications between switchboard and other platoons/sections.
f. Establishes wire communications between HQ and switchboard.
3. Company HQ supervises company analog and/or digital communication nets.
a. Functions as company net control station.
b. Manages communications security for the company.
c. Establishes alternate means of communications to include analog and/or digital communications and messenger with higher, lower and adjacent units.
d. Ensures unit personnel practice COMSEC/ELSEC procedures. •
4. Platoon Headquarters supervises platoon analog and/or digital communication nets.
a. Functions as Platoon net control station.
b. Manages communications security for the platoon.
c. Establish alternate means of communications to include analog and/or digital communications and messenger with higher, lower and supported units.

TASK PERFORMANCE/EVALUATION SUMMARY BLOCK
1 2 3 4 5 M TOTAL
ITERATION
TOTAL TASK STEPS EVALUATED
TOTAL TASK STEPS "GO"
TRAINING STATUS "GO/NO GO"

"s" indicates a leader task step.
OPFOR TASKS AND STANDARDS: NONE
5-379
ELEMENTS: Company Headquarters
3 Truck Platoon Headquarters
6 Truck Squads
Maintenance Section
2 Light Truck Platoon Headquarters
4 Light Truck Squads
Light and Medium Truck Platoon Headquarters
Medium Truck Squad
TASK:.Plan Unit Mobilization in a Peacetime Environment (63-2-4827) (FM 100-17, AR 220-1, AR 220-10, AR 350-41, AR 710-2, FM 4-30.3)
.
(circle)
ITERATION 2.3.4.5.M.
COMMANDER/LEADER ASSESSMENT . T.P.U.(circle)
CONDITIONS: The unit is operating in a normal peacetime environment at a normal state of readiness. The unit has a wartime mission with a corresponding OPLAN on file. Unit is conducting its operational mission and METL training. The unit MOBPLAN, movement plan, recall plan, security plan, unit access rosters, and current maps are available. The unit is deploying as part of a higher echelon deployment. Training requirements identified during this task are performed in the task (Perform Predeployment Training Activities). Peacetime deployment planning activities are performed under all day or night environmental conditions, except NBC. This task should not be trained in MOPP4.
TASK STANDARDS: MOBPLAN (RC), movement plan, and RSOP are completed lAW
governing regulations and higher HQ directions.
NOTE: MOBPLANs are required only for RC units. RC-specific task steps and performance
measures are annotated "RC".
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES GO NO GO
*
I. Commander analyzes mission.

a.
Identifies tasks in the OPLAN/CONPLAN.

b.
Identifies documented deployment policies and procedures
from the RSOP MOBPLAN (RC) and movement plan.

c.
Updates unit METL to reflect current mission.

d.
Verifies mission parameters and details with higher HQ.

e.
Briefs unit leaders on deployment and mission requirements.

ARTEP 55-718-30-MTP
TASK STEPS AND PERFORMANCE MEASURES *2. Commander directs deployment planning. GO NO GO
a. Directs Mobilization Officer to update MOBPLAN (RC) based on current mission guidance.
b. Directs UMO to update the unit movement plan based on current mission guidance.
c. Verifies UMO and alternate UMO are on orders and trained. •
d. Directs unit leaders to update unit RSOP.
e. Directs unit leaders to update unit battle book, to include the unit missions, organization, locations of mobilization station and ports, and extracts from the applicable OPLANs.
f. Coordinates mission parameters and details with higher HQ.
g. Identifies deployment training requirements.
h. Validates MOBPLAN (RC).
*3. Mobilization Officer updates MOBPLAN (RC).
NOTE: MOBPLAN is updated annually or whenever a change occurs in unit mission or structure.
a. Revalidates support agreements.
b. Updates. annexes.
c. Validates unit retrieval plan.
*4. UMO updates unit movement plan.
NOTE: The unit movement plan is updated annually or whenever a change occurs in unit mission or structure.
a. Identifies the administrative, logistics and coordinating requirements for the plan.
b. Verifies load plans are current and entered into the AUEL.
c. Updates DEL(s) based on current mission(s).

5-381

Doc_nid: 
2607
Doc_type_num: 
75